Gek 113386B
Gek 113386B
Gek 113386B
GE
Grid Solutions
833711A2.CDR
E83849
S T ER
GI
ED
RE
E
IN
*1601-0108-W3*
Copyright © 2019 GE Multilin Inc. All rights reserved.
M60 Motor Protection System UR Series Instruction Manual revision 5.9x.
FlexLogic, FlexElement, FlexCurve, FlexAnalog, FlexInteger, FlexState, EnerVista,
CyberSentry, HardFiber, Multilin, and GE Multilin are trademarks or registered
trademarks of GE Multilin Inc.
The contents of this manual are the property of GE Multilin Inc. This
documentation is furnished on license and may not be reproduced in whole or
in part without the permission of GE Multilin. The content of this manual is for
informational use only and is subject to change without notice.
Part number: 1601-0108-W3 (April 2019)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
3.2 WIRING
3.2.1 TYPICAL WIRING ............................................................................................3-12
3.2.2 DIELECTRIC STRENGTH................................................................................3-14
3.2.3 CONTROL POWER..........................................................................................3-14
3.2.4 CT/VT MODULES.............................................................................................3-15
3.2.5 PROCESS BUS MODULES .............................................................................3-17
3.2.6 CONTACT INPUTS AND OUTPUTS................................................................3-17
3.2.7 TRANSDUCER INPUTS/OUTPUTS.................................................................3-29
3.2.8 RS232 FACEPLATE PORT ..............................................................................3-31
3.2.9 CPU COMMUNICATION PORTS.....................................................................3-31
3.2.10 IRIG-B ...............................................................................................................3-34
3.3 DIRECT INPUT/OUTPUT COMMUNICATIONS
3.3.1 DESCRIPTION .................................................................................................3-36
3.3.2 FIBER: LED AND ELED TRANSMITTERS ......................................................3-39
3.3.3 FIBER-LASER TRANSMITTERS .....................................................................3-39
3.3.4 G.703 INTERFACE...........................................................................................3-39
3.3.5 RS422 INTERFACE .........................................................................................3-43
3.3.6 RS422 AND FIBER INTERFACE .....................................................................3-45
3.3.7 G.703 AND FIBER INTERFACE ......................................................................3-46
3.3.8 IEEE C37.94 INTERFACE................................................................................3-46
3.3.9 C37.94SM INTERFACE ...................................................................................3-49
3.4 MANAGED ETHERNET SWITCH MODULES
3.4.1 OVERVIEW ......................................................................................................3-52
3.4.2 MANAGED ETHERNET SWITCH MODULE HARDWARE..............................3-52
3.4.3 MANAGED SWITCH LED INDICATORS .........................................................3-53
3.4.4 INITIAL SETUP OF THE ETHERNET SWITCH MODULE...............................3-53
3.4.5 CONFIGURING THE MANAGED ETHERNET SWITCH MODULE .................3-57
3.4.6 UPLOADING M60 SWITCH MODULE FIRMWARE.........................................3-60
3.4.7 ETHERNET SWITCH SELF-TEST ERRORS...................................................3-62
INDEX
EN Battery Disposal
This product contains a battery that cannot be disposed of as unsorted municipal waste in the European Union. See the product
documentation for specific battery information. The battery is marked with this symbol, which may include lettering to indicate cadmium
(Cd), lead (Pb), or mercury (Hg). For proper recycling return the battery to your supplier or to a designated collection point. For more
information see: www.recyclethis.info.
CS Nakládání s bateriemi
Tento produkt obsahuje baterie, které nemohou být zneškodněny v Evropské unii jako netříděný komunální odpadu. Viz dokumentace k
produktu pro informace pro konkrétní baterie. Baterie je označena tímto symbolem, který může zahrnovat i uvedena písmena, kadmium
(Cd), olovo (Pb), nebo rtuť (Hg). Pro správnou recyklaci baterií vraťte svémudodavateli nebo na určeném sběrném místě. Pro více informací
viz: www.recyclethis.info.
DA Batteri affald
Dette produkt indeholder et batteri som ikke kan bortskaffes sammen med almindeligt husholdningsaffald i Europa. Se
produktinformation for specifikke informationer om batteriet. Batteriet er forsynet med indgraveret symboler for hvad batteriet
indeholder: kadmium (Cd), bly (Pb) og kviksølv (Hg). Europæiske brugere af elektrisk udstyr skal aflevere kasserede produkter til genbrug
eller til leverandøren. Yderligere oplysninger findes på webstedet www.recyclethis.info.
DE Entsorgung von Batterien
Dieses Produkt beinhaltet eine Batterie, die nicht als unsortierter städtischer Abfall in der europäischen Union entsorgt werden darf.
Beachten Sie die spezifischen Batterie-informationen in der Produktdokumentation. Die Batterie ist mit diesem Symbol gekennzeichnet,
welches auch Hinweise auf möglicherweise enthaltene Stoffe wie Kadmium (Cd), Blei (Pb) oder Quecksilber (Hektogramm) darstellt. Für
die korrekte Wiederverwertung bringen Sie diese Batterie zu Ihrem lokalen Lieferanten zurück oder entsorgen Sie das Produkt an den
gekennzeichneten Sammelstellen. Weitere Informationen hierzu finden Sie auf der folgenden Website: www.recyclethis.info.
EL Απόρριψη μπαταριών
Αυτό το προϊόν περιέχει μια μπαταρία που δεν πρέπει να απορρίπτεται σε δημόσια συστήματα απόρριψης στην Ευρωπαϊκή
Κοινότητα. ∆είτε την τεκμηρίωση του προϊόντος για συγκεκριμένες πληροφορίες που αφορούν τη μπαταρία. Η μπαταρία είναι φέρει
σήμανση με αυτό το σύμβολο, το οποίο μπορεί να περιλαμβάνει γράμματα για να δηλώσουν το κάδμιο (Cd), τον μόλυβδο (Pb), ή τον
υδράργυρο (Hg). Για την κατάλληλη ανακύκλωση επιστρέψτε την μπαταρία στον προμηθευτή σας ή σε καθορισμένο σημείο συλλογής.
Για περισσότερες πληροφορίες δείτε: www.recyclethis.info.
ES Eliminacion de baterias
Este producto contiene una batería que no se pueda eliminar como basura normal sin clasificar en la Unión Europea. Examine la
documentación del producto para la información específica de la batería. La batería se marca con este símbolo, que puede incluir siglas
para indicar el cadmio (Cd), el plomo (Pb), o el mercurio (Hg ). Para el reciclaje apropiado, devuelva este producto a su distribuidor ó
deshágase de él en los puntos de reciclaje designados. Para mas información : wwwrecyclethis.info.
ET Patareide kõrvaldamine
Käesolev toode sisaldab patareisid, mida Euroopa Liidus ei tohi kõrvaldada sorteerimata olmejäätmetena. Andmeid patareide kohta
vaadake toote dokumentatsioonist. Patareid on märgistatud käesoleva sümboliga, millel võib olla kaadmiumi (Cd), pliid (Pb) või
elavhõbedat (Hg) tähistavad tähed. Nõuetekohaseks ringlusse võtmiseks tagastage patarei tarnijale või kindlaksmääratud
vastuvõtupunkti. Lisainformatsiooni saab Internetist aadressil: www.recyclethis.info.
FI Paristoje ja akkujen hävittäminen
Tuote sisältää pariston, jota ei saa hävittää Euroopan Unionin alueella talousjätteen mukana. Tarkista tuoteselosteesta tuotteen tiedot.
Paristo on merkitty tällä symbolilla ja saattaa sisältää cadmiumia (Cd), lyijyä (Pb) tai elohopeaa (Hg). Oikean kierrätystavan
varmistamiseksi palauta tuote paikalliselle jälleenmyyjälle tai palauta se paristojen keräyspisteeseen. Lisätietoja sivuilla
www.recyclethis.info.
FR Élimination des piles
Ce produit contient une batterie qui ne peuvent être éliminés comme déchets municipaux non triés dans l'Union européenne. Voir la
documentation du produit au niveau des renseignements sur la pile. La batterie est marqué de ce symbole, qui comprennent les
indications cadmium (Cd), plomb (Pb), ou mercure (Hg). Pour le recyclage, retourner la batterie à votre fournisseur ou à un point de
collecte. Pour plus d'informations, voir: www.recyclethis.info.
HU Akkumulátor hulladék kezelése
Ezen termék akkumulátort tartalmaz, amely az Európai Unión belül csak a kijelölt módon és helyen dobható ki. A terméken illetve a
mellékelt ismertetőn olvasható a kadmium (Cd), ólom (Pb) vagy higany (Hg) tartalomra utaló betűjelzés. A hulladék akkumulátor leadható
a termék forgalmazójánál új akkumulátor vásárlásakor, vagy a kijelölt elektronikai hulladékudvarokban. További információ a
www.recyclethis.info oldalon.
IT Smaltimento batterie
0 Questo prodotto contiene una batteria che non può essere smaltita nei comuni contenitori per lo smaltimento rifiuti, nell' Unione
Europea. Controllate la documentazione del prodotto per le informazioni specifiche sulla batteria. La batteria è contrassegnata con
questo simbolo e può includere alcuni caratteri ad indicare la presenza di cadmio (Cd), piombo (Pb) oppure mercurio (Hg). Per il corretto
smaltimento, potete restituirli al vostro fornitore locale, oppure rivolgervi e consegnarli presso i centri di raccolta preposti. Per maggiori
informazioni vedere: ww.recyclethis.info.
LT Baterijų šalinimas
Šios įrangos sudėtyje yra baterijų, kurias draudžiama šalinti Europos Sąjungos viešose nerūšiuotų atliekų šalinimo sistemose. Informaciją
apie baterijas galite rasti įrangos techninėje dokumentacijoje. Baterijos žymimos šiuo simboliu, papildomai gali būti nurodoma kad
baterijų sudėtyje yra kadmio (Cd), švino (Pb) ar gyvsidabrio (Hg). Eksploatavimui nebetinkamas baterijas pristatykite į tam skirtas
surinkimo vietas arba grąžinkite jas tiesioginiam tiekėjui, kad jos būtų tinkamai utilizuotos. Daugiau informacijos rasite šioje interneto
svetainėje: www.recyclethis.info.
LV Bateriju likvidēšana
Šis produkts satur bateriju vai akumulatoru, kuru nedrīkst izmest Eiropas Savienībā esošajās sadzīves atkritumu sistēmās. Sk. produkta
dokumentācijā, kur ir norādīta konkrēta informācija par bateriju vai akumulatoru. Baterijas vai akumulatora marķējumā ir šis simbols,
kas var ietvert burtus, kuri norāda kadmiju (Cd), svinu (Pb) vai dzīvsudrabu (Hg). Pēc ekspluatācijas laika beigām baterijas vai akumulatori
jānodod piegādātājam vai specializētā bateriju savākšanas vietā. Sīkāku informāciju var iegūt vietnē: www.recyclethis.info.
NL Verwijderen van baterijen
Dit product bevat een batterij welke niet kan verwijdert worden via de gemeentelijke huisvuilscheiding in de Europese Gemeenschap.
Gelieve de product documentatie te controleren voor specifieke batterij informatie. De batterijen met deze label kunnen volgende
indictaies bevatten cadium (Cd), lood (Pb) of kwik (Hg). Voor correcte vorm van kringloop, geef je de producten terug aan jou locale
leverancier of geef het af aan een gespecialiseerde verzamelpunt. Meer informatie vindt u op de volgende website: www.recyclethis.info.
NO Retur av batteri
Dette produkt inneholder et batteri som ikke kan kastes med usortert kommunalt søppel i den Europeiske Unionen. Se
produktdokumentasjonen for spesifikk batteriinformasjon. Batteriet er merket med dette symbolet som kan inkludere symboler for å
indikere at kadmium (Cd), bly (Pb), eller kvikksølv (Hg) forekommer. Returner batteriet til leverandøren din eller til et dedikert
oppsamlingspunkt for korrekt gjenvinning. For mer informasjon se: www.recyclethis.info.
PL Pozbywanie się zużytych baterii
Ten produkt zawiera baterie, które w Unii Europejskiej mogą być usuwane tylko jako posegregowane odpady komunalne. Dokładne
informacje dotyczące użytych baterii znajdują się w dokumentacji produktu. Baterie oznaczone tym symbolem mogą zawierać
dodatkowe oznaczenia literowe wskazujące na zawartość kadmu (Cd), ołowiu (Pb) lub rtęci (Hg). Dla zapewnienia właściwej utylizacji,
należy zwrócić baterie do dostawcy albo do wyznaczonego punktu zbiórki. Więcej informacji można znaleźć na stronie internetowej
www.recyclethis.info.
PT Eliminação de Baterias
Este produto contêm uma bateria que não pode ser considerado lixo municipal na União Europeia. Consulte a documentação do
produto para obter informação específica da bateria. A bateria é identificada por meio de este símbolo, que pode incluir a rotulação
para indicar o cádmio (Cd), chumbo (Pb), ou o mercúrio (hg). Para uma reciclagem apropriada envie a bateria para o seu fornecedor ou
para um ponto de recolha designado. Para mais informação veja: www.recyclethis.info.
RU Утилизация батарей
Согласно европейской директиве об отходах электрического и электронного оборудования, продукты, содержащие батареи,
нельзя утилизировать как обычные отходы на территории ЕС. Более подробную информацию вы найдете в документации к
продукту. На этом символе могут присутствовать буквы, которые означают, что батарея собержит кадмий (Cd), свинец (Pb) или ртуть
(Hg). Для надлежащей утилизации по окончании срока эксплуатации пользователь должен возвратить батареи локальному
поставщику или сдать в специальный пункт приема. Подробности можно найти на веб-сайте: www.recyclethis.info.
SK Zaobchádzanie s batériami
Tento produkt obsahuje batériu, s ktorou sa v Európskej únii nesmie nakladať ako s netriedeným komunálnym odpadom. Dokumentácia
k produktu obsahuje špecifické informácie o batérii. Batéria je označená týmto symbolom, ktorý môže obsahovať písmená na označenie
kadmia (Cd), olova (Pb), alebo ortuti (Hg). Na správnu recykláciu vráťte batériu vášmu lokálnemu dodávateľovi alebo na určené zberné
miesto. Pre viac informácii pozrite: www.recyclethis.info.
SL Odlaganje baterij
Ta izdelek vsebuje baterijo, ki je v Evropski uniji ni dovoljeno odstranjevati kot nesortiran komunalni odpadek. Za posebne informacije o
bateriji glejte dokumentacijo izdelka. Baterija je označena s tem simbolom, ki lahko vključuje napise, ki označujejo kadmij (Cd), svinec (Pb)
ali živo srebro (Hg). Za ustrezno recikliranje baterijo vrnite dobavitelju ali jo odstranite na določenem zbirališču. Za več informacij obiščite
spletno stran: www.recyclethis.info.
SV Kassering av batteri
Denna produkt innehåller ett batteri som inte får kastas i allmänna sophanteringssytem inom den europeiska unionen. Se
produktdokumentationen för specifik batteriinformation. Batteriet är märkt med denna symbol, vilket kan innebära att det innehåller
kadmium (Cd), bly (Pb) eller kvicksilver (Hg). För korrekt återvinning skall batteriet returneras till leverantören eller till en därför avsedd
deponering. För mer information, se: www.recyclethis.info.
Before attempting to install or use the device, review all safety indicators in this document to help prevent injury, equipment
damage, or downtime.
The following safety and equipment symbols are used in this document.
Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.
DANGER
Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.
WARNING
Indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in minor or moderate
CAUTION injury.
Indicates practices not related to personal injury.
NOTICE
a) GENERAL CAUTIONS AND WARNINGS
The following general safety precautions and warnings apply.
Ensure that all connections to the product are correct so as to avoid accidental risk of shock
DANGER and/or fire, for example such as can arise from high voltage connected to low voltage termi-
nals.
Follow the requirements of this manual, including adequate wiring size and type, terminal torque settings, voltage,
current magnitudes applied, and adequate isolation/clearance in external wiring from high to low voltage circuits.
Use the device only for its intended purpose and application.
Ensure that all ground paths are uncompromised for safety purposes during device operation and service.
Ensure that the control power applied to the device, the AC current, and voltage input match the ratings specified
on the relay nameplate. Do not apply current or voltage in excess of the specified limits.
Only qualified personnel are to operate the device. Such personnel must be thoroughly familiar with all safety cau-
tions and warnings in this manual and with applicable country, regional, utility, and plant safety regulations.
Hazardous voltages can exist in the power supply and at the device connection to current transformers, voltage
transformers, control, and test circuit terminals. Make sure all sources of such voltages are isolated prior to
attempting work on the device.
Hazardous voltages can exist when opening the secondary circuits of live current transformers. Make sure that
current transformer secondary circuits are shorted out before making or removing any connection to the current
transformer (CT) input terminals of the device.
For tests with secondary test equipment, ensure that no other sources of voltages or currents are connected to
such equipment and that trip and close commands to the circuit breakers or other switching apparatus are iso-
lated, unless this is required by the test procedure and is specified by appropriate utility/plant procedure.
When the device is used to control primary equipment, such as circuit breakers, isolators, and other switching
apparatus, all control circuits from the device to the primary equipment must be isolated while personnel are
working on or around this primary equipment to prevent any inadvertent command from this device.
Use an external disconnect to isolate the mains voltage supply.
Personal safety can be affected if the product is physically modified by the end user. Modifications to the product
outside of recommended wiring configuration, hardware, or programming boundaries is not recommended end-
use practice. Product disassembly and repairs are not permitted. All service needs to be conducted by the factory.
LED transmitters are classified as IEC 60825-1 Accessible Emission Limit (AEL) Class 1M.
CAUTION Class 1M devices are considered safe to the unaided eye. Do not view directly with optical
instruments.
This product is rated to Class A emissions levels and is to be used in Utility, Substation Industrial
1 environments. Not to be used near electronic devices rated for Class B levels.
1. Open the relay packaging and inspect the unit for physical damage.
2. View the rear nameplate and verify that the correct model has been ordered.
Model: M60D00HCHF8AH6AM6BP8BX7A
M60
RATINGS:
Mods: 000
Control Power: 88-300V DC @ 35W / 77-265V AC @ 35VA
Motor Management Relay Contact Inputs: 300V DC Max 10mA
Wiring Diagram:
Inst. Manual:
See manual
1601-0108
Contact Outputs: Refer to Instruction Manual Serial Number: MAZB98000029
E83849 Firmware: D
GE Multilin Mfg. Date: NOV 26, 2012
- M A A B 9 7 0 0 0 0 9 9 -
PO Num: 600001234.56
Item Num:
LISTED
IND.CONT. EQ.
52TL - M A A B 9 7 0 0 0 0 9 9 -
833722A3.CDR
Historically, substation protection, control, and metering functions were performed with electromechanical equipment. This
1
first generation of equipment was gradually replaced by analog electronic equipment, most of which emulated the single-
function approach of their electromechanical precursors. Both of these technologies required expensive cabling and auxil-
iary equipment to produce functioning systems.
Recently, digital electronic equipment has begun to provide protection, control, and metering functions. Initially, this equip-
ment was either single function or had very limited multi-function capability, and did not significantly reduce the cabling and
auxiliary equipment required. However, recent digital relays have become quite multi-functional, reducing cabling and aux-
iliaries significantly. These devices also transfer data to central control facilities and Human Machine Interfaces using elec-
tronic communications. The functions performed by these products have become so broad that many users now prefer the
term IED (Intelligent Electronic Device).
It is obvious to station designers that the amount of cabling and auxiliary equipment installed in stations can be even further
reduced, to 20% to 70% of the levels common in 1990, to achieve large cost reductions. This requires placing even more
functions within the IEDs.
Users of power equipment are also interested in reducing cost by improving power quality and personnel productivity, and
as always, in increasing system reliability and efficiency. These objectives are realized through software which is used to
perform functions at both the station and supervisory levels. The use of these systems is growing rapidly.
High speed communications are required to meet the data transfer rates required by modern automatic control and moni-
toring systems. In the near future, very high speed communications will be required to perform protection signaling with a
performance target response time for a command signal between two IEDs, from transmission to reception, of less than 3
milliseconds. This has been established by the IEC 61850 standard.
IEDs with the capabilities outlined above will also provide significantly more power system data than is presently available,
enhance operations and maintenance, and permit the use of adaptive system configuration for protection and control sys-
tems. This new generation of equipment must also be easily incorporated into automation systems, at both the station and
enterprise levels. The GE Multilin Universal Relay (UR) has been developed to meet these goals.
1 a) UR BASIC DESIGN
The UR is a digital-based device containing a central processing unit (CPU) that handles multiple types of input and output
signals. The UR can communicate over a local area network (LAN) with an operator interface, a programming device, or
another UR device.
/$1
3URJUDPPLQJ 2SHUDWRU
GHYLFH LQWHUIDFH
$&'5
b) UR SIGNAL TYPES
The contact inputs and outputs are digital signals associated with connections to hard-wired contacts. Both ‘wet’ and ‘dry’
contacts are supported.
The virtual inputs and outputs are digital signals associated with UR-series internal logic signals. Virtual inputs include
signals generated by the local user interface. The virtual outputs are outputs of FlexLogic™ equations used to customize
the device. Virtual outputs can also serve as virtual inputs to FlexLogic™ equations.
The analog inputs and outputs are signals that are associated with transducers, such as Resistance Temperature Detec-
tors (RTDs).
The CT and VT inputs refer to analog current transformer and voltage transformer signals used to monitor AC power lines.
The UR-series relays support 1 A and 5 A CTs.
The remote inputs and outputs provide a means of sharing digital point state information between remote UR-series
devices. The remote outputs interface to the remote inputs of other UR-series devices. Remote outputs are FlexLogic™
operands inserted into IEC 61850 GSSE and GOOSE messages.
The direct inputs and outputs provide a means of sharing digital point states between a number of UR-series IEDs over a
dedicated fiber (single or multimode), RS422, or G.703 interface. No switching equipment is required as the IEDs are con-
nected directly in a ring or redundant (dual) ring configuration. This feature is optimized for speed and intended for pilot-
aided schemes, distributed logic applications, or the extension of the input/output capabilities of a single relay chassis.
c) UR SCAN OPERATION
The UR-series devices operate in a cyclic scan fashion. The device reads the inputs into an input status table, solves the
logic program (FlexLogic™ equation), and then sets each output to the appropriate state in an output status table. Any
1
resulting task execution is priority interrupt-driven.
5HDG,QSXWV
3URWHFWLRQHOHPHQWV
VHUYLFHGE\VXEVFDQ
3URWHFWLYH(OHPHQWV
3.3
6ROYH/RJLF '32
23
6HW2XWSXWV
("'("#1!34B
The firmware (software embedded in the relay) is designed in functional modules which can be installed in any relay as
required. This is achieved with object-oriented design and programming (OOD/OOP) techniques.
Object-oriented techniques involve the use of objects and classes. An object is defined as “a logical entity that contains
both data and code that manipulates that data”. A class is the generalized form of similar objects. By using this concept,
one can create a protection class with the protection elements as objects of the class, such as time overcurrent, instanta-
neous overcurrent, current differential, undervoltage, overvoltage, underfrequency, and distance. These objects represent
completely self-contained software modules. The same object-class concept can be used for metering, input/output control,
hmi, communications, or any functional entity in the system.
Employing OOD/OOP in the software architecture of the M60 achieves the same features as the hardware architecture:
modularity, scalability, and flexibility. The application software for any UR-series device (for example, feeder protection,
transformer protection, distance protection) is constructed by combining objects from the various functionality classes. This
results in a common look and feel across the entire family of UR-series platform-based applications.
As described above, the architecture of the UR-series relays differ from previous devices. To achieve a general understand-
ing of this device, some sections of Chapter 5 are quite helpful. The most important functions of the relay are contained in
“elements”. A description of the UR-series elements can be found in the Introduction to Elements section in chapter 5.
Examples of simple elements, and some of the organization of this manual, can be found in the Control Elements section of
chapter 5. An explanation of the use of inputs from CTs and VTs is in the Introduction to AC Sources section in chapter 5. A
description of how digital signals are used and routed within the relay is contained in the Introduction to FlexLogic™ section
in chapter 5.
1 The faceplate keypad and display or the EnerVista UR Setup software interface can be used to communicate with the relay.
The EnerVista UR Setup software interface is the preferred method to edit settings and view actual values because the
computer monitor can display more information in a simple comprehensible format.
The following minimum requirements must be met for the EnerVista UR Setup software to properly operate on a computer.
• Pentium class or higher processor (Pentium II 300 MHz or higher recommended)
• Windows 95, 98, 98SE, ME, NT 4.0 (Service Pack 4 or higher), 2000, XP
• Internet Explorer 4.0 or higher
• 128 MB of RAM (256 MB recommended)
• 200 MB of available space on system drive and 200 MB of available space on installation drive
• Video capable of displaying 800 x 600 or higher in high-color mode (16-bit color)
• RS232 and/or Ethernet port for communications to the relay
The following qualified modems have been tested to be compliant with the M60 and the EnerVista UR Setup software.
• US Robotics external 56K FaxModem 5686
• US Robotics external Sportster 56K X2
• PCTEL 2304WT V.92 MDC internal modem
1.3.2 INSTALLATION
After ensuring the minimum requirements for using EnerVista UR Setup are met (see previous section), use the following
procedure to install the EnerVista UR Setup from the enclosed GE EnerVista CD.
1. Insert the GE EnerVista CD into your CD-ROM drive.
2. Click the Install Now button and follow the installation instructions to install the no-charge EnerVista software.
3. When installation is complete, start the EnerVista Launchpad application.
4. Click the IED Setup section of the Launch Pad window.
5. In the EnerVista Launch Pad window, click the Add Product button and select the “M60 Motor Protection System”
from the Install Software window as shown below. Select the “Web” option to ensure the most recent software release,
or select “CD” if you do not have a web connection, then click the Add Now button to list software items for the M60. 1
6. EnerVista Launchpad will obtain the software from the Web or CD and automatically start the installation program.
7. Select the complete path, including the new directory name, where the EnerVista UR Setup will be installed.
8. Click on Next to begin the installation. The files will be installed in the directory indicated and the installation program
will automatically create icons and add EnerVista UR Setup to the Windows start menu.
9. Click Finish to end the installation. The UR-series device will be added to the list of installed IEDs in the EnerVista
Launchpad window, as shown below.
1 a) OVERVIEW
The user can connect remotely to the M60 through the rear RS485 port or the rear Ethernet port with a computer running
the EnerVista UR Setup software. The M60 can also be accessed locally with a computer through the front panel RS232
port or the rear Ethernet port using the Quick Connect feature.
• To configure the M60 for remote access via the rear RS485 port(s), refer to the Configuring Serial Communications
section.
• To configure the M60 for remote access via the rear Ethernet port, refer to the Configuring Ethernet Communications
section. An Ethernet module must be specified at the time of ordering.
• To configure the M60 for local access with a computer through either the front RS232 port or rear Ethernet port, refer to
the Using the Quick Connect Feature section. An Ethernet module must be specified at the time of ordering for Ether-
net communications.
Implement IP addresses for the computer and a M60 device as follows.
The UR family supports the use of subnetworks as documented in RFC 950, which divides class-based networks into sub-
networks (non-CIDR). The classes and IP address ranges are defined as follows.
Table 1–1: IP ADDRESS CLASSES
CLASSES IP ADDRESS RANGE DEFAULT SUBNET MASK ADDRESS UR DEVICES
A 1.0.0.0 to 127.255.255.255 255.0.0.0 65,535 or more
B 128.0.0.0 to 191.255.255.255 255.255.0.0 255 to 65,534
C 192.0.0.0 to 223.255.255.255 255.255.255.0 0 to 254
D 224.0.0.0 to 239.255.255.255 (Reserved for multicasting)
E 240.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 (Reserved)
Both network and subnet addresses are contained within a range. The number of hosts determines the class and
addresses as follows:
• Class A 255.0.0.0 — The first octet (255) specifies the network, the second to fourth octets (0) specify the subnet and
host. Use this class when you have more than 65,535 hosts (UR devices).
• Class B 255.255.0.0 — The first two octets (255) specify the network, the third octet (0) specifies the subnet, and the
fourth octet (0) specifies the host. Use this class when you have 255 to 65,534 hosts (UR devices).
• Class C 255.255.255.0 — The first three octets (255) specify the network and the last octet (0) specifies the subnet
and host. Use this class when you have up to 254 hosts (UR devices).
An example of implementation is one computer and one UR device. Because there is one UR device, class C addressing is
required. So we use UR 192.167.2.x with subnet mask 255.255.255.0 and computer 192.167.3.x with subnet mask
255.255.255.0.
For older, non-CIDR routing protocols, such as RIP version 1, follow these restrictions:
• Identical subnet masks — Use a single mask for all subnets within a network
• Contiguous subnets — The subnets must be contiguous and not split among networks. The subnets cannot pass traffic
through other networks.
2. Connect the computer to the F485 and the F485 to the RS485 terminal on the back of the UR device, or connect the
computer to the RS232 port on the front of the relay.
3. Select the “UR” device from the EnerVista Launchpad to start EnerVista UR Setup.
1
4. Click the Device Setup button to open the Device Setup window and click the Add Site button to define a new site.
5. Enter the desired site name in the “Site Name” field. If desired, a short description of site can also be entered along
with the display order of devices defined for the site. In this example, we will use “Location 1” as the site name. Click
the OK button when complete.
6. The new site will appear in the upper-left list in the EnerVista UR Setup window. Click the Device Setup button then
select the new site to re-open the Device Setup window.
7. Click the Add Device button to define the new device.
8. Enter the desired name in the “Device Name” field and a description (optional) of the site.
9. Select “Serial” from the Interface drop-down list. This will display a number of interface parameters that must be
entered for proper serial communications.
1 Before starting, verify that the Ethernet network cable is properly connected to the Ethernet port on the back of the relay. To
set up the relay for Ethernet communications, you define a Site, then add the relay as a Device at that site.The computer
and UR device must be on the same subnet.
1. Verify that the latest version of the EnerVista UR Setup software is installed (available from the GE EnerVista CD or
online from http://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin). See the Software Installation section for installation details.
2. Select the “UR” device from the EnerVista Launchpad to start EnerVista UR Setup.
3. Click the Device Setup button to open the Device Setup window, then click the Add Site button to define a new site.
4. Enter the desired site name in the “Site Name” field. If desired, a short description of site can also be entered along
with the display order of devices defined for the site. In this example, we will use “Location 2” as the site name. Click
the OK button when complete.
5. The new site will appear in the upper-left list in the EnerVista UR Setup window. Click the Device Setup button then
select the new site to re-open the Device Setup window.
6. Click the Add Device button to define the new device.
7. Enter the desired name in the “Device Name” field and a description (optional) of the site.
8. Select “Ethernet” from the Interface drop-down list. This will display a number of interface parameters that must be
entered for proper Ethernet functionality.
The Site Device has now been configured for Ethernet communications. Proceed to the Connecting to the M60 section to
begin communications.
1
1.3.4 USING THE QUICK CONNECT FEATURE
4. Select the Serial interface and the correct COM Port, then click Connect.
5. The EnerVista UR Setup software will create a site named “Quick Connect” with a corresponding device also named
“Quick Connect” and display them on the upper-left corner of the screen. Expand the sections to view data directly
from the M60 device.
Each time the EnerVista UR Setup software is initialized, click the Quick Connect button to establish direct communica-
tions to the M60. This ensures that configuration of the EnerVista UR Setup software matches the M60 model number.
1 2
3 4 5 6
7
END 1
Pin Wire color Diagram
END 2
Pin Wire color Diagram
1 8 1 White/orange 1 White/green
2 Orange 2 Green
3 White/green 3 White/orange
4 Blue 4 Blue
5 White/blue 5 White/blue
6 Green 6 Orange
7 White/brown 7 White/brown
8 Brown 8 Brown
842799A1.CDR
3. Select the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) item from the list provided and click the Properties button.
1 Request
Request
timed
timed
out.
out.
Request timed out.
Request timed out.
Ping statistics for 1.1.1.1:
Packets: Sent = 4, Received = 0, Lost = 4 (100% loss),
Approximate round trip time in milli-seconds:
Minimum = 0ms, Maximum = 0ms, Average = 0 ms
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Verify the physical connection between the M60 and the laptop computer, and double-check the programmed IP address in
the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK IP ADDRESS setting, then repeat step 2 in the above procedure.
If the following sequence of messages appears when entering the C:\WINNT>ping 1.1.1.1 command:
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Hardware error.
Hardware error.
Hardware error.
Hardware error.
Ping statistics for 1.1.1.1:
Packets: Sent = 4, Received = 0, Lost = 4 (100% loss),
Approximate round trip time in milli-seconds:
Minimum = 0ms, Maximum = 0ms, Average = 0 ms
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Verify the physical connection between the M60 and the laptop computer, and double-check the programmed IP address in
the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK IP ADDRESS setting, then repeat step 2 in the above procedure.
If the following sequence of messages appears when entering the C:\WINNT>ping 1.1.1.1 command:
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Destination host unreachable.
Destination host unreachable.
Destination host unreachable.
Destination host unreachable.
Ping statistics for 1.1.1.1:
Packets: Sent = 4, Received = 0, Lost = 4 (100% loss),
Approximate round trip time in milli-seconds:
Minimum = 0ms, Maximum = 0ms, Average = 0 ms
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 32 bytes of data:
Verify the IP address is programmed in the local computer by entering the ipconfig command in the command window.
C:\WINNT>ipconfig
Windows 2000 IP Configuration
Ethernet adapter <F4FE223E-5EB6-4BFB-9E34-1BD7BE7F59FF>:
Connection-specific DNS suffix. . :
IP Address. . . . . . . . . . . . : 0.0.0.0
Subnet Mask . . . . . . . . . . . : 0.0.0.0
Default Gateway . . . . . . . . . :
Ethernet adapter Local Area Connection:
Connection-specific DNS suffix . :
IP Address. . . . . . . . . . . . : 1.1.1.2
Subnet Mask . . . . . . . . . . . : 255.0.0.0
Default Gateway . . . . . . . . . :
C:\WINNT>
It may be necessary to restart the laptop for the change in IP address to take effect (Windows 98 or NT).
Before using the Quick Connect feature through the Ethernet port, it is necessary to disable any configured proxy settings
in Internet Explorer.
1. Start the Internet Explorer software.
1
2. Select the Tools > Internet Options menu item and click on Connections tab.
3. Click on the LAN Settings button to open the following window.
4. Ensure that the “Use a proxy server for your LAN” box is not checked.
If this computer is used to connect to the Internet, re-enable any proxy server settings after the laptop has been discon-
nected from the M60 relay.
1. Verify that the latest version of the EnerVista UR Setup software is installed (available from the GE EnerVista CD or
online from http://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin). See the Software Installation section for installation details.
2. Start the Internet Explorer software.
3. Select the “UR” device from the EnerVista Launchpad to start EnerVista UR Setup.
4. Click the Quick Connect button to open the Quick Connect dialog box.
5. Select the Ethernet interface and enter the IP address assigned to the M60, then click Connect.
6. The EnerVista UR Setup software will create a site named “Quick Connect” with a corresponding device also named
“Quick Connect” and display them on the upper-left corner of the screen. Expand the sections to view data directly
from the M60 device.
Each time the EnerVista UR Setup software is initialized, click the Quick Connect button to establish direct communica-
tions to the M60. This ensures that configuration of the EnerVista UR Setup software matches the M60 model number.
When direct communications with the M60 via Ethernet is complete, make the following changes:
1. From the Windows desktop, right-click the My Network Places icon and select Properties to open the network con-
nections window.
2. Right-click the Local Area Connection icon and select the Properties item.
3. Select the Internet Protocol (TCP/IP) item from the list provided and click the Properties button.
If this computer is used to connect to the Internet, re-enable any proxy server settings after the laptop has been discon-
nected from the M60 relay.
AUTOMATIC DISCOVERY OF ETHERNET DEVICES
The EnerVista UR Setup software can automatically discover and communicate to all UR-series IEDs located on an Ether-
net network.
Using the Quick Connect feature, a single click of the mouse will trigger the software to automatically detect any UR-series
relays located on the network. The EnerVista UR Setup software will then proceed to configure all settings and order code
options in the Device Setup menu, for the purpose of communicating to multiple relays. This feature allows the user to
identify and interrogate, in seconds, all UR-series devices in a particular location.
When unable to connect because of an "ACCESS VIOLATION," access Device Setup and refresh the order code for the
device.
1. Open the Display Properties window through the Site List tree as shown below:
1
Quick action hot links
842743A3.CDR
2. The Display Properties window will open with a status indicator on the lower left of the EnerVista UR Setup window.
3. If the status indicator is red, verify that the Ethernet network cable is properly connected to the Ethernet port on the
back of the relay and that the relay has been properly setup for communications (steps A and B earlier).
If a relay icon appears in place of the status indicator, than a report (such as an oscillography or event record) is open.
Close the report to re-display the green status indicator.
4. The Display Properties settings can now be edited, printed, or changed according to user specifications.
Refer to chapter 4 in this manual and the EnerVista UR Setup Help File for more information about the using the
EnerVista UR Setup software interface.
127(
1 Please refer to Chapter 3: Hardware for detailed mounting and wiring instructions. Review all WARNINGS and CAUTIONS
carefully.
1.4.2 COMMUNICATIONS
The EnerVista UR Setup software communicates to the relay via the faceplate RS232 port or the rear panel RS485 / Ether-
net ports. To communicate via the faceplate RS232 port, a standard straight-through serial cable is used. The DB-9 male
end is connected to the relay and the DB-9 or DB-25 female end is connected to the computer COM1 or COM2 port as
described in the CPU Communications Ports section of chapter 3.
Regional
control
center
Ethernet Remote
10/100 Mbps communications link
Local
control
UR-series IED
EnerVista Engineer
Modem
GE Multilin F485
communications converter
RS232
EnerVista
Reports
EnerVista
Troubleshooting
Commissioning
Setting changes
842759A2.CDR
All messages are displayed on a 2 20 backlit liquid crystal display (LCD) to make them visible under poor lighting condi-
tions. While the keypad and display are not actively being used, the display will default to user-defined messages. Any high
priority event driven message will automatically override the default message and appear on the display.
Display messages are organized into pages under the following headings: actual values, settings, commands, and targets.
1
The MENU key navigates through these pages. Each heading page is broken down further into logical subgroups.
The MESSAGE keys navigate through the subgroups. The VALUE keys scroll increment or decrement numerical setting
values when in programming mode. These keys also scroll through alphanumeric values in the text edit mode. Alterna-
tively, values may also be entered with the numeric keypad.
The decimal key initiates and advance to the next character in text edit mode or enters a decimal point. The HELP key may
be pressed at any time for context sensitive help messages. The ENTER key stores altered setting values.
Press the MENU key to select the desired header display page (top-level menu). The header title appears momentarily fol-
lowed by a header display page menu item. Each press of the MENU key advances through the following main heading
pages:
• Actual values.
• Settings.
• Commands.
• Targets.
• User displays (when enabled).
The setting and actual value messages are arranged hierarchically. The header display pages are indicated by double
scroll bar characters (), while sub-header pages are indicated by single scroll bar characters (). The header display
pages represent the highest level of the hierarchy and the sub-header display pages fall below this level. The MESSAGE
UP and DOWN keys move within a group of headers, sub-headers, setting values, or actual values. Continually pressing
the MESSAGE RIGHT key from a header display displays specific information for the header category. Conversely, contin-
ually pressing the MESSAGE LEFT key from a setting value or actual value display returns to the header display.
SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP
The relay is defaulted to the “Not Programmed” state when it leaves the factory. This safeguards against the installation of
a relay whose settings have not been entered. When powered up successfully, the Trouble LED will be on and the In Ser-
vice LED off. The relay in the “Not Programmed” state will block signaling of any output relay. These conditions will remain
until the relay is explicitly put in the “Programmed” state.
Select the menu message SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS
RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
To put the relay in the “Programmed” state, press either of the VALUE keys once and then press ENTER. The faceplate
1 Trouble LED will turn off and the In Service LED will turn on. The settings for the relay can be programmed manually (refer
to Chapter 5) via the faceplate keypad or remotely (refer to the EnerVista UR Setup help file) via the EnerVista UR Setup
software interface.
It is recommended that passwords be set up for each security level and assigned to specific personnel. There are two user
password security access levels, COMMAND and SETTING:
1. COMMAND
The COMMAND access level restricts the user from making any settings changes, but allows the user to perform the fol-
lowing operations:
• change state of virtual inputs
• clear event records
• clear oscillography records
• operate user-programmable pushbuttons
2. SETTING
The SETTING access level allows the user to make any changes to any of the setting values.
Refer to the Changing Settings section in Chapter 4 for complete instructions on setting up security level pass-
words.
127(
FlexLogic™ equation editing is required for setting up user-defined logic for customizing the relay operations. See the Flex-
Logic™ section in Chapter 5 for additional details.
1.5.7 COMMISSIONING
The M60 requires a minimum amount of maintenance when it is commissioned into service. Since the M60 is a micropro-
1
cessor-based relay, its characteristics do not change over time. As such, no further functional tests are required. Expected
service life is 20 years for UR devices manufactured June 2014 or later when applied in a controlled indoors environment
and electrical conditions within specification.
Furthermore, the M60 performs a number of continual self-tests and takes the necessary action in case of any major errors
(see the Relay Self-Tests section in chapter 7 for details). However, it is recommended that M60 maintenance be scheduled
with other system maintenance. This maintenance may involve the in-service, out-of-service, or unscheduled maintenance.
In-service maintenance:
1. Visual verification of the analog values integrity such as voltage and current (in comparison to other devices on the cor-
responding system).
2. Visual verification of active alarms, relay display messages, and LED indications.
3. LED test.
4. Visual inspection for any damage, corrosion, dust, or loose wires.
5. Event recorder file download with further events analysis.
Out-of-service maintenance:
1. Check wiring connections for firmness.
2. Analog values (currents, voltages, RTDs, analog inputs) injection test and metering accuracy verification. Calibrated
test equipment is required.
3. Protection elements setting verification (analog values injection or visual verification of setting file entries against relay
settings schedule).
4. Contact inputs and outputs verification. This test can be conducted by direct change of state forcing or as part of the
system functional testing.
5. Visual inspection for any damage, corrosion, or dust.
6. Event recorder file download with further events analysis.
7. LED Test and pushbutton continuity check.
Unscheduled maintenance such as during a disturbance causing system interruption:
1. View the event recorder and oscillography or fault report for correct operation of inputs, outputs, and elements.
If the relay or one of its modules is of concern, contact GE Multilin for service.
The M60 Motor Protection System is a microprocessor based relay designed for the protection and management of
medium and large sized motors.
Overvoltage and undervoltage protection, thermal overload, fault diagnostics, and RTU functions are provided. The M60
provides phase, neutral, ground and negative sequence, instantaneous and time overcurrent protection. The time overcur-
rent function provides multiple curve shapes or FlexCurve™ for optimum co-ordination.
The relay also features an enhanced thermal model with custom curves, current unbalance biasing, and running and
2
stopped exponential cooling curves. An optional RTD module allows for the thermal model RTD bias function. Motor start
and supervision functions include starts per hour, time between starts, restart time, acceleration time, emergency restart,
and start inhibit. Sensitive directional power, mechanical jam, and current unbalance elements are also included as stan-
dard functions. Additional functions that are not part of the standard M60 element set can be easily configured and imple-
mented using the FlexElement™ and FlexLogic™ functionality.
Voltage, current, and power metering is built into the relay as a standard feature. Current parameters are available as total
waveform RMS magnitude, or as fundamental frequency only RMS magnitude and angle (phasor).
Diagnostic features include an event recorder capable of storing 1024 time-tagged events, oscillography capable of storing
up to 64 records with programmable trigger, content and sampling rate, and data logger acquisition of up to 16 channels,
with programmable content and sampling rate. The internal clock used for time-tagging can be synchronized with an IRIG-
B signal or via the SNTP protocol over the Ethernet port. This precise time stamping allows the sequence of events to be
determined throughout the system. Events can also be programmed (via FlexLogic™ equations) to trigger oscillography
data capture which may be set to record the measured parameters before and after the event for viewing on a computer.
These tools significantly reduce troubleshooting time and simplify report generation in the event of a system fault.
A faceplate RS232 port may be used to connect to a computer for the programming of settings and the monitoring of actual
values. A variety of communications modules are available. Two rear RS485 ports allow independent access by operating
and engineering staff. All serial ports use the Modbus® RTU protocol. The RS485 ports may be connected to system com-
puters with baud rates up to 115.2 kbps. The RS232 port has a fixed baud rate of 19.2 kbps. Optional communications
modules include a 10Base-F Ethernet interface which can be used to provide fast, reliable communications in noisy envi-
ronments. Another option provides two 10Base-F fiber optic ports for redundancy. The Ethernet port supports IEC 61850,
Modbus®/TCP, and TFTP protocols, and allows access to the relay via any standard web browser (M60 web pages). The
IEC 60870-5-104 protocol is supported on the Ethernet port. DNP 3.0 and IEC 60870-5-104 cannot be enabled at the same
time.
Settings and actual values can be accessed from the front panel or EnerVista software.
The M60 IEDs use flash memory technology that allows field upgrading as new features are added.
The following single line diagram illustrates the relay functionality using ANSI (American National Standards Institute)
device numbers.
52
Trip Close 59N 59P 27P 59_2 47 81O 81U
2 50G 51G
M
RTD
Metering
87S
2.1.2 ORDERING
a) OVERVIEW
The M60 is available as a 19-inch rack horizontal mount or reduced-size (¾) vertical unit and consists of the following mod-
ules: power supply, CPU, CT/VT, digital input and output, transducer input and output, and inter-relay communications.
Each of these modules can be supplied in a number of configurations specified at the time of ordering. The information
required to completely specify the relay is provided in the following tables (see chapter 3 for full details of relay modules).
Order codes are subject to change without notice. CPU modules 9G, 9H, 9L, and 9M are obsolete. See the web 2
page for the product for the latest ordering options.
127(
The order code structure is dependent on the mounting option (horizontal or vertical) and the type of CT/VT modules (regu-
lar CT/VT modules or the HardFiber modules). The order code options are described in the following sub-sections.
2
N | | | | | | | | | | RS485 and 10/100Base-T
S | | | | | | | | | | RS485 and six-port managed Ethernet switch
SOFTWARE 00 | | | | | | | | | No Software Options
01 | | | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD); not available for Type E CPUs
03 | | | | | | | | | IEC 61850; not available for Type E CPUs
04 | | | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD) and IEC 61850; not available for Type E CPUs
28 | | | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection
29 | | | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection and Ethernet Global Data (EGD); not available for Type E CPUs
30 | | | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection and IEC 61850; not available for Type E CPUs
31 | | | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection, Ethernet Global Data (EGD), and IEC 61850; not available for Type E CPUs
MOUNT/COATING H | | | | | | | | Horizontal (19” rack)
A | | | | | | | | Horizontal (19” rack) with harsh environmental coating
FACEPLATE/ DISPLAY C | | | | | | | English display
D | | | | | | | French display
R | | | | | | | Russian display
A | | | | | | | Chinese display
P | | | | | | | English display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
G | | | | | | | French display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
S | | | | | | | Russian display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
B | | | | | | | Chinese display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
K | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display
M | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display
Q | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display
U | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
L | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
N | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
T | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
V | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
POWER SUPPLY H | | | | | | 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
(redundant supply must H | | | | | RH 125 / 250 V AC/DC with redundant 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
be same type as main supply) L | | | | | | 24 to 48 V (DC only) power supply
L | | | | | RL 24 to 48 V (DC only) with redundant 24 to 48 V DC power supply
CT/VT MODULES 8F | 8F | | | Standard 4CT/4VT
8G | 8G | | | Sensitive Ground 4CT/4VT
8H | 8H | | | Standard 8CT
8J | 8J | | | Sensitive Ground 8CT
8L | 8L | | | Standard 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
8M | 8M | | | Sensitive Ground 4CT/4VT with enhanced diagnostics
8N | 8N | | | Standard 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
8R | 8R | | | Sensitive Ground 8CT with enhanced diagnostics
DIGITAL INPUTS/OUTPUTS XX XX XX XX XX No Module
4A 4A 4A 4A 4A 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
4B 4B 4B 4B 4B 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
4C 4C 4C 4C 4C 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
4D 4D 4D 4D 4D 16 digital inputs with Auto-Burnishing
4L 4L 4L 4L 4L 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
67 67 67 67 67 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
6A 6A 6A 6A 6A 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
6B 6B 6B 6B 6B 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
6C 6C 6C 6C 6C 8 Form-C outputs
6D 6D 6D 6D 6D 16 digital inputs
6E 6E 6E 6E 6E 4 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
6F 6F 6F 6F 6F 8 Fast Form-C outputs
6G 6G 6G 6G 6G 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6H 6H 6H 6H 6H 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 digital inputs
6K 6K 6K 6K 6K 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
6L 6L 6L 6L 6L 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
6M 6M 6M 6M 6M 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
6N 6N 6N 6N 6N 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6P 6P 6P 6P 6P 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 digital inputs
6R 6R 6R 6R 6R 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
6S 6S 6S 6S 6S 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
6T 6T 6T 6T 6T 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6U 6U 6U 6U 6U 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 digital inputs
6V 6V 6V 6V 6V 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching output, 8 digital inputs
TRANSDUCER 5A 5A 5A 5A 5A 4 DCmA inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
INPUTS/OUTPUTS 5C 5C 5C 5C 5C 8 RTD inputs
(select a maximum of 3 per unit) 5D 5D 5D 5D 5D 4 RTD inputs, 4 DCmA outputs (only one 5A or 5D module is allowed)
5E 5E 5E 5E 5E 4 RTD inputs, 4 DCmA inputs
5F 5F 5F 5F 5F 8 DCmA inputs
INTER-RELAY 2A 2A C37.94SM, 1300nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
COMMUNICATIONS 2B 2B C37.94SM, 1300nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
(select a maximum of 1 per unit) 2E 2E Bi-phase, single channel
2F 2F Bi-phase, dual channel
2G 2G IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
2H 2H IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
| 2S Six-port managed Ethernet switch with high voltage power supply (110 to 250 V DC / 100 to 240 V AC)
| 2T Six-port managed Ethernet switch with low voltage power supply (48 V DC)
72 72 1550 nm, single-mode, LASER, 1 Channel
73 73 1550 nm, single-mode, LASER, 2 Channel
74 74 Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, LASER
75 75 Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, Single-mode LASER
76 76 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
77 77 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7A 7A 820 nm, multi-mode, LED, 1 Channel
7B 7B 1300 nm, multi-mode, LED, 1 Channel
7C 7C 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
7D 7D 1300 nm, single-mode, LASER, 1 Channel
7E 7E Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multi-mode
7F 7F Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multi-mode
7G 7G Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
7H 7H 820 nm, multi-mode, LED, 2 Channels
7I 7I 1300 nm, multi-mode, LED, 2 Channels
7J 7J 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
7K 7K 1300 nm, single-mode, LASER, 2 Channels
7L 7L Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multi-mode, LED
7M 7M Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multi-mode, LED
7N 7N Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
7P 7P Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, LASER
7Q 7Q Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode LASER
7R 7R G.703, 1 Channel
7S 7S G.703, 2 Channels
7T 7T RS422, 1 Channel
7W 7W RS422, 2 Channels
The order codes for the reduced size vertical mount units with traditional CTs and VTs are shown below.
Table 2–5: M60 ORDER CODES (HORIZONTAL UNITS WITH PROCESS BUS)
M60 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P ** - U ** - W/X ** Full Size Horizontal Mount
BASE UNIT M60 | | | | | | | | | | | Base Unit
CPU E | | | | | | | | | | RS485 and RS485
J | | | | | | | | | | RS485, multi-mode ST 100Base-FX and 10/100Base-T
K | | | | | | | | | | RS485, multi-mode ST redundant 100Base-FX and 10/100Base-T
2
N | | | | | | | | | | RS485 and 10/100Base-T
S | | | | | | | | | | RS485 and 6-port managed Ethernet Switch
SOFTWARE 00 | | | | | | | | | No Software Options
01 | | | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD); not available for Type E CPUs
03 | | | | | | | | | IEC 61850; not available for Type E CPUs
04 | | | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD) and IEC 61850; not available for Type E CPUs
28 | | | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection
29 | | | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection and Ethernet Global Data (EGD); not available for Type E CPUs
30 | | | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection and IEC 61850; not available for Type E CPUs
31 | | | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection, Ethernet Global Data (EGD), and IEC 61850; not available for Type E CPUs
MOUNT/COATING H | | | | | | | | Horizontal (19” rack)
A | | | | | | | | Horizontal (19” rack) with harsh environmental coating
FACEPLATE/ DISPLAY C | | | | | | | English display
D | | | | | | | French display
R | | | | | | | Russian display
A | | | | | | | Chinese display
P | | | | | | | English display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
G | | | | | | | French display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
S | | | | | | | Russian display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
B | | | | | | | Chinese display with 4 small and 12 large programmable pushbuttons
K | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display
M | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display
Q | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display
U | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
L | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
N | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
T | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
V | | | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
POWER SUPPLY H | | | | | | 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
(redundant supply must H | | | | | RH 125 / 250 V AC/DC with redundant 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
be same type as main supply) L | | | | | | 24 to 48 V (DC only) power supply
L | | | | | RL 24 to 48 V (DC only) with redundant 24 to 48 V DC power supply
PROCESS BUS MODULE | 81 | | | | Eight-port digital process bus module
DIGITAL INPUTS/OUTPUTS XX XX XX XX XX No Module
4A 4A | 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
4B 4B | 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
4C 4C | 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
4D 4D | 16 digital inputs with Auto-Burnishing
4L 4L | 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
67 67 | 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
6A 6A | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
6B 6B | 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
6C 6C | 8 Form-C outputs
6D 6D | 16 digital inputs
6E 6E | 4 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
6F 6F | 8 Fast Form-C outputs
6G 6G | 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6H 6H | 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 digital inputs
6K 6K | 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
6L 6L | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
6M 6M | 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
6N 6N | 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6P 6P | 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 digital inputs
6R 6R | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
6S 6S | 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
6T 6T | 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6U 6U | 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 digital inputs
6V 6V | 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching output, 8 digital inputs
INTER-RELAY 2A C37.94SM, 1300nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
COMMUNICATIONS 2B C37.94SM, 1300nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
(select a maximum of 1 per unit) 2E Bi-phase, single channel
2F Bi-phase, dual channel
2G IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
2H IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
72 1550 nm, single-mode, LASER, 1 Channel
73 1550 nm, single-mode, LASER, 2 Channel
74 Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, LASER
75 Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, Single-mode LASER
76 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
77 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7A 820 nm, multi-mode, LED, 1 Channel
7B 1300 nm, multi-mode, LED, 1 Channel
7C 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
7D 1300 nm, single-mode, LASER, 1 Channel
7E Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multi-mode
7F Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multi-mode
7G Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
7H 820 nm, multi-mode, LED, 2 Channels
7I 1300 nm, multi-mode, LED, 2 Channels
7J 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
7K 1300 nm, single-mode, LASER, 2 Channels
7L Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multi-mode, LED
7M Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multi-mode, LED
7N Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
7P Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, LASER
7Q Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode LASER
7R G.703, 1 Channel
7S G.703, 2 Channels
7T RS422, 1 Channel
7W RS422, 2 Channels
The order codes for the reduced size vertical mount units with the process bus module are shown below.
Table 2–6: M60 ORDER CODES (REDUCED SIZE VERTICAL UNITS WITH PROCESS BUS)
M60 - * ** - * * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P/R ** Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note regarding P/R slot below)
BASE UNIT M60 | | | | | | | | | Base Unit
CPU E | | | | | | | | RS485 and RS485
J | | | | | | | | RS485, multi-mode ST 100Base-FX and 10/100Base-T
K | | | | | | | | RS485, multi-mode ST redundant 100Base-FX and 10/100Base-T
N | | | | | | | | RS485 and 10/100Base-T
SOFTWARE 00 | | | | | | | No Software Options
01 | | | | | | | Ethernet Global Data (EGD); not available for Type E CPUs
03 | | | | | | | IEC 61850; not available for Type E CPUs
04
28
29
30
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Ethernet Global Data (EGD) and IEC 61850; not available for Type E CPUs
Broken rotor bar detection
Broken rotor bar detection and Ethernet Global Data (EGD); not available for Type E CPUs
Broken rotor bar detection and IEC 61850; not available for Type E CPUs
2
31 | | | | | | | Broken rotor bar detection, Ethernet Global Data (EGD), and IEC 61850; not available for Type E CPUs
MOUNT/COATING V | | | | | | Vertical (3/4 rack)
B | | | | | | Vertical (3/4 rack) with harsh environmental coating
FACEPLATE/ DISPLAY F | | | | | English display
D | | | | | French display
R | | | | | Russian display
A | | | | | Chinese display
K | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display
M | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display
Q | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display
U | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display
L | | | | | Enhanced front panel with English display and user-programmable pushbuttons
N | | | | | Enhanced front panel with French display and user-programmable pushbuttons
T | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Russian display and user-programmable pushbuttons
V | | | | | Enhanced front panel with Chinese display and user-programmable pushbuttons
POWER SUPPLY H | | | | 125 / 250 V AC/DC power supply
L | | | | 24 to 48 V (DC only) power supply
PROCESS BUS MODULE | 81 | | Eight-port digital process bus module
DIGITAL INPUTS/OUTPUTS XX XX XX No Module
4A 4 Solid-State (no monitoring) MOSFET outputs
4B 4 Solid-State (voltage with optional current) MOSFET outputs
4C 4 Solid-State (current with optional voltage) MOSFET outputs
4D 16 digital inputs with Auto-Burnishing
4L 14 Form-A (no monitoring) Latching outputs
67 8 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs
6A 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
6B 2 Form-A (voltage with optional current) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
6C 8 Form-C outputs
6D 16 digital inputs
6E 4 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
6F 8 Fast Form-C outputs
6G 4 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6H 6 Form-A (voltage with optional current) outputs, 4 digital inputs
6K 4 Form-C and 4 Fast Form-C outputs
6L 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
6M 2 Form-A (current with optional voltage) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
6N 4 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6P 6 Form-A (current with optional voltage) outputs, 4 digital inputs
6R 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 2 Form-C outputs, 8 digital inputs
6S 2 Form-A (no monitoring) and 4 Form-C outputs, 4 digital inputs
6T 4 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 8 digital inputs
6U 6 Form-A (no monitoring) outputs, 4 digital inputs
6V 2 Form-A outputs, 1 Form-C output, 2 Form-A (no monitoring) latching output, 8 digital inputs
INTER-RELAY 2A C37.94SM, 1300nm single-mode, ELED, 1 channel single-mode
COMMUNICATIONS 2B C37.94SM, 1300nm single-mode, ELED, 2 channel single-mode
(select a maximum of 1 per unit) 2E Bi-phase, single channel
For the last module, slot P is used for digital 2F Bi-phase, dual channel
2G IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
input/output modules; slot R is used for inter-relay
2H IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 128 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
communications modules. 72 1550 nm, single-mode, LASER, 1 Channel
73 1550 nm, single-mode, LASER, 2 Channel
74 Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, single-mode, LASER
75 Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1550 nm, Single-mode LASER
76 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 1 Channel
77 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, 64 kbps, multimode, LED, 2 Channels
7A 820 nm, multi-mode, LED, 1 Channel
7B 1300 nm, multi-mode, LED, 1 Channel
7C 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
7D 1300 nm, single-mode, LASER, 1 Channel
7E Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multi-mode
7F Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multi-mode
7G Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode ELED
7H 820 nm, multi-mode, LED, 2 Channels
7I 1300 nm, multi-mode, LED, 2 Channels
7J 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
7K 1300 nm, single-mode, LASER, 2 Channels
7L Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multi-mode, LED
7M Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multi-mode, LED
7N Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED
7P Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, LASER
7Q Channel 1 - G.703; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode LASER
7R G.703, 1 Channel
7S G.703, 2 Channels
7T RS422, 1 Channel
7W RS422, 2 Channels
Replacement modules can be ordered separately as shown below. When ordering a replacement CPU module or face-
plate, please provide the serial number of your existing unit.
Not all replacement modules may be applicable to the M60 relay. Only the modules specified in the order codes are
available as replacement modules.
127(
2 Replacement module codes are subject to change without notice. CPU modules 9G, 9H, 9L, and 9M are obsolete.
See the web page for the product for the latest ordering options.
The replacement module order codes for the horizontal mount units are shown below.
The replacement module order codes for the reduced-size vertical mount units are shown below.
The UR series relays are microprocessor-based protective relays that are designed to measure power system conditions
directly via CT and VT inputs and via other sources of information, such as analog inputs, communications inputs and con-
tact inputs. The following figure shows the overall signal processing in URs.
An analog low pass anti-aliasing filter with a 3 dB corner frequency is set at 2.4 kHz and is used for current and voltage
analog filtering as well as signal conditioning. The same filtering is applied for phase, ground currents, phase-to-phase
2 (when applicable), and auxiliary voltages. The 2.4 kHz cut-off frequency applies to both 50 Hz and 60 Hz applications and
fixed in the hardware, and thus is not dependent on the system nominal frequency setting.
Tracking
HMI frequency Events
Protection
Ethernet selection,
algorithms Control
ports estimation Comtrade, data
I> elements,
Communi- logger
Serial cation Z< monitoring
Serial
ports protocols U< elements,
FlexLogic, DNP, Modbus,
IEC60870
IRIG-B
Accurate
IEEE Real-Time Time stamping PMU (IEEE C37.118,
Ethernet
1588 clock Synchrophasors Aggregation, IEC 61850-90-5)
SNTP calculations post-filtering IEC 61850 (GOOSE,
CPU module MMS Server)
Contact Inputs
Analog Inputs
Inter-relay
Inter-relay
comms
module
module
module
comms
module
Channel A
Ddebounce monitoring
filtering CRC check D Contact Outputs
module
G.703, RS-422,
Optoisolated C37.94, direct fiber DCmA, RTD
859740A1.vsd
Currents:
Current harmonics are estimated based on raw samples with the use of the full-cycle Fourier filter. Harmonics 2nd through
25th are estimated.
True RMS value for the current is calculated on a per-phase basis. The true RMS can be used for demand recording or as
an input signal to Time Overcurrent function, if the latter is intended for thermal protection. The true RMS is calculated as
per the widely accepted definition:
t 2
I RMS t = --1-
2
i t dt (EQ 2.3)
T
t – T
RMS values include harmonics, inter-harmonics, DC components, and so on, along with fundamental frequency values.
The true RMS value reflects thermal effects of the current and is used for the thermal related monitoring and protection
functions.
Protection and control functions respond to phasors of the fundamental and/or harmonic frequency components (magni-
tudes and angles), with an exception for some functions that have an option for RMS or fundamental measurements, or
some function responding to RMS only. This type of response is explained typically in each element's section in the instruc-
tion manual.
Currents are pre-filtered using a Finite Impulse Response (FIR) digital filter. The filter is designed to reject DC components
and low-frequency distortions, without amplifying high-frequency noise. This filter is referred to as a modified MIMIC filter,
which provides excellent filtering and overall balance between speed and accuracy of filtering. The filter is cascaded with
the full-cycle Fourier filter for the current phasor estimation.
Voltages are pre-filtered using a patented Finite Impulse Response (FIR) digital filter. The filter has been optimized to reject
voltage transformers specific distortions, such as Capacitive Voltage Transformer (CVT) noise and high-frequency oscilla-
tory components. The filter is cascaded with the half-cycle Fourier filter for the voltage phasor estimation.
The URs measure power system frequency using the Clarke transformation by estimating the period of the waveform from
two consecutive zero-crossings in the same direction (negative-to-positive). Voltage or current samples are pre-filtered
using a Finite Impulse Response (FIR) digital filter to remove high frequency noise contained in the signal. The period is
used after several security conditions are met, such as true RMS signal must be above 6% nominal for a certain time and
others. If these security conditions are not met, the last valid measurement is used for a specific time after which the UR
reverts to nominal system frequency.
Synchrophasors are calculated using a patented convolution integral algorithm. This algorithm allows use of the same time
stamped samples, which are used for protection and taken at the same sampling frequency. This allows URs to use one
sampling clock for both protection algorithms and synchrophasors.
Synchrophasors on firmware versions 7.23 and up have been tested and certified to meet IEEE C.37.118-2011 and
C.37.118.1a-2014 standards for both metering and protection classes with outputs available up to 60 synchrophasors per
second for the metering class and 120 synchrophasors per second for the protection class. Synchrophasors measurement
are also available via IEC 61850-90-5 protocol.
Contact inputs threshold is settable in the firmware with 17, 33, 84, 166 VDC settings available. Inputs are scanned every
0.5 ms and can be conditioned for the critical applications, using debounce time timer, settable from 0.0 ms to 16.0 ms.
Contact inputs with auto-burnishing are available as well, when external contacts are exposed to the contamination in a
harsh industrial environment.
All measured values are available in the UR metering section on the front panel and via communications protocols. Mea-
sured analog values and binary signals can be captured in COMTRADE format with sampling rates from 8 to 64 samples
per power cycle. Analog values can be captured with Data Logger, allowing much slower rates extended over long period of
time.
Other advanced UR order code options are available to support IEC 61850 Ed2.0 (including fast GOOSE, MMS server,
61850 services, ICD/CID/IID files, and so on), IEEE 1588 (IEEE C37.238 power profile) based time synchronization,
CyberSentry (advanced cyber security), the Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP), IEC 60870-5-103, and so on.
The operating times below include the activation time of a trip rated form-A output contact unless otherwise indi-
cated. FlexLogic™ operands of a given element are 4 ms faster. This should be taken into account when using
127( FlexLogic™ to interconnect with other protection or control elements of the relay, building FlexLogic™ equations, or
2 interfacing with other IEDs or power system devices via communications or different output contacts.
THERMAL MODEL GROUND TOC
Thermal overload curves: standard curve (Motor), FlexCurve™, Current: Phasor or RMS
standard curve (Motor) with voltage Pickup level: 0.000 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001
dependent function, IEC curve
Dropout level: 97% to 98% of pickup
Standard curve (motor) time multiplier: 0.00 to 16.00 in steps of
Level accuracy:
0.01
0.1 to 2.0 CT: ±0.5% of reading or ±0.4% of rated
Motor curve time multiplier: 0.00 to 16.00 in steps of 0.01 (whichever is greater)
FlexCurve™curve time multiplier: 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 > 2.0 CT: ±1.5% of reading > 2.0 CT rating
IEC curve time constant: 0 to 1000 in steps of 1 Curve shapes: IEEE Moderately/Very/Extremely
Thermal overload pickup: pu = overload factor FLA Inverse; IEC (and BS) A/B/C and Short
Overload factor (OF): 1.00 to 1.50 in steps of 0.01 Inverse; GE IAC Inverse, Short/Very/
Motor full load current (FLA): 0.050 to 1.000 pu in steps of 0.001 Extremely Inverse; I2t; FlexCurves™
(programmable); Definite Time (0.01 s
Standard overload curve, cutoff effect:
base curve)
TD 2.2116623
t trip = ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2
Curve multiplier: Time Dial = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of
I motor I motor
0.02530337 -------------- – 1 + 0.05054758 -------------- – 1
0.01
FLA FLA
Reset type: Instantaneous/Timed (per IEEE)
Standard overload curve, shift effect: Timing accuracy: Operate at > 1.03 actual pickup
TD 2.2116623 ±3.5% of operate time or ±½ cycle
t trip = --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
I 2 I motor (whichever is greater)
0.02530337 ------------------------- – 1 + 0.05054758 ------------------------- – 1
motor
OF FLA OF FLA Voltage restraint: Modifies pickup current for voltage in the
range of 0.1<V<0.9 VT Nominal in a
Motor rated voltage: 1 to 50000 V in steps of 1
fixed linear relationship
Thermal model biasing: current unbalance, RTDs
Thermal model update rate: 2 power cycles PHASE/NEUTRAL/GROUND IOC
Current: Phasor only
Thermal capacity level accuracy: ±1%
Pickup level: 0.000 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Stopped/running time cool constants: 1 to 65000 min. in steps of 1
Dropout level: 97 to 98% of pickup
Stopped/running time cool constants decay: exponential
Level accuracy:
Hot/cold safe stall ratio: 0.01 to 1.00 in steps of 0.01
0.1 to 2.0 CT rating: ±0.5% of reading or ±0.4% of rated
Current accuracy: per phase current inputs
(whichever is greater)
Current source: true RMS
> 2.0 CT rating ±1.5% of reading
Timing accuracy: ±100 ms or ±2%, whichever is greater
Overreach: <2%
Timing accuracy for voltage dependent overload:
Pickup delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
±100 ms or ±4%, whichever is greater
Reset delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
STATOR DIFFERENTIAL Operate time: <16 ms at 3 pickup at 60 Hz
Pickup: 0.050 to 1.00 pu in steps of 0.01 (Phase/Ground IOC)
Slope 1 and 2: 1 to 100% in steps of 1 <20 ms at 3 pickup at 60 Hz
Break 1: 1.00 to 1.50 pu in steps of 0.01 (Neutral IOC)
Break 2: 1.50 to 30.00 pu in steps of 0.01 Timing accuracy: Operate at 1.5 pickup
Operate time: <¾ cycle at Idiff > 5 × pickup ±3% or ±4 ms (whichever is greater)
Limit angle: 40 to 90° in steps of 1, independent for Pickup level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading or ±0.4% of rated
(whichever is greater) at 0.1 to 2.0 CT
forward and reverse
rating; ±1.5% of reading at >2.0 CT rat-
Angle accuracy: ±2°
ing
Offset impedance: 0.00 to 250.00 in steps of 0.01
Dropout level: 102 to 103% of pickup
Pickup level: 0.002 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.01
Pickup delay: 0 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Dropout level: 97 to 98%
Time accuracy: ±3% or ±10 ms, whichever is greater
Operation time: < 16 ms at 3 pickup at 60 Hz
Pickup time: <55 ms at 60 Hz
AMP UNBALANCE SENSITIVE DIRECTIONAL POWER
Average and full load amps: RMS
Measured power: 3-phase, true RMS
I_1 and I_2 amps: phasor
Number of stages: 2
Pickup level: 0.0 to 100.0% in steps of 0.1
Characteristic angle: 0 to 359° in steps of 1
Dropout level: 97 to 98% of pickup
Calibration angle: 0.00 to 0.95° in steps of 0.05
Level accuracy: ±0.1
Minimum power: –1.200 to 1.200 pu in steps of 0.001
Pickup delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Pickup level accuracy: ±1% or ±0.001 pu, whichever is greater
Reset delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Hysteresis: 2% or 0.001 pu, whichever is greater
Operate time: <20 ms at 1.10 pickup at 60 Hz
Pickup delay: 0 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Timing accuracy: ±3% or ±20 ms, whichever is greater
Time accuracy: ±3% or ±4 ms, whichever is greater
MECHANICAL JAM Operate time: 50 ms
Operating condition: Phase overcurrent
Arming condition: Motor not starting
Pickup level: 1.00 to 10.00 FLA in steps of 0.01
Dropout level: 97 to 98% of pickup
Level accuracy: at 0.1 to 2.0 CT: ±0.5% of reading
at > 2.0 CT rating: ±1.5% of reading
Pickup delay: 0.10 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Reset delay: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Time accuracy: ±3% or ±20 ms, whichever is greater
FLEXLOGIC™ FLEXELEMENTS™
Programming language: Reverse Polish Notation with graphical Number of elements: 16
visualization (keypad programmable) Operating signal: any analog actual value, or two values in
Lines of code: 512 differential mode
Internal variables: 64 Operating signal mode: signed or absolute value
Supported operations: NOT, XOR, OR (2 to 16 inputs), AND (2 Operating mode: level, delta
to 16 inputs), NOR (2 to 16 inputs), Comparator direction: over, under
NAND (2 to 16 inputs), latch (reset-domi-
Pickup Level: –90.000 to 90.000 pu in steps of 0.001
nant), edge detectors, timers
Hysteresis: 0.1 to 50.0% in steps of 0.1
Inputs: any logical variable, contact, or virtual
input Delta dt: 20 ms to 60 days
Number of timers: 32 Pickup & dropout delay: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
Pickup delay: 0 to 60000 (ms, sec., min.) in steps of 1 NON-VOLATILE LATCHES
Dropout delay: 0 to 60000 (ms, sec., min.) in steps of 1 Type: set-dominant or reset-dominant
Number: 16 (individually programmed)
FLEXCURVES™
Output: stored in non-volatile memory
Number: 4 (A through D)
Execution sequence: as input prior to protection, control, and
Reset points: 40 (0 through 1 of pickup)
FlexLogic™
Operate points: 80 (1 through 20 of pickup)
Time delay: 0 to 65535 ms in steps of 1 USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDs
Number: 48 plus trip and alarm
FLEX STATES Programmability: from any logical variable, contact, or vir-
Number: up to 256 logical variables grouped
tual input
under 16 Modbus addresses
Reset mode: self-reset or latched
Programmability: any logical variable, contact, or virtual
input LED TEST
Initiation: from any digital input or user-program-
mable condition
Number of tests: 3, interruptible at any time
Duration of full test: approximately 3 minutes
Test sequence 1: all LEDs on
Test sequence 2: all LEDs off, one LED at a time on for 1 s
Test sequence 3: all LEDs on, one LED at a time off for 1 s
2.3.3 MONITORING
2.3.4 METERING
2.3.5 INPUTS
2.3.7 OUTPUTS
Break (DC inductive, L/R = 40 ms): Break at L/R of 40 ms: 0.25 A DC max. (DC resistive as per IEC
61810-1)
VOLTAGE CURRENT
Operate time: < 4 ms
24 V 1A
Contact material: silver alloy
48 V 0.5 A
Control: separate operate and reset inputs
125 V 0.3 A
Control mode: operate-dominant or reset-dominant
250 V 0.2 A
Operate time: < 4 ms
Contact material: silver alloy
2.3.8 COMMUNICATIONS
The following specifications apply to C37.94 modules implemented before January 2012.
EMITTER, FIBER TRANSMIT RECEIVED POWER MAX. OPTICAL
TYPE POWER SENSITIVITY BUDGET INPUT POWER
820 nm LED, –20 dBm –30 dBm 10 dB –7.6 dBm
Multimode
1300 nm LED, –21 dBm –30 dBm 9 dB –11 dBm
Multimode
1300 nm ELED, –23 dBm –32 dBm 9 dB –14 dBm
Single mode
1300 nm Laser, –1 dBm –30 dBm 29 dB –14 dBm
Single mode
1550 nm Laser, +5 dBm –30 dBm 35 dB –14 dBm
Single mode
These power budgets are calculated from the manu- The power budgets for the 1300 nm ELED are calcu-
127( facturer’s worst-case transmitter power and worst 127( lated from the manufacturer's transmitter power and
case receiver sensitivity. receiver sensitivity at ambient temperature. At
extreme temperatures these values deviate based
on component tolerance. On average, the output
power decreases as the temperature is increased by
a factor 1dB / 5°C.
2.3.10 ENVIRONMENTAL
THERMAL
Products go through an environmental test based upon an
Accepted Quality Level (AQL) sampling process.
2.3.13 APPROVALS
APPROVALS
COMPLIANCE APPLICABLE ACCORDING TO
COUNCIL DIRECTIVE
CE Low voltage directive EN 60255-5
EMC directive EN 60255-26 / EN 50263
2 EN 61000-6-5
C-UL-US --- UL 508
UL 1053
C22.2 No. 14
2.3.14 MAINTENANCE
MOUNTING CLEANING
Attach mounting brackets using 20 inch-pounds (±2 inch-pounds) Normally, cleaning is not required; but for situations where dust
of torque. has accumulated on the faceplate display, a dry cloth can be used.
Units that are stored in a de-energized state should be
powered up once per year, for one hour continuously, to
127( avoid deterioration of electrolytic capacitors.
a) HORIZONTAL UNITS
The M60 Motor Protection System is available as a 19-inch rack horizontal mount unit with a removable faceplate. The
faceplate can be specified as either basic or enhanced at the time of ordering. The enhanced faceplate contains additional
user-programmable pushbuttons and LED indicators.
The modular design allows the relay to be easily upgraded or repaired by a qualified service person. The faceplate is
hinged to allow easy access to the removable modules, and is itself removable to allow mounting on doors with limited rear
depth.
In November 2017, GE began transitioning to Rev. 2 of the enhanced horizontal front panel. This panel can be identified by
the use of a screw instead of a knob to close the panel. It can conform to an IP54 rating with the IP54 mounting collar pur-
chased separately. The IP54 mounting collar can be used in panel-mount installations, not 19-inch rack-mount installations.
The IP54 mounting collar cannot be used with Rev. 1 enhanced front panels.
3
The case dimensions are shown below, along with panel cutout details for panel mounting. When planning the location of
your panel cutout, ensure that provision is made for the faceplate to swing open without interference to or from adjacent
equipment.
The relay must be mounted such that the faceplate sits semi-flush with the panel or switchgear door, allowing the operator
access to the keypad and the RS232 communications port. The relay is secured to the panel with the use of four screws
supplied with the relay.
11.016”
[279,81 mm]
9.687”
[246,05 mm]
17.56”
[446,02 mm]
7.460”
[189,48 mm]
6.995” 6.960”
[177,67 mm] [176,78 mm]
19.040”
[483,62 mm]
842807A1.CDR
9.687”
[24.605 cm] 10.97”
[27.86 cm]
6.995” 6.96”
[17.767 cm] [17.68 cm]
18.370”
[466,60 mm]
0.280”
[7,11 mm]
Typ. x 4
CUT-OUT
7.13” 4.000”
[181.1 mm] [101,60 mm]
17.750”
[450,85 mm] 842808A2.CDR
BEZEL OUTLINE
8x0.156”
(9.5 mm)
0.375”
(3.962 mm)
(47.6 mm)
10.90”
1.875”
8.97”
(227.8 mm) (276.8 mm)
9.80”
(248.9 mm) 6.960”
(9.5 mm)
0.375”
(176.8 mm)
(121.5 mm)
4.785”
0.375”
17.52” Brackets repositioned (9.5 mm)
(445.0 mm) for switchgear mounting 5.000” 0.375”
(127.0 mm)
9.520” (9.5 mm)
14.520”
(368.8 mm)
17.720”
(241.8 mm)
3
HORIZONTAL PANEL MOUNTING
4x0.28” (450.1 mm)
18.37” (7.1 mm
(466.6 mm) diameter)
HORIZONTAL FRONT VIEW
CUTOUT
7.13” 4.00”
(181.1 mm) (101.6 mm) 7.00”
(177.8 mm)
17.75” 19.00”
(450.8 mm) (482.6 mm)
827704B5.cdr
MOUNTING PANEL
3
16.00” [40.64 cm]
Ø 0.200
6 PLACES
8.34”
[21.18 cm]
7.65”
[19.43 cm]
IP54 COLLAR
NOTES
1. INSPECT THE COLLAR BEFORE INSTALLATION, VERIFY GASKET IS ADHERED TO THE METAL ON ALL SIDES
2. MAKE SURE THE RELAY IS POSITIONED CENTER TO THE CUT OUT
3. INSTALL IP-54 COLLAR, CONFIRM THE GASKET PROPERLY MATES WITH THE PANEL ON ALL SIDES
SECURE USING #8-32 HEX NUT AT 6 PLACES. 842497A1.cdr
b) VERTICAL UNITS
The M60 Motor Protection System is available as a reduced size (¾) vertical mount unit, with a removable faceplate. The
faceplate can be specified as either basic or enhanced at the time of ordering. The enhanced faceplate contains additional
user-programmable pushbuttons and LED indicators.
The modular design allows the relay to be easily upgraded or repaired by a qualified service person. The faceplate is
hinged to allow easy access to the removable modules, and is itself removable to allow mounting on doors with limited rear
depth. There is also a removable dust cover that fits over the faceplate, which must be removed when attempting to access
the keypad or RS232 communications port.
The case dimensions are shown below, along with panel cutout details for panel mounting. When planning the location of
your panel cutout, ensure that provision is made for the faceplate to swing open without interference to or from adjacent
equipment.
The relay must be mounted such that the faceplate sits semi-flush with the panel or switchgear door, allowing the operator
access to the keypad and the RS232 communications port. The relay is secured to the panel with the use of four screws
supplied with the relay.
Front
Bezel
13.56”
15.00” (344.4 mm)
(381.0 mm)
14.03”
9.58” (356.2 mm) CUTOUT
(243.4 mm)
Front of Panel
Reference only 13.66”
(347.0 mm)
1.38”
(35.2 mm)
Mounting Bracket
Vertical Enhanced Top View
7.00"
Front of (177.8 mm)
panel Panel
Mounting bracket
Front
bezel
13.72" 13.50"
(348.5 mm) (342.9 mm)
7.13”
(181.1 mm)
1.85" 4.00
(47.0 mm) (101.6)
1.57” 0.46”
(39.9 mm) (11.7 mm)
9.00"
(228.6 mm) Mounting bracket
(365.8 mm)
(346.7 mm)
14.40”
13.65”
Terminal blocks
7.00"
(177.8 mm)
DISPLAY CABLE
GROUND CABLE
ATTACH CABLE TO
FRONT BEZEL
BEFORE MOUNTING
FRONT BEZEL ON
THE
PANEL
3-7
3
3.1 DESCRIPTION 3 HARDWARE
6.66"
(169.2)
5.33"
(135.4)
INCHES
(MILLIMETERS) 2.83"
1.00"
(71.9)
(25.4)
PANEL SHOWN FOR
0.68" 0.04" 1.33" REFERENCE ONLY
(17.3) (1.0) (33.9) (VIEWED FROM FRONT)
'X' 'X'
1.00"
(25.4)
T
OU
T-
CU
3
5.27"
(133.8)
12.20"
(309.9)
'X' 'X'
Figure 3–9: M60 VERTICAL SIDE MOUNTING REAR DIMENSIONS (BASIC PANEL)
Module withdrawal and insertion may only be performed when control power has been
WARNING removed from the unit. Inserting an incorrect module type into a slot may result in personal
injury, damage to the unit or connected equipment, or undesired operation.
Proper electrostatic discharge protection (for example, a static strap) must be used when
coming in contact with modules while the relay is energized.
The relay, being modular in design, allows for the withdrawal and insertion of modules. Modules must only be replaced with
like modules in their original factory configured slots.
The enhanced faceplate can be opened to the left, once the thumb screw has been removed, as shown below. This allows
for easy accessibility of the modules for withdrawal. The new wide-angle hinge assembly in the enhanced front panel opens
completely and allows easy access to all modules in the M60.
842812A1.CDR
The 4.0x release of the M60 relay includes new hardware modules.The new CPU modules are specified with codes
9E and higher. The new CT/VT modules are specified with the codes 8F and higher.
127(
The new CT/VT modules can only be used with new CPUs; similarly, old CT/VT modules can only be used with old
CPUs. To prevent hardware mismatches, the new modules have blue labels and a warning sticker stating “Attn.:
Ensure CPU and DSP module label colors are the same!”. In the event that there is a mismatch between the
CPU and CT/VT module, the relay will not function and a DSP ERROR or HARDWARE MISMATCH error will be dis-
played.
All other input and output modules are compatible with the new hardware. Firmware versions 4.0x and higher are
only compatible with the new hardware modules. Previous versions of the firmware (3.4x and earlier) are only com-
patible with the older hardware modules.
3
M60 Motor Management Relay RATINGS: Model: M60D00HCHF8AH6AM6BP8BX7A
Mods: 000
Control Power: 88-300V DC @ 35W / 77-265V AC @ 35VA Wiring Diagram: ZZZZZZ
Contact Inputs: 300V DC Max 10mA Inst. Manual: D
Contact Outputs: Standard Pilot Duty / 250V AC 7.5A Serial Number: MAZB98000029
360V A Resistive / 125V DC Break Firmware: D
GE Multilin 4A @ L/R = 40mS / 300W Mfg. Date: 1998/01/05
Technical Support:
Made in
Tel: (905) 294-6222 http://www.GEIndustrial.com/Multilin ®
®
Canada
Fax: (905) 201-2098 - M A A B 9 7 0 0 0 0 9 9 -
X W V U T S R P N M L K J H G F D B
c b a c b a c b a c b a
b a b a
Tx1 1 1
1 1
2 2
Rx1 2 2
3 Tx1 3
3 3
Tx1
4 4
CH1
4 4
Rx1 5
Tx2 CH1 5
Tx 6
Rx 6
CH2
Rx2 IN 7
Tx2
7
8
CH2
Tx2 8
OUT
Rx2
7<3,&$/&21),*85$7,21
7+($&6,*1$/3$7+,6&21),*85$%/(
326,7,9(:$776
&,5&8,7%5($.(5
$
%
&
3
)XVH *URXQG
LVRODWLRQ
OLQN
0D
0D
0D
0D
0E
0E
0E
0E
0F
0F
0F
0F
)D
)D
)D
)D
)D
)D
)D
)E
)E
)E
)E
)F
)F
)F
)F
)F
)F
)F
9%
9&
9$
,*
,*
9%
9&
,*
,*
,*
9$
,*
,$
,$
,%
,&
,$
,&
,&
,%
,%
,$
,$
,%
,&
,$
,&
,&
,%
,%
&855(17683(59,6,21
92/7$*($1'
92/7$*(,13876 &855(17,13876 &855(17,13876
)* )*
3D &217$&7,13873D ',*,7$/,138762873876 * , 3D 7&
3F &217$&7,13873F 3 3E
9
3D &217$&7,13873D 3F
3F &217$&7,13873F , 3D
3E &200213E 3 3E
92/7$*(683(59,6,21
9
3F
3D &217$&7,13873D
, 3D
3F &217$&7,13873F
3 3E 7&
3D &217$&7,13873D 9
3F
3F &217$&7,13873F
, 3D
3E &200213E
3 3E
9
3E 685*( 3F
+D +RW
&
57'+
+F &RPS
'%
+E 5HWXUQ IRU57'V+DQG+
56
+D +RW IURQW
'&21/<
57'+
+F &RPS
+D +RW
57'+
+F &RPS
3RZHU
+E 685*( VXSSO\
%
%E
&5,7,&$/
%D )$,/85(
%E ' &38
%D 9'&
'& 287387
%E
)
32:(56833/<
%E +,
&21752/ &797
$&RU'& %E /2 *
32:(5
%D
%D 685*( +
%E ),/7(5 57'
-
.
6KLHOGHG
WZLVWHGSDLUV /
&217$&766+2:1
'E :,7+12 0
&38(
56
'E &21752/32:(5 &797
*URXQGDW &20 1
85
'E FRP
'D 3
GHYLFH
56 ,QSXWV
'D &20 5 RXWSXWV
'D FRP
'E 6
&RD[LDO
'D ,5,*%
5HDUYLHZ
,QSXW
&RD[LDO %1& 9(57,&$/
02'8/($55$1*(0(17
,5,*%
&RD[LDO %1& 2XWSXW
&RD[LDO
)RU,5,*%LQSXW
RQO\XVHRQH +25,=217$/02'8/($55$1*(0(17
$D&'5
WHUPLQDODVLQSXW ; : 9 8 7 6 5 3 1 0 / . - + * ) ' %
7KLVGLDJUDPLVEDVHGRQWKHIROORZLQJRUGHUFRGH
1R$:* 0++&+))+&0)3*8;;:;;
PLQLPXP ,QSXW 97&7 57' 97&7 &38 3RZHU 7KLVGLDJUDPSURYLGHVDQH[DPSOHRIKRZWKHGHYLFH
02'8/(60867%(
RXWSXW 6XSSO\
*5281'(',) LVZLUHGQRWVSHFLILFDOO\KRZWRZLUHWKHGHYLFH3OHDVH
*5281'
%86
7(50,1$/,6 5HDU9LHZ UHIHUWRWKH,QVWUXFWLRQ0DQXDOIRUDGGLWLRQDOGHWDLOVRQ
3529,'('
2SWLRQDO ZLULQJEDVHGRQYDULRXVFRQILJXUDWLRQV
+F S
+E 5HWXUQ IRU57'V+DQG+
+RWWHVW
6WDWRU 56 +D +RW
57'+
57' +F &RPS
57'
+D +RW
57'+
+F &RPS
$1$/2*
2873876
&RP FSP
237,21,2
6KLHOG +E 5HWXUQ IRU57'V+DQG+
VKOG 0(7(5
6KLHOG +D +RW
57'+
+F &RPS
3/&
75$16'8&(5,138762873876
) +E 685*(
%E
557' &5,7,&$/
%D )$,/85(
5HPRWH57'0RGXOH %E
%D 9'&
'& 287387
%E
&+$11(/ &+$11(/ &+$11(/
:,7+237,21)
%E +,
56 56 56 &21752/
),%(5 $&RU'& %E /2
32:(5 0027253527(&7,216<67(0
6+/' 6+/' 6+/' 7[ 5[ %D
%D 685*(
32:(56833/<
%E ),/7(5
3-13
3
3.2 WIRING 3 HARDWARE
The dielectric strength of the UR-series module hardware is shown in the following table:
Table 3–1: DIELECTRIC STRENGTH OF UR-SERIES MODULE HARDWARE
MODULE MODULE FUNCTION TERMINALS DIELECTRIC STRENGTH
TYPE (AC)
FROM TO
1 Power supply High (+); Low (+); (–) Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute
1 Power supply 48 V DC (+) and (–) Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute
1 Power supply Relay terminals Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute
2 Reserved N/A N/A N/A
3 Reserved N/A N/A N/A
3 4
5
Digital inputs/outputs
Analog inputs/outputs
All
All except 8b
Chassis
Chassis
2000 V AC for 1 minute
< 50 V DC
6 Digital inputs/outputs All Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute
G.703 All except 2b, 3a, 7b, 8a Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute
7
RS422 All except 6a, 7b, 8a Chassis < 50 V DC
8 CT/VT All Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute
9 CPU All Chassis 2000 V AC for 1 minute
Filter networks and transient protection clamps are used in the hardware to prevent damage caused by high peak voltage
transients, radio frequency interference (RFI), and electromagnetic interference (EMI). These protective components can
be damaged by application of the ANSI/IEEE C37.90 specified test voltage for a period longer than the specified one min-
ute.
Control power supplied to the relay must be connected to the matching power supply range of the
NOTICE relay. If voltage is applied to the wrong terminals, damage can occur.
The M60 relay, like almost all electronic relays, contains electrolytic capacitors. These capacitors are
well-known to deteriorate over time if voltage is not applied periodically. Deterioration can be avoided
by powering up the relay at least once a year.
The power supply module can be ordered for two possible voltage ranges, and the UR can be ordered with or without a
redundant power supply module option. Each range has a dedicated input connection for proper operation. The ranges are
as shown below (see the Technical Specifications section of chapter 2 for additional details):
• Low (LO) range: 24 to 48 V (DC only) nominal.
• High (HI) range: 125 to 250 V nominal.
The power supply module provides power to the relay and supplies power for dry contact input connections.
The power supply module provides 48 V DC power for dry contact input connections and a critical failure relay (see the
Typical Wiring Diagram earlier). The critical failure relay is a form-C device that will be energized once control power is
applied and the relay has successfully booted up with no critical self-test failures. If on-going self-test diagnostic checks
detect a critical failure (see the Self-Test Errors section in chapter 7) or control power is lost, the relay will de-energize.
For high reliability systems, the M60 has a redundant option in which two M60 power supplies are placed in parallel on the
bus. If one of the power supplies become faulted, the second power supply will assume the full load of the relay without any
interruptions. Each power supply has a green LED on the front of the module to indicate it is functional. The critical fail relay
of the module will also indicate a faulted power supply.
An LED on the front of the control power module shows the status of the power supply:
LED INDICATION POWER SUPPLY
CONTINUOUS ON OK
ON / OFF CYCLING Failure
OFF Failure
127(
$&RU'& JDXJHVWUDQGHG $&RU'&
ZLUHZLWKVXLWDEOH
GLVFRQQHFWGHYLFHV
LVUHFRPPHQGHG
+HDY\FRSSHUFRQGXFWRU )XVHV )XVHV
RUEUDLGHGZLUH
*1'
³
¯ /2: +,*+
),/7(5 685*(
&21752/
32:(5
237,21$/
(7+(51(76:,7&+
3
6ZLWFKJHDU 85
JURXQGEXV SURWHFWLRQV\VWHP
$%&'5
A CT/VT module can have voltage or current inputs on channels 1 through 4 inclusive, or channels 5 through 8 inclusive.
Channels 1 and 5 are intended for connection to phase A, and are labeled as such in the relay. Likewise, channels 2 and 6
are intended for connection to phase B, and channels 3 and 7 are intended for connection to phase C.
Channels 4 and 8 are intended for connection to a single-phase source. For voltage inputs, these channel are labelled as
auxiliary voltage (VX). For current inputs, these channels are intended for connection to a CT between system neutral and
ground, and are labelled as ground current (IG).
Verify that the connection made to the relay terminals for nominal current of 1 A or 5 A matches the
NOTICE secondary rating of the connected CTs. Unmatched CTs can result in equipment damage or inade-
quate protection.
To connect the module, size 12 American Wire Gauge (AWG) is commonly used; the maximum size is 10 AWG.
CT/VT modules may be ordered with a standard ground current input that is the same as the phase current input. Each AC
current input has an isolating transformer and an automatic shorting mechanism that shorts the input when the module is
withdrawn from the chassis. There are no internal ground connections on the current inputs. Current transformers with 1 to
50000 A primaries and 1 A or 5 A secondaries can be used.
CT/VT modules with a sensitive ground input are also available. The ground CT input of the sensitive ground modules is 10
times more sensitive than the ground CT input of standard CT/VT modules. However, the phase CT inputs and phase VT
inputs are the same as those of regular CT/VT modules.
The above modules have enhanced diagnostics, when ordered as such, that can automatically detect CT/VT hardware fail-
ure and take the relay out of service.
CT connections for both ABC and ACB phase rotations are identical as shown in the Typical Wiring Diagram.
The exact placement of a zero-sequence core balance CT to detect ground fault current is shown as follows. Twisted-pair
cabling on the zero-sequence CT is recommended.
Ground
outside CT
3
To ground;
LOAD must be on
load side
LOAD 996630A5
127(
~ 1a
~ 1b
~ 2a
~ 2b
~ 3a
~ 3b
~ 4a
~ 4b
~ 5a
~ 6a
~ 7a
~ 8a
~ 1c
~ 2c
~ 3c
~ 4c
~ 5c
~ 6c
~ 7c
~ 8c
VC
VB
VA
VX
IG
IG1
IA
IC
IA1
IC1
IB
IB1
IG5
VC
VB
VA
VX
IA5
IC5
IB5
~ 1b
~ 2a
~ 2b
~ 3a
~ 3b
~ 4a
~ 4b
~ 5a
~ 5b
~ 6a
~ 6b
~ 7a
~ 7b
~ 8a
~ 8b
~ 1c
~ 2c
~ 3c
~ 4c
~ 5c
~ 6c
~ 7c
~ 8c
IG
IG
IG1
IG1
IA
IC
IA
IC
IA1
IC1
IA1
IC1
IB
IB
IB1
IB1
IG5
IG5
IA5
IC5
IA5
IC5
IB5
IB5
Current inputs
8H, 8J, 8N, and 8R modules (8 CTs)
842766A3.CDR
The M60 can be ordered with a process bus interface module. This module is designed to interface with the GE Multilin
HardFiber system, allowing bi-directional IEC 61850 fiber optic communications with up to eight HardFiber merging units,
known as Bricks. The HardFiber system has been designed to integrate seamlessly with the existing UR-series applica-
tions, including protection functions, FlexLogic™, metering, and communications.
The IEC 61850 process bus system offers the following benefits.
• Drastically reduces labor associated with design, installation, and testing of protection and control applications using
the M60 by reducing the number of individual copper terminations.
• Integrates seamlessly with existing M60 applications, since the IEC 61850 process bus interface module replaces the
traditional CT/VT modules.
• Communicates using open standard IEC 61850 messaging.
For additional details on the HardFiber system, refer to GE publication GEK-113500: HardFiber System Instruction Manual.
3
3.2.6 CONTACT INPUTS AND OUTPUTS
Every contact input/output module has 24 terminal connections. They are arranged as three terminals per row, with eight
rows in total. A given row of three terminals may be used for the outputs of one relay. For example, for form-C relay outputs,
the terminals connect to the normally open (NO), normally closed (NC), and common contacts of the relay. For a form-A
output, there are options of using current or voltage detection for feature supervision, depending on the module ordered.
The terminal configuration for contact inputs is different for the two applications.
The contact inputs are grouped with a common return. The input/output modules have two versions of grouping: four inputs
per common return and two inputs per common return. When a contact input/output module is ordered, four inputs per com-
mon is used. If the inputs must be isolated per row, then two inputs per common return should be selected (4D module).
The tables and diagrams on the following pages illustrate the module types (6A, etc.) and contact arrangements that may
be ordered for the relay. Since an entire row is used for a single contact output, the name is assigned using the module slot
position and row number. However, since there are two contact inputs per row, these names are assigned by module slot
position, row number, and column position.
Some form-A / solid-state relay outputs include circuits to monitor the DC voltage across the output contact when it is open,
and the DC current through the output contact when it is closed. Each of the monitors contains a level detector whose out-
put is set to logic “On” when the current in the circuit is above the threshold setting. The voltage monitor is set to “On” when
there is a voltage across open contact (the detector allows a current of about 1 to 2.5 mA), and the current monitor is set to
“On” when the current flowing through the closed contact exceeds about 80 to 100 mA. The voltage monitor is intended to
check the health of the overall trip circuit, and the current monitor can be used to seal-in the output contact until an external
contact has interrupted current flow. If enabled, the current monitoring can be used as a seal-in signal to ensure that the
form-A contact does not attempt to break the energized inductive coil circuit and weld the output contacts.
Block diagrams are shown below for form-A and solid-state relay outputs with optional voltage monitor, optional current
monitor, and with no monitoring. The actual values shown for contact output 1 are the same for all contact outputs. Form-A
contact output with or without a current or voltage monitoring option is not polarity sensitive. The polarity shown in the figure
is required for solid-state contact output connection.
~#a ~#a
I I
~#b ~#b Load
V Load V
~#c + ~#c +
a) Voltage with optional
Voltage monitoring only Both voltage and current monitoring
current monitoring
~#a ~#a
V V
3 I ~#b
Load
I ~#b Load
~#c + ~#c +
b) Current with optional
Current monitoring only Both voltage and current monitoring
voltage monitoring
(external jumper a-b is required)
~#a
~#b
Load
~#c +
c) No monitoring
827862A5.CDR
Figure 3–19: FORM-A AND SOLID-STATE CONTACT OUTPUTS WITH VOLTAGE AND CURRENT MONITORING
The operation of voltage and current monitors is reflected with the corresponding FlexLogic™ operands (CONT OP # VON,
CONT OP # VOFF, and CONT OP # ION) which can be used in protection, control, and alarm logic. The typical application of
the voltage monitor is breaker trip circuit integrity monitoring; a typical application of the current monitor is seal-in of the
control command.
Refer to the Digital Elements section of chapter 5 for an example of how form-A and solid-state relay contacts can be
applied for breaker trip circuit integrity monitoring.
Consider relay contacts unsafe to touch when the unit is energized.
WARNING
USE OF FORM-A AND SOLID-STATE RELAY OUTPUTS IN HIGH IMPEDANCE CIRCUITS
127( For form-A and solid-state relay output contacts internally equipped with a voltage measuring cIrcuit across the
contact, the circuit has an impedance that can cause a problem when used in conjunction with external high input
impedance monitoring equipment such as modern relay test set trigger circuits. These monitoring circuits may con-
tinue to read the form-A contact as being closed after it has closed and subsequently opened, when measured as
an impedance.
The solution to this problem is to use the voltage measuring trigger input of the relay test set, and connect the form-
A contact through a voltage-dropping resistor to a DC voltage source. If the 48 V DC output of the power supply is
used as a source, a 500 , 10 W resistor is appropriate. In this configuration, the voltage across either the form-A
contact or the resistor can be used to monitor the state of the output.
Wherever a tilde “~” symbol appears, substitute with the slot position of the module; wherever a number sign “#”
appears, substitute the contact number.
127(
When current monitoring is used to seal-in the form-A and solid-state relay contact outputs, the Flex-
NOTICE Logic™ operand driving the contact output should be given a reset delay of 10 ms to prevent dam-
age of the output contact (in situations when the element initiating the contact output is bouncing, at
values in the region of the pickup value).
3
~4B MODULE ~4C MODULE ~4D MODULE ~4L MODULE
TERMINAL OUTPUT TERMINAL OUTPUT TERMINAL OUTPUT TERMINAL OUTPUT
ASSIGNMENT ASSIGNMENT ASSIGNMENT ASSIGNMENT
~1 Not Used ~1 Not Used ~1a, ~1c 2 Inputs ~1 2 Outputs
~2 Solid-State ~2 Solid-State ~2a, ~2c 2 Inputs ~2 2 Outputs
~3 Not Used ~3 Not Used ~3a, ~3c 2 Inputs ~3 2 Outputs
~4 Solid-State ~4 Solid-State ~4a, ~4c 2 Inputs ~4 2 Outputs
~5 Not Used ~5 Not Used ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs ~5 2 Outputs
~6 Solid-State ~6 Solid-State ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs ~6 2 Outputs
~7 Not Used ~7 Not Used ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7 2 Outputs
~8 Solid-State ~8 Solid-State ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8 Not Used
842762A4.CDR
6K
I I
~ 1b ~1 ~ 5c CONTACT IN ~ 5c ~1 ~ 1b ~ 7c CONTACT IN ~ 7c ~1 ~ 1b
~ 1c ~ 6a CONTACT IN ~ 6a ~ 1c ~ 8a CONTACT IN ~ 8a ~ 1c
~ 2a ~ 6c CONTACT IN ~ 6c V ~ 2a ~ 8c CONTACT IN ~ 8c V ~ 2a
I I
~ 2b ~2 ~ 5b COMMON ~ 5b ~2 ~ 2b ~ 7b COMMON ~ 7b ~2 ~ 2b
~ 2c ~ 2c ~ 2c
~ 7a CONTACT IN ~ 7a ~ 8b SURGE
~ 3a ~ 3a ~ 3a
~ 7c CONTACT IN ~ 7c
~ 3b ~3 ~3 ~ 3b ~3 ~ 3b
~ 8a CONTACT IN ~ 8a
~ 3c ~ 3c ~ 3c
~ 8c CONTACT IN ~ 8c
~ 4a ~ 4a ~ 4a
~ 7b COMMON ~ 7b
~ 4b ~4 ~4 ~ 4b ~4 ~ 4b
~ 4c ~ 8b SURGE ~ 4c ~ 4c
~ 5a ~ 5a
~ 5b ~5 ~5 ~ 5b
~ 5c ~ 5c
~ 6a ~ 6a
~ 6b ~6 ~6 ~ 6b
~ 6c ~ 6c
~ 7a
DIGITAL I/O
~ 7b ~7
~ 7c
~ 8a
3 ~ 8b
~ 8c
~8
842763A2.CDR
CONTACT INPUTS
A dry contact has one side connected to terminal B3b. This is the positive 48 V DC voltage rail supplied by the power sup-
ply module. The other side of the dry contact is connected to the required contact input terminal. Each contact input group
has its own common (negative) terminal which must be connected to the DC negative terminal (B3a) of the power supply
module. When a dry contact closes, a current of 1 to 3 mA will flow through the associated circuit.
A wet contact has one side connected to the positive terminal of an external DC power supply. The other side of this contact
is connected to the required contact input terminal. If a wet contact is used, then the negative side of the external source
must be connected to the relay common (negative) terminal of each contact group. The maximum external source voltage
for this arrangement is 300 V DC.
The voltage threshold at which each group of four contact inputs will detect a closed contact input is programmable as
17 V DC for 24 V sources, 33 V DC for 48 V sources, 84 V DC for 110 to 125 V sources, and 166 V DC for 250 V sources.
B1b
B1a Critical failure
B2b
Power supply module
B3a
48 V DC output
B3b
B5b HI+
B6b LO+ Control power
B6a
B8a Surge
B8b Filter
827741A5.CDR
127(
There is no provision in the relay to detect a DC ground fault on 48 V DC control power external output. We recommend
using an external DC supply.
There is no provision in the relay to detect a DC ground fault on 48 V DC control power external output. We recommend
using an external DC supply.
GENERAL APPLICATION CONSIDERATIONS
Contacts outputs of protective relays, auxiliary contacts from breakers, disconnectors and other devices, are generally con-
nected to contacts inputs of protective relays. In some situations, the contact outputs of some protective relays can have
high impedance connected across it. When such a contact output is connected across a M60 contact input, it can spuri-
ously operate the M60 input even when the output is open, if there is a substantial distributed capacitance (represented by
C1) present in the wiring between the output and the M60 input and the debounce time setting in the M60 relay is low
enough. This false assertion of the contact input, when there is inadvertent ground present at the DC positive terminal, can
be prevented by inserting a resistor across the M60 input.
The following figure shows a typical DC circuit, with battery ground detection, of contact input. The contact output has par-
allel impedance across it (represented by R1).
3
$POUBDU*OQVU
$FGU
$POUBDU*OQVU
$FGU
Figure 3–24: CONTACT INPUT CONNECTED TO A CONTACT OUTPUT WITH RESISTOR (R2) ACROSS THE INPUT
APPLICATION EXAMPLE
This example is for illustrative purposes only and the calculations present the worst-case scenario. In practice, the value of
debounce time can be lower.
Contact input ON state impedance used in the calculation of the discharge period is based on the following table.
Table 3–3: DISCHARGE PERIOD
BATTERY VOLTAGE (V) INPUT IMPEDANCE (KΩ)
130 50
250 97
Vresistor = 2 mA * 14 Kohm = 28 V
Vresistor < contact input threshold (84 V) (EQ 3.5)
In conclusion, in this example, the contact input does NOT operate falsely with the Burden Resistor across its input AND
when a battery ground is present.
USE OF CONTACT INPUTS WITH AUTO-BURNISHING
The contact inputs sense a change of the state of the external device contact based on the measured current. When exter-
nal devices are located in a harsh industrial environment (either outdoor or indoor), their contacts can be exposed to vari-
ous types of contamination. Normally, there is a thin film of insulating sulfidation, oxidation, or contaminates on the surface
of the contacts, sometimes making it difficult or impossible to detect a change of the state. This film must be removed to
establish circuit continuity – an impulse of higher than normal current can accomplish this.
The contact inputs with auto-burnish create a high current impulse when the threshold is reached to burn off this oxidation
3 layer as a maintenance to the contacts. Afterwards the contact input current is reduced to a steady-state current. The
impulse will have a 5 second delay after a contact input changes state.
current
50 to 70 mA
3 mA
time
25 to 50 ms 842749A1.CDR
3
CONTACT INPUT 1 AUTO-BURNISH = ON
CONTACT INPUT 2 AUTO-BURNISH = ON
842751A1.CDR
30
84 V threshold
166 V threshold
17 V threshold
33 V threshold
e
at
st
e
25
nc
da
pe
im
w
Lo
20
3
Current (millamperes)
15
s
m
oh
K
10
10
166 V threshold
84 V threshold
5 33 V threshold
17 V threshold
dance state
100 K ohms HIgh impe
0 5
0 100 150 200 250 300
0
Voltage (Volts) 859757A2.vsd
Transducer input modules can receive input signals from external DCmA output transducers (DCmA In) or resistance tem-
perature detectors (RTDs). Hardware and software are provided to receive signals from these external transducers and
convert these signals into a digital format for use as required.
Transducer output modules provide DC current outputs in several standard DCmA ranges. Software is provided to config-
ure virtually any analog quantity used in the relay to drive the analog outputs.
Every transducer input/output module has a total of 24 terminal connections. These connections are arranged as three ter-
minals per row with a total of eight rows. A given row may be used for either inputs or outputs, with terminals in column "a"
having positive polarity and terminals in column "c" having negative polarity. Since an entire row is used for a single input/
output channel, the name of the channel is assigned using the module slot position and row number.
Each module also requires that a connection from an external ground bus be made to terminal 8b. The current outputs
require a twisted-pair shielded cable, where the shield is grounded at one end only. The following figure illustrates the trans- 3
ducer module types (5A, 5C, 5D, 5E, and 5F) and channel arrangements that may be ordered for the relay.
Wherever a tilde “~” symbol appears, substitute with the slot position of the module.
127(
842764A1.CDR
Hot ~1a
RTD ~1
Comp ~1c
For RTD ~1 & ~2 Return ~1b RTD terminals
3 RTD ~2
Hot ~2a
Comp ~2c
RTD
A 9-pin RS232C serial port is located on the M60 faceplate for programming with a personal computer. All that is required
to use this interface is a personal computer running the EnerVista UR Setup software provided with the relay. Cabling for
the RS232 port is shown in the following figure for both 9-pin and 25-pin connectors.
The baud rate for this port is fixed at 19200 bps.
127( )URQWSDQHOSLQ563URJUDPSRUW
1$
7;'
5;'
5(/$<
3(5621$/ 1$
&20387(5 6*1'6LJQDO*URXQG
)52173$1(/
1$
3
352*5$03257 1$
1$
1$
3,1
56 56
'&211(&725 '&211(&725
856,17(5)$&( &2025&20
6(5,$/3257
5(/$< &20387(5
$FGU
7;' 5;'
5;' 7;'
6*1' 6*1'
3,1 3,1
&211(&725 &211(&725
a) OVERVIEW
In addition to the faceplate RS232 port, the M60 provides two additional communication ports or a managed six-port Ether-
net switch, depending on the installed CPU module. In the following table, multiple Ethernet ports are supported, but only
one can be used at a time. For example, the 10Base-F (normal) port and 10Base-T (alternate) port are supported in the 9G
module, but only one can be used at a time.
The CPU modules do not require a surge ground connection.
127(
Table 3–5: CPU MODULE COMMUNICATIONS (MODULE APPLICABLE DEPENDS ON ORDER CODE)
CPU TYPE COM1 COM2
9E RS485 RS485
9G 10Base-F or 10Base-T (obsolete) RS485
9H Redundant 10Base-F or 10Base-T (obsolete) RS485
9J 100Base-FX or 10/100Base-T RS485
9K Redundant 100Base-FX or 10/100Base-T RS485
9L 100Base-FX (obsolete) RS485
9M Redundant 100Base-FX (obsolete) RS485
9N 10/100Base-T RS485
9S Six-port managed Ethernet switch RS485
For the 9G/9H CPU, the 10Base-T port can only be used when the CH1 10Base-F fiber has been removed. The
10Base-T Ethernet cable and the CH1 10Base-F fiber cable cannot both be installed at the same time.
127(
For 9J/9K CPU, the 10/100Base-T port has the lowest priority and is only active if both CH1 and CH2 fiber links are
down. Installation of the 10/100Base-T Ethernet cable at the same time as the CH1 and/or CH2 100Base-F fiber
cables does not affect the communication over the CH1 or CH2 fiber ports.
6KLHOGHGWZLVWHGSDLUFDEOH
'E
(
56 60ILEHU
'E ³
/
&20 RSWLFFDEOH %DVH)/ 1250$/ &20
*URXQGDW 'E &20021
85 'D
'D 56
GHYLFH 56 'D ³
'D ³ &20
&20 *URXQGDW 'D &20021
'D &20021
85
'E 'E
GHYLFH
³ 'D ³ ,5,*%
'D ,5,*%
LQSXW LQSXW
%1&
3
%1&
&RD[LDOFDEOH &RD[LDOFDEOH
&38
&38
,5,*%RXWSXW %1& ,5,*%RXWSXW
%1&
&RD[LDOFDEOH &RD[LDOFDEOH
00ILEHU
7[
*
1250$/
&20
RSWLFFDEOH %DVH)/ 60ILEHURSWLFFDEOH
0
5[ 1250$/
&20
%DVH)/
6KLHOGHG(WKHUQHWFDEOH %DVH7 $/7(51$7( %DVH) $/7(51$7(
6KLHOGHGWZLVWHGSDLUFDEOH 6KLHOGHGWZLVWHGSDLUFDEOH
'D 'D
56 56
'D ³ 'D ³
&20 &20
*URXQGDW 'D &20021 *URXQGDW 'D &20021
85 'E 85
GHYLFH
'E
'D ³ ,5,*% GHYLFH
'D ³ ,5,*%
LQSXW LQSXW
%1& %1&
&RD[LDOFDEOH &RD[LDOFDEOH
&38
,5,*%RXWSXW
&38
%1& %1& ,5,*%RXWSXW
&RD[LDOFDEOH &RD[LDOFDEOH
00ILEHU
+
7[
5[ %DVH)/ 5('81'$17 6KLHOGHG(WKHUQHWFDEOH
1
6KLHOGHG(WKHUQHWFDEOH %DVH7 1250$/ &20
%DVH7 $/7(51$7( 6KLHOGHGWZLVWHGSDLUFDEH
6KLHOGHGWZLVWHGSDLUFDEOH 'D
'D 56
56 'D ³
'D ³ &20
&20 *URXQGDW 'D &20021
*URXQGDW 'D &20021 85 'E
85 'E GHYLFH
GHYLFH 'D ³ ,5,*%
'D ³ ,5,*% LQSXW
LQSXW %1&
%1& &RD[LDOFDEOH
&38
&RD[LDOFDEOH
,5,*%RXWSXW
&38
%1&
%1& ,5,*%RXWSXW &RD[LDOFDEOH
&RD[LDOFDEOH
00ILEHU
7[ %DVH); 1250$/ &20
-
RSWLFFDEOH 5[
%DVH7 $/7(51$7(
6KLHOGHG(WKHUQHWFDEOH
'D 6KLHOGHGWZLVWHGSDLUFDEOH
56
'D ³ 'D
6
&20 56
*URXQGDW 'D &20021 'D ³
&20
85 'E *URXQGDW 'D &20021
GHYLFH 85
'D ³ ,5,*% 'E
GHYLFH
LQSXW 'D ³ ,5,*%
%1& LQSXW
&RD[LDOFDEOH %1&
&38
$F&'5
00ILEHU
7[ %DVH); 1250$/
.
RSWLFFDEOH 5[
&20
7[
5[ %DVH); 5('81'$17
6KLHOGHG(WKHUQHWFDEOH
%DVH7 $/7(51$7(
6KLHOGHGWZLVWHGSDLUFDEOH
'D
56
'D ³
&20
*URXQGDW 'D &20021
85 'E
GHYLFH
'D ³ ,5,*%
LQSXW
%1&
&RD[LDOFDEOH
&38
%1& ,5,*%RXWSXW
&RD[LDOFDEOH
Figure 3–31: CPU MODULE COMMUNICATIONS WIRING (MODULE APPLICABLE DEPENDS ON ORDER CODE)
b) RS485 PORTS
RS485 data transmission and reception are accomplished over a single twisted pair with transmit and receive data alternat-
ing over the same two wires. Through the use of these ports, continuous monitoring and control from a remote computer,
SCADA system or PLC is possible.
To minimize errors from noise, the use of shielded twisted pair wire is recommended. Correct polarity must also be
observed. For instance, the relays must be connected with all RS485 “+” terminals connected together, and all RS485 “–”
terminals connected together. Though data is transmitted over a two-wire twisted pair, all RS485 devices require a shared
reference, or common voltage. This common voltage is implied to be a power supply common. Some systems allow the
shield (drain wire) to be used as common wire and to connect directly to the M60 COM terminal (#3); others function cor-
rectly only if the common wire is connected to the M60 COM terminal, but insulated from the shield.
To avoid loop currents, the shield should be grounded at only one point. If other system considerations require the shield to
be grounded at more than one point, install resistors (typically 100 ohms) between the shield and ground at each grounding
point. Each relay should also be daisy-chained to the next one in the link. A maximum of 32 relays can be connected in this
manner without exceeding driver capability. For larger systems, additional serial channels must be added. It is also possible
3
to use commercially available repeaters to have more than 32 relays on a single channel. Star or stub connections should
be avoided entirely.
Lightning strikes and ground surge currents can cause large momentary voltage differences between remote ends of the
communication link. For this reason, surge protection devices are internally provided at both communication ports. An iso-
lated power supply with an optocoupled data interface also acts to reduce noise coupling. To ensure maximum reliability, all
equipment should have similar transient protection devices installed.
Both ends of the RS485 circuit should also be terminated with an impedance as shown below.
COM
COMP 485COM
COMP 485COM
Up to 32 devices,
maximum 4000 feet
(1200 m)
Relay
ZT (*)
RS485 +
RS485 –
The fiber optic communication ports allow for fast and efficient communications between relays at 10 Mbps or 100 Mbps.
Optical fiber may be connected to the relay supporting a wavelength of 820 nm in multi-mode or 1310 nm in multi-mode
and single-mode. The 10 Mbps rate is available for CPU modules 9G and 9H; 100Mbps is available for modules 9J, 9K, 9L,
9M, and 9N. The 9H, 9K, and 9M modules have a second pair of identical optical fiber transmitter and receiver for redun-
dancy.
The optical fiber sizes supported include 50/125 µm, 62.5/125 µm and 100/140 µm for 10 Mbps. In order to engage or dis-
engage the ST type connector, only a quarter turn of the coupling is required.
3 3.2.10 IRIG-B
IRIG-B is a standard time code format that allows stamping of events to be synchronized among connected devices. The
IRIG-B code allows time accuracies of up to 100 ns. Using the IRIG-B input, the M60 operates an internal oscillator with 1
µs resolution and accuracy. The IRIG time code formats are serial, pulse width-modulated codes that can be either DC
level shifted or amplitude modulated (AM). The GE MultiSync 100 1588 GPS Clock as well as third-party equipment are
available for generating the IRIG-B signal; this equipment can use a global positioning system (GPS) satellite system to
obtain the time reference so that devices at different geographic locations can be synchronized.
*36FRQQHFWLRQ *36VDWHOOLWHV\VWHP
85
% ,5,*%
,5,*%
$ ,5,*%²
WLPHFRGHJHQHUDWRU
5*FRD[LDOFDEOH 5HFHLYHU
'&VKLIWRU %1&LQ
DPSOLWXGHPRGXODWHG
VLJQDOFDQEHXVHG
7RRWKHUGHYLFHV %1&RXW 5HSHDWHU
'&VKLIWRQO\
*36FRQQHFWLRQ *36VDWHOOLWHV\VWHP
,5,*%
WLPHFRGHJHQHUDWRU
6KLHOGHGWZLVWHGSDLUFDEOH 85
'&VKLIWRU % ,5,*%
DPSOLWXGHPRGXODWHG
$ ,5,*%²
VLJQDOFDQEHXVHG
5HFHLYHU
%1&LQ
$&'5
The IRIG-B repeater provides an amplified DC-shift IRIG-B signal to other equipment. By using one IRIG-B serial connec-
tion, several UR-series relays can be synchronized. The IRIG-B repeater has a bypass function to maintain the time signal
even when a relay in the series is powered down.
127( The M60 is intended for use with external clocks that set the IRIG-B control bits according to IEEE Std C37.118.1-
2011. When used with a source that sets the IRIG-B control bits according to IEEE Std 1344-1995, the source must
have the sign of its local time offset setting reversed, and if daylight savings time (DST) is used, the source's DST
start and DST stop date settings must be interchanged.
The M60 direct inputs and outputs feature makes use of the type 7 series of communications modules. These modules are
also used by the L90 Line Differential Relay for inter-relay communications. The direct input and output feature uses the
communications channels provided by these modules to exchange digital state information between relays. This feature is
available on all UR-series relay models except for the L90 Line Differential relay.
The communications channels are normally connected in a ring configuration as shown below. The transmitter of one mod-
ule is connected to the receiver of the next module. The transmitter of this second module is then connected to the receiver
of the next module in the ring. This is continued to form a communications ring. The figure below illustrates a ring of four
UR-series relays with the following connections: UR1-Tx to UR2-Rx, UR2-Tx to UR3-Rx, UR3-Tx to UR4-Rx, and UR4-Tx
to UR1-Rx. A maximum of 16 URs can be connected in a single ring.
3 UR #1
Tx
Rx
Tx
UR #2
Rx
Tx
UR #3
Rx
Tx
UR #4
Rx
842006A1.CDR
$&'5
Figure 3–36: RING CONFIGURATION FOR C37.94 MODULE (CONCEPT ALSO APPLIES TO G.703)
The interconnection for dual-channel Type 7 communications modules is shown below. Two channel modules allow for a
redundant ring configuration. That is, two rings can be created to provide an additional independent data path. The required
connections are: UR1-Tx1 to UR2-Rx1, UR2-Tx1 to UR3-Rx1, UR3-Tx1 to UR4-Rx1, and UR4-Tx1 to UR1-Rx1 for the first
ring; and UR1-Tx2 to UR4-Rx2, UR4-Tx2 to UR3-Rx2, UR3-Tx2 to UR2-Rx2, and UR2-Tx2 to UR1-Rx2 for the second
ring.
Tx1
Rx1
UR #1
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
Rx1
UR #2
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
3
Rx1
UR #3
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
Rx1
UR #4
Tx2
Rx2
842007A1.CDR
Tx
UR #1
Rx
Channel #1
Tx1
Rx1
UR #2
Tx2
Rx2
Channel #2
Tx
UR #3
Rx
842013A1.CDR
Figure 3–38: DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT SINGLE/DUAL CHANNEL COMBINATION CONNECTION
The interconnection requirements are described in further detail in this section for each specific variation of type 7 commu-
nications module. These modules are listed in the following table. All fiber modules use ST type connectors.
Not all the direct input and output communications modules may be applicable to the M60 relay. Only the modules
specified in the order codes are available as direct input and output communications modules.
127(
The following figure shows the configuration for the 7A, 7B, 7C, 7H, 7I, and 7J fiber-only modules.
Module: 7A / 7B / 7C 7H / 7I / 7J
Connection Location: Slot X Slot X
RX1 RX1
TX1 TX1
3
RX2
TX2
The following figure shows the configuration for the 72, 73, 7D, and 7K fiber-laser module.
TX1 TX1
RX1 RX1
TX2
RX2
a) DESCRIPTION
The following figure shows the 64K ITU G.703 co-directional interface configuration.
The G.703 module is fixed at 64 kbps. The SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP DIRECT I/O DIRECT I/O DATA RATE
setting is not applicable to this module.
127(
AWG 24 twisted shielded pair is recommended for external connections, with the shield grounded only at one end. Con-
necting the shield to pin X1a or X6a grounds the shield since these pins are internally connected to ground. Thus, if pin X1a
or X6a is used to ground the shield at one end, do not ground the shield at the other end. This interface module is protected
by surge suppression devices.
Shield X 1a
7S
Tx – X 1b
G.703
channel 1 Rx – X 2a
Inter-relay communications
Tx + X 2b
Rx + X 3a
Surge X 3b
Shield X 6a
Tx – X 6b
G.703
3 X 7a
Rx –
channel 2
Tx + X 7b
Rx + X 8a
Surge X 8b
842773A2.CDR
Shld. X 1a X 1a Shld.
7S
7S
Tx - X 1b X 1b Tx -
G.703 G.703
CHANNEL 1
Rx - X 2a X 2a Rx -
CHANNEL 1
Tx + X 2b X 2b Tx +
Rx + X 3a X 3a Rx +
SURGE X 3b X 3b SURGE
Shld. X 6a X 6a Shld.
Tx - X 6b X 6b Tx -
G.703 G.703
Rx - X 7a X 7a Rx -
COMM.
COMM.
CHANNEL 2 CHANNEL 2
Tx + X 7b X 7b Tx +
Rx + X 8a X 8a Rx +
SURGE X 8b X 8b SURGE
831727A3.CDR
842752A1.CDR
3 In minimum remote loopback mode, the multiplexer is enabled to return the data from the external interface without any
processing to assist in diagnosing G.703 line-side problems irrespective of clock rate. Data enters from the G.703 inputs,
passes through the data stabilization latch which also restores the proper signal polarity, passes through the multiplexer
and then returns to the transmitter. The differential received data is processed and passed to the G.703 transmitter module
after which point the data is discarded. The G.703 receiver module is fully functional and continues to process data and
passes it to the differential Manchester transmitter module. Since timing is returned as it is received, the timing source is
expected to be from the G.703 line side of the interface.
DMX G7R
842774A1.CDR
DMX G7R
842775A1.CDR
a) DESCRIPTION
There are two RS422 inter-relay communications modules available: single-channel RS422 (module 7T) and dual-channel
RS422 (module 7W). The modules can be configured to run at 64 kbps or 128 kbps. AWG 24 twisted shielded pair cable is
recommended for external connections. These modules are protected by optically-isolated surge suppression devices.
The shield pins (6a and 7b) are internally connected to the ground pin (8a). Proper shield termination is as follows:
• Site 1: Terminate shield to pins 6a or 7b or both.
• Site 2: Terminate shield to COM pin 2b.
The clock terminating impedance should match the impedance of the line.
7W
Tx – Tx –
7T
~ 3a Rx – ~ 3a Rx –
RS422
~ 2a Tx + RS422 ~ 2a Tx +
channel 1
Inter-relay comms.
~ 4b Rx + ~ 4b Rx +
~ 6a Shield ~ 6a Shield
Inter-relay communications
~ 7a ~ 5b Tx –
Clock
~ 8b ~ 5a Rx –
RS422
~ 2b COM ~ 4a Tx +
channel 2
~ 8a Surge ~ 6b Rx +
~ 7b Shield
~ 7a
Clock
~ 8b
~ 2b COM
'DWDPRGXOH
6LJQDOQDPH
7[ :D 6'$6HQGGDWD
:
7[² :E 6'%6HQGGDWD
56
5[ :E 5'$5HFHLYHGGDWD
&+$11(/
5[² :D 5'%5HFHLYHGGDWD
6KLHOG :D 56$5HTXHVWWRVHQG576
:D 56%5HTXHVWWRVHQG576
&/2&.
² :E 57$5HFHLYHWLPLQJ
56&20081,&$7,216
'DWDPRGXOH
6LJQDOQDPH
77$7HUPLQDOWLPLQJ
77%7HUPLQDOWLPLQJ
6'$6HQGGDWD
6'%6HQGGDWD
5'$5HFHLYHGGDWD
5'%5HFHLYHGGDWD
56$5HTXHVWWRVHQG576
56%5HTXHVWWRVHQG576
&6$&OHDU7RVHQG
&6%&OHDU7RVHQG
/RFDOORRSEDFN
5HPRWHORRSEDFN
6LJQDOJURXQG
67$6HQGWLPLQJ
67%6HQGWLPLQJ
$&'5
c) TRANSMIT TIMING
The RS422 interface accepts one clock input for transmit timing. It is important that the rising edge of the 64 kHz transmit
timing clock of the multiplexer interface is sampling the data in the center of the transmit data window. Therefore, it is
important to confirm clock and data transitions to ensure proper system operation. For example, the following figure shows
the positive edge of the Tx clock in the center of the Tx data bit.
7[FORFN
7[GDWD
$&'5
d) RECEIVE TIMING
The RS422 interface utilizes NRZI-MARK modulation code and; therefore, does not rely on an Rx clock to recapture data.
NRZI-MARK is an edge-type, invertible, self-clocking code.
To recover the Rx clock from the data-stream, an integrated DPLL (digital phase lock loop) circuit is utilized. The DPLL is
driven by an internal clock, which is 16-times over-sampled, and uses this clock along with the data-stream to generate a
data clock that can be used as the SCC (serial communication controller) receive clock.
The following figure shows the combined RS422 plus Fiber interface configuration at 64K baud. The 7L, 7M, 7N, 7P, and 74
modules are used in two-terminal with a redundant channel or three-terminal configurations where channel 1 is employed
via the RS422 interface (possibly with a multiplexer) and channel 2 via direct fiber.
AWG 24 twisted shielded pair is recommended for external RS422 connections and the shield should be grounded only at
one end. For the direct fiber channel, power budget issues should be addressed properly.
When using a laser interface, attenuators may be necessary to ensure that you do not exceed maxi-
NOTICE mum optical input power to the receiver.
~ 1a
7L, 7M, 7N, 7P, 74
Clock
~ 1b (channel 1)
~ 2b COM
~ 2a Tx1 +
~ 3a Rx1 –
RS422
~ 3b Tx1 –
channel 1
Inter-relay comms.
~ 4b Rx1 +
~ 6a Shield
Fiber
Tx2 Rx2 channel 2
~ 8a Surge
842777A1.CDR
The figure below shows the combined G.703 plus fiber interface configuration at 64 kbps. The 7E, 7F, 7G, 7Q, and 75 mod-
ules are used in configurations where channel 1 is employed via the G.703 interface (possibly with a multiplexer) and chan-
nel 2 via direct fiber. AWG 24 twisted shielded pair is recommended for external G.703 connections connecting the shield to
pin 1a at one end only. For the direct fiber channel, power budget issues should be addressed properly. See previous sec-
tions for additional details on the G.703 and fiber interfaces.
When using a laser interface, attenuators may be necessary to ensure that you do not exceed the
NOTICE maximum optical input power to the receiver.
3 ~ 2a Rx –
G.703
channel 1
~ 2b Tx +
communications
~ 3a Rx +
~ 3b Surge
Inter-relay
Tx2 Fiber
Rx2 channel 2
842778A1.CDR
The UR-series IEEE C37.94 communication modules (modules types 2G, 2H, 76, and 77) are designed to interface with
IEEE C37.94 compliant digital multiplexers or an IEEE C37.94 compliant interface converter for use with direct input and
output applications for firmware revisions 3.30 and higher. The IEEE C37.94 standard defines a point-to-point optical link
for synchronous data between a multiplexer and a teleprotection device. This data is typically 64 kbps, but the standard
provides for speeds up to 64n kbps, where n = 1, 2,…, 12. The UR-series C37.94 communication modules are either
64 kbps (with n fixed at 1) or 128 kbps (with n fixed at 2). The frame is a valid International Telecommunications Union (ITU-
T) recommended G.704 pattern from the standpoint of framing and data rate. The frame is 256 bits and is repeated at a
frame rate of 8000 Hz, with a resultant bit rate of 2048 kbps.
The specifications for the module are as follows:.
• IEEE standard: C37.94 for 1 128 kbps optical fiber interface (for 2G and 2H modules) or C37.94 for 2 64 kbps opti-
cal fiber interface (for 76 and 77 modules).
• Fiber optic cable type: 50 nm or 62.5 µm core diameter optical fiber.
• Fiber optic mode: multi-mode.
• Fiber optic cable length: up to 2 km.
• Fiber optic connector: type ST.
• Wavelength: 820 ±40 nm.
• Connection: as per all fiber optic connections, a Tx-to-Rx connection is required.
The UR-series C37.94 communication module can be connected directly to any compliant digital multiplexer that supports
the IEEE C37.94 standard as shown below.
The UR-series C37.94 communication module can be connected to the electrical interface (G.703, RS422, or X.21) of a
non-compliant digital multiplexer via an optical-to-electrical interface converter that supports the IEEE C37.94 standard, as
shown below.
3
In 2008, GE Grid Solutions released revised modules 76 and 77 for C37.94 communication to enable multi-ended fault
location functionality with firmware 5.60 release and higher. All modules 76 and 77 shipped since the change support this
feature and are fully backward compatible with firmware releases below 5.60. For customers using firmware release 5.60
and higher, the module can be identified with "Rev D" printed on the module and is to be used on all ends of M60 commu-
nication for two and three terminal applications. Failure to use it at all ends results in intermittent communication alarms.
For customers using firmware revisions below 5.60, it is not required to match the revision of the modules installed.
The UR-series C37.94 communication module has six switches that are used to set the clock configuration. The functions
of these control switches is shown below.
842753A1.CDR
For the internal timing mode, the system clock is generated internally. therefore, the timing switch selection should be inter-
nal timing for relay 1 and loop timed for relay 2. There must be only one timing source configured.
For the looped timing mode, the system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, the timing selection
should be in loop timing mode for connections to higher order systems.
The IEEE C37.94 communications module cover removal procedure is as follows:
1. Remove the IEEE C37.94 module (type 2G, 2H, 76 or 77 module):
The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module, must be pulled simultaneously in order
to release the module for removal. Before performing this action, control power must be removed from the relay.
The original location of the module should be recorded to help ensure that the same or replacement module is inserted
into the correct slot.
2. Remove the module cover screw.
3. Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
4. Set the timing selection switches (channel 1, channel 2) to the desired timing modes (see description above).
5. Replace the top cover and the cover screw.
6. Re-insert the IEEE C37.94 module. Take care to ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot
position. The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged posi-
tion as the module is smoothly inserted into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis,
engage the clips simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module will be fully inserted.
The UR-series C37.94SM communication modules (2A and 2B) are designed to interface with modified IEEE C37.94 com-
pliant digital multiplexers or IEEE C37.94 compliant interface converters that have been converted from 820 nm multi-mode
fiber optics to 1300 nm ELED single-mode fiber optics. The IEEE C37.94 standard defines a point-to-point optical link for
synchronous data between a multiplexer and a teleprotection device. This data is typically 64 kbps, but the standard pro-
vides for speeds up to 64n kbps, where n = 1, 2,…, 12. The UR-series C37.94SM communication module is 64 kbps only
with n fixed at 1. The frame is a valid International Telecommunications Union (ITU-T) recommended G.704 pattern from
the standpoint of framing and data rate. The frame is 256 bits and is repeated at a frame rate of 8000 Hz, with a resultant bit
rate of 2048 kbps.
The specifications for the module are as follows:
• Emulated IEEE standard: emulates C37.94 for 1 64 kbps optical fiber interface (modules set to n = 1 or 64 kbps).
• Fiber optic cable type: 9/125 m core diameter optical fiber. 3
• Fiber optic mode: single-mode, ELED compatible with HP HFBR-1315T transmitter and HP HFBR-2316T receiver.
• Fiber optic cable length: up to 10 km.
• Fiber optic connector: type ST.
• Wavelength: 1300 ±40 nm.
• Connection: as per all fiber optic connections, a Tx-to-Rx connection is required.
The UR-series C37.94SM communication module can be connected directly to any compliant digital multiplexer that sup-
ports C37.94SM as shown below.
It can also can be connected directly to any other UR-series relay with a C37.94SM module as shown below.
In 2008, GE Grid Solutions released revised modules 2A and 2B for C37.94SM communication to enable multi-ended fault
location functionality with firmware 5.60 release and higher. All modules 2A and 2B shipped since the change support this
feature and are fully backward compatible with firmware releases below 5.60. For customers using firmware release 5.60
and higher, the module can be identified with "Rev D" printed on the module and is to be used on all ends of M60 commu-
nication for two and three terminal applications. Failure to use it at all ends results in intermittent communication alarms.
For customers using firmware revisions below 5.60, it is not required to match the revision of the modules installed.
The UR-series C37.94SM communication module has six switches that are used to set the clock configuration. The func-
tions of these control switches is shown below.
842753A1.CDR
For the internal timing mode, the system clock is generated internally. Therefore, the timing switch selection should be
internal timing for relay 1 and loop timed for relay 2. There must be only one timing source configured.
3 For the looped timing mode, the system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, the timing selection
should be in loop timing mode for connections to higher order systems.
The C37.94SM communications module cover removal procedure is as follows:
1. Remove the C37.94SM module (modules 2A or 2B):
The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module, must be pulled simultaneously in order
to release the module for removal. Before performing this action, control power must be removed from the relay.
The original location of the module should be recorded to help ensure that the same or replacement module is inserted
into the correct slot.
2. Remove the module cover screw.
3. Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
4. Set the timing selection switches (channel 1, channel 2) to the desired timing modes (see description above).
5. Replace the top cover and the cover screw.
6. Re-insert the C37.94SM module. Take care to ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot
position. The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged posi-
tion as the module is smoothly inserted into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis,
engage the clips simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module will be fully inserted.
The type 2S and 2T embedded managed switch modules are supported by UR-series relays containing type 9S CPU mod-
ules with revisions 5.5x and higher. The modules communicate to the M60 through an internal Ethernet port (referred to as
the UR port or port 7) and provide an additional six external Ethernet ports: two 10/100Base-T ports and four multimode ST
100Base-FX ports.
The Ethernet switch module should be powered up before or at the same time as the M60. Otherwise, the switch
module will not be detected on power up and the EQUIPMENT MISMATCH: ORDERCODE 500 self-test warning will be
127(
issued.
3 The type 2S and 2T managed Ethernet switch modules provide two 10/100Base-T and four multimode ST 100Base-FX
external Ethernet ports accessible through the rear of the module. In addition, a serial console port is accessible from the
front of the module (requires the front panel faceplate to be open).
The pin assignment for the console port signals is shown in the following table.
Two 10/100Base-T
ports
Four 100Base-FX
multimode ports
with ST connectors
RS232
console port
Independent power
supply. Options:
2S: high-voltage
2T: low-voltage
00ILEHURSWLFFDEOH 7[
67
5[ %DVH);
00ILEHURSWLFFDEOH 7[ %DVH);
5[ )LEHU
00ILEHURSWLFFDEOH 7[ %DVH); SRUWV
5[
00ILEHURSWLFFDEOH 7[
5[ %DVH);
&38
:D *5281'
$&'5
842868A2.CDR
a) DESCRIPTION
Upon initial power up of a M60 device with an installed Ethernet switch, the front panel trouble LED will be illuminated and
the ENET MODULE OFFLINE error message will be displayed. It will be necessary to configure the Ethernet switch and then
place it online. This involves two steps:
1. Configuring the network settings on the local computer.
2. Configuring the M60 switch module through EnerVista UR Setup.
These procedures are described in the following sections. When the M60 is properly configured, the LED will be off and the
error message will be cleared.
1. Initiate communications from a computer to the M60 through a front panel serial connection (see the Configuring Serial
Communications section in chapter 1 for details), or if you are familiar with the UR keypad you can use it to set up the
network IP address and check the Modbus slave address and Modbus TCP port.
2. Ensure that the computer and the M60 are on the same IP network.
If your computer is on another network or has a dynamic IP address assigned upon a network login, then setup your
own IP address as follows
2.1. From the Windows Start Menu, select the Settings > Network Connections menu item.
2.2. Right-click on the Local Area Connection icon and select the Properties item. This will open the LAN proper-
ties window.
2.3. Click the Properties button as shown below.
&OLFNWKH3URSHUWLHVEXWWRQ
$&'5
2.4. The following window is displayed. Select the Use the Following IP Address option and enter appropriate IP
address, Subnet mask, and Default gateway values. It may be necessary to contact your network administra-
tor for assistance.
&OLFNKHUHWRVHWXS,3
DGGUHVV
$&'5
Alternately, you can open a command window (type “cmd” from the Run item in the Start menu) and enter the ipconfig
command.
3
Now the computer should be able to communicate to the UR relay through the UR Setup software.
1HZVLWH
2OGVLWH
,QWHUIDFHLV(WKHUQHWQRZ
0DNHVXUHWKHVHVHWWLQJV
DUHFRUUHFW
$&'5
5. Click the Read Order Code button. You should be able to communicate with the M60 device regardless of the value of
the Ethernet switch IP address and even though the front panel display states that the Ethernet module is offline.
6. Select the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > Ethernet Switch > Configure IP menu item as shown
below.
7. Enter (or verify) the MAC Address, IP Address, Subnet Mask, and Gateway IP Address settings.
8. Click the Save button. It will take few seconds to save the settings to the Ethernet switch module and the following
message displayed.
9. Verify that the target message is cleared and that the M60 displays the MAC address of the Ethernet switch in the
Actual Values > Status > Ethernet Switch window.
The M60 device and the Ethernet switch module communications setup is now complete.
A suitable IP/gateway and subnet mask must be assigned to both the switch and the UR relay for correct operation. The
Switch has been shipped with a default IP address of 192.168.1.2 and a subnet mask of 255.255.255.0. Consult your net-
work administrator to determine if the default IP address, subnet mask or default gateway needs to be modified.
Do not connect to network while configuring the switch module.
CAUTION
2. Enter “3.94.247.229” in the IP Address field and “255.255.252.0” in the Subnet Mask field, then click OK.
The software will send the new settings to the M60 and prompt as follows when complete.
3. Cycle power to the M60 and switch module to activate the new settings.
The system will request the name and destination path for the settings file.
1. Select the desired device from site tree in the online window.
2. Select the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > Ethernet Switch > Ethernet Switch Settings File >
Transfer Settings File item from the device settings tree.
The system will request the name and destination path for the settings file.
3. Navigate to the folder containing the Ethernet switch settings file, select the file, then click Open.
The settings file will be transferred to the Ethernet switch and the settings uploaded to the device.
a) DESCRIPTION
This section describes the process for upgrading firmware on a UR-2S or UR-2T switch module.
There are several ways of updating firmware on a switch module:
• Using the EnerVista UR Setup software.
• Serially using the M60 switch module console port.
• Using FTP or TFTP through the M60 switch module console port.
It is highly recommended to use the EnerVista UR Setup software to upgrade firmware on a M60 switch module.
Firmware upgrades using the serial port, TFTP, and FTP are described in detail in the switch module manual.
3 127(
127(
The firmware version installed on the switch will appear on the lower left corner of the screen.
2. Using the EnerVista UR Setup program, select the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > Ethernet Switch
> Firmware Upload menu item.
The following popup screen will appear warning that the settings will be lost when the firmware is upgraded.
It is highly recommended that you save the switch settings before upgrading the firmware.
127(
3. After saving the settings file, proceed with the firmware upload by selecting Yes to the above warning.
Another window will open, asking you to point to the location of the firmware file to be uploaded. 3
4. Select the firmware file to be loaded on to the Switch, and select the Open option.
The following window will pop up, indicating that the firmware file transfer is in progress.
If the firmware load was successful, the following window will appear:
Note
The switch will automatically reboot after a successful firmware file transfer.
127(
5. Once the firmware has been successfully uploaded to the switch module, load the settings file using the procedure
described earlier.
The following table provides details about Ethernet module self-test errors.
Be sure to enable the ETHERNET SWITCH FAIL setting in the PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE SELF-TESTS menu
and the relevant PORT 1 EVENTS through PORT 6 EVENTS settings under the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS ETH-
ERNET SWITCH menu.
The EnerVista UR Setup software provides a graphical user interface (GUI) as one of two human interfaces to a UR device.
The alternate human interface is implemented via the device’s faceplate keypad and display (refer to the Faceplate Inter-
face section in this chapter).
The EnerVista UR Setup software provides a single facility to configure, monitor, maintain, and trouble-shoot the operation
of relay functions, connected over local or wide-area networks. It can be used while disconnected (off-line) or connected
(on-line) to a UR device. In off-line mode, settings files can be created for eventual downloading to the device. In on-line
mode, communication with the device is real-time.
The EnerVista UR Setup software, provided with every M60 relay, can be run from any computer supporting Microsoft Win-
dows® 95, 98, NT, 2000, ME, and XP. This chapter provides a summary of the basic EnerVista UR Setup software interface
features. The EnerVista UR Setup Help File provides details for getting started and using the EnerVista UR Setup software
interface.
To start using the EnerVista UR Setup software, a site definition and device definition must first be created. See the EnerV-
ista UR Setup Help File or refer to the Connecting EnerVista UR Setup with the M60 section in Chapter 1 for details.
f) FILE SUPPORT
• Execution: Any EnerVista UR Setup file which is double clicked or opened will launch the application, or provide focus
to the already opened application. If the file was a settings file (has a URS extension) which had been removed from
the Settings List tree menu, it will be added back to the Settings List tree menu.
• Drag and Drop: The Site List and Settings List control bar windows are each mutually a drag source and a drop target
for device-order-code-compatible files or individual menu items. Also, the Settings List control bar window and any
Windows Explorer directory folder are each mutually a file drag source and drop target.
New files which are dropped into the Settings List window are added to the tree which is automatically sorted alphabet-
ically with respect to settings file names. Files or individual menu items which are dropped in the selected device menu
in the Site List window will automatically be sent to the on-line communicating device.
g) FIRMWARE UPGRADES
The firmware of a M60 device can be upgraded, locally or remotely, via the EnerVista UR Setup software. The correspond-
ing instructions are provided by the EnerVista UR Setup Help file under the topic “Upgrading Firmware”.
Before backing up settings and upgrading, set the Settings > Product Setup > Security > Dual Permission Security
Access > Remote Setting Authorized and Local Setting Authorized settings to "ON." Otherwise, the upgrade is blocked
and results in an "Unable to put relay in flash mode" message.
Modbus addresses assigned to firmware modules, features, settings, and corresponding data items (i.e. default
values, minimum/maximum values, data type, and item size) may change slightly from version to version of firm-
127(
ware. The addresses are rearranged when new features are added or existing features are enhanced or modified.
The EEPROM DATA ERROR message displayed after upgrading/downgrading the firmware is a resettable, self-test
message intended to inform users that the Modbus addresses have changed with the upgraded firmware. This
message does not signal any problems when appearing after firmware upgrades.
The EnerVista UR Setup software main window supports the following primary display components:
1. Title bar which shows the pathname of the active data view.
2. Main window menu bar.
3. Main window tool bar.
4. Site list control bar window.
5. Settings list control bar window. 4
6. Device data view windows, with common tool bar.
7. Settings file data view windows, with common tool bar.
8. Workspace area with data view tabs.
9. Status bar.
10. Quick action hot links.
2 1 6 7
10
4
4 5
9 8 842786A2.CDR
Setting file templates simplify the configuration and commissioning of multiple relays that protect similar assets. An exam-
ple of this is a substation that has ten similar feeders protected by 10 UR-series F60 relays.
In these situations, typically 90% or greater of the settings are identical between all devices. The templates feature allows
engineers to configure and test these common settings, then lock them so they are not available to users. For example,
these locked down settings can be hidden from view for field engineers, allowing them to quickly identify and concentrate
on the specific settings.
The remaining settings (typically 10% or less) can be specified as editable and be made available to field engineers install-
ing the devices. These will be settings such as protection element pickup values and CT and VT ratios.
The settings template mode allows the user to define which settings will be visible in EnerVista UR Setup. Settings tem-
plates can be applied to both settings files (settings file templates) and online devices (online settings templates). The func-
tionality is identical for both purposes.
The settings template feature requires that both the EnerVista UR Setup software and the M60 firmware are at ver-
sions 5.40 or higher.
127(
The software will prompt for a template password. This password is required to use the template feature and must be
at least four characters in length.
3. Enter and re-enter the new password, then click OK to continue.
The online settings template is now enabled. The device is now in template editing mode.
By default, all settings are specified as locked and displayed against a grey background. The icon on the upper right of
the settings window also indicates that the EnerVista software is in EDIT mode. The following example shows the
phase time overcurrent settings window in edit mode.
The software will prompt for a template password. This password must be at least four characters in length.
Figure 4–4: APPLYING TEMPLATES VIA THE VIEW IN TEMPLATE MODE COMMAND
Viewing the settings in template mode also modifies the settings tree, showing only the settings categories that contain
editable settings. The effect of applying the template to a typical settings tree view is shown below.
Typical settings tree view without template applied. Typical settings tree view with template applied via
the Template Mode > View In Template Mode
command.
842860A1.CDR
Figure 4–5: APPLYING TEMPLATES VIA THE VIEW IN TEMPLATE MODE SETTINGS COMMAND
4 Use the following procedure to display settings available for editing and settings locked by the template.
1. Right-click the device in the Online or Offline Window area and apply the template by selecting the Template Mode >
View All Settings option.
2. Enter the template password then click OK to apply the template.
Once the template has been applied, users will only be able to edit the settings specified by the template, but all settings
will be shown. The effect of applying the template to the phase time overcurrent settings is shown below.
Phase time overcurrent settings window without template applied. Phase time overcurrent window with template applied via
the Template Mode > View All Settings command.
The template specifies that only the Pickup and Curve
settings be available.
842859A1.CDR
Figure 4–6: APPLYING TEMPLATES VIA THE VIEW ALL SETTINGS COMMAND
3. Verify one more time that you wish to remove the template by clicking Yes.
The EnerVista software will remove all template information and all settings will be available.
The UR allows users to secure parts or all of a FlexLogic™ equation, preventing unauthorized viewing or modification of
critical FlexLogic™ applications. This is accomplished using the settings template feature to lock individual entries within
FlexLogic™ equations.
Secured FlexLogic™ equations will remain secure when files are sent to and retrieved from any UR-series device.
Once the template has been applied, users will only be able to view and edit the FlexLogic™ entries not locked by the tem-
plate. The effect of applying the template to the FlexLogic™ entries in the above procedure is shown below.
Typical FlexLogic™ entries without template applied. Typical FlexLogic™ entries locked with template via
the Template Mode > View In Template Mode command.
4
842861A1.CDR
1. Right-click the setting file in the Offline Window area and select the Edit Settings File Properties option. The window
opens.
A traceability feature for settings files allows the user to quickly determine if the settings in a M60 device have been
changed since the time of installation from a settings file. When a settings file is transferred to a M60 device, the date, time,
and serial number of the M60 are sent back to EnerVista UR Setup and added to the settings file on the local computer.
This information can be compared with the M60 actual values at any later date to determine if security has been compro-
mised.
The traceability information is only included in the settings file if a complete settings file is either transferred to the M60
device or obtained from the M60 device. Any partial settings transfers by way of drag and drop do not add the traceability
information to the settings file.
The serial number of the UR-series device and the file transfer
date are added to the settings file when settings files
are transferred to the device.
842863A1.CDR
Traceability data
in settings report
4
842862A1.CDR
842865A1.CDR
The EnerVista UR Setup software suite contains an automatic configurator for motor starting settings. The configurator
automatically populates settings and operands for input relays, output relays, trip bus, AC inputs, and signal sources based
on user requirements and the relay features.
a) ENHANCED FACEPLATE
The front panel interface is one of two supported interfaces, the other interface being EnerVista UR Setup software. The
front panel interface consists of LED panels, an RS232 port, keypad, LCD display, control pushbuttons, and optional user-
programmable pushbuttons.
The faceplate is hinged to allow easy access to the removable modules.
Display
Keypad
Control
pushbuttons (3) 4
Front panel
RS232 port
b) BASIC FACEPLATE
There are two interfaces: the front panel and the EnerVista UR Setup software. The front panel interface consists of LED
panels, an RS232 port, keypad, LCD display, control pushbuttons, and optional user-programmable pushbuttons.
The faceplate is hinged to allow easy access to the removable modules. There is also a removable dust cover that fits over
the faceplate which must be removed in order to access the keypad panel. The following figure shows the horizontal
arrangement of the faceplate panels.
Display
Front panel
RS232 port
Small user-programmable
User-programmable Keypad
(control) pushbuttons 1 to 7
pushbuttons 1 to 12
827801A9.CDR
DISPLAY
MENU 7 8 9
KEYPAD
HELP MESSAGE 4 5 6
ESCAPE 1 2 3
LED PANEL 3
4 LED PANEL 2
USER 2
LED PANEL 1
827830A1.CDR
PHASE C
NEUTRAL/GROUND USER 3
a) ENHANCED FACEPLATE
The enhanced front panel display provides five columns of LED indicators. The first column contains 14 status and event
cause LEDs, and the next four columns contain the 48 user-programmable LEDs.
The RESET key is used to reset any latched LED indicator or target message, once the condition has been cleared (these
latched conditions can also be reset via the SETTINGS INPUT/OUTPUTS RESETTING menu). The RS232 port is
intended for connection to a computer.
The USER keys are used by the breaker control feature.
842811A1.CDR
• TROUBLE: This LED indicates that the relay has detected an internal problem.
• TEST MODE: This LED indicates that the relay is in test mode. For more information, see the Test Mode section in the
Settings chapter.
• TRIP: This LED indicates that the FlexLogic™ operand serving as a trip switch has operated. This indicator always
latches; as such, a reset command must be initiated to allow the latch to be reset.
• ALARM: This LED indicates that the FlexLogic™ operand serving as an alarm switch has operated. This indicator is
never latched.
• PICKUP: This LED indicates that an element is picked up. This indicator is never latched.
The event cause indicators in the first column are described below.
Events cause LEDs are turned on or off by protection elements that have their respective target setting selected as either
“Enabled” or “Latched”. If a protection element target setting is “Enabled”, then the corresponding event cause LEDs
remain on as long as operate operand associated with the element remains asserted. If a protection element target setting
is “Latched”, then the corresponding event cause LEDs turn on when the operate operand associated with the element is
asserted and remain on until the RESET button on the front panel is pressed after the operand is reset.
All elements that are able to discriminate faulted phases can independently turn off or on the phase A, B, or C LEDs. This
includes phase instantaneous overcurrent, phase undervoltage, etc. This means that the phase A, B, and C operate oper-
ands for individual protection elements are ORed to turn on or off the phase A, B, or C LEDs.
• VOLTAGE: This LED indicates voltage was involved.
4
• CURRENT: This LED indicates current was involved.
• FREQUENCY: This LED indicates frequency was involved.
• OTHER: This LED indicates a composite function was involved.
• PHASE A: This LED indicates phase A was involved.
• PHASE B: This LED indicates phase B was involved.
• PHASE C: This LED indicates phase C was involved.
• NEUTRAL/GROUND: This LED indicates that neutral or ground was involved.
The user-programmable LEDs consist of 48 amber LED indicators in four columns. The operation of these LEDs is user-
defined. Support for applying a customized label beside every LED is provided. Default labels are shipped in the label pack-
age of every M60, together with custom templates. The default labels can be replaced by user-printed labels.
User customization of LED operation is of maximum benefit in installations where languages other than English are used to
communicate with operators. Refer to the User-Programmable LEDs section in chapter 5 for the settings used to program
the operation of the LEDs on these panels.
b) BASIC FACEPLATE
The basic faceplate consists of three panels with LED indicators, keys, and a communications port. The RESET key is
used to reset any latched LED indicator or target message, once the condition has been cleared (these latched conditions
can also be reset via the SETTINGS INPUT/OUTPUTS RESETTING menu). The RS232 port is intended for connection
to a computer.
The USER keys are used by the breaker control feature.
842781A1.CDR
842782A1.CDR
SETTINGS IN USE
842783A1.CDR
a) ENHANCED FACEPLATE
The following procedure requires the pre-requisites listed below.
• EnerVista UR Setup software is installed and operational.
• The M60 settings have been saved to a settings file.
• The M60 front panel label cutout sheet (GE Multilin part number 1006-0047) has been downloaded from
http://www.gegridsolutions.com/products/support/ur/URLEDenhanced.doc and printed.
• Small-bladed knife.
This procedure describes how to create custom LED labels for the enhanced front panel display.
1. Start the EnerVista UR Setup software.
2. Select the Front Panel Report item at the bottom of the menu tree for the settings file. The front panel report window
will be displayed.
4
Figure 4–22: FRONT PANEL REPORT WINDOW
3. Enter the text to appear next to each LED and above each user-programmable pushbuttons in the fields provided.
4. Feed the M60 front panel label cutout sheet into a printer and press the Print button in the front panel report window.
5. When printing is complete, fold the sheet along the perforated lines and punch out the labels.
6. Remove the M60 label insert tool from the package and bend the tabs as described in the following procedures. These
tabs will be used for removal of the default and custom LED labels.
It is important that the tool be used EXACTLY as shown below, with the printed side containing the GE part number
facing the user.
127(
The label package shipped with every M60 contains the three default labels shown below, the custom label template sheet,
and the label removal tool.
If the default labels are suitable for your application, insert them in the appropriate slots and program the LEDs to match
them. If you require custom labels, follow the procedures below to remove the original labels and insert the new ones.
The following procedure describes how to setup and use the label removal tool.
1. Bend the tabs at the left end of the tool upwards as shown below.
2. Bend the tab at the center of the tool tail as shown below.
The following procedure describes how to remove the LED labels from the M60 enhanced front panel and insert the custom
labels.
1. Use the knife to lift the LED label and slide the label tool underneath. Make sure the bent tabs are pointing away from
the relay.
4
2. Slide the label tool under the LED label until the tabs snap out as shown below. This will attach the label tool to the LED
label.
4. Slide the new LED label inside the pocket until the text is properly aligned with the LEDs, as shown below.
The following procedure describes how to remove the user-programmable pushbutton labels from the M60 enhanced front
panel and insert the custom labels.
1. Use the knife to lift the pushbutton label and slide the tail of the label tool underneath, as shown below. Make sure the
bent tab is pointing away from the relay.
2. Slide the label tool under the user-programmable pushbutton label until the tabs snap out as shown below. This will
attach the label tool to the user-programmable pushbutton label.
3. Remove the tool and attached user-programmable pushbutton label as shown below.
4
4. Slide the new user-programmable pushbutton label inside the pocket until the text is properly aligned with the buttons,
as shown below.
4.3.4 DISPLAY
All messages are displayed on a 2 20 backlit liquid crystal display (LCD) to make them visible under poor lighting condi-
tions. While the keypad and display are not actively being used, the display will default to user-defined messages. Any high
priority event driven message will automatically override the default message and appear on the display.
4.3.5 KEYPAD
Display messages are organized into pages under the following headings: actual values, settings, commands, and targets.
The MENU key navigates through these pages. Each heading page is broken down further into logical subgroups.
The MESSAGE keys navigate through the subgroups. The VALUE keys scroll increment or decrement numerical setting
values when in programming mode. These keys also scroll through alphanumeric values in the text edit mode. Alterna-
tively, values may also be entered with the numeric keypad.
The decimal key initiates and advance to the next character in text edit mode or enters a decimal point. The HELP key may
be pressed at any time for context sensitive help messages. The ENTER key stores altered setting values.
a) INTRODUCTION
The M60 can interface with associated circuit breakers. In many cases the application monitors the state of the breaker,
which can be presented on faceplate LEDs, along with a breaker trouble indication. Breaker operations can be manually
initiated from faceplate keypad or automatically initiated from a FlexLogic™ operand. A setting is provided to assign names
to each breaker; this user-assigned name is used for the display of related flash messages. These features are provided for
two breakers; the user may use only those portions of the design relevant to a single breaker, which must be breaker 1.
For the following discussion it is assumed the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP BREAKERS BREAKER 1(2) BREAKER
FUNCTION setting is "Enabled" for each breaker.
For the following discussion it is assumed the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP BREAKERS BREAKER 1(2) BREAKER
1(2) PUSH BUTTON CONTROL setting is “Enabled” for each breaker.
ENTER COMMAND This message appears when the USER 1, USER 2, or USER 3 key is pressed and a
PASSWORD COMMAND PASSWORD is required; i.e. if COMMAND PASSWORD is enabled and no com-
mands have been issued within the last 30 minutes.
Press USER 1 This message appears if the correct password is entered or if none is required. This mes-
To Select Breaker sage will be maintained for 30 seconds or until the USER 1 key is pressed again. 4
BKR1-(Name) SELECTED This message is displayed after the USER 1 key is pressed for the second time. Three
USER 2=CLS/USER 3=OP possible actions can be performed from this state within 30 seconds as per items (1), (2)
and (3) below:
(1)
USER 2 OFF/ON If the USER 2 key is pressed, this message appears for 20 seconds. If the USER 2 key is
To Close BKR1-(Name) pressed again within that time, a signal is created that can be programmed to operate an
output relay to close breaker 1.
(2)
USER 3 OFF/ON If the USER 3 key is pressed, this message appears for 20 seconds. If the USER 3 key is
To Open BKR1-(Name) pressed again within that time, a signal is created that can be programmed to operate an
output relay to open breaker 1.
(3)
BKR2-(Name) SELECTED If the USER 1 key is pressed at this step, this message appears showing that a different
USER 2=CLS/USER 3=OP breaker is selected. Three possible actions can be performed from this state as per (1),
(2) and (3). Repeatedly pressing the USER 1 key alternates between available breakers.
Pressing keys other than USER 1, 2 or 3 at any time aborts the breaker control function.
4.3.7 MENUS
a) NAVIGATION
Press the MENU key to select the desired header display page (top-level menu). The header title appears momentarily fol-
lowed by a header display page menu item. Each press of the MENU key advances through the following main heading
pages:
• Actual values.
• Settings.
• Commands.
• Targets.
• User displays (when enabled).
b) HIERARCHY
The setting and actual value messages are arranged hierarchically. The header display pages are indicated by double
scroll bar characters (), while sub-header pages are indicated by single scroll bar characters (). The header display
pages represent the highest level of the hierarchy and the sub-header display pages fall below this level. The MESSAGE
UP and DOWN keys move within a group of headers, sub-headers, setting values, or actual values. Continually pressing
the MESSAGE RIGHT key from a header display displays specific information for the header category. Conversely, contin-
ually pressing the MESSAGE LEFT key from a setting value or actual value display returns to the header display.
SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP
ACTUAL VALUES Press the MENU key until the header for the first Actual Values page appears. This
STATUS page contains system and relay status information. Repeatedly press the MESSAGE
keys to display the other actual value headers.
SETTINGS Press the MENU key until the header for the first page of Settings appears. This page
PRODUCT SETUP contains settings to configure the relay.
SETTINGS Press the MESSAGE DOWN key to move to the next Settings page. This page con-
SYSTEM SETUP tains settings for System Setup. Repeatedly press the MESSAGE UP and DOWN
keys to display the other setting headers and then back to the first Settings page
header.
SECURITY From the Settings page one header (Product Setup), press the MESSAGE RIGHT
key once to display the first sub-header (Security).
ACCESS LEVEL: Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key once more and this will display the first setting for
Restricted Security. Pressing the MESSAGE DOWN key repeatedly will display the remaining
setting messages for this sub-header.
SECURITY Press the MESSAGE LEFT key once to move back to the first sub-header message.
DISPLAY Pressing the MESSAGE DOWN key will display the second setting sub-header asso-
PROPERTIES ciated with the Product Setup header.
FLASH MESSAGE Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key once more and this will display the first setting for
TIME: 1.0 s Display Properties.
FLASH MESSAGE For example, select the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES FLASH
TIME: 1.0 s MESSAGE TIME setting.
MINIMUM: 0.5 Press the HELP key to view the minimum and maximum values. Press the HELP key
MAXIMUM: 10.0 again to view the next context sensitive help message.
Two methods of editing and storing a numerical setting value are available.
• 0 to 9 and decimal point: The relay numeric keypad works the same as that of any electronic calculator. A number is
entered one digit at a time. The leftmost digit is entered first and the rightmost digit is entered last. Pressing the MES-
SAGE LEFT key or pressing the ESCAPE key, returns the original value to the display.
• VALUE keys: The VALUE UP key increments the displayed value by the step value, up to the maximum value allowed.
While at the maximum value, pressing the VALUE UP key again will allow the setting selection to continue upward
from the minimum value. The VALUE DOWN key decrements the displayed value by the step value, down to the mini-
mum value. While at the minimum value, pressing the VALUE DOWN key again will allow the setting selection to con-
tinue downward from the maximum value.
FLASH MESSAGE
TIME: 2.5 s
As an example, set the flash message time setting to 2.5 seconds. Press the appropriate
numeric keys in the sequence “2 . 5". The display message will change as the digits are
4
being entered.
NEW SETTING Until ENTER is pressed, editing changes are not registered by the relay. Therefore, press
HAS BEEN STORED ENTER to store the new value in memory. This flash message will momentarily appear
as confirmation of the storing process. Numerical values which contain decimal places
will be rounded-off if more decimal place digits are entered than specified by the step
value.
ACCESS LEVEL: For example, the selections available for ACCESS LEVEL are "Restricted", "Command",
Restricted "Setting", and "Factory Service".
Enumeration type values are changed using the VALUE keys. The VALUE UP key displays the next selection while the
VALUE DOWN key displays the previous selection.
ACCESS LEVEL: If the ACCESS LEVEL needs to be "Setting", press the VALUE keys until the proper selec-
Setting tion is displayed. Press HELP at any time for the context sensitive help messages.
NEW SETTING Changes are not registered by the relay until the ENTER key is pressed. Pressing
HAS BEEN STORED ENTER stores the new value in memory. This flash message momentarily appears as
confirmation of the storing process.
RELAY SETTINGS: When the relay is powered up, the Trouble LED will be on, the In Service LED off, and
Not Programmed this message displayed, indicating the relay is in the "Not Programmed" state and is safe-
guarding (output relays blocked) against the installation of a relay whose settings have
not been entered. This message remains until the relay is explicitly put in the "Pro-
grammed" state.
To change the RELAY SETTINGS: "Not Programmed" mode to "Programmed", proceed as follows:
1. Press the MENU key until the SETTINGS header flashes momentarily and the PRODUCT SETUP message appears on the
display.
2. Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key until the PASSWORD SECURITY message appears on the display.
4 3. Press the MESSAGE DOWN key until the INSTALLATION message appears on the display.
4. Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key until the RELAY SETTINGS: Not Programmed message is displayed.
SETTINGS
SETTINGS SECURITY
PRODUCT SETUP
DISPLAY
PROPERTIES
5. After the RELAY SETTINGS: Not Programmed message appears on the display, press the VALUE keys change the
selection to "Programmed".
6. Press the ENTER key.
7. When the "NEW SETTING HAS BEEN STORED" message appears, the relay will be in "Programmed" state and the
In Service LED will turn on.
2. Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key until the ACCESS LEVEL message appears on the display.
3. Press the MESSAGE DOWN key until the CHANGE LOCAL PASSWORDS message appears on the display.
4. Press the MESSAGE RIGHT key until the CHANGE SETTING PASSWORD or CHANGE COMMAND PASSWORD message
appears on the display.
SECURITY ACCESS LEVEL:
Restricted
CHANGE LOCAL CHANGE COMMAND
PASSWORDS PASSWORD: No
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: No
ENCRYPTED COMMAND
PASSWORD: ---------
ENCRYPTED SETTING
PASSWORD: ---------
5. After the CHANGE...PASSWORD message appears on the display, press the VALUE UP or DOWN key to change the
selection to “Yes”. 4
6. Press the ENTER key and the display will prompt you to ENTER NEW PASSWORD.
7. Type in a numerical password (up to 10 characters) and press the ENTER key.
8. When the VERIFY NEW PASSWORD is displayed, re-type in the same password and press ENTER.
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: No
NEW PASSWORD
HAS BEEN STORED
9. When the NEW PASSWORD HAS BEEN STORED message appears, your new Setting (or Command) Password will be
active.
SETTINGS SECURITY
See page 5-8.
PRODUCT SETUP
DISPLAY
See page 5-13.
PROPERTIES
CLEAR RELAY
See page 5-14.
RECORDS
COMMUNICATIONS
See page 5-15.
MODBUS USER MAP
See page 5-40.
REAL TIME
See page 5-41.
CLOCK
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
See page 5-42.
FAULT REPORT
OSCILLOGRAPHY
See page 5-43.
DATA LOGGER
See page 5-45.
5
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
See page 5-46.
LEDS
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
See page 5-49.
SELF TESTS
CONTROL
See page 5-50.
PUSHBUTTONS
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
See page 5-52.
PUSHBUTTONS
FLEX STATE
See page 5-56.
PARAMETERS
USER-DEFINABLE
See page 5-57.
DISPLAYS
DIRECT I/O
See page 5-59.
TELEPROTECTION
See page 5-67.
INSTALLATION
See page 5-68.
SETTINGS AC INPUTS
See page 5-70.
SYSTEM SETUP
POWER SYSTEM
See page 5-71.
SIGNAL SOURCES
See page 5-72.
MOTOR
See page 5-75.
BREAKERS
See page 5-78.
SWITCHES
See page 5-82.
FLEXCURVES
See page 5-85.
SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC
See page 5-108.
FLEXLOGIC EQUATION EDITOR
FLEXLOGIC
See page 5-108.
TIMERS
FLEXELEMENTS
See page 5-109.
NON-VOLATILE
See page 5-113.
LATCHES
5 SETTING GROUP 2
SETTING GROUP 6
MONITORING
See page 5-216.
ELEMENTS
In the design of UR relays, the term element is used to describe a feature that is based around a comparator. The compar-
ator is provided with an input (or set of inputs) that is tested against a programmed setting (or group of settings) to deter-
mine if the input is within the defined range that will set the output to logic 1, also referred to as setting the flag. A single
comparator may make multiple tests and provide multiple outputs; for example, the time overcurrent comparator sets a
pickup flag when the current input is above the setting and sets an operate flag when the input current has been at a level
above the pickup setting for the time specified by the time-current curve settings. All comparators use analog actual values
as the input.
An exception to this rule is digital elements, which use logic states as inputs.
127(
Elements are arranged into two classes, grouped and control. Each element classed as a grouped element is provided with
six alternate sets of settings, in setting groups numbered 1 through 6. The performance of a grouped element is defined by
the setting group that is active at a given time. The performance of a control element is independent of the selected active
5 setting group.
The main characteristics of an element are shown on the element logic diagram. This includes the inputs, settings, fixed
logic, and the output operands generated (abbreviations used on scheme logic diagrams are defined in Appendix F).
Some settings are specified in per-unit (pu) calculated quantities:
pu quantity = (actual quantity) / (base quantity)
Where the current source is from a single CT, the base quantity is the nominal secondary or primary current of the CT. Use
the secondary current base to convert per-unit current settings to/from a secondary current value, and use the primary cur-
rent base to convert to/from a primary current value.
Where the current source is the sum of two or more CTs with different nominal primary current, the primary base quantity is
the largest nominal primary current. For example, if CT1 = 300 / 5 A and CT2 = 100 / 1 A, then in order to sum these, CT2
is scaled to the CT1 ratio. In this case, the base quantity is 300 A primary, 5 A secondary for CT1, and 300/(100/1) = 3 A
secondary for CT2.
For voltage elements the primary base quantity is the nominal phase-to-phase primary voltage of the protected system pro-
vided that the VT ratio setting is set to the nominal ratio of the VTs and the secondary voltage setting is set to the phase-to-
phase voltage seen by the relay when the voltage of the protected system in nominal. The UR uses the convention that
nominal voltages in a three-phase system are phase-to-phase voltages.
For example, on a system with a 13.8 kV nominal primary voltage, the base quantity is 13800 V. With 14400:120 V delta-
connected VTs, the secondary base quantity and secondary voltage setting is:
13800
---------------- 120 = 115 V (EQ 5.1)
14400
For wye-connected VTs, the primary and secondary bases quanitities are as before, but the secondary voltage (here a
phase-to-phase ground value) is:
13800
---------------- 120
---------- = 66.4 V (EQ 5.2)
14400 3
Many settings are common to most elements and are discussed below:
• FUNCTION setting: This setting programs the element to be operational when selected as “Enabled”. The factory
default is “Disabled”. Once programmed to “Enabled”, any element associated with the function becomes active and all
options become available.
• NAME setting: This setting is used to uniquely identify the element.
• SOURCE setting: This setting is used to select the AC source to be monitored. See the Introduction to AC Sources
section later.
• PICKUP setting: For simple elements, this setting is used to program the level of the measured parameter above or
below which the pickup state is established. In more complex elements, a set of settings may be provided to define the
range of the measured parameters which will cause the element to pickup.
• PICKUP DELAY setting: This setting sets a time-delay-on-pickup, or on-delay, for the duration between the pickup
and operate output states.
• RESET DELAY setting: This setting is used to set a time-delay-on-dropout, or off-delay, for the duration between the
Operate output state and the return to logic 0 after the input transits outside the defined pickup range.
• BLOCK setting: The default output operand state of all comparators is a logic 0 or “flag not set”. The comparator
remains in this default state until a logic 1 is asserted at the RUN input, allowing the test to be performed. If the RUN
input changes to logic 0 at any time, the comparator returns to the default state. The RUN input is used to supervise
the comparator. The BLOCK input is used as one of the inputs to RUN control.
• TARGET setting: This setting is used to define the operation of an element target message. When set to “Disabled”,
no target message or illumination of a faceplate LED indicator is issued upon operation of the element. When set to
“Self-Reset”, the target message and LED indication follow the operate state of the element, and self-resets once the
operate element condition clears. When set to “Latched”, the target message and LED indication will remain visible
after the element output returns to logic 0 until a RESET command is received by the relay.
• EVENTS setting: This setting is used to control whether the pickup, dropout or operate states are recorded by the
event recorder. When set to “Disabled”, element pickup, dropout or operate are not recorded as events. When set to
5
“Enabled”, events are created for:
(Element) PKP (pickup)
(Element) DPO (dropout)
(Element) OP (operate)
The DPO event is created when the measure and decide comparator output transits from the pickup state (logic 1) to
the dropout state (logic 0). This could happen when the element is in the operate state if the reset delay time is not 0.
Not every operand of a given element in a UR relay generates events, only the major output operands. Elements,
asserting output per phase, log operating phase output only, without asserting the common three-phase operand
event.
a) BACKGROUND
A mechanism called a source configures the routing of CT and VT input channels to measurement sub-systems. Sources,
in the context of UR series relays, refer to the logical grouping of current and voltage signals such that one source contains
all the signals required to measure the load or fault in a particular power apparatus. A given source may contain all or some
of the following signals: three-phase currents, single-phase ground current, three-phase voltages and an auxiliary voltage
from a single VT for checking for synchronism.
The basic idea of an AC source is to select a point on the power system where the voltages and currents are of interest. To
illustrate the concept of sources, as applied to current inputs only, consider the breaker-and-a-half scheme below. (The
breaker-and-a-half scheme is used for illustrative purposes and is available on select UR products.) In this application, the
current flows as shown by the arrows. Some current flows through the upper bus bar to some other location or power
equipment, and some current flows into transformer winding 1. The current into winding 1 is the phasor sum (or difference)
of the currents in CT1 and CT2 (whether the sum or difference is used depends on the relative polarity of the CT connec-
tions). The same considerations apply to transformer winding 2. The protection elements require access to the net current
for transformer protection, but some elements may need access to the individual currents from CT1 and CT2.
Winding 1
current
Winding 1
UR-series
relay Power
transformer
Winding 2
CT3 CT4
827791A3.CDR
Banks are ordered sequentially from the block of lower-numbered channels to the block of higher-numbered channels, and
from the CT/VT module with the lowest slot position letter to the module with the highest slot position letter, as follows:
INCREASING SLOT POSITION LETTER -->
CT/VT MODULE 1 CT/VT MODULE 2 CT/VT MODULE 3
< bank 1 > < bank 3 > < bank 5 >
< bank 2 > < bank 4 > < bank 6 >
The UR platform allows for a maximum of three sets of three-phase voltages and six sets of three-phase currents. The
result of these restrictions leads to the maximum number of CT/VT modules in a chassis to three. The maximum number of
sources is six. A summary of CT/VT module configurations is shown below.
ITEM MAXIMUM NUMBER
CT/VT Module 2
CT Bank (3 phase channels, 1 ground channel) 4
VT Bank (3 phase channels, 1 auxiliary channel) 2
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY
CHANGE LOCAL
MESSAGE See page 5–9.
PASSWORDS
ACCESS
MESSAGE See page 5–11.
SUPERVISION
DUAL PERMISSION
MESSAGE See page 5–11.
SECURITY ACCESS
PASSWORD ACCESS Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
EVENTS: Disabled
For the ACCESS LEVEL, the "Restricted" option means both settings and commands can be accessed, but there is no
access to factory configuration.
The "Factory Service" level is not available and intended for factory use only.
Two levels of password security are provided via the ACCESS LEVEL setting, setting and command, for which you set a
password for each. Use of a password for each level controls whether users can enter commands or change settings.
Another option is to specify setting and/or command access for individual user accounts.
The state of the session (local or remote, setting or command) determines the state of the following FlexLogic™ operands.
• ACCESS LOC SETG OFF: Asserted when local setting access is disabled.
• ACCESS LOC SETG ON: Asserted when local setting access is enabled.
• ACCESS LOC CMND OFF: Asserted when local command access is disabled.
• ACCESS LOC CMND ON: Asserted when local command access is enabled.
• ACCESS REM SETG OFF: Asserted when remote setting access is disabled.
• ACCESS REM SETG ON: Asserted when remote setting access is enabled.
• ACCESS REM CMND OFF: Asserted when remote command access is disabled.
• ACCESS REM CMND ON: Asserted when remote command access is enabled.
The appropriate events are also logged in the Event Recorder as well. The FlexLogic™ operands and events are updated
every five seconds.
A command or setting write operation is required to update the state of all the remote and local security operands
shown above. Changing the password, or any other setting, does not take the relay out of service. The relay is
127(
taken out of service when a settings file is written to it.
b) LOCAL PASSWORDS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY CHANGE LOCAL PASSWORDS
Proper password codes are required to enable each access level. A password consists of 1 to 10 numerical characters.
When a CHANGE COMMAND PASSWORD or CHANGE SETTING PASSWORD setting is programmed to “Yes” via the front panel
interface, the following message sequence is invoked:
1. ENTER NEW PASSWORD: ____________.
2. VERIFY NEW PASSWORD: ____________.
3. NEW PASSWORD HAS BEEN STORED.
To gain write access to a “Restricted” setting, program the ACCESS LEVEL setting in the main security menu to “Setting” and
then change the setting, or attempt to change the setting and follow the prompt to enter the programmed password. If the
password is correctly entered, access will be allowed. Accessibility automatically reverts to the “Restricted” level according
to the access level timeout setting values.
If an entered password is lost (or forgotten), consult the factory with the corresponding ENCRYPTED PASSWORD.
If the setting and command passwords are identical, then this one password allows access to both commands and
settings.
127(
If a remote connection is established, local passcodes are not visible.
c) REMOTE PASSWORDS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY CHANGE REMOTE PASSWORDS
This menu displays when the ACCESS LEVEL setting is other than Restricted or Command.
Otherwise, in EnerVista, select the Settings > Product Setup > Password Security menu item to open the remote pass-
word settings window.
5. The new password is accepted and a value is assigned to the ENCRYPTED PASSWORD item.
If a command or setting password is lost (or forgotten), consult the factory with the corresponding Encrypted Password
value.
If you establish a local connection to the relay (serial), you cannot view remote passcodes.
127(
d) ACCESS SUPERVISION
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY ACCESS SUPERVISION
This menu displays when the ACCESS LEVEL setting is other than Restricted or Command.
The following access supervision settings are available.
• INVALID ATTEMPTS BEFORE LOCKOUT: This setting specifies the number of times an incorrect password can be
entered within a three-minute time span before lockout occurs. When lockout occurs, the LOCAL ACCESS DENIED or
REMOTE ACCESS DENIED FlexLogic™ operands are set to “On”. These operands are returned to the “Off” state upon
expiration of the lockout.
• PASSWORD LOCKOUT DURATION: This setting specifies the time that the M60 will lockout password access after
the number of invalid password entries specified by the INVALID ATTEMPTS BEFORE LOCKOUT setting has occurred.
The M60 provides a means to raise an alarm upon failed password entry. Should password verification fail while accessing
a password-protected level of the relay (either settings or commands), the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS FlexLogic™ operand is
asserted. The operand can be programmed to raise an alarm via contact outputs or communications. This feature can be
used to protect against both unauthorized and accidental access attempts.
The UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS operand is reset with the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS RESET UNAUTHORIZED
ALARMS command. Therefore, to apply this feature with security, the command level should be password-protected. The
5
operand does not generate events or targets.
If events or targets are required, the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS operand can be assigned to a digital element programmed
with event logs or targets enabled.
The access level timeout settings are shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY ACCESS SUPERVISION ACCESS LEVEL TIMEOUTS
These settings allow the user to specify the length of inactivity required before returning to the restricted access level. Note
that the access level will set as restricted if control power is cycled.
• COMMAND LEVEL ACCESS TIMEOUT: This setting specifies the length of inactivity (no local or remote access)
required to return to restricted access from the command password level.
• SETTING LEVEL ACCESS TIMEOUT: This setting specifies the length of inactivity (no local or remote access)
required to return to restricted access from the command password level.
DUAL PERMISSION LOCAL SETTING AUTH: Range: selected FlexLogic™ operands (see below)
SECURITY ACCESS On
REMOTE SETTING AUTH: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
On
ACCESS AUTH Range: 5 to 480 minutes in steps of 1
MESSAGE
TIMEOUT: 30 min
This menu displays when the ACCESS LEVEL setting is other than Restricted or Command.
The dual permission security access feature provides a mechanism for customers to prevent unauthorized or unintended
upload of settings to a relay through the local or remote interfaces interface.
The following settings are available through the local (front panel) interface only.
• LOCAL SETTING AUTH: This setting is used for local (front panel or RS232 interface) setting access supervision.
Valid values for the FlexLogic™ operands are either “On” (default) or any physical “Contact Input ~~ On” value.
If this setting is “On“, then local setting access functions as normal; that is, a local setting password is required. If this
setting is any contact input on FlexLogic™ operand, then the operand must be asserted (set as on) prior to providing
the local setting password to gain setting access.
If setting access is not authorized for local operation (front panel or RS232 interface) and the user attempts to obtain
setting access, then the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS message is displayed on the front panel.
If this setting is "Off," firmware upgrades are blocked. If this setting is "On," firmware upgrades are allowed.
• REMOTE SETTING AUTH: This setting is used for remote (Ethernet or RS485 interfaces) setting access supervision.
If this setting is “On” (the default setting), then remote setting access functions as normal; that is, a remote password is
required). If this setting is “Off”, then remote setting access is blocked even if the correct remote setting password is
provided. If this setting is any other FlexLogic™ operand, then the operand must be asserted (set as on) prior to pro-
viding the remote setting password to gain setting access.
If this setting is "Off," firmware upgrades are blocked. If this setting is "On," firmware upgrades are allowed.
• ACCESS AUTH TIMEOUT: This setting represents the timeout delay for local setting access. This setting is applicable
when the LOCAL SETTING AUTH setting is programmed to any operand except “On”. The state of the FlexLogic™ oper-
and is continuously monitored for an off-to-on transition. When this occurs, local access is permitted and the timer pro-
5 grammed with the ACCESS AUTH TIMEOUT setting value is started. When this timer expires, local setting access is
immediately denied. If access is permitted and an off-to-on transition of the FlexLogic™ operand is detected, the time-
out is restarted. The status of this timer is updated every five seconds.
The following settings are available through the remote (EnerVista UR Setup) interface only. Select the Settings > Product
Setup > Security menu item to display the security settings window.
The Remote Settings Authorization setting is used for remote (Ethernet or RS485 interfaces) setting access supervision.
If this setting is “On” (the default setting), then remote setting access functions as normal; that is, a remote password is
required. If this setting is “Off”, then remote setting access is blocked even if the correct remote setting password is pro-
vided. If this setting is any other FlexLogic™ operand, then the operand must be asserted (set as on) prior to providing the
remote setting password to gain setting access.
The Access Authorization Timeout setting represents the timeout delay remote setting access. This setting is applicable
when the Remote Settings Authorization setting is programmed to any operand except “On” or “Off”. The state of the
FlexLogic™ operand is continuously monitored for an off-to-on transition. When this occurs, remote setting access is per-
mitted and the timer programmed with the Access Authorization Timeout setting value is started. When this timer
expires, remote setting access is immediately denied. If access is permitted and an off-to-on transition of the FlexLogic™
operand is detected, the timeout is restarted. The status of this timer is updated every five seconds.
Some relay messaging characteristics can be modified to suit different situations using the display properties settings.
• LANGUAGE: This setting selects the language used to display settings, actual values, and targets. The setting dis-
5
plays when a language other than English was purchased, and the range depends on the order code of the relay.
• FLASH MESSAGE TIME: Flash messages are status, warning, error, or information messages displayed for several
seconds in response to certain key presses during setting programming. These messages override any normal mes-
sages. The duration of a flash message on the display can be changed to accommodate different reading rates.
• DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT: If the keypad is inactive for a period of time, the relay automatically reverts to a
default message. The inactivity time is modified via this setting to ensure messages remain on the screen long enough
during programming or reading of actual values.
• DEFAULT MESSAGE INTENSITY: To extend phosphor life in the vacuum fluorescent display, the brightness can be
attenuated during default message display. During keypad interrogation, the display always operates at full brightness.
• SCREEN SAVER FEATURE and SCREEN SAVER WAIT TIME: These settings are only visible if the M60 has a liquid
crystal display (LCD) and control its backlighting. When the SCREEN SAVER FEATURE is “Enabled”, the LCD backlighting
is turned off after the DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT followed by the SCREEN SAVER WAIT TIME, providing that no keys
have been pressed and no target messages are active. When a keypress occurs or a target becomes active, the LCD
backlighting is turned on.
• CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL: This setting modifies the current cut-off threshold. Very low currents (1 to 2% of the
rated value) are very susceptible to noise. Some customers prefer very low currents to display as zero, while others
prefer the current be displayed even when the value reflects noise rather than the actual signal. The M60 applies a cut-
off value to the magnitudes and angles of the measured currents. If the magnitude is below the cut-off level, it is substi-
tuted with zero. This applies to phase and ground current phasors as well as true RMS values and symmetrical compo-
nents. The cut-off operation applies to quantities used for metering, protection, and control, as well as those used by
communications protocols. Note that the cut-off level for the sensitive ground input is 10 times lower that the CURRENT
CUT-OFF LEVEL setting value. Raw current samples available via oscillography are not subject to cut-off.
• VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL: This setting modifies the voltage cut-off threshold. Very low secondary voltage measure-
ments (at the fractional volt level) can be affected by noise. Some customers prefer these low voltages to be displayed
as zero, while others prefer the voltage to be displayed even when the value reflects noise rather than the actual sig-
nal. The M60 applies a cut-off value to the magnitudes and angles of the measured voltages. If the magnitude is below
the cut-off level, it is substituted with zero. This operation applies to phase and auxiliary voltages, and symmetrical
components. The cut-off operation applies to quantities used for metering, protection, and control, as well as those
used by communications protocols. Raw samples of the voltages available via oscillography are not subject cut-off.
The CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL and the VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL are used to determine the metered power cut-off levels. The
power cut-off level is calculated as shown below. For Delta connections:
We have:
Selected records can be cleared from user-programmable conditions with FlexLogic™ operands. Assigning user-program-
mable pushbuttons to clear specific records are typical applications for these commands. Since the M60 responds to rising
edges of the configured FlexLogic™ operands, they must be asserted for at least 50 ms to take effect.
Clearing records with user-programmable operands is not protected by the command password. However, user-program-
mable pushbuttons are protected by the command password. Thus, if they are used to clear records, the user-programma-
ble pushbuttons can provide extra security if required.
For example, to assign user-programmable pushbutton 1 to clear demand records, the following settings should be applied.
1. Assign the clear demand function to pushbutton 1 by making the following change in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP
CLEAR RELAY RECORDS menu:
CLEAR DEMAND: “PUSHBUTTON 1 ON”
2. Set the properties for user-programmable pushbutton 1 by making the following changes in the SETTINGS PRODUCT
SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS USER PUSHBUTTON 1 menu:
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: “Self-reset”
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME: “0.20 s”
5.2.4 COMMUNICATIONS 5
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS
EGD PROTOCOL
MESSAGE See page 5–38.
ETHERNET SWITCH
MESSAGE See page 5–40.
b) SERIAL PORTS
The M60 is equipped with up to three independent serial communication ports. The faceplate RS232 port is intended for
local use and is fixed at 19200 baud and no parity. The rear COM1 port type is selected when ordering: either an Ethernet
or RS485 port. The rear COM2 port be used for either RS485 or RRTD communications.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS SERIAL PORTS
SERIAL PORTS RS485 COM1 BAUD Range: 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 14400, 19200,
RATE: 19200 28800, 33600, 38400, 57600, 115200. Only
active if CPU Type E is ordered.
RS485 COM1 PARITY: Range: None, Odd, Even
MESSAGE Only active if CPU Type E is ordered
None
RS485 COM1 RESPONSE Range: 0 to 1000 ms in steps of 10
MESSAGE Only active if CPU Type E is ordered
MIN TIME: 0 ms
COM2 USAGE: Range: RS485, RRTD
MESSAGE
RS485
RRTD SLAVE ADDRESS: Range: 1 to 254 in steps of 1. Shown only if the COM2
MESSAGE USAGE setting is “RRTD”.
254
5 MESSAGE
RS485 COM2 BAUD
RATE: 19200
Range: 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 14400, 19200,
28800, 33600, 38400, 57600, 115200. Shown
only if the COM2 USAGE is setting is “RS485”.
RRTD BAUD RATE: Range: 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200. Shown only if
MESSAGE the COM2 USAGE is setting is “RRTD”.
19200
RS485 COM2 PARITY: Range: None, Odd, Even.
MESSAGE
None
RS485 COM2 RESPONSE Range: 0 to 1000 ms in steps of 10.
MESSAGE
MIN TIME: 0 ms
It is important that the baud rate and parity settings agree with the settings used on the computer or other equipment that is
connected to these ports.
The RS485 ports may be connected to a computer running EnerVista UR Setup. This software can download and upload
setting files, view measured parameters, and upgrade the relay firmware. A maximum of 32 relays can be daisy-chained
and connected to a DCS, PLC or computer using the RS485 ports.
The baud rate for standard RS485 communications can be selected as 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 14400, 19200,
28800, 33600, 38400, 57600, or 115200 bps.
For each RS485 port, the minimum time before the port will transmit after receiving data from a host can be set.
This feature allows operation with hosts which hold the RS485 transmitter active for some time after each transmis-
127(
sion.
If the COM2 USAGE setting is “RRTD”, then the COM2 port is used to monitor the RTDs on a remote RTD unit. The remote
RTD unit uses the Modbus RTU protocol over RS485. The RRTD device must have a unique address from 1 to 254. The
baud rate for RRTD communications can be selected as 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 14400, or 19200 bps.
If the RS485 COM2 port is used for an RRTD, then there must not be any other devices connected in the daisy-chain for
any other purpose. The port is strictly dedicated to RRTD usage when COM2 USAGE is selected as “RRTD”.
Power must be cycled to the M60 for changes to the COM2 USAGE setting to take effect.
127(
c) NETWORK
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK
These messages appear only if the M60 is ordered with an Ethernet card.
To obtain a list of all port numbers used, for example for audit purposes, contact GE technical support with substantiating
information, such as the serial number and order code of your device.
The IP addresses are used with the DNP, Modbus/TCP, IEC 61580, IEC 60870-5-104, TFTP, and HTTP protocols. The
NSAP address is used with the IEC 61850 protocol over the OSI (CLNP/TP4) stack only. Each network protocol has a set-
ting for the TCP/UDP port number. These settings are used only in advanced network configurations and should normally
be left at their default values, but may be changed if required (for example, to allow access to multiple UR-series relays
behind a router). By setting a different TCP/UDP PORT NUMBER for a given protocol on each UR-series relay, the router can
map the relays to the same external IP address. The client software (EnerVista UR Setup, for example) must be configured
to use the correct port number if these settings are used. 5
Follow the IP and subnet mask rules outlined in the Configuring the M60 for Software Access section of the first chapter.
When the NSAP address, any TCP/UDP port number, or any user map setting (when used with DNP) is changed, it
will not become active until power to the relay has been cycled (off-on).
127(
d) MODBUS PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS MODBUS PROTOCOL
The serial communication ports utilize the Modbus protocol, unless the port is configured for DNP or IEC 60870-5-104
operation. This allows the EnerVista UR Setup software to be used on the port. The UR operates as a Modbus slave device
only.
When using Modbus protocol on the RS232 port, the M60 responds regardless of the MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS pro-
grammed. For the RS485 port, each device on the serial bus must have a unique slave address from 1 to 254. Address 0
and addresses from 248 and up are reserved by the Modbus protocol specification, and so their use here is not recom-
mended. Address 0 is the broadcast address that all Modbus slave devices listen to. When MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS is set
to 0, the UR accepts broadcast messages, but in compliance with protocol specifications for broadcast messages, never
replies. Addresses do not have to be sequential, but no two devices can have the same address or conflicts resulting in
errors occur. Generally, each device added to the link should use the next higher address starting at 1. When using Modbus
TCP/IP, the client must use the programmed MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS value in the Unit Identifier field. See Appendix B for
more information on the Modbus protocol.
Modbus over TCP/IP can also be used on any of the Ethernet ports. The listening TCP port 502 is reserved for Modbus
communications, and only in exceptional cases when MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER is set to any other port. The MODBUS TCP
PORT NUMBER setting sets the TCP port used by Modbus on Ethernet. A MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER of 0 disables Modbus
over TCP/IP, meaning closes the Modbus TCP port. When it is set to 0, use the front panel or serial port to communicate
with the relay.
When a 0 value is involved in a change, the changes to the MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER setting take effect when the
M60 is restarted.
127(
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
e) DNP PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP PROTOCOL
The M60 supports the Distributed Network Protocol (DNP) version 3.0. The M60 can be used as a DNP slave device con-
nected to multiple DNP masters (usually an RTU or a SCADA master station). Since the M60 maintains two sets of DNP
data change buffers and connection information, two DNP masters can actively communicate with the M60 at one time.
The IEC 60870-5-104 and DNP protocols cannot be simultaneously. When the IEC 60870-5-104 FUNCTION set-
ting is set to “Enabled”, the DNP protocol is not operational. When this setting is changed, it becomes active when
127(
power to the relay has been cycled (off-to-on).
The DNP Channels sub-menu is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP PROTOCOL DNP CHANNELS
DNP CHANNELS DNP CHANNEL 1 PORT: Range: NONE, COM1 - RS485, COM2 - RS485,
NONE FRONT PANEL - RS232, NETWORK - TCP,
NETWORK - UDP
DNP CHANNEL 2 PORT: Range: NONE, COM1 - RS485, COM2 - RS485,
MESSAGE FRONT PANEL - RS232, NETWORK - TCP,
NONE
NETWORK - UDP
The DNP CHANNEL 1 PORT and DNP CHANNEL 2 PORT settings select the communications port assigned to the DNP protocol
for each channel. Once DNP is assigned to a serial port, the Modbus protocol is disabled on that port. Note that COM1 can
be used only in non-Ethernet UR relays. When this setting is set to “Network - TCP”, the DNP protocol can be used over
TCP/IP on channels 1 or 2. When this value is set to “Network - UDP”, the DNP protocol can be used over UDP/IP on chan-
nel 1 only. Refer to Appendix E for additional information on the DNP protocol.
Changes to the DNP CHANNEL 1 PORT and DNP CHANNEL 2 PORT settings take effect when power has been cycled to
the relay.
127(
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
The DNP ADDRESS setting is the DNP slave address. This number identifies the M60 on a DNP communications link. Each
DNP slave should be assigned a unique address.
The DNP NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESS settings can force the M60 to respond to a maximum of five specific DNP masters. The
settings in this sub-menu are shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP PROTOCOL DNP NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESSES
5 0.0.0.0
CLIENT ADDRESS 5: Range: standard IP address
MESSAGE
0.0.0.0
The DNP ADDRESS setting is the DNP slave address. This number identifies the M60 on a DNP communications link. Each
DNP slave should be assigned a unique address.
The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE FUNCTION should be “Disabled” for RS485 applications since there is no collision avoidance
mechanism. The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE TIMEOUT sets the time the M60 waits for a DNP master to confirm an unsolicited
response. The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE MAX RETRIES setting determines the number of times the M60 retransmits an unsolic-
ited response without receiving confirmation from the master; a value of “255” allows infinite re-tries. The DNP UNSOL
RESPONSE DEST ADDRESS is the DNP address to which all unsolicited responses are sent. The IP address to which unsolic-
ited responses are sent is determined by the M60 from the current TCP connection or the most recent UDP message.
The DNP scale factor settings are numbers used to scale analog input point values. These settings group the M60 analog
input data into the following types: current, voltage, power, energy, power factor, and other. Each setting represents the
scale factor for all analog input points of that type. For example, if the DNP VOLTAGE SCALE FACTOR setting is set to “1000”,
all DNP analog input points that are voltages will be returned with values 1000 times smaller (for example, a value of 72000
V on the M60 will be returned as 72). These settings are useful when analog input values must be adjusted to fit within cer-
tain ranges in DNP masters. Note that a scale factor of 0.1 is equivalent to a multiplier of 10 (that is, the value will be 10
times larger).
The DNP DEFAULT DEADBAND settings determine when to trigger unsolicited responses containing analog input data. These
settings group the M60 analog input data into the following types: current, voltage, power, energy, power factor, and other.
Each setting represents the default deadband value for all analog input points of that type. For example, to trigger unsolic-
ited responses from the M60 when any current values change by 15 A, the DNP CURRENT DEFAULT DEADBAND setting
should be set to “15”. Note that these settings are the deadband default values. DNP object 34 points can be used to
change deadband values, from the default, for each individual DNP analog input point. Whenever power is removed and
re-applied to the M60, the default deadbands will be in effect.
The DNP TIME SYNC IIN PERIOD setting determines how often the Need Time Internal Indication (IIN) bit is set by the M60.
Changing this time allows the DNP master to send time synchronization commands more or less often, as required.
The DNP MESSAGE FRAGMENT SIZE setting determines the size, in bytes, at which message fragmentation occurs. Large
fragment sizes allow for more efficient throughput; smaller fragment sizes cause more application layer confirmations to be
necessary which can provide for more robust data transfer over noisy communication channels.
When the DNP data points (analog inputs and/or binary inputs) are configured for Ethernet-enabled relays, check
the “DNP Points Lists” M60 web page to view the points lists. This page can be viewed with a web browser by
127(
entering the M60 IP address to access the M60 “Main Menu”, then by selecting the “Device Information Menu” >
“DNP Points Lists” menu item.
The DNP OBJECT 1 DEFAULT VARIATION to DNP OBJECT 32 DEFAULT VARIATION settings allow the user to select the DNP
default variation number for object types 1, 2, 20, 21, 22, 23, 30, and 32. The default variation refers to the variation
response when variation 0 is requested and/or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans. Refer to the DNP Implementation section in
Appendix E for additional details.
The DNP binary outputs typically map one-to-one to IED data points. That is, each DNP binary output controls a single
physical or virtual control point in an IED. In the M60 relay, DNP binary outputs are mapped to virtual inputs. However,
some legacy DNP implementations use a mapping of one DNP binary output to two physical or virtual control points to sup-
port the concept of trip/close (for circuit breakers) or raise/lower (for tap changers) using a single control point. That is, the
DNP master can operate a single point for both trip and close, or raise and lower, operations. The M60 can be configured to
support paired control points, with each paired control point operating two virtual inputs. The DNP NUMBER OF PAIRED CON-
TROL POINTS setting allows configuration of from 0 to 32 binary output paired controls. Points not configured as paired oper-
ate on a one-to-one basis.
The DNP ADDRESS setting is the DNP slave address. This number identifies the M60 on a DNP communications link. Each
DNP slave should be assigned a unique address.
The DNP TCP CONNECTION TIMEOUT setting specifies a time delay for the detection of dead network TCP connections. If
there is no data traffic on a DNP TCP connection for greater than the time specified by this setting, the connection will be
aborted by the M60. This frees up the connection to be re-used by a client.
5
Relay power must be re-cycled after changing the DNP TCP CONNECTION TIMEOUT setting for the changes to take
effect.
127(
The binary and analog inputs points for the DNP protocol, or the MSP and MME points for IEC 60870-5-104 protocol, can
configured to a maximum of 256 points. The value for each point is user-programmable and can be configured by assigning
FlexLogic™ operands for binary inputs / MSP points or FlexAnalog parameters for analog inputs / MME points.
The menu for the binary input points (DNP) or MSP points (IEC 60870-5-104) is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT LISTS BINARY INPUT / MSP POINTS
Up to 256 binary input points can be configured for the DNP or IEC 60870-5-104 protocols. The points are configured by
assigning an appropriate FlexLogic™ operand. Refer to the Introduction to FlexLogic™ section in this chapter for the full
range of assignable operands.
The menu for the analog input points (DNP) or MME points (IEC 60870-5-104) is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT LISTS ANALOG INPUT / MME POINTS
Up to 256 analog input points can be configured for the DNP or IEC 60870-5-104 protocols. The analog point list is config-
ured by assigning an appropriate FlexAnalog parameter to each point. Refer to Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters for the
full range of assignable parameters.
The DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists always begin with point 0 and end at the first “Off” value. Since DNP / IEC
60870-5-104 point lists must be in one continuous block, any points assigned after the first “Off” point are ignored.
127(
Changes to the DNP / IEC 60870-5-104 point lists take effect when the M60 is restarted.
5 MESSAGE
SERVER
CONFIGURATION
IEC 61850 LOGICAL
MESSAGE
NODE NAME PREFIXES
MMXU DEADBANDS
MESSAGE
GGIO1 STATUS
MESSAGE
CONFIGURATION
GGIO2 CONTROL
MESSAGE
CONFIGURATION
GGIO4 ANALOG
MESSAGE
CONFIGURATION
GGIO5 UINTEGER
MESSAGE
CONFIGURATION
REPORT CONTROL
MESSAGE
CONFIGURATION
XCBR
MESSAGE
CONFIGURATION
XSWI
MESSAGE
CONFIGURATION
The M60 Motor Protection System is provided with optional IEC 61850 communications capability. This
feature is specified as a software option at the time of ordering. Refer to the Ordering section of chapter 2
for additional details. The IEC 61850 protocol features are not available if CPU type E is ordered.
The M60 supports the Manufacturing Message Specification (MMS) protocol as specified by IEC 61850. MMS is supported
over two protocol stacks: TCP/IP over Ethernet and TP4/CLNP (OSI) over Ethernet. The M60 operates as an IEC 61850
server. The Remote Inputs and Outputs section in this chapter describe the peer-to-peer GSSE/GOOSE message scheme.
The EnerVista software includes an interface that is compatible with firmware versions 5.0 to 7.2 to configure subscribers.
Use the Simplified GOOSE Configurator in the Offline Window area.
The GSSE/GOOSE configuration main menu is divided into two areas: transmission and reception.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION
The DEFAULT GSSE/GOOSE UPDATE TIME sets the time between GSSE or GOOSE messages when there are no remote out-
put state changes to be sent. When remote output data changes, GSSE or GOOSE messages are sent immediately. This
setting controls the steady-state heartbeat time interval.
The DEFAULT GSSE/GOOSE UPDATE TIME setting is applicable to GSSE, fixed M60 GOOSE, and configurable GOOSE.
The GSSE settings are shown below:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION
TRANSMISSION GSEE
GSSE GSSE FUNCTION: Range: Enabled, Disabled
Enabled
GSSE ID: Range: 65-character ASCII string
MESSAGE
GSSEOut
DESTINATION MAC: Range: standard MAC address
MESSAGE
000000000000
These settings are applicable to GSSE only. If the fixed GOOSE function is enabled, GSSE messages are not transmitted.
The GSSE ID setting represents the IEC 61850 GSSE application ID name string sent as part of each GSSE message. This
string identifies the GSSE message to the receiving device. In M60 releases previous to 5.0x, this name string was repre-
sented by the RELAY NAME setting.
The table shows details about each scheme. Times are maximum values. Retransmitted messages can occur faster than
the times listed.
5 4
5
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
Heartbeat
T0
T0
Heartbeat * 4.5
Heartbeat * 4.5
Heartbeat 0 0 ms 0 ms Event 2000 ms
1 Heartbeat Heartbeat T1 2000 ms
2 Heartbeat Heartbeat T1 2000 ms
3 Heartbeat Heartbeat T2 Heartbeat * 4.5
4 Heartbeat Heartbeat T0 Heartbeat * 4.5
5 Heartbeat Heartbeat T0 Heartbeat * 4.5
The configurable GOOSE feature is recommended for applications that require GOOSE data transfer between UR-series
IEDs and devices from other manufacturers. Fixed GOOSE is recommended for applications that require GOOSE data
transfer between UR-series IEDs.
IEC 61850 GOOSE messaging contains a number of configurable parameters, all of which must be correct to achieve the
successful transfer of data. It is critical that the configured datasets at the transmission and reception devices are an exact
match in terms of data structure, and that the GOOSE addresses and name strings match exactly. Manual configuration is
possible, but third-party substation configuration software may be used to automate the process. The EnerVista UR Setup
software can produce IEC 61850 ICD files and import IEC 61850 SCD files produced by a substation configurator (refer to
the IEC 61850 IED Configuration section later in this appendix).
The following example illustrates the configuration required to transfer IEC 61850 data items between two devices. The
general steps required for transmission configuration are:
1. Configure the transmission dataset.
2. Configure the GOOSE service settings.
3. Configure the data.
The general steps required for reception configuration are:
1. Configure the reception dataset.
2. Configure the GOOSE service settings.
3. Configure the data.
This example shows how to configure the transmission and reception of three IEC 61850 data items: a single point status
value, its associated quality flags, and a floating point analog value.
The following procedure illustrates the transmission configuration.
1. Configure the transmission dataset by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION
IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION TRANSMISSION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE
GOOSE 1 CONFIG GSE 1 DATASET ITEMS settings menu:
– Set ITEM 1 to “GGIO1.ST.Ind1.q” to indicate quality flags for GGIO1 status indication 1.
– Set ITEM 2 to “GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal” to indicate the status value for GGIO1 status indication 1.
– Set ITEM 3 to “MMXU1.MX.Hz.mag.f” to indicate the analog frequency magnitude for MMXU1 (the metered fre-
quency for SRC1).
The transmission dataset now contains a quality flag, a single point status Boolean value, and a floating point analog
value. The reception dataset on the receiving device must exactly match this structure.
2. Configure the GOOSE service settings by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION
IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION TRANSMISSION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGU-
RABLE GOOSE 1 settings menu:
– Set ITEM 1 to “GGIO3.ST.Ind1.q” to indicate quality flags for GGIO3 status indication 1.
– Set ITEM 2 to “GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal” to indicate the status value for GGIO3 status indication 1.
– Set ITEM 3 to “GGIO3.MX.AnIn1.mag.f” to indicate the analog magnitude for GGIO3 analog input 1.
The reception dataset now contains a quality flag, a single point status Boolean value, and a floating point analog
value. This matches the transmission dataset configuration above.
2. Configure the GOOSE service settings by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE DEVICES
REMOTE DEVICE 1 settings menu:
– Set REMOTE DEVICE 1 ID to match the GOOSE ID string for the transmitting device. Enter “GOOSEOut_1”.
– Set REMOTE DEVICE 1 ETYPE APPID to match the ETHERTYPE application ID from the transmitting device. This is
“0” in the example above.
– Set the REMOTE DEVICE 1 DATASET value. This value represents the dataset number in use. Since we are using
configurable GOOSE 1 in this example, program this value as “GOOSEIn 1”.
3. Configure the Boolean data by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE INPUTS REMOTE
INPUT 1settings menu:
– Set REMOTE IN 1 DEVICE to “GOOSEOut_1”.
– Set REMOTE IN 1 ITEM to “Dataset Item 2”. This assigns the value of the GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal single point status
item to remote input 1.
4. Configure the analog data by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS IEC 61850 GOOSE ANALOG
INPUTS settings menu:
– Set the IEC61850 GOOSE ANALOG INPUT 1 DEFAULT VALUE to “60.000”.
– Enter “Hz” for the IEC61850 GOOSE ANALOG INPUT 1 UNITS setting.
The GOOSE analog input 1 can now be used as a FlexAnalog™ value in a FlexElement™ or in other settings. The M60
must be rebooted (control power removed and re-applied) before these settings take effect.
The value of GOOSE analog input 1 in the receiving device will be determined by the MMXU1.MX.Hz.mag.f value in the
sending device. This MMXU value is determined by the source 1 frequency value and the MMXU Hz deadband setting of
the sending device.
Remote input 1 can now be used in FlexLogic™ equations or other settings. The M60 must be rebooted (control power
removed and re-applied) before these settings take effect.
The value of remote input 1 (Boolean on or off) in the receiving device will be determined by the GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal value
5 in the sending device. The above settings will be automatically populated by the EnerVista UR Setup software when a com-
plete SCD file is created by third party substation configurator software.
For intercommunication between M60 IEDs, the fixed (DNA/UserSt) dataset can be used. The DNA/UserSt dataset con-
tains the same DNA and UserSt bit pairs that are included in GSSE messages. All GOOSE messages transmitted by the
M60 (DNA/UserSt dataset and configurable datasets) use the IEC 61850 GOOSE messaging services (for example, VLAN
support).
Set the CONFIG GSE 1 FUNCTION function to “Disabled” when configuration changes are required. Once changes are
entered, return the CONFIG GSE 1 FUNCTION to “Enabled” and restart the unit for changes to take effect.
127(
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION
TRANSMISSION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE 1(8) CONFIG GSE 1(64) DATA ITEMS
CONFIG GSE 1 ITEM 1: Range: all valid MMS data item references for
DATASET ITEMS GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal transmitted data
ITEM 64: Range: all valid MMS data item references for
MESSAGE transmitted data
None
To create a configurable GOOSE dataset that contains an IEC 61850 Single Point Status indication and its associated qual-
ity flags, the following dataset items can be selected: “GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal” and “GGIO1.ST.Ind1.q”. The M60 will then cre-
ate a dataset containing these two data items. The status value for GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal is determined by the FlexLogic™
operand assigned to GGIO1 indication 1. Changes to this operand will result in the transmission of GOOSE messages con-
taining the defined dataset.
The main reception menu is applicable to configurable GOOSE only and contains the configurable GOOSE dataset items
for reception:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION
RECEPTION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE 1(16) CONFIG GSE 1(32) DATA ITEMS
CONFIG GSE 1 ITEM 1: Range: all valid MMS data item references for
DATASET ITEMS GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal transmitted data
ITEM 32: Range: all valid MMS data item references for
MESSAGE transmitted data
None
The configurable GOOSE settings allow the M60 to be configured to receive a number of different datasets within IEC
61850 GOOSE messages. Up to 16 different configurable datasets can be configured for reception. This is useful for inter-
communication between M60 IEDs and devices from other manufacturers that support IEC 61850.
For intercommunication between M60 IEDs, the fixed (DNA/UserSt) dataset can be used. The DNA/UserSt dataset con-
tains the same DNA and UserSt bit pairs that are included in GSSE messages.
To set up a M60 to receive a configurable GOOSE dataset that contains two IEC 61850 single point status indications, the
following dataset items can be selected (for example, for configurable GOOSE dataset 1): “GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal” and
“GGIO3.ST.Ind2.stVal”. The M60 will then create a dataset containing these two data items. The Boolean status values
from these data items can be utilized as remote input FlexLogic™ operands. First, the REMOTE DEVICE 1(16) DATASET setting 5
must be set to contain dataset “GOOSEIn 1” (that is, the first configurable dataset). Then REMOTE IN 1(16) ITEM settings
must be set to “Dataset Item 1” and “Dataset Item 2”. These remote input FlexLogic™ operands will then change state in
accordance with the status values of the data items in the configured dataset.
Double-point status values may be included in the GOOSE dataset. Received values are populated in the GGIO3.ST.Ind-
Pos1.stVal and higher items.
Floating point analog values originating from MMXU logical nodes may be included in GOOSE datasets. Deadband (non-
instantaneous) values can be transmitted. Received values are used to populate the GGIO3.MX.AnIn1 and higher items.
Received values are also available as FlexAnalog™ parameters (GOOSE analog In1 and up).
GGIO3.MX.AnIn1 to GGIO3.MX.AnIn32 can only be used once for all 16 reception datasets.
127(
The main menu for the IEC 61850 server configuration is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL SERVER CONFIGURATION
The IED NAME and LD INST settings represent the MMS domain name (IEC 61850 logical device) where all IEC/MMS logical
nodes are located. Valid characters for these values are upper and lowercase letters, numbers, and the underscore (_)
character, and the first character in the string must be a letter. This conforms to the IEC 61850 standard. The LOCATION is a
variable string and can be composed of ASCII characters. This string appears within the PhyName of the LPHD node.
The IEC/MMS TCP PORT NUMBER setting allows the user to change the TCP port number for MMS connections. The INCLUDE
NON-IEC DATA setting determines whether or not the “UR” MMS domain will be available. This domain contains a large num-
ber of UR-series specific data items that are not available in the IEC 61850 logical nodes. This data does not follow the IEC
61850 naming conventions. For communications schemes that strictly follow the IEC 61850 standard, this setting should be
“Disabled”.
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
127(
The SERVER SCANNING feature should be set to “Disabled” when IEC 61850 client/server functionality is not required. IEC
61850 has two modes of functionality: GOOSE/GSSE inter-device communication and client/server communication. If the
GOOSE/GSSE functionality is required without the IEC 61850 client server feature, then server scanning can be disabled
to increase CPU resources. When server scanning is disabled, there will be not updated to the IEC 61850 logical node sta-
tus values in the M60. Clients will still be able to connect to the server (M60 relay), but most data values will not be updated.
This setting does not affect GOOSE/GSSE operation.
Changes to the IED NAME setting, LD INST setting, and GOOSE dataset will not take effect until the M60 is restarted.
127(
The main menu for the IEC 61850 logical node name prefixes is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL
5 IEC 61850 LOGICAL NODE NAME PREFIXES
IEC 61850 LOGICAL LPHD LOGICAL NODE
NODE NAME PREFIXES NAME PREFIXES
The IEC 61850 logical node name prefix settings are used to create name prefixes to uniquely identify each logical node.
For example, the logical node “PTOC1” may have the name prefix “abc”. The full logical node name will then be “abcM-
MXU1”. Valid characters for the logical node name prefixes are upper and lowercase letters, numbers, and the underscore
(_) character, and the first character in the prefix must be a letter. This conforms to the IEC 61850 standard.
Changes to the logical node prefixes will not take effect until the M60 is restarted.
The main menu for the IEC 61850 MMXU deadbands is shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL MMXU DEADBANDS
MMXU2 DEADBANDS
MESSAGE
MMXU3 DEADBANDS
MESSAGE
MMXU4 DEADBANDS
MESSAGE
The MMXU deadband settings represent the deadband values used to determine when the update the MMXU “mag” and
“cVal” values from the associated “instmag” and “instcVal” values. The “mag” and “cVal” values are used for the IEC 61850
buffered and unbuffered reports. These settings correspond to the associated “db” data items in the CF functional con-
straint of the MMXU logical node, as per the IEC 61850 standard. According to IEC 61850-7-3, the db value “shall repre-
sent the percentage of difference between the maximum and minimum in units of 0.001%”. Thus, it is important to know the
maximum value for each MMXU measured quantity, since this represents the 100.00% value for the deadband.
The minimum value for all quantities is 0; the maximum values are as follows:
• phase current: 46 phase CT primary setting
• neutral current: 46 ground CT primary setting
• voltage: 275 VT ratio setting
• power (real, reactive, and apparent): 46 phase CT primary setting 275 VT ratio setting
• frequency: 90 Hz
• power factor: 2
The GGIO1 status configuration points are shown below:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GGIO1 STATUS CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
GGIO1 INDICATION 2 Range: FlexLogic™ operand 5
Off
The NUMBER OF STATUS POINTS IN GGIO1 setting specifies the number of “Ind” (single point status indications) that are
instantiated in the GGIO1 logical node. Changes to the NUMBER OF STATUS POINTS IN GGIO1 setting will not take effect until
the M60 is restarted.
The GGIO2 control configuration points are shown below:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GGIO2 CONTROL CONFIGURATION
GGIO2 CF SPSCO 1(64)
GGIO2 CF SPCSO 1 GGIO2 CF SPCSO 1 Range: 0, 1, or 2
CTLMODEL: 1
The GGIO2 control configuration settings are used to set the control model for each input. The available choices are “0”
(status only), “1” (direct control), and “2” (SBO with normal security). The GGIO2 control points are used to control the M60
virtual inputs.
GGIO4 ANALOG 1
MESSAGE
MEASURED VALUE
GGIO4 ANALOG 2
MESSAGE
MEASURED VALUE
GGIO4 ANALOG 3
MESSAGE
MEASURED VALUE
GGIO4 ANALOG 32
MESSAGE
MEASURED VALUE
The NUMBER OF ANALOG POINTS setting determines how many analog data points will exist in GGIO4. When this value is
changed, the M60 must be rebooted in order to allow the GGIO4 logical node to be re-instantiated and contain the newly
configured number of analog points.
The measured value settings for each of the 32 analog values are shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT... COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GGIO4 ANALOG CONFIGURATION
GGIO4 ANALOG 1(32) MEASURED VALUE
5 GGIO4 ANALOG 1
MEASURED VALUE
ANALOG IN
Off
1 VALUE: Range: any FlexAnalog value
The GGIO5 logical node allows IEC 61850 client access to integer data values. This allows access to as many as 16
unsigned integer value points, associated timestamps, and quality flags. The method of configuration is similar to that of
GGIO1 (binary status values). The settings allow the selection of FlexInteger™ values for each GGIO5 integer value point.
It is intended that clients use GGIO5 to access generic integer values from the M60. Additional settings are provided to
allow the selection of the number of integer values available in GGIO5 (1 to 16), and to assign FlexInteger™ values to the
GGIO5 integer inputs. The following setting is available for all GGIO5 configuration points.
• GGIO5 UINT IN 1 VALUE: This setting selects the FlexInteger™ value to drive each GGIO5 integer status value
(GGIO5.ST.UIntIn1). This setting is stored as an 32-bit unsigned integer value.
The report control configuration settings are shown below:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL REPORT CONTROL CONFIGURATION
5
CONFIGURABLE REPORT 1 REPORT 1 DATASET ITEMS
REPORT 1 ITEM 1: Range: all valid MMS data item references
DATASET ITEMS
To create the dataset for logical node LN, program the ITEM 1 to ITEM 64 settings to a value from the list of IEC 61850 data
attributes supported by the M60. Changes to the dataset will only take effect when the M60 is restarted. It is recommended
to use reporting service from logical node LLN0 if a user needs some (but not all) data from already existing GGIO1,
GGIO4, and MMXU4 points and their quantity is not greater than 64 minus the number items in this dataset.
The breaker configuration settings are shown below. Changes to these values will not take effect until the UR is restarted:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL XCBR CONFIGURATION
The CLEAR XCBR1 OpCnt setting represents the breaker operating counter. As breakers operate by opening and closing, the
XCBR operating counter status attribute (OpCnt) increments with every operation. Frequent breaker operation may result
in very large OpCnt values over time. This setting allows the OpCnt to be reset to “0” for XCBR1.
The disconnect switch configuration settings are shown below. Changes to these values will not take effect until the UR is
restarted:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL XSWI CONFIGURATION
MESSAGE
CLEAR XSWI24 OpCnt: Range: No, Yes 5
No
The CLEAR XSWI1 OpCnt setting represents the disconnect switch operating counter. As disconnect switches operate by
opening and closing, the XSWI operating counter status attribute (OpCnt) increments with every operation. Frequent switch
operation may result in very large OpCnt values over time. This setting allows the OpCnt to be reset to “0” for XSWI1.
Since GSSE/GOOSE messages are multicast Ethernet by specification, they are not usually be forwarded by net-
work routers. However, GOOSE messages may be forwarded by routers if the router has been configured for VLAN
127( functionality.
The M60 contains an embedded web server and is capable of transferring web pages to a web browser such as Microsoft
Internet Explorer or Mozilla Firefox. This feature is available only if the M60 has the Ethernet option installed. The web
pages are organized as a series of menus that can be accessed starting at the M60 “Main Menu”. Web pages are available
showing DNP and IEC 60870-5-104 points lists, Modbus registers, event records, fault reports, etc. The web pages can be
accessed by connecting the UR and a computer to an Ethernet network. The main menu will be displayed in the web
browser on the computer simply by entering the IP address of the M60 into the “Address” box on the web browser.
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
127(
i) TFTP PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS TFTP PROTOCOL
The Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) can be used to transfer files from the M60 over a network. The M60 operates as a
TFTP server. TFTP client software is available from various sources, including Microsoft Windows NT. The dir.txt file
obtained from the M60 contains a list and description of all available files (event records, oscillography, etc.).
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
127(
5 NUMBER: 2404
IEC NETWORK Range: see sub-menu below
MESSAGE
CLIENT ADDRESSES
IEC COMMON ADDRESS Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
OF ASDU: 0
IEC CYCLIC DATA Range: 1 to 65535 s in steps of 1
MESSAGE
PERIOD: 60 s
IEC CURRENT DEFAULT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
THRESHOLD: 30000
IEC VOLTAGE DEFAULT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
THRESHOLD: 30000
IEC POWER DEFAULT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
THRESHOLD: 30000
IEC ENERGY DEFAULT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
THRESHOLD: 30000
IEC PF DEFAULT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
THRESHOLD: 30000
IEC OTHER DEFAULT Range: 0 to 65535 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
THRESHOLD: 30000
IEC REDUNDANCY Range: No, Yes
MESSAGE
ENABLED: No
The M60 supports the IEC 60870-5-104 protocol. The M60 can be used as an IEC 60870-5-104 slave device connected to
a maximum of two masters (usually either an RTU or a SCADA master station). Since the M60 maintains two sets of IEC
60870-5-104 data change buffers, no more than two masters should actively communicate with the M60 at one time.
Do not set more than one protocol to the same TCP/UDP port number, as this results in unreliable operation of
those protocols.
127(
The IEC ------- DEFAULT THRESHOLD settings are used to determine when to trigger spontaneous responses containing
M_ME_NC_1 analog data. These settings group the M60 analog data into types: current, voltage, power, energy, and other.
Each setting represents the default threshold value for all M_ME_NC_1 analog points of that type. For example, to trigger
spontaneous responses from the M60 when any current values change by 15 A, the IEC CURRENT DEFAULT THRESHOLD set-
ting should be set to 15. Note that these settings are the default values of the deadbands. P_ME_NC_1 (parameter of mea-
sured value, short floating point value) points can be used to change threshold values, from the default, for each individual
M_ME_NC_1 analog point. Whenever power is removed and re-applied to the M60, the default thresholds will be in effect.
The IEC REDUNDANCY setting decides whether multiple client connections are accepted or not. If redundancy is set to Yes,
two simultaneous connections can be active at any given time.
The IEC 60870-5-104 and DNP protocols cannot be used simultaneously. When the IEC 60870-5-104 FUNCTION set-
ting is set to “Enabled”, the DNP protocol is not operational. When this setting is changed, it becomes active when
127(
power to the relay has been cycled (off-to-on).
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 60870-5-104 PROTOCOL IEC NETWORK CLIENT
ADDRESSES
5
MESSAGE
0.0.0.0
CLIENT ADDRESS 4: Range: Standard IPV4 address format
MESSAGE
0.0.0.0
CLIENT ADDRESS 5: Range: Standard IPV4 address format
MESSAGE
0.0.0.0
The UR can specify a maximum of five clients for its IEC 104 connections. These are IP addresses for the controllers to
which the UR can connect.
A maximum of two simultaneous connections are supported at any given time.
k) SNTP PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS SNTP PROTOCOL
The M60 supports the Simple Network Time Protocol specified in RFC-2030. With SNTP, the M60 can obtain clock time
over an Ethernet network. The M60 acts as an SNTP client to receive time values from an SNTP/NTP server, usually a
dedicated product using a GPS receiver to provide an accurate time. Both unicast and broadcast SNTP are supported.
If SNTP functionality is enabled at the same time as IRIG-B, the IRIG-B signal provides the time value to the M60 clock for
as long as a valid signal is present. If the IRIG-B signal is removed, the time obtained from the SNTP server is used. If
either SNTP or IRIG-B is enabled, the M60 clock value cannot be changed using the front panel keypad.
To use SNTP in unicast mode, SNTP SERVER IP ADDR must be set to the SNTP/NTP server IP address. Once this address is
set and SNTP FUNCTION is “Enabled”, the M60 attempts to obtain time values from the SNTP/NTP server. Since many time
values are obtained and averaged, it generally takes three to four minutes until the M60 clock is closely synchronized with
the SNTP/NTP server. It may take up to two minutes for the M60 to signal an SNTP self-test error if the server is offline.
To use SNTP in broadcast mode, set the SNTP SERVER IP ADDR setting to “0.0.0.0” and SNTP FUNCTION to “Enabled”. The
M60 then listens to SNTP messages sent to the “all ones” broadcast address for the subnet. The M60 waits up to eighteen
minutes (>1024 seconds) without receiving an SNTP broadcast message before signaling an SNTP self-test error.
The UR-series relays do not support the multicast or anycast SNTP functionality.
l) EGD PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS EGD PROTOCOL
The M60 Motor Protection System is provided with optional Ethernet Global Data (EGD) communications
capability. This feature is specified as a software option at the time of ordering. Refer to the Ordering sec-
tion of chapter 2 for additional details. The Ethernet Global Data (EGD) protocol feature is not available if
CPU Type E is ordered.
5 The relay supports one fast Ethernet Global Data (EGD) exchange and two slow EGD exchanges. There are 20 data items
in the fast-produced EGD exchange and 50 data items in each slow-produced exchange.
Ethernet Global Data (EGD) is a suite of protocols used for the real-time transfer of data for display and control purposes.
The relay can be configured to ‘produce’ EGD data exchanges, and other devices can be configured to ‘consume’ EGD
data exchanges. The number of produced exchanges (up to three), the data items in each exchange (up to 50), and the
exchange production rate can be configured.
EGD cannot be used to transfer data between UR-series relays. The relay supports EGD production only. An EGD
exchange will not be transmitted unless the destination address is non-zero, and at least the first data item address is set to
a valid Modbus register address. Note that the default setting value of “0” is considered invalid.
The settings menu for the fast EGD exchange is shown below:
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS EGD PROTOCOL FAST PROD EXCH 1 CONFIGURATION
Fast exchanges (50 to 1000 ms) are generally used in control schemes. The M60 has one fast exchange (exchange 1) and
two slow exchanges (exchange 2 and 3).
The settings menu for the slow EGD exchanges is shown below: 5
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS EGD PROTOCOL SLOW PROD EXCH 1(2) CONFIGURATION
Slow EGD exchanges (500 to 1000 ms) are generally used for the transfer and display of data items. The settings for the
fast and slow exchanges are described below:
• EXCH 1 DESTINATION: This setting specifies the destination IP address of the produced EGD exchange. This is usu-
ally unicast or broadcast.
• EXCH 1 DATA RATE: This setting specifies the rate at which this EGD exchange is transmitted. If the setting is 50 ms,
the exchange data will be updated and sent once every 50 ms. If the setting is 1000 ms, the exchange data will be
updated and sent once per second. EGD exchange 1 has a setting range of 50 to 1000 ms. Exchanges 2 and 3 have a
setting range of 500 to 1000 ms.
• EXCH 1 DATA ITEM 1 to 20/50: These settings specify the data items that are part of this EGD exchange. Almost any
data from the M60 memory map can be configured to be included in an EGD exchange. The settings are the starting
Modbus register address for the data item in decimal format. See Appendix B for the complete Modbus memory map.
Note that the Modbus memory map displays shows addresses in hexadecimal format. as such, it will be necessary to
convert these values to decimal format before entering them as values for these setpoints.
To select a data item to be part of an exchange, it is only necessary to choose the starting Modbus address of the item.
That is, for items occupying more than one Modbus register (for example, 32 bit integers and floating point values),
only the first Modbus address is required. The EGD exchange configured with these settings contains the data items
up to the first setting that contains a Modbus address with no data, or 0. That is, if the first three settings contain valid
Modbus addresses and the fourth is 0, the produced EGD exchange will contain three data items.
m) ETHERNET SWITCH
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS ETHERNET SWITCH
These settings appear only if the M60 is ordered with an Ethernet switch module (type 2S or 2T).
The IP address and Modbus TCP port number for the Ethernet switch module are specified in this menu. These settings
are used in advanced network configurations. Please consult the network administrator before making changes to these
settings. The client software (EnerVista UR Setup, for example) is the preferred interface to configure these settings.
The PORT 1 EVENTS through PORT 6 EVENTS settings allow Ethernet switch module events to be logged in the event
recorder.
The Modbus user map provides read-only access for up to 256 registers. To obtain a memory map value, enter the desired
address in the ADDRESS line (this value must be converted from hex to decimal format). The corresponding value is dis-
played in the VALUE line. A value of “0” in subsequent register ADDRESS lines automatically returns values for the previous
ADDRESS lines incremented by “1”. An address value of “0” in the initial register means “none” and values of “0” will be dis-
played for all registers. Different ADDRESS values can be entered as required in any of the register positions.
REAL TIME IRIG-B SIGNAL TYPE: Range: None, DC Shift, Amplitude Modulated
CLOCK None
REAL TIME CLOCK Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
EVENTS: Disabled
LOCAL TIME OFFSET Range: –24.0 to 24.0 hrs in steps of 0.5
MESSAGE
FROM UTC: 0.0 hr
DAYLIGHT SAVINGS Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
TIME: Disabled
DST START MONTH: Range: January to December (all months)
MESSAGE
January
DST START DAY: Range: Sunday to Saturday (all days of the week)
MESSAGE
Sunday
DST START DAY Range: First, Second, Third, Fourth, Last
MESSAGE
INSTANCE: First
DST START HOUR: Range: 0:00 to 23:00
MESSAGE
2:00
DST STOP MONTH: Range: January to December (all months)
MESSAGE
January 5
DST STOP DAY: Range: Sunday to Saturday (all days of the week)
MESSAGE
Sunday
DST STOP DAY Range: First, Second, Third, Fourth, Last
MESSAGE
INSTANCE: First
DST STOP HOUR: Range: 0:00 to 23:00
MESSAGE
2:00
The date and time can be synchronized a known time base and to other relays using an IRIG-B signal. It has the same
accuracy as an electronic watch, approximately ±1 minute per month. If an IRIG-B signal is connected to the relay, only the
current year needs to be entered. See the COMMANDS SET DATE AND TIME menu to manually set the relay clock.
The REAL TIME CLOCK EVENTS setting allows changes to the date and/or time to be captured in the event record.
The LOCAL TIME OFFSET FROM UTC setting is used to specify the local time zone offset from Universal Coordinated Time
(Greenwich Mean Time) in hours. This setting has two uses. When the M60 is time synchronized with IRIG-B, or has no
permanent time synchronization, the offset is used to calculate UTC time for IEC 61850 features. When the M60 is time
synchronized with SNTP, the offset is used to determine the local time for the M60 clock, since SNTP provides UTC time.
The daylight savings time (DST) settings can be used to allow the M60 clock can follow the DST rules of the local time
zone. Note that when IRIG-B time synchronization is active, the DST settings are ignored. The DST settings are used when
the M60 is synchronized with SNTP, or when neither SNTP nor IRIG-B is used.
Only timestamps in the event recorder and communications protocols are affected by the daylight savings time set-
tings. The reported real-time clock value does not change.
127(
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE FAULT REPORT USER-PROGRAMMABLE FAULT REPORT 1(2)
FAULT REPORT 1 #32: Range: Off, any actual value analog parameter
MESSAGE
Off
When enabled, this function monitors the pre-fault trigger. The pre-fault data are stored in the memory for prospective cre-
ation of the fault report on the rising edge of the pre-fault trigger. The element waits for the fault trigger as long as the pre-
fault trigger is asserted, but not shorter than 1 second. When the fault trigger occurs, the fault data is stored and the com-
plete report is created. If the fault trigger does not occur within 1 second after the pre-fault trigger drops out, the element
5 resets and no record is created.
The user programmable record contains the following information: the user-programmed relay name, detailed firmware
revision (5.9x, for example) and relay model (M60), the date and time of trigger, the name of pre-fault trigger (a specific
FlexLogic™ operand), the name of fault trigger (a specific FlexLogic™ operand), the active setting group at pre-fault trig-
ger, the active setting group at fault trigger, pre-fault values of all programmed analog channels (one cycle before pre-fault
trigger), and fault values of all programmed analog channels (at the fault trigger).
Each fault report is stored as a file to a maximum capacity of ten files. An eleventh trigger overwrites the oldest file. The
EnerVista UR Setup software is required to view all captured data. A FAULT RPT TRIG event is automatically created when
the report is triggered.
The relay includes two user-programmable fault reports to enable capture of two types of trips (for example, trip from ther-
mal protection with the report configured to include temperatures, and short-circuit trip with the report configured to include
voltages and currents). Both reports feed the same report file queue.
The last record is available as individual data items via communications protocols.
• PRE-FAULT 1 TRIGGER: Specifies the FlexLogic™ operand to capture the pre-fault data. The rising edge of this
operand stores one cycle-old data for subsequent reporting. The element waits for the fault trigger to actually create a
record as long as the operand selected as PRE-FAULT 1 TRIGGER is “On”. If the operand remains “Off” for 1 second, the
element resets and no record is created.
• FAULT 1 TRIGGER: Specifies the FlexLogic™ operand to capture the fault data. The rising edge of this operand
stores the data as fault data and results in a new report. The trigger (not the pre-fault trigger) controls the date and time
of the report.
• FAULT REPORT 1 # 1 to FAULT REPORT 1 #32: These settings specify an actual value such as voltage or current
magnitude, true RMS, phase angle, frequency, temperature, etc., to be stored should the report be created. Up to 32
channels can be configured. Two reports are configurable to cope with variety of trip conditions and items of interest.
5.2.8 OSCILLOGRAPHY
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP OSCILLOGRAPHY
Oscillography records contain waveforms captured at the sampling rate as well as other relay data at the point of trigger.
Oscillography records are triggered by a programmable FlexLogic™ operand. Multiple oscillography records can be cap-
tured simultaneously.
5
The NUMBER OF RECORDS is selectable, but the number of cycles captured in a single record varies considerably based on
other factors, such as sample rate and the number of operational modules. There is a fixed amount of data storage for
oscillography; the more data captured, the less the number of cycles captured per record. See the ACTUAL VALUES
RECORDS OSCILLOGRAPHY menu to view the number of cycles captured per record. The following table provides sam-
ple configurations with corresponding cycles/record.
A new record can automatically overwrite an older record when TRIGGER MODE is set to “Automatic Overwrite.”
Set the TRIGGER POSITION to a percentage of the total buffer size (for example, 10%, 50%, 75%, and so on). A trigger posi-
tion of 25% consists of 25% pre- and 75% post-trigger data. The TRIGGER SOURCE is always captured in oscillography and
can be any FlexLogic™ parameter (element state, contact input, virtual output, and so on). The relay sampling rate is 64
samples per cycle.
The AC INPUT WAVEFORMS setting determines the sampling rate at which AC input signals (that is, current and voltage) are
stored. Reducing the sampling rate allows longer records to be stored. This setting has no effect on the internal sampling
rate of the relay which is always 64 samples per cycle; that is, it has no effect on the fundamental calculations of the device.
When changes are made to the oscillography settings, all existing oscillography records are cleared.
127(
b) DIGITAL CHANNELS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP OSCILLOGRAPHY DIGITAL CHANNELS
A DIGITAL 1(63) CHANNEL setting selects the FlexLogic™ operand state recorded in an oscillography trace. The length of
each oscillography trace depends in part on the number of parameters selected here. Parameters set to “Off” are ignored.
Upon startup, the relay will automatically prepare the parameter list.
c) ANALOG CHANNELS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP OSCILLOGRAPHY ANALOG CHANNELS
5 ANALOG CHANNELS
ANALOG CHANNEL
Off
1: Range: Off, any FlexAnalog parameter
See Appendix A for complete list.
These settings select the metering actual value recorded in an oscillography trace. The length of each oscillography trace
depends in part on the number of parameters selected here. Parameters set to “Off” are ignored. The parameters available
in a given relay are dependent on:
• The type of relay,
• The type and number of CT/VT hardware modules installed, and
• The type and number of analog input hardware modules installed.
Upon startup, the relay will automatically prepare the parameter list. A list of all possible analog metering actual value
parameters is presented in Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters. The parameter index number shown in any of the tables is
used to expedite the selection of the parameter on the relay display. It can be quite time-consuming to scan through the list
of parameters via the relay keypad and display - entering this number via the relay keypad will cause the corresponding
parameter to be displayed.
All eight CT/VT module channels are stored in the oscillography file. The CT/VT module channels are named as follows:
<slot_letter><terminal_number>—<I or V><phase A, B, or C, or 4th input>
The fourth current input in a bank is called IG, and the fourth voltage input in a bank is called VX. For example, F2-IB desig-
nates the IB signal on terminal 2 of the CT/VT module in slot F.
If there are no CT/VT modules and analog input modules, no analog traces will appear in the file; only the digital traces will
appear.
The data logger samples and records up to 16 analog parameters at a user-defined sampling rate. This recorded data may
5
be downloaded to EnerVista UR Setup and displayed with parameters on the vertical axis and time on the horizontal axis.
All data is stored in non-volatile memory, meaning that the information is retained when power to the relay is lost.
For a fixed sampling rate, the data logger can be configured with a few channels over a long period or a larger number of
channels for a shorter period. The relay automatically partitions the available memory between the channels in use. Exam-
ple storage capacities for a system frequency of 60 Hz are shown in the following table.
Changing any setting affecting data logger operation clears any data that is currently in the log.
127(
• DATA LOGGER MODE: This setting configures the mode in which the data logger will operate. When set to “Continu-
ous”, the data logger will actively record any configured channels at the rate as defined by the DATA LOGGER RATE. The
data logger will be idle in this mode if no channels are configured. When set to “Trigger”, the data logger will begin to
record any configured channels at the instance of the rising edge of the DATA LOGGER TRIGGER source FlexLogic™
operand. The data logger will ignore all subsequent triggers and will continue to record data until the active record is
full. Once the data logger is full a CLEAR DATA LOGGER command is required to clear the data logger record before a
new record can be started. Performing the CLEAR DATA LOGGER command will also stop the current record and reset
the data logger to be ready for the next trigger.
• DATA LOGGER TRIGGER: This setting selects the signal used to trigger the start of a new data logger record. Any
FlexLogic™ operand can be used as the trigger source. The DATA LOGGER TRIGGER setting only applies when the
mode is set to “Trigger”.
• DATA LOGGER RATE: This setting selects the time interval at which the actual value data will be recorded.
• DATA LOGGER CHNL 1(16): This setting selects the metering actual value that is to be recorded in Channel 1(16) of
the data log. The parameters available in a given relay are dependent on: the type of relay, the type and number of CT/
VT hardware modules installed, and the type and number of Analog Input hardware modules installed. Upon startup,
the relay will automatically prepare the parameter list. A list of all possible analog metering actual value parameters is
shown in Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters. The parameter index number shown in any of the tables is used to
expedite the selection of the parameter on the relay display. It can be quite time-consuming to scan through the list of
parameters via the relay keypad/display – entering this number via the relay keypad will cause the corresponding
parameter to be displayed.
• DATA LOGGER CONFIG: This display presents the total amount of time the Data Logger can record the channels not
selected to “Off” without over-writing old data.
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
MESSAGE
LED 48
b) LED TEST
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS LED TEST
When enabled, the LED test can be initiated from any digital input or user-programmable condition such as user-program-
mable pushbutton. The control operand is configured under the LED TEST CONTROL setting. The test covers all LEDs,
including the LEDs of the optional user-programmable pushbuttons.
The test consists of three stages.
1. All 62 LEDs on the relay are illuminated. This is a quick test to verify if any of the LEDs is “burned”. This stage lasts as
long as the control input is on, up to a maximum of 1 minute. After 1 minute, the test will end.
2. All the LEDs are turned off, and then one LED at a time turns on for 1 second, then back off. The test routine starts at
the top left panel, moving from the top to bottom of each LED column. This test checks for hardware failures that lead
to more than one LED being turned on from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
3. All the LEDs are turned on. One LED at a time turns off for 1 second, then back on. The test routine starts at the top left
panel moving from top to bottom of each column of the LEDs. This test checks for hardware failures that lead to more
than one LED being turned off from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
When testing is in progress, the LEDs are controlled by the test sequence, rather than the protection, control, and monitor-
ing features. However, the LED control mechanism accepts all the changes to LED states generated by the relay and
stores the actual LED states (on or off) in memory. When the test completes, the LEDs reflect the actual state resulting from
relay response during testing. The reset pushbutton will not clear any targets when the LED Test is in progress.
A dedicated FlexLogic™ operand, LED TEST IN PROGRESS, is set for the duration of the test. When the test sequence is ini-
tiated, the LED TEST INITIATED event is stored in the event recorder.
The entire test procedure is user-controlled. In particular, stage 1 can last as long as necessary, and stages 2 and 3 can be
interrupted. The test responds to the position and rising edges of the control input defined by the LED TEST CONTROL set-
ting. The control pulses must last at least 250 ms to take effect. The following diagram explains how the test is executed.
READY TO TEST
Reset the
LED TEST IN PROGRESS
rising edge of the
operand
control input
5
Start the software image of Restore the LED states
the LEDs from the software image
Set the
LED TEST IN PROGRESS
operand
control input is on
STAGE 1 time-out
(all LEDs on) (1 minute)
rising edge
STAGE 3
of the control
(one LED off at a time) input
842011A1.CDR
Configure the LED test to recognize user-programmable pushbutton 1 by making the following entries in the SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS LED TEST menu:
The test will be initiated when the user-programmable pushbutton 1 is pressed. The pushbutton should remain pressed for
as long as the LEDs are being visually inspected. When finished, the pushbutton should be released. The relay will then
automatically start stage 2. At this point forward, test may be aborted by pressing the pushbutton.
APPLICATION EXAMPLE 2:
Assume one needs to check if any LEDs are “burned” as well as exercise one LED at a time to check for other failures. This
is to be performed via user-programmable pushbutton 1.
After applying the settings in application example 1, hold down the pushbutton as long as necessary to test all LEDs. Next,
release the pushbutton to automatically start stage 2. Once stage 2 has started, the pushbutton can be released. When
stage 2 is completed, stage 3 will automatically start. The test may be aborted at any time by pressing the pushbutton.
TRIP & ALARM LEDS TRIP LED INPUT: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
Off
ALARM LED INPUT: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
5 MESSAGE
Off
The trip and alarm LEDs are in the first LED column (enhanced faceplate) and on LED panel 1 (basic faceplate). Each indi-
cator can be programmed to become illuminated when the selected FlexLogic™ operand is in the logic 1 state.
There are 48 amber LEDs across the relay faceplate LED panels. Each of these indicators can be programmed to illumi-
nate when the selected FlexLogic™ operand is in the logic 1 state.
For the basic faceplate, the LEDs are located as follows.
• LED Panel 2: user-programmable LEDs 1 through 24
• LED Panel 3: user programmable LEDs 25 through 48
For the enhanced faceplate, the LEDs are located as follows.
• LED column 2: user-programmable LEDs 1 through 12
• LED column 3: user-programmable LEDs 13 through 24
• LED column 4: user-programmable LEDs 25 through 36
• LED column 5: user-programmable LEDs 37 through 48
Refer to the LED Indicators section in chapter 4 for additional information on the location of these indexed LEDs.
The user-programmable LED settings select the FlexLogic™ operands that control the LEDs. If the LED 1 TYPE setting is
“Self-Reset” (the default setting), the LED illumination will track the state of the selected LED operand. If the LED 1 TYPE set-
ting is “Latched”, the LED, once lit, remains so until reset by the faceplate RESET button, from a remote device via a com-
munications channel, or from any programmed operand, even if the LED operand state de-asserts.
See the figure in the Setting Groups section of the Control Elements section later in this chapter for an example of group
activation.
USER-PROGRAMMABLE DIRECT RING BREAK Range: Disabled, Enabled. Valid for units equipped with
SELF TESTS FUNCTION: Enabled Direct Input/Output module. 5
DIRECT DEVICE OFF Range: Disabled, Enabled. Valid for units equipped with
MESSAGE Direct Input/Output module.
FUNCTION: Enabled
REMOTE DEVICE OFF Range: Disabled, Enabled. Valid for units that contain a
MESSAGE CPU with Ethernet capability.
FUNCTION: Enabled
PRI. ETHERNET FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled. Valid for units that contain a
MESSAGE CPU with a primary fiber port.
FUNCTION: Disabled
SEC. ETHERNET FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled. Valid for units that contain a
MESSAGE CPU with a redundant fiber port.
FUNCTION: Disabled
BATTERY FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled.
MESSAGE
FUNCTION: Enabled
SNTP FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled. Valid for units that contain a
MESSAGE CPU with Ethernet capability.
FUNCTION: Enabled
IRIG-B FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled.
MESSAGE
FUNCTION: Enabled
ETHERNET SWITCH FAIL Range: Disabled, Enabled.
MESSAGE Displays when Ethernet switch present.
FUNCTION: Enabled
All major self-test alarms are reported automatically with their corresponding FlexLogic™ operands, events, and targets.
Most of the minor alarms can be disabled if desired.
When in the “Disabled” mode, minor alarms will not assert a FlexLogic™ operand, write to the event recorder, or display
target messages. Moreover, they will not trigger the ANY MINOR ALARM or ANY SELF-TEST messages. When in the “Enabled”
mode, minor alarms continue to function along with other major and minor alarms. Refer to the Relay Self-Tests section in
chapter 7 for additional information on major and minor self-test alarms.
There are three standard control pushbuttons, labeled USER 1, USER 2, and USER 3, on the basic and enhanced front
panels. These are user-programmable and can be used for various applications such as performing an LED test, switching
setting groups, and invoking and scrolling though user-programmable displays.
The locations of the control pushbuttons are shown in the following figures.
Control pushbuttons
842813A1.CDR
67$786 (9(17&$86(
,16(59,&( 92/7$*(
7528%/( &855(17 5(6(7
7(6702'( )5(48(1&<
75,3 27+(5 86(5 7+5((
$/$50 3+$6($ 67$1'$5'
3,&.83 3+$6(% 86(5
3+$6(&
&21752/
1(875$/*5281' 86(5 386+%877216
86(5
86(5 )285(;75$
237,21$/
86(5
&21752/
86(5 386+%877216
($"'##1"34B
SETTING
CONTROL PUSHBUTTON
{
1 FUNCTION:
Enabled=1
SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP/
BREAKERS/BREAKER 1/
BREAKER 1 PUSHBUTTON
CONTROL:
When applicable
AND RUN
Enabled=1
OFF TIMER
SYSTEM SETUP/ FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKERS/BREAKER 2/ ON 0 CONTROL PUSHBTN 1 ON
BREAKER 2 PUSHBUTTON 100 msec
CONTROL:
842010A2.CDR
Enabled=1
5 MESSAGE
DELAY: 1.0 s
PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT Range: 0 to 60.00 s in steps of 0.05
MESSAGE
TIME: 0.00 s
PUSHBTN 1 LED CTL: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE: Range: Disabled, Normal, High Priority
MESSAGE
Disabled
PUSHBUTTON 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
EVENTS: Disabled
The M60 is provided with this optional feature, specified as an option at the time of ordering. Using the
order code for your device, see the order codes in chapter 2 for details.
User-programmable pushbuttons provide an easy and error-free method of entering digital state (on, off) information. The
number depends on the front panel ordered.
• Enhanced horizontal front panel — 16 user-programmable pushbuttons
• Enhanced vertical front panel — 6 user-programmable pushbuttons
• Basic horizontal front panel — 12 user-programmable pushbuttons
User-programmable pushbuttons require a front panel with that option. If the front panel was ordered separately,
update the EnerVista software under Maintenance > Enable Pushbutton.
127(
The digital state can be entered locally (by directly pressing the front panel pushbutton) or remotely (via FlexLogic oper-
ands) into FlexLogic equations, protection elements, and control elements. Typical applications include breaker control,
autorecloser blocking, and setting groups changes. The user-programmable pushbuttons are under the control level of
password protection.
The figure shows user-configurable pushbuttons for the enhanced front panel.
USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER USER
LABEL 1 LABEL 2 LABEL 3 LABEL 4 LABEL 5 LABEL 6 LABEL 7 LABEL 8 LABEL 9 LABEL 10 LABEL 11 LABEL 12 LABEL 13 LABEL 14 LABEL 15 LABEL 16
842814A1.CDR
1 3 5 7 9 11
USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL
2 4 6 8 10 12
USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL
5
842779A1.cdr
The activation and deactivation of user-programmable pushbuttons depends on whether latched or self-reset mode is pro-
grammed.
• Latched mode: In latched mode, a pushbutton can be set (activated) by asserting the operand assigned to the
PUSHBTN 1 SET setting or by directly pressing the associated front panel pushbutton. The state of each pushbutton is
stored in non-volatile memory and maintained through a loss of control power.
The pushbutton is reset (deactivated) in latched mode by asserting the operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 RESET set-
ting or by directly pressing the associated active front panel pushbutton.
It can also be programmed to reset automatically through the PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST and PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST DELAY set-
tings. These settings enable the autoreset timer and specify the associated time delay. The autoreset timer can be
used in select-before-operate (SBO) breaker control applications, where the command type (close/open) or breaker
location (feeder number) must be selected prior to command execution. The selection must reset automatically if con-
trol is not executed within a specified time period.
• Self-reset mode: In self-reset mode, a user-programmable pushbutton can be set (activated) by asserting the operand
assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET setting or by pressing the front panel pushbutton. A pushbutton remains active for the
time it is pressed plus the dropout time specified in the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME setting. If the pushbutton is activated
via FlexLogic, the pulse duration is specified by the PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME only. The time the operand remains
assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET setting remains On has no effect on the pulse duration.
The pulse duration of the remote set or local front panel pushbutton must be at least 50 ms to operate the pushbut-
ton. This allows the user-programmable pushbuttons to properly operate during power cycling events and various
127( system disturbances that can cause transient assertion of the operating signals.
The local and remote operation of each user-programmable pushbutton can be inhibited through the PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL and
PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE settings. If local inhibit is applied, the pushbutton ignores set and reset commands executed through
the front panel pushbuttons. If remote inhibit is applied, the pushbutton ignores set and reset commands executed through
FlexLogic operands.
The inhibit functions are not applied to the autoreset feature. The inhibit function can be used in SBO control operations to
prevent user-programmable pushbutton activation and ensuring “one-at-a-time” select operation.
The inhibit functions can also be used to prevent pushbutton activation from the accidental pressing of the front panel push-
buttons. The separate inhibit of the local and remote operation simplifies the implementation of local/remote control super-
vision.
Pushbutton states can be logged by the event recorder. User-defined messages can also be associated with each pushbut-
ton and displayed when the pushbutton is activated and when in latched mode when the pushbutton deactivated.
• PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION: This setting selects the mode of the pushbutton (Self-Reset, Latched, Disabled). If set
to “Disabled,” the pushbutton is not active and the corresponding FlexLogic operands (both “On” and “Off”) are de-
asserted.
• PUSHBTN 1 ID TEXT: This setting specifies the top 20-character line of the user-programmable pushbutton message
and is intended to provide ID information of the pushbutton. See the User-Definable Displays section in this chapter for
instructions on how to enter alphanumeric characters from the keypad.
• PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT: This setting specifies the bottom 20-character line of the user-programmable message and is
displayed when the pushbutton is in the “on” position. See the User-Definable Displays section for instructions on
5 •
entering alphanumeric characters from the keypad.
PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT: This setting specifies the bottom 20-character line of the user-programmable pushbutton
message and displays when the pushbutton is deactivated and the PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is “Latched”. A message
does not display when the PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is “Self-reset” as the pushbutton operand status is implied to be
“Off” upon its release. The length of the “Off” message is configured with the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES
FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting.
• PUSHBTN 1 HOLD: This setting specifies the time required for a front panel pushbutton to be pressed before it is
deemed active. This timer is reset upon release of the pushbutton. Note that user-programmable pushbutton operation
requires the front panel pushbutton to be pressed a minimum of 50 ms. This minimum time is required prior to activat-
ing the user-programmable pushbutton hold timer.
• PUSHBTN 1 SET: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to activate the user-programmable pushbutton
element. The duration of the incoming set signal must be at least 50 ms.
• PUSHBTN 1 RESET: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to deactivate the user-programmable push-
button element. This setting is applicable only if the user-programmable pushbutton is in "Latched" mode.
• PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST: This setting enables the user-programmable pushbutton autoreset feature. This setting is
applicable only if the pushbutton is in “Latched” mode.
• PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST DELAY: This setting specifies the time delay for automatic reset of the pushbutton when in
"Latched" mode.
• PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to inhibit user-programmable pushbutton
operation from the operand assigned to the PUSHBTN 1 SET or PUSHBTN 1 RESET settings.
• PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to inhibit user-programmable pushbutton
operation from the front panel pushbuttons. This inhibit functionality is not applicable to pushbutton autoreset.
• PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME: This setting applies only to “Self-Reset” mode and specifies the duration of the user-
programmable pushbutton active status after the front panel pushbutton has been released. When activated remotely,
this setting specifies the entire activation time of the pushbutton; the length of time the operand selected by PUSHBTN
1 SET remains on has no effect on the pulse duration.
• PUSHBTN 1 LED CTL: This setting assigns the FlexLogic operand serving to drive the front panel pushbutton LED. If
this setting is “Off”, then LED operation is directly linked to the PUSHBUTTON 1 ON operand.
• PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE: This setting controls the behavior of the user-programmable pushbutton that is programmed
in the PUSHBTN 1 ID and PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT settings, and the behavior of the user-programmable pushbutton off mes-
sage that is programmed in the PUSHBTN1 ID and PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT settings.
When set to "Disabled", user-programmable pushbutton messages do not display. Otherwise the on message displays
when the user-programmable pushbutton becomes activated, and if in the "Latched" mode the off message displays
when the user-programmable pushbutton becomes deactivated.
When set to "Normal", the duration the message displays is as specified by the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting.
When set to "High Priority", the duration of the off message is as specified by the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting, but the
on message is displayed as long as the user-programmable pushbutton is activated. While activated, target and other
messages are suppressed. To allow front panel keypad operation, when a keypad button is pressed the message is
supressed for 10 seconds.
• PUSHBUTTON 1 EVENTS: If this setting is enabled, each user-programmable pushbutton state change is logged as
an event into the event recorder.
The figures show the user-programmable pushbutton logic.
SETTING
PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION
= Enabled
= Latched LATCHED To user-programmable
= Self-Reset pushbuttons logic
sheet 2
OR From front panel
SETTING SETTING
PUSHBTN 1 LOCAL PUSHBTN 1 HOLD
Off = 0 TPKP
From front panel AND
5
0
AND
TIMER
50 ms
SETTING 0 OR
PUSHBTN 1 SET
Off = 0 TIMER
50 ms Non-volatile latch
SETTING AND S
AND
0
PUSHBTN 1 REMOTE Latch
Off = 0 R
TIMER
SETTING 200 ms
PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF
0
SETTING
PUSHBTN 1 RESET AND
Off = 0
OR To user-programmable
SETTING OR PUSHBUTTON ON pushbuttons logic
SETTING sheet 2
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST DELAY
PUSHBTN 1 AUTORST
TPKP
= Enabled
AND AND
= Disabled
0
TIMER
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND 200 ms OR
PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
0
SETTING
AND PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME
0
OR
TRST
AND
842021A4.CDR
OFF MESSAGE
ENGAGE MESSAGE
SETTING
LATCHED FLASH MESSAGE TIME
SETTINGS
0 PUSHBTN ID TEXT
AND
OR TRST = XXXXXXXXXX
PUSHBTN OFF TEXT
= XXXXXXXXXX
Instantaneous
From user-programmable reset *
pushbuttons logic sheet 1
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
LATCHED/SELF-RESET
AND PUSHBUTTON 1 OFF
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PUSHBUTTON ON PUSHBUTTON 1 ON
ON MESSAGE
SETTING ENGAGE MESSAGE
PUSHBTN 1 MESSAGE
AND
= Disabled
= High Priority SETTINGS
= Normal PUSHBTN ID TEXT
= XXXXXXXXXX
OR
PUSHBTN ON TEXT
SETTING
= XXXXXXXXXX
FLASH MESSAGE TIME
0
AND The message is temporarily removed if
5
TRST any keypad button is pressed. Ten
seconds of keypad inactivity restores
Instantaneous the message.
Instantaneous reset is executed if any reset *
front panel button is pressed or any new
target or message becomes active.
This feature provides a mechanism where any of 256 selected FlexLogic™ operand states can be used for efficient moni-
toring. The feature allows user-customized access to the FlexLogic™ operand states in the relay. The state bits are packed
so that 16 states may be read out in a single Modbus register. The state bits can be configured so that all of the states
which are of interest to the user are available in a minimum number of Modbus registers.
The state bits may be read out in the “Flex States” register array beginning at Modbus address 0900h. Sixteen states are
packed into each register, with the lowest-numbered state in the lowest-order bit. There are 16 registers to accommodate
the 256 state bits.
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS
MESSAGE
USER DISPLAY 16
Range: up to 20 alphanumeric characters
5
This menu provides a mechanism for manually creating up to 16 user-defined information displays in a convenient viewing
sequence in the USER DISPLAYS menu (between the TARGETS and ACTUAL VALUES top-level menus). The sub-menus facili-
tate text entry and Modbus register data pointer options for defining the user display content.
Once programmed, the user-definable displays can be viewed in two ways.
• KEYPAD: Use the MENU key to select the USER DISPLAYS menu item to access the first user-definable display (note
that only the programmed screens are displayed). The screens can be scrolled using the UP and DOWN keys. The
display disappears after the default message time-out period specified by the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPER-
TIES DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT setting.
• USER-PROGRAMMABLE CONTROL INPUT: The user-definable displays also respond to the INVOKE AND SCROLL
setting. Any FlexLogic™ operand (in particular, the user-programmable pushbutton operands), can be used to navi-
gate the programmed displays.
On the rising edge of the configured operand (such as when the pushbutton is pressed), the displays are invoked by
showing the last user-definable display shown during the previous activity. From this moment onward, the operand
acts exactly as the down key and allows scrolling through the configured displays. The last display wraps up to the first
one. The INVOKE AND SCROLL input and the DOWN key operate concurrently.
When the default timer expires (set by the DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT setting), the relay will start to cycle through the
user displays. The next activity of the INVOKE AND SCROLL input stops the cycling at the currently displayed user dis-
play, not at the first user-defined display. The INVOKE AND SCROLL pulses must last for at least 250 ms to take effect.
Any existing system display can be automatically copied into an available user display by selecting the existing display and
pressing the ENTER key. The display will then prompt ADD TO USER DISPLAY LIST?. After selecting “Yes”, a message indi-
cates that the selected display has been added to the user display list. When this type of entry occurs, the sub-menus are
automatically configured with the proper content – this content may subsequently be edited.
5 This menu is used to enter user-defined text and user-selected Modbus-registered data fields into the particular user dis-
play. Each user display consists of two 20-character lines (top and bottom). The tilde (~) character is used to mark the start
of a data field – the length of the data field needs to be accounted for. Up to five separate data fields can be entered in a
user display – the nth tilde (~) refers to the nth item.
A user display may be entered from the faceplate keypad or the EnerVista UR Setup interface (preferred for convenience).
The following procedure shows how to enter text characters in the top and bottom lines from the faceplate keypad:
1. Select the line to be edited.
2. Press the decimal key to enter text edit mode.
3. Use either VALUE key to scroll through the characters. A space is selected like a character.
4. Press the decimal key to advance the cursor to the next position.
5. Repeat step 3 and continue entering characters until the desired text is displayed.
6. The HELP key may be pressed at any time for context sensitive help information.
7. Press the ENTER key to store the new settings.
To enter a numerical value for any of the five items (the decimal form of the selected Modbus address) from the faceplate
keypad, use the number keypad. Use the value of “0” for any items not being used. Use the HELP key at any selected sys-
tem display (setting, actual value, or command) which has a Modbus address, to view the hexadecimal form of the Modbus
address, then manually convert it to decimal form before entering it (EnerVista UR Setup usage conveniently facilitates this
conversion).
Use the MENU key to go to the user displays menu to view the user-defined content. The current user displays will show in
sequence, changing every four seconds. While viewing a user display, press the ENTER key and then select the ‘Yes”
option to remove the display from the user display list. Use the MENU key again to exit the user displays menu.
USER DISPLAY 1 DISP 1 TOP LINE: Shows user-defined text with first tilde marker.
Current X ~ A
DISP 1 BOTTOM LINE: Shows user-defined text with second tilde marker.
MESSAGE
Current Y ~ A
DISP 1 ITEM 1: Shows decimal form of user-selected Modbus register
MESSAGE address, corresponding to first tilde marker.
6016
DISP 1 ITEM 2: Shows decimal form of user-selected Modbus register
MESSAGE address, corresponding to second tilde marker.
6357
DISP 1 ITEM 3: This item is not being used. There is no corresponding
MESSAGE tilde marker in top or bottom lines.
0
DISP 1 ITEM 4: This item is not being used. There is no corresponding
MESSAGE tilde marker in top or bottom lines.
0
DISP 1 ITEM 5: This item is not being used. There is no corresponding
MESSAGE
0 tilde marker in top or bottom lines.
If the parameters for the top line and the bottom line items have the same units, then the unit is displayed on the
bottom line only. The units are only displayed on both lines if the units specified both the top and bottom line items 5
127(
are different.
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP DIRECT I/O
This option is available when an INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS card is specified at the time of order-
ing. With the option, direct inputs/outputs display by default. When you enable the teleprotection feature,
direct I/O is not visible.
Direct inputs and outputs are intended for exchange of status information (inputs and outputs) between UR-series relays
connected directly via type 7 or type 2 digital communications cards. The mechanism is very similar to IEC 61850 GSSE,
except that communications takes place over a non-switchable isolated network and is optimized for speed. On type 7
cards that support two channels, direct output messages are sent from both channels simultaneously. This effectively
sends direct output messages both ways around a ring configuration. On type 7 cards that support one channel, direct out-
put messages are sent only in one direction. Messages will be resent (forwarded) when it is determined that the message
did not originate at the receiver.
For the direct I/Os to function properly, all UR devices sending I/Os using an Inter-Relay Communications card must have
identical firmware revisions.
Direct output message timing is similar to GSSE message timing. Integrity messages (with no state changes) are sent at
least every 1000 ms. Messages with state changes are sent within the main pass scanning the inputs and asserting the
outputs unless the communication channel bandwidth has been exceeded. Two self-tests are performed and signaled by
the following FlexLogic™ operands:
1. DIRECT RING BREAK (direct input/output ring break). This FlexLogic™ operand indicates that direct output messages
sent from a UR-series relay are not being received back by the relay.
2. DIRECT DEVICE 1 OFF to DIRECT DEVICE 16 OFF (direct device offline). These FlexLogic™ operands indicate that direct
output messages from at least one direct device are not being received.
5 Direct input and output settings are similar to remote input and output settings. The equivalent of the remote device name
strings for direct inputs and outputs is the DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID. The DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID setting identifies the
relay in all direct output messages. All UR-series IEDs in a ring should have unique numbers assigned. The IED ID is used
to identify the sender of the direct input and output message.
If the direct input and output scheme is configured to operate in a ring (DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION or DIRECT I/O
CH2 RING CONFIGURATION is “Yes”), all direct output messages should be received back. If not, the direct input/output ring
break self-test is triggered. The self-test error is signaled by the DIRECT RING BREAK FlexLogic™ operand.
Select the DIRECT I/O DATA RATE to match the data capabilities of the communications channel. All IEDs communicating
over direct inputs and outputs must be set to the same data rate. UR-series IEDs equipped with dual-channel communica-
tions cards apply the same data rate to both channels. Delivery time for direct input and output messages is approximately
0.2 of a power system cycle at 128 kbps and 0.4 of a power system cycle at 64 kbps, per each ‘bridge’.
The G.703 modules are fixed at 64 kbps. The DIRECT I/O DATA RATE setting is not applicable to these modules.
127(
The DIRECT I/O CHANNEL CROSSOVER setting applies to M60s with dual-channel communication cards and allows crossing
over messages from channel 1 to channel 2. This places all UR-series IEDs into one direct input and output network
regardless of the physical media of the two communication channels.
The following application examples illustrate the basic concepts for direct input and output configuration. Refer to the Inputs
and Outputs section in this chapter for information on configuring FlexLogic™ operands (flags, bits) to be exchanged.
7;
85,('
5;
7;
85,('
5;
$&'5
Figure 5–11: INPUT AND OUTPUT EXTENSION VIA DIRECT INPUTS AND OUTPUTS
In the above application, the following settings should be applied. For UR-series IED 1:
DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID: “1”
DIRECT I/O CH1 RING CONFIGURATION: “Yes”
DIRECT I/O DATA RATE: “128 kbps”
The message delivery time is about 0.2 of power cycle in both ways (at 128 kbps); that is, from device 1 to device 2, and
from device 2 to device 1. Different communications cards can be selected by the user for this back-to-back connection (for
example: fiber, G.703, or RS422).
EXAMPLE 2: INTERLOCKING BUSBAR PROTECTION
A simple interlocking busbar protection scheme could be accomplished by sending a blocking signal from downstream
devices, say 2, 3, and 4, to the upstream device that monitors a single incomer of the busbar, as shown below.
85,(' %/2&.
($"'!"1!34B
7; 5;
85,('
5; 7;
7; 5;
85,('
5; 7;
($"'!&1!34B
85,(' 85,('
85,(' ($"'!#1!34B
5
5;
85,('
7;
($"'!$1!34B
7; 5;
85,('
5; 7;
($"'!%1!34B
The M60 checks integrity of the incoming direct input and output messages using a 32-bit CRC. The CRC alarm function is
available for monitoring the communication medium noise by tracking the rate of messages failing the CRC check. The
monitoring function counts all incoming messages, including messages that failed the CRC check. A separate counter adds
up messages that failed the CRC check. When the failed CRC counter reaches the user-defined level specified by the CRC
ALARM CH1 THRESHOLD setting within the user-defined message count CRC ALARM 1 CH1 COUNT, the DIR IO CH1 CRC ALARM
FlexLogic™ operand is set.
When the total message counter reaches the user-defined maximum specified by the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT set-
ting, both the counters reset and the monitoring process is restarted.
The operand shall be configured to drive an output contact, user-programmable LED, or selected communication-based
output. Latching and acknowledging conditions - if required - should be programmed accordingly.
The CRC alarm function is available on a per-channel basis. The total number of direct input and output messages that
failed the CRC check is available as the ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIRECT INPUTS CRC FAIL COUNT CH1 actual
value.
• Message count and length of the monitoring window: To monitor communications integrity, the relay sends 1 message
per second (at 64 kbps) or 2 messages per second (128 kbps) even if there is no change in the direct outputs. For
example, setting the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT to “10000”, corresponds a time window of about 160 minutes at
64 kbps and 80 minutes at 128 kbps. If the messages are sent faster as a result of direct outputs activity, the monitor-
ing time interval will shorten. This should be taken into account when determining the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT
setting. For example, if the requirement is a maximum monitoring time interval of 10 minutes at 64 kbps, then the CRC
ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT should be set to 10 60 1 = 600.
• Correlation of failed CRC and bit error rate (BER): The CRC check may fail if one or more bits in a packet are cor-
rupted. Therefore, an exact correlation between the CRC fail rate and the BER is not possible. Under certain assump-
tions an approximation can be made as follows. A direct input and output packet containing 20 bytes results in 160 bits
of data being sent and therefore, a transmission of 63 packets is equivalent to 10,000 bits. A BER of 10–4 implies 1 bit
error for every 10000 bits sent or received. Assuming the best case of only 1 bit error in a failed packet, having 1 failed
packet for every 63 received is about equal to a BER of 10–4.
The M60 checks integrity of the direct input and output communication ring by counting unreturned messages. In the ring
configuration, all messages originating at a given device should return within a pre-defined period of time. The unreturned
messages alarm function is available for monitoring the integrity of the communication ring by tracking the rate of unre-
turned messages. This function counts all the outgoing messages and a separate counter adds the messages have failed
to return. When the unreturned messages counter reaches the user-definable level specified by the UNRET MSGS ALARM
CH1 THRESHOLD setting and within the user-defined message count UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 COUNT, the DIR IO CH1 UNRET
ALM FlexLogic™ operand is set.
When the total message counter reaches the user-defined maximum specified by the UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 MESSAGE
COUNT setting, both the counters reset and the monitoring process is restarted.
The operand shall be configured to drive an output contact, user-programmable LED, or selected communication-based
output. Latching and acknowledging conditions, if required, should be programmed accordingly.
The unreturned messages alarm function is available on a per-channel basis and is active only in the ring configuration.
The total number of unreturned input and output messages is available as the ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIRECT
INPUTS UNRETURNED MSG COUNT CH1 actual value.
5.2.17 TELEPROTECTION
This option is available when an INTER-RELAY COMMUNICATIONS card is specified at the time of order-
ing. With the option, direct inputs/outputs display by default. When you enable the teleprotection feature,
direct I/O is not visible.
Digital teleprotection functionality is designed to transfer protection commands between two or three relays in a secure,
fast, dependable, and deterministic fashion. Possible applications are permissive or blocking pilot schemes and direct
5
transfer trip (DTT). Teleprotection can be applied over any analog or digital channels and any communications media, such
as direct fiber, copper wires, optical networks, or microwave radio links. A mixture of communication media is possible.
Once teleprotection is enabled and the teleprotection input/outputs are configured, data packets are transmitted continu-
ously every 1/4 cycle (3/8 cycle if using C37.94 modules) from peer-to-peer. Security of communication channel data is
achieved by using CRC-32 on the data packet.
Teleprotection inputs/outputs and direct inputs/outputs are mutually exclusive – as such, they cannot be used simu-
latneously. Once teleprotection inputs and outputs are enabled, direct inputs and outputs are blocked, and vice
127( versa.
• NUMBER OF TERMINALS: Specifies whether the teleprotection system operates between two peers or three peers.
• NUMBER OF CHANNELS: Specifies how many channels are used. If the NUMBER OF TERMINALS is “3” (three-terminal
system), set the NUMBER OF CHANNELS to “2”. For a two-terminal system, the NUMBER OF CHANNELS can set to “1” or
“2” (redundant channels).
• LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER, TERMINAL 1 RELAY ID NUMBER, and TERMINAL 2 RELAY ID NUMBER: In installa-
tions that use multiplexers or modems, it is desirable to ensure that the data used by the relays protecting a given line
is from the correct relays. The teleprotection function performs this check by reading the message ID sent by transmit-
ting relays and comparing it to the programmed ID in the receiving relay. This check is also used to block inputs if inad-
vertently set to loopback mode or data is being received from a wrong relay by checking the ID on a received channel.
If an incorrect ID is found on a channel during normal operation, the TELEPROT CH1 ID FAIL or TELEPROT CH2 ID FAIL
FlexLogic™ operand is set, driving the event with the same name and blocking the teleprotection inputs. For commis-
sioning purposes, the result of channel identification is also shown in the STATUS CHANNEL TESTS VALIDITY OF
CHANNEL CONFIGURATION actual value. The default value of “0” for the LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER indicates that relay ID
is not to be checked. On two- terminals two-channel systems, the same LOCAL RELAY ID NUMBER is transmitted over
both channels; as such, only the TERMINAL 1 ID NUMBER has to be programmed on the receiving end.
5.2.18 INSTALLATION
To safeguard against the installation of a relay without any entered settings, the unit will not allow signaling of any output
relay until RELAY SETTINGS is set to "Programmed". This setting is defaulted to "Not Programmed" when at the factory. The
UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED self-test error message is displayed until the relay is put into the "Programmed" state.
The RELAY NAME setting allows the user to uniquely identify a relay. This name will appear on generated reports. This name
is also used to identify specific devices which are engaged in automatically sending/receiving data over the Ethernet com-
munications channel using the IEC 61850 protocol.
When M60 is ordered with a process card module as a part of HardFiber system, then an additional Remote Resources
menu tree is available in EnerVista UR Setup software to allow configuring HardFiber system.
a) CURRENT BANKS
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS CURRENT BANK F1(M5)
Because energy parameters are accumulated, record these values and then reset immediately prior to changing CT char-
acteristics.
Four banks of phase and ground CTs can be set, where the current banks are denoted in the following format (X represents
the module slot position letter):
Xa, where X = {F, M} and a = {1, 5}
See the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for details.
These settings are critical for all features that have settings dependent on current measurements. When the relay is
ordered, the CT module must be specified to include a standard or sensitive ground input. As the phase CTs are connected
5 in wye (star), the calculated phasor sum of the three phase currents (IA + IB + IC = neutral current = 3Io) is used as the
input for the neutral overcurrent elements. In addition, a zero-sequence (core balance) CT which senses current in all of the
circuit primary conductors, or a CT in a neutral grounding conductor can also be used. For this configuration, the ground CT
primary rating must be entered. To detect low level ground fault currents, the sensitive ground input can be used. In this
case, the sensitive ground CT primary rating must be entered. Refer to chapter 3 for more details on CT connections.
Enter the rated CT primary current values. For both 1000:5 and 1000:1 CTs, the entry would be 1000. For correct opera-
tion, the CT secondary rating must match the setting (which must also correspond to the specific CT connections used).
The following example illustrates how multiple CT inputs (current banks) are summed as one source current. Given the fol-
lowing current banks:
• F1: CT bank with 500:1 ratio.
• F5: CT bank with 1000:1 ratio
• M1: CT bank with 800:1 ratio.
The following rule applies:
SRC 1 = F1 + F5 + M1 (EQ 5.6)
1 pu is the highest primary current. In this case, 1000 is entered and the secondary current from the 500:1 ratio CT will be
adjusted to that created by a 1000:1 CT before summation. If a protection element is set up to act on SRC 1 currents, then
a pickup level of 1 pu will operate on 1000 A primary.
The same rule applies for current sums from CTs with different secondary taps (5 A and 1 A).
b) VOLTAGE BANKS
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK F5(M5)
Because energy parameters are accumulated, these values should be recorded and then reset immediately prior to chang-
ing VT characteristics.
Two banks of phase/auxiliary VTs can be set, where voltage banks are denoted in the following format (X represents the
module slot position letter):
Xa, where X = {F, M} and a = {5}
See the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for details.
5
With VTs installed, the relay can perform voltage measurements as well as power calculations. Enter the PHASE VT F5 CON-
NECTION made to the system as “Wye” or “Delta”. An open-delta source VT connection would be entered as “Delta”.
The nominal PHASE VT F5 SECONDARY voltage setting is the voltage across the relay input terminals when nominal
voltage is applied to the VT primary.
127(
For example, on a system with a 13.8 kV nominal primary voltage and with a 14400:120 volt VT in a delta connec-
tion, the secondary voltage would be 115; that is, (13800 / 14400) × 120. For a wye connection, the voltage value
entered must be the phase to neutral voltage which would be 115 3 = 66.4.
On a 14.4 kV system with a delta connection and a VT primary to secondary turns ratio of 14400:120, the voltage
value entered would be 120; that is, 14400 / 120.
The power system NOMINAL FREQUENCY value is used as a default to set the digital sampling rate if the system frequency
cannot be measured from available signals. This may happen if the signals are not present or are heavily distorted. Before
reverting to the nominal frequency, the frequency tracking algorithm holds the last valid frequency measurement for a safe
period of time while waiting for the signals to reappear or for the distortions to decay. After changing this setting, restart the
relay using Maintenance > Reboot Relay Command.
The phase sequence of the power system is required to properly calculate sequence components and power parameters.
The PHASE ROTATION setting matches the power system phase sequence. Note that this setting informs the relay of the
actual system phase sequence, either ABC or ACB. CT and VT inputs on the relay, labeled as A, B, and C, must be con-
nected to system phases A, B, and C for correct operation.
The FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE setting determines which signal source is used (and hence which AC signal) for
phase angle reference. The AC signal used is prioritized based on the AC inputs that are configured for the signal source:
phase voltages takes precedence, followed by auxiliary voltage, then phase currents, and finally ground current.
For three phase selection, phase A is used for angle referencing ( V ANGLE REF = V A ), while Clarke transformation of the
phase signals is used for frequency metering and tracking ( V FREQUENCY = 2V A – V B – V C 3 ) for better performance
during fault, open pole, and VT and CT fail conditions.
The phase reference and frequency tracking AC signals are selected based upon the Source configuration, regardless of
whether or not a particular signal is actually applied to the relay.
Phase angle of the reference signal will always display zero degrees and all other phase angles will be relative to this sig-
nal. If the pre-selected reference signal is not measurable at a given time, the phase angles are not referenced.
The phase angle referencing is done via a phase locked loop, which can synchronize independent UR-series relays if they
have the same AC signal reference. These results in very precise correlation of time tagging in the event recorder between
different UR-series relays provided the relays have an IRIG-B connection.
FREQUENCY TRACKING should only be set to “Disabled” in very unusual circumstances; consult the factory for spe-
cial variable-frequency applications.
127(
The frequency tracking feature will function only when the M60 is in the “Programmed” mode. If the M60 is “Not
Programmed”, then metering values will be available but may exhibit significant errors.
Identical menus are available for each source. The "SRC 1" text can be replaced by with a user-defined name appropriate
for the associated source.
The first letter in the source identifier represents the module slot position. The number directly following this letter rep-
resents either the first bank of four channels (1, 2, 3, 4) called “1” or the second bank of four channels (5, 6, 7, 8) called “5”
in a particular CT/VT module. Refer to the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for additional
details on this concept.
It is possible to select the sum of all CT combinations. The first channel displayed is the CT to which all others will be
referred. For example, the selection “F1+F5” indicates the sum of each phase from channels “F1” and “F5”, scaled to
whichever CT has the higher ratio. Selecting “None” hides the associated actual values.
The approach used to configure the AC sources consists of several steps; first step is to specify the information about each
CT and VT input. For CT inputs, this is the nominal primary and secondary current. For VTs, this is the connection type,
ratio and nominal secondary voltage. Once the inputs have been specified, the configuration for each source is entered,
including specifying which CTs will be summed together.
C5DD9>7
13DE1<F1<E5
@B?4E3DC5DE@49C@<1I
C?EB35! @B?@5BD95C3EBB5>D
3EBB5>D@81C?B 3ED?66<5F5<
7O! 7O!7O!Å."3ED?66 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
7O"
7O
7O"7O"Å."3ED?66
7O 7O Å."3ED?66
?B CB3!% 44?@
5
GXUbU7ÅYc"SiS\Uc_\T
C5DD9>7
13DE1<F1<E5
@B?4E3DC5DE@49C@<1I
C?EB35" @B?@5BD95C3EBB5>D
3EBB5>D@81C?B 3ED?66<5F5<
7O! 7O!7O!Å."3ED?66 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
7O" 7O"7O"Å."3ED?66 ?B CB3"% 44?@
7O 7O 7O Å."3ED?66
GXUbU7ÅYc"SiS\Uc_\T
C5DD9>7
13DE1<F1<E5
@B?4E3DC5DE@49C@<1I
C?EB35& @B?@5BD95C3EBB5>D
3EBB5>D@81C?B 3ED?66<5F5<
7O! 7O!7O!Å."3ED?66 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
7O" 7O"7O"Å."3ED?66 ?B CB3&% 44?@
7O 7O 7O Å."3ED?66
GXUbU7ÅYc"SiS\Uc_\T ("' )"1#34B
This configuration could be used on a two-winding transformer, with one winding connected into a breaker-and-a-half sys-
tem. The following figure shows the arrangement of sources used to provide the functions required in this application, and
the CT/VT inputs that are used to provide the data.
F1 DSP Bank
F5
Source 1 Source 2
Amps Amps
Source 3
51BF-1 51BF-2
U1 Volts Amps
5 V
A W Var 87T
A W Var 51P
Volts Amps
M1
M1 Source 4
UR Relay
M5
827794A1.CDR
Y LV D HV AUX
SRC 1 SRC 2 SRC 3
Phase CT M1 F1+F5 None
Ground CT M1 None None
Phase VT M5 None None
Aux VT None None U1
5.4.4 MOTOR
MOTOR MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS Range: 0.050 to 1.000 pu in steps of 0.001
(FLA): 1.000 pu
MOTOR OVERLOAD Range: 1.00 to 1.50 in steps of 0.01
MESSAGE
FACTOR: 1.00
MOTOR NAMEPLATE Range: 100 to 50000 V in steps of 1
MESSAGE
VOLTAGE: 600 V
MOTOR OFFLINE: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
EMERGENCY RESTART: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
MOTOR LINE SOURCE: Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4
MESSAGE
SRC 1
NUMBER OF STARTS Range: 1 to 5 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
TO LEARN: 5
MOTOR LOAD AVERAGE Range: 1 to 90 minutes in steps of 1
MESSAGE
CALC. PERIOD: 15 min.
2-SPEED MOTOR Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
PROTECTION: Disabled 5
SPEED2 MOTOR SWITCH: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
SPEED2 SWITCH 2-1 Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
MESSAGE
DELAY: 5.00 s
SPEED2 MOTOR SOURCE: Range: SRC 1, SRC 2, SRC 3, SRC 4
MESSAGE
SRC 1
SPEED2 MOTOR FLA: Range: 0.050 to 1.000 pu in steps of 0.001
MESSAGE
1.000 pu
These settings reflect the design and configuration of the motor that the relay will protect. Note that some protection ele-
ments are dependent on these settings for correct operation.
Prior to revision 5.40, RTDs used for motor stator thermal model were defined in this section. With revisions 5.40
and higher, RTDs are defined in the SETTINGS TRANSDUCER I/O RTD INPUTS menu.
127(
• MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS: This setting represents the full load current (FLA) of the motor as a fraction of the CT pri-
mary rating. FLA is a standard motor parameter that can be found on the motor nameplate.
• MOTOR OVERLOAD FACTOR: This setting defines the current level at which the motor is considered to be over-
loaded. If the motor current exceeds the MOTOR OVERLOAD FACTOR threshold, the M60 thermal model reacts by accu-
mulating thermal capacity. Normally, this factor is set slightly above the motor service factor to account for inherent
load measuring errors (CTs and limited relay accuracy). The typical total inaccuracy factor is 8 to 10%; as such, for
motors with a thermal capability at rated service factor of 1 or 1.15, the MOTOR OVERLOAD FACTOR should be set to 1.1
or 1.25, respectively.
If the average load current is between full load and the overload factor, the thermal capacity remains constant. If the
average current is less than the full load current, the thermal capacity decays exponentially.
• MOTOR NAMEPLATE VOLTAGE: This setting represents the rated phase-to-phase motor voltage. The MOTOR NAME-
PLATE VOLTAGE setting is used as a reference for the voltage dependant thermal overload curve feature and indicates
a 100% voltage starting condition.
• MOTOR OFFLINE: This input must be connected to the appropriate external contact. This setting is selected to a con-
tact input that is connected to an auxiliary contact of the breaker or contactor used to switch the motor. The motor is
declared to be stopped when the phase current falls below 2% of motor full load current (FLA) and the external contact
indicates the switching device is open.
For example, a circuit breaker 52b auxiliary contact is closed when the breaker is open and open when the breaker is
closed. Therefore the setting should be "Cont Ip n On". For a 52a contact the setting should be "Cont Ip n Off".
Four mutually exclusive FlexLogic™ operands that reflect the motor state are generated by a state machine in the
relay to determine motor status. They are: MOTOR OFFLINE, MOTOR STARTING, MOTOR RUNNING, and MOTOR OVER-
LOAD.
The state machine initially sets the MOTOR OFFLINE operand, as the auxiliary contact reports the switching device is
open and motor current is less than 2% of FLA. If the previous motor status is offline and a phase current greater than
2% of FLA is detected and the MOTOR OFFLINE operand de-asserts, the MOTOR STARTING operand becomes true.
After 1 second, if motor current is less than FLA times the MOTOR OVERLOAD FACTOR setting, the MOTOR RUNNING
operand is set (this accounts for the use of a soft-starter mechanism that slowly increases current such that it never
exceeds FLA overload factor during a starting sequence). For normal starting, the MOTOR STARTING operand
remains set until the current falls below FLA overload factor, at which time the MOTOR RUNNING operand is set. If
current rises above FLA Service Factor at that point, the MOTOR OVERLOAD operand is set. If current then falls below
FLA overload factor, the MOTOR OVERLOAD operand is reset and the MOTOR RUNNING operand is set. A MOTOR
OFFLINE state is determined per the logic noted above.
When two-speed motor functionality is employed, this setting is used to indicate the breaker or contactor position at
speed 1. As such, the speed 1 auxiliary contact is connected to the input specified by this setting for two-speed appli-
cations.
• EMERGENCY RESTART: As the name implies, this feature should only be used in an emergency, as it defeats the
5 purpose of the relay – protecting the motor!. The input selected by this setting is used to reset the motor thermal
capacity used from its current value to 0% so that a hot motor may be restarted. However, trip conditions that are still
present (for example, hot RTD) will still cause a trip. In the event of a real emergency, the EMERGENCY RESTART oper-
and should remain at logic 1 until the emergency is over. Any EMERGENCY RESTART operand transition will be logged
as an event.
• MOTOR LINE SOURCE: This setting selects the source connected to phase current transformers on the power sys-
tem side of the stator winding.
• NUMBER OF STARTS TO LEARN: This setting selects number of motor start and stop records to average data pre-
sented in the ACTUAL VALUES RECORDS MOTOR LEARNED DATA menu.
• MOTOR LOAD AVERAGE CALC. PERIOD: This setting specifies the period of time over which parameter averages
are calculated. The calculation is a sliding window.
• 2-SPEED MOTOR PROTECTION: This setting is used to enable the two-speed motor function. This function provides
proper protection for a two-speed motor where there are two different full load values. The two-speed functionality is
required for motors having two windings wound into one stator. One winding, when energized, provides one of the
speeds. When the second winding is energized, the motor takes on the speed determined by the second winding. The
M60 algorithm integrates the heating at each speed into one thermal model using a common thermal capacity used
register value for both speeds. Using the M60 for such applications provides several options, allowing the removal of
traditional wiring and interlocking:
– Use the M60 front panel pushbuttons and provide necessary operate and interlock logic via FlexLogic™.
– Use external pushbuttons and provide necessary operate and interlock logic using FlexLogic™ as shown below.
– Use a traditional external control schematic with some connections to the M60 for control and protection.
• SPEED2 MOTOR SWITCH: If the two-speed motor feature is used, this setting specifies a FlexLogic™ operand to
indicate the current motor speed. This is typically an indication that the contactor at speed 2 is energized. When the
assigned FlexLogic™ operand (typically a contact input operand) is asserted, the algorithm switches to speed 2 (high
speed). If the assigned FlexLogic™ operand is de-asserted, the algorithm switches to speed 1 (low speed). This allows
the M60 to determine which settings should be active at any given time. To maintain correct motor status indication, the
M60 expects a transition from speed 1 to speed 2 within two seconds; otherwise, the motor status value may be reset.
• SPEED2 SWITCH 2-1 DELAY: This setting specifies the time delay to transfer from high to low speed. This allows the
motor to slow down before energizing at low speed.
• SPEED2 MOTOR SOURCE: This setting selects source for a motor protection when two-speed motor functionality is
used. This can be separate voltage and current banks or one voltage and current bank one with different full load cur-
rent value at the second speed (entered in the SPEED2 MOTOR FLA setting). If separate CTs with different ratios or sec-
ondary currents are required for speed 2, then the relay should be ordered with two CT banks.
• SPEED2 MOTOR FLA: This setting specifies the motor full load current for speed 2.
L1 L T1
H T2
L2 L
H
L3 L T3
MOTOR
H T4
H T5
H T6
CT bank 1 CT bank 2
Contact
outputs
H
L
STOP
M60 protection
Contact inputs
LOW
and logic
HIGH
H
L
833723A1.CDR 5
Figure 5–20: TWO SPEED MOTOR CONNECTIONS
5.4.5 BREAKERS
5 MESSAGE
Off
BREAKER1 A/3P OPND: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
BREAKER 1 B CLOSED: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
BREAKER 1 B OPENED: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
BREAKER 1 C CLOSED: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
BREAKER 1 C OPENED: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
BREAKER 1 Toperate: Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
MESSAGE
0.070 s
BREAKER 1 EXT ALARM: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
BREAKER 1 ALARM Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
MESSAGE
DELAY: 0.000 s
MANUAL CLOSE RECAL1 Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
MESSAGE
TIME: 0.000 s
BREAKER 1 OUT OF SV: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
BREAKER 1 EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
Disabled
A description of the operation of the breaker control and status monitoring features is provided in chapter 4. Only informa-
tion concerning programming of the associated settings is covered here. These features are provided for two or more
breakers; a user may use only those portions of the design relevant to a single breaker, which must be breaker 1.
The number of breaker control elements is dependent on the number of CT/VT modules specified with the M60. The follow-
ing settings are available for each breaker control element.
• BREAKER 1 FUNCTION: This setting enables and disables the operation of the breaker control feature.
• BREAKER1 PUSH BUTTON CONTROL: Set to “Enable” to allow faceplate push button operations.
• BREAKER 1 NAME: Assign a user-defined name (up to six characters) to the breaker. This name will be used in flash
messages related to breaker 1.
• BREAKER 1 MODE: This setting selects “3-Pole” mode, where all breaker poles are operated simultaneously, or “1-
Pole” mode where all breaker poles are operated either independently or simultaneously.
• BREAKER 1 OPEN: This setting selects an operand that creates a programmable signal to operate an output relay to
open breaker 1.
• BREAKER 1 BLK OPEN: This setting selects an operand that prevents opening of the breaker. This setting can be
used for select-before-operate functionality or to block operation from a panel switch or from SCADA.
• BREAKER 1 CLOSE: This setting selects an operand that creates a programmable signal to operate an output relay
to close breaker 1.
• BREAKER 1 BLK CLOSE: This setting selects an operand that prevents closing of the breaker. This setting can be
used for select-before-operate functionality or to block operation from a panel switch or from SCADA.
• BREAKER1 A/3P CLOSED: This setting selects an operand, usually a contact input connected to a breaker auxiliary
position tracking mechanism. This input should be a normally-open 52/a status input to create a logic 1 when the
breaker is closed. If the BREAKER 1 MODE setting is selected as “3-Pole”, this setting selects a single input as the oper-
and used to track the breaker open or closed position. If the mode is selected as “1-Pole”, the input mentioned above
5
is used to track phase A and the BREAKER 1 B and BREAKER 1 C settings select operands to track phases B and C,
respectively.
• BREAKER1 A/3P OPND: This setting selects an operand, usually a contact input, that should be a normally-closed
52/b status input to create a logic 1 when the breaker is open. If a separate 52/b contact input is not available, then the
inverted BREAKER 1 CLOSED status signal can be used.
• BREAKER 1 B CLOSED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected
as single-pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase B closed position as above for phase A.
• BREAKER 1 B OPENED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected
as single-pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase B opened position as above for phase A.
• BREAKER 1 C CLOSED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected
as single-pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase C closed position as above for phase A.
• BREAKER 1 C OPENED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected
as single-pole, this input is used to track the breaker phase C opened position as above for phase A.
• BREAKER 1 Toperate: This setting specifies the required interval to overcome transient disagreement between the
52/a and 52/b auxiliary contacts during breaker operation. If transient disagreement still exists after this time has
expired, the BREAKER 1 BAD STATUS FlexLogic™ operand is asserted from alarm or blocking purposes.
• BREAKER 1 EXT ALARM: This setting selects an operand, usually an external contact input, connected to a breaker
alarm reporting contact.
• BREAKER 1 ALARM DELAY: This setting specifies the delay interval during which a disagreement of status among
the three-pole position tracking operands will not declare a pole disagreement. This allows for non-simultaneous oper-
ation of the poles.
• MANUAL CLOSE RECAL1 TIME: This setting specifies the interval required to maintain setting changes in effect after
an operator has initiated a manual close command to operate a circuit breaker.
• BREAKER 1 OUT OF SV: Selects an operand indicating that breaker 1 is out-of-service.
SETTING
BREAKER 1 FUNCTION
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
= Enabled
AND BREAKER 1 OFF CMD
= Disabled
BREAKER 1 TRIP A
BREAKER 1 TRIP B
SETTING AND
BREAKER 1 TRIP C
BREAKER 1 BLOCK OPEN
Off = 0 AND
TRIP PHASE A
TRIP PHASE B
TRIP PHASE C
TRIP 3-POLE
SETTING
BREAKER 1 OPEN
Off = 0
OR
SETTING
BREAKER 1 PUSHBUTTON
CONTROL
= Enabled
AND
USER 2 OFF/ON
To close BRK1-(Name)
OR
AND
5
SETTING
BREAKER 1 CLOSE
Off = 0
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND BREAKER 1 MNL CLS
61850 Select & Close SETTING
MANUAL CLOSE RECAL1 TIME AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
OR AND BREAKER 1 ON CMD
BREAKER 1 BLOCK CLOSE
Off = 0 827061AT.CDR
127(
from breaker
control logic
sheet 1, BKR ENABLED
827061 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND BREAKER 1
AND AND BREAKER 1 CLOSED CLOSED
OR (DEFAULT)
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING SETTING OR BREAKER 1 BAD STATUS
AND
BREAKER 1 ΦA/3P CLSD BREAKER 1 Toperate
= Off FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND AND
BREAKER 1 FA BAD ST
0 OR
BREAKER 1 FA CLSD
SETTING
AND BREAKER 1 FA OPEN
BREAKER 1 ΦA/3P OPND
AND BREAKER 1 FA INTERM
= Off
AND
AND
AND
SETTING SETTING
AND
5
BREAKER 1 ΦB CLSD BREAKER 1 Toperate
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
= Off AND
AND BREAKER 1 FB BAD ST
0 OR BREAKER 1 ΦB CLSD
SETTING BREAKER 1 ΦB OPEN
AND
BREAKER 1 ΦB OPND BREAKER 1 ΦB INTERM
AND
= Off
AND
AND
AND
SETTING SETTING
AND
BREAKER 1 ΦC CLSD BREAKER 1 Toperate
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
= Off AND
AND BREAKER 1 FC BAD ST
0 OR BREAKER 1 ΦC CLSD
SETTING BREAKER 1 ΦC OPEN
AND
BREAKER 1 ΦC OPND BREAKER 1 ΦC INTERM
AND
= Off
AND
AND
AND
XOR AND
SETTING
BREAKER 1 OUT OF SV AND
= Off 842025A4.CDR
5 MESSAGE
Off
SWITCH 1 B CLOSED: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
SWITCH 1 B OPENED: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
SWITCH 1 C CLOSED: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
SWITCH 1 C OPENED: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
SWITCH 1 TOPERATE: Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
MESSAGE
0.070 s
SWITCH 1 ALARM Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
MESSAGE
DELAY: 0.000 s
SWITCH 1 EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
Disabled
The disconnect switch control element contains the auxiliary logic for status and serves as the interface for opening and
closing of disconnect switches from SCADA or through the front panel interface. The disconnect switch control element can
be used to create interlocking functionality. For greater security in determination of the switch pole position, both the 89/a
and 89/b auxiliary contacts are used with reporting of the discrepancy between them. The number of available disconnect
switches is four per breaker.
To use this element, configure the contact outputs that open and close the disconnect switch to use FlexLogic operands
SWITCH 1 OFF CMD and SWITCH 1 ON CMD, and configure the disconnect switch control element's inputs as outlined here.
• SWITCH 1 FUNCTION: This setting enables and disables the operation of the disconnect switch element.
• SWITCH 1 NAME: Assign a user-defined name (up to six characters) to the disconnect switch. This name will be used
in flash messages related to disconnect switch 1.
• SWITCH 1 MODE: This setting selects “3-Pole” mode, where disconnect switch poles have a single common auxiliary
switch, or “1-Pole” mode where each disconnect switch pole has its own auxiliary switch.
• SWITCH 1 OPEN: This setting selects an operand that when activated, and unless blocked, initiates the disconnect
switch 1 open command.
• SWITCH 1 BLK OPEN: This setting selects an operand that prevents initiation of the disconnect switch 1 command.
This setting can be used for blocking disconnect switch opening for instance when switchyard monitoring indicates cur-
rent exceeding the switch's interrupting rating can be flowing through the switch.
• SWITCH 1 CLOSE: This setting selects an operand that when activated, and unless blocked, initiates the disconnect
switch 1 close command.
• SWITCH 1 BLK CLOSE: This setting selects an operand that prevents initiation of disconnect switch 1 close com-
mands. This setting can be used for blocking disconnect switch closing, for instance to prevent closing into a closed
ground switch.
• SWTCH 1 A/3P CLSD: This setting selects an operand, usually a contact input connected to a disconnect switch
auxiliary position tracking mechanism. This input is for a normally-open 89/a status input that creates a logic 1 when
the disconnect switch is closed. If the SWITCH 1 MODE setting is selected as “3-Pole”, this setting selects a single 89/a
input as the operand used to track the disconnect switch open or closed position. If the mode is selected as “1-Pole”,
the input mentioned above is used to track phase A and the SWITCH 1 B and SWITCH 1 C settings select operands to
track phases B and C, respectively.
• SWTCH 1 A/3P OPND: This setting selects an operand, usually a contact input, that is for a normally-closed 89/b
status input that creates a logic 1 when the disconnect switch is open. If a separate 89/b contact input is not available,
then an inverted 89/a status signal can be used.
• SWITCH 1 B CLOSED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as
•
single-pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase B closed position as above for phase A.
SWITCH 1 B OPENED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as
5
single-pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase B opened position as above for phase A.
• SWITCH 1 C CLOSED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as
single-pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase C closed position as above for phase A.
• SWITCH 1 C OPENED: If the mode is selected as three-pole, this setting has no function. If the mode is selected as
single-pole, this input is used to track the disconnect switch phase C opened position as above for phase A.
• SWITCH 1 TOPERATE: This setting specifies the required interval to overcome transient disagreement between the
89/a and 89/b auxiliary contacts during disconnect switch operation. If transient disagreement still exists after this time
has expired, the SWITCH 1 BAD STATUS FlexLogic operand is asserted for alarm or blocking purposes.
• SWITCH 1 ALARM DELAY: This setting specifies the delay interval during which a disagreement of status among the
pole position tracking operands will not declare a pole disagreement. This allows for non-simultaneous operation of the
poles.
IEC 61850 functionality is permitted when the M60 is in “Programmed” mode and not in the local control mode.
127(
SETTINGS
SWITCH 1 FUNCTION
= Disabled
= Enabled
SWITCH 1 OPEN FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
= Off SWITCH 1 OFF CMD
OR AND
SETTING 61850 Select & Open
SWITCH 1 BLK OPEN
= Off
SETTING
SWITCH 1 CLOSE
= Off FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR AND SWITCH 1 ON CMD
SETTING 61850 Select & Close
SWITCH 1 BLK CLOSE
= Off
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND AND SWITCH 1 CLOSED
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING SETTING OR SWITCH 1 BAD STATUS
AND
SWTCH 1 ΦA/3P CLSD SWITCH 1 Toperate
5
= Off FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND AND
SWITCH 1 FA BAD ST
0 OR
SWITCH 1 FA CLSD
SETTING
AND SWITCH 1 FA OPEN
SWTCH 1 ΦA/3P OPND
AND SWITCH 1 FA INTERM
= Off
AND
AND
AND
SETTING SETTING
AND
SWITCH 1 ΦB CLSD SWITCH 1 Toperate
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
= Off AND
AND SWITCH 1 FB BAD ST
0 OR SWITCH 1 ΦB CLSD
SETTING SWITCH 1 ΦB OPEN
AND
SWITCH 1 ΦB OPND SWITCH 1 ΦB INTERM
AND
= Off
AND
AND
AND
SETTING SETTING
AND
SWITCH 1 ΦC CLSD SWITCH 1 Toperate
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
= Off AND
AND SWITCH 1 FC BAD ST
0 OR SWITCH 1 ΦC CLSD
SETTING SWITCH 1 ΦC OPEN
AND
SWITCH 1 ΦC OPND SWITCH 1 ΦC INTERM
AND
= Off
AND
AND
AND
842026A5.CDR
5.4.7 FLEXCURVES™
a) SETTINGS
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP FLEXCURVES FLEXCURVE A(D)
FlexCurves™ A through D have settings for entering times to reset and operate at the following pickup levels: 0.00 to 0.98
and 1.03 to 20.00. This data is converted into two continuous curves by linear interpolation between data points. To enter a
custom FlexCurve™, enter the reset and operate times (using the VALUE keys) for each selected pickup point (using the
MESSAGE UP/DOWN keys) for the desired protection curve (A, B, C, or D).
The relay using a given FlexCurve™ applies linear approximation for times between the user-entered points. Spe-
cial care must be applied when setting the two points that are close to the multiple of pickup of 1; that is, 0.98 pu
127(
and 1.03 pu. It is recommended to set the two times to a similar value; otherwise, the linear approximation may
result in undesired behavior for the operating quantity that is close to 1.00 pu.
+LJK&XUUHQW7LPH$OORZVWKHXVHUWRVHWDSLFNXSPXOWLSOH
IURPZKLFKSRLQWRQZDUGVWKHRSHUDWLQJWLPHLVIL[HG7KLVLV
QRUPDOO\RQO\UHTXLUHGDWKLJKHUFXUUHQWOHYHOV7KH+&75DWLR
GHILQHVWKHKLJKFXUUHQWSLFNXSPXOWLSOHWKH+&7GHILQHVWKH
RSHUDWLQJWLPH
($"'"!1!34B
d) EXAMPLE
A composite curve can be created from the GE_111 standard with MRT = 200 ms and HCT initially disabled and then
enabled at eight times pickup with an operating time of 30 ms. At approximately four times pickup, the curve operating time
is equal to the MRT and from then onwards the operating time remains at 200 ms (see below).
($"'!)1!34B
($"'" 1!34B
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(& (&
(& (&
5 $633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
(&
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(&
$633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
($"'"%1!34B
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(& (&
(&
Figure 5–29: RECLOSER CURVES GE134, GE137, GE140, GE151 AND GE201
($"'# 1!34B
5
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(&
(&
$633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
($"'"(1!34B
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(&
(&
(&
(&
$633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
5
($"'")1!34B
Figure 5–31: RECLOSER CURVES GE133, GE161, GE162, GE163, GE164 AND GE165
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(&
(&
(& (&
$633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
($"'"&1!34B
Figure 5–32: RECLOSER CURVES GE116, GE117, GE118, GE132, GE136, AND GE139
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(&
(&
$633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
5
($"'"$1!34B
Figure 5–33: RECLOSER CURVES GE107, GE111, GE112, GE114, GE115, GE121, AND GE122
(&
5*.& TFD
(&
(&
$633&/5 NVMUJQMFPGQJDLVQ
($"'"'1!34B
To provide maximum flexibility to the user, the arrangement of internal digital logic combines fixed and user-programmed
parameters. Logic upon which individual features are designed is fixed, and all other logic, from digital input signals through
elements or combinations of elements to digital outputs, is variable. The user has complete control of all variable logic
through FlexLogic™. In general, the system receives analog and digital inputs which it uses to produce analog and digital
outputs. The major sub-systems of a generic UR-series relay involved in this process are shown below.
The logic that determines the interaction of inputs, elements, schemes and outputs is field programmable through the use
of logic equations that are sequentially processed. The use of virtual inputs and outputs in addition to hardware is available
internally and on the communication ports for other relays to use (distributed FlexLogic™).
FlexLogic™ allows users to customize the relay through a series of equations that consist of operators and operands. The
operands are the states of inputs, elements, schemes and outputs. The operators are logic gates, timers and latches (with
set and reset inputs). A system of sequential operations allows any combination of specified operands to be assigned as
inputs to specified operators to create an output. The final output of an equation is a numbered register called a virtual out-
put. Virtual outputs can be used as an input operand in any equation, including the equation that generates the output, as a
seal-in or other type of feedback.
A FlexLogic™ equation consists of parameters that are either operands or operators. Operands have a logic state of 1 or 0.
Operators provide a defined function, such as an AND gate or a Timer. Each equation defines the combinations of parame-
ters to be used to set a Virtual Output flag. Evaluation of an equation results in either a 1 (=ON, i.e. flag set) or 0 (=OFF, i.e.
flag not set). Each equation is evaluated at least 4 times every power system cycle.
Some types of operands are present in the relay in multiple instances; e.g. contact and remote inputs. These types of oper-
ands are grouped together (for presentation purposes only) on the faceplate display. The characteristics of the different
types of operands are listed in the table below.
The operands available for this relay are listed alphabetically by types in the following table.
Table 5–8: M60 FLEXLOGIC™ OPERANDS (Sheet 1 of 8)
OPERAND TYPE OPERAND SYNTAX OPERAND DESCRIPTION
CONTROL CONTROL PUSHBTN 1 ON Control pushbutton 1 is being pressed
PUSHBUTTONS CONTROL PUSHBTN 2 ON Control pushbutton 2 is being pressed
CONTROL PUSHBTN 3 ON Control pushbutton 3 is being pressed
CONTROL PUSHBTN 4 ON Control pushbutton 4 is being pressed
CONTROL PUSHBTN 5 ON Control pushbutton 5 is being pressed
CONTROL PUSHBTN 6 ON Control pushbutton 6 is being pressed
CONTROL PUSHBTN 7 ON Control pushbutton 7 is being pressed
DIRECT DEVICES DIRECT DEVICE 1On Flag is set, logic=1
DIRECT DEVICE 16On Flag is set, logic=1
DIRECT DEVICE 1Off Flag is set, logic=1
DIRECT DEVICE 16Off Flag is set, logic=1
DIRECT INPUT/ DIR IO CH1 CRC ALARM The rate of direct input messages received on channel 1 and failing the CRC
OUTPUT exceeded the user-specified level
CHANNEL DIR IO CH2 CRC ALARM The rate of direct input messages received on channel 2 and failing the CRC
MONITORING exceeded the user-specified level
DIR IO CH1 UNRET ALM The rate of returned direct input/output messages on channel 1 exceeded the
user-specified level (ring configurations only)
DIR IO CH2 UNRET ALM The rate of returned direct input/output messages on channel 2 exceeded the
user-specified level (ring configurations only)
ELEMENT: AMP UNBALANCE 1 PKP Amp unbalance 1 element is picked up
Amp unbalance AMP UNBALANCE 1 OP Amp unbalance 1 element is operated
AMP UNBALANCE 1 DPO Amp unbalance 1 element is dropped out
AMP UNBALANCE 2 Same set of operands as shown for AMP UNBALANCE 1
ELEMENT: AUX OV1 PKP Auxiliary overvoltage element has picked up
5 Auxiliary
overvoltage
AUX OV1 DPO
AUX OV1 OP
Auxiliary overvoltage element has dropped out
Auxiliary overvoltage element has operated
AUX OV2 Same set of operands as shown for AUX OV1
ELEMENT: AUX UV1 PKP Auxiliary undervoltage element has picked up
Auxiliary AUX UV1 DPO Auxiliary undervoltage element has dropped out
undervoltage AUX UV1 OP Auxiliary undervoltage element has operated
AUX UV2 Same set of operands as shown for AUX UV1
ELEMENT BKR 1 FLSHOVR PKP A Breaker 1 flashover element phase A has picked up
Breaker flashover BKR 1 FLSHOVR PKP B Breaker 1 flashover element phase B has picked up
BKR 1 FLSHOVR PKP C Breaker 1 flashover element phase C has picked up
BKR 1 FLSHOVR PKP Breaker 1 flashover element has picked up
BKR 1 FLSHOVR OP A Breaker 1 flashover element phase A has operated
BKR 1 FLSHOVR OP B Breaker 1 flashover element phase B has operated
BKR 1 FLSHOVR OP C Breaker 1 flashover element phase C has operated
BKR 1 FLSHOVR OP Breaker 1 flashover element has operated
BKR 1 FLSHOVR DPO A Breaker 1 flashover element phase A has dropped out
BKR 1 FLSHOVR DPO B Breaker 1 flashover element phase B has dropped out
BKR 1 FLSHOVR DPO C Breaker 1 flashover element phase C has dropped out
BKR 1 FLSHOVR DPO Breaker 1 flashover element has dropped out
BKR 2 FLSHOVR Same set of operands as shown for BKR 1 FLSHOVR
ELEMENT BKR FAIL 1 RETRIPA Breaker failure 1 re-trip phase A (only for 1-pole schemes)
Breaker failure BKR FAIL 1 RETRIPB Breaker failure 1 re-trip phase B (only for 1-pole schemes)
BKR FAIL 1 RETRIPC Breaker failure 1 re-trip phase C (only for 1-pole schemes)
BKR FAIL 1 RETRIP Breaker failure 1 re-trip 3-phase
BKR FAIL 1 T1 OP Breaker failure 1 timer 1 is operated
BKR FAIL 1 T2 OP Breaker failure 1 timer 2 is operated
BKR FAIL 1 T3 OP Breaker failure 1 timer 3 is operated
BKR FAIL 1 TRIP OP Breaker failure 1 trip is operated
BKR FAIL 2 Same set of operands as shown for BKR FAIL 1
5 ELEMENT:
Neutral overvoltage
NEUTRAL OV1 PKP
NEUTRAL OV1 DPO
NEUTRAL OV1 OP
Neutral overvoltage element 1 has picked up
Neutral overvoltage element 1 has dropped out
Neutral overvoltage element 1 has operated
NEUTRAL OV2 to 3 Same set of operands as shown for NEUTRAL OV1
ELEMENT: NTRL DIR OC1 FWD Neutral directional overcurrent 1 forward has operated
Neutral directional NTRL DIR OC1 REV Neutral directional overcurrent 1 reverse has operated
overcurrent
NTRL DIR OC2 Same set of operands as shown for NTRL DIR OC1
ELEMENT: OVERFREQ 1 PKP Overfrequency 1 has picked up
Overfrequency OVERFREQ 1 OP Overfrequency 1 has operated
OVERFREQ 1 DPO Overfrequency 1 has dropped out
OVERFREQ 2 to 4 Same set of operands as shown for OVERFREQ 1
ELEMENT: PH DIR1 BLK A Phase A directional 1 block
Phase directional PH DIR1 BLK B Phase B directional 1 block
overcurrent PH DIR1 BLK C Phase C directional 1 block
PH DIR1 BLK Phase directional 1 block
PH DIR2 Same set of operands as shown for PH DIR1
ELEMENT: PHASE IOC1 PKP At least one phase of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has picked up
Phase PHASE IOC1 OP At least one phase of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has operated
instantaneous PHASE IOC1 DPO All phases of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 have dropped out
overcurrent PHASE IOC1 PKP A Phase A of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has picked up
PHASE IOC1 PKP B Phase B of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has picked up
PHASE IOC1 PKP C Phase C of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has picked up
PHASE IOC1 OP A Phase A of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has operated
PHASE IOC1 OP B Phase B of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has operated
PHASE IOC1 OP C Phase C of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has operated
PHASE IOC1 DPO A Phase A of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has dropped out
PHASE IOC1 DPO B Phase B of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has dropped out
PHASE IOC1 DPO C Phase C of phase instantaneous overcurrent 1 has dropped out
PHASE IOC2 to 8 Same set of operands as shown for PHASE IOC1
ELEMENT:
UNDERFREQ 2 to 6
UNDERPWR 1 ALARM PKP
Same set of operands as shown for UNDERFREQ 1
Asserted when the underpower 1 alarm stage picks up
5
Underpower UNDERPWR 1 TRIP PKP Asserted when the underpower 1 trip stage picks up
UNDERPWR 1 ALARM DPO Asserted when the underpower 1 alarm stage drops out
UNDERPWR 1 TRIP DPO Asserted when the underpower 1 trip stage drops out
UNDERPWR 1 ALARM OP Asserted when the underpower 1 alarm stage operates
UNDERPWR 1 TRIP OP Asserted when the underpower 1 trip stage operates
UNDERPWR 2 Same set of operands as UNDERPWR 1
FIXED OPERANDS Off Logic = 0. Does nothing and may be used as a delimiter in an equation list;
used as ‘Disable’ by other features.
On Logic = 1. Can be used as a test setting.
INPUTS/OUTPUTS: Cont Ip 1 On (will not appear unless ordered)
Contact inputs Cont Ip 2 On (will not appear unless ordered)
Cont Ip 1 Off (will not appear unless ordered)
Cont Ip 2 Off (will not appear unless ordered)
Cont Ip 96 On (will not appear unless ordered)
Cont Ip 96 Off (will not appear unless ordered)
INPUTS/OUTPUTS: Cont Op 1 Closed Contact output is closed
Contact outputs Cont Op 1 IOn Current is flowing through the contact
Cont Op 1 VOn Voltage exists across the contact (present for contact outputs equipped with
monitoring)
Cont Op 1 VOff Voltage exists across the contact (present for contact outputs equipped with
monitoring)
Cont Op 2 to 64 Same set of operands as shown for Cont Op 1
INPUTS/OUTPUTS DIRECT INPUT 1 On Flag is set, logic=1
Direct inputs
DIRECT INPUT 32 On Flag is set, logic=1
INPUTS/OUTPUTS: RemDPS Ip 1 BAD Asserted while the remote double-point status input is in the bad state
Remote double- RemDPS Ip 1 INTERM Asserted while the remote double-point status input is in the intermediate
point status inputs state
RemDPS Ip 1 OFF Asserted while the remote double-point status input is off
RemDPS Ip 1 ON Asserted while the remote double-point status input is on
REMDPS Ip 2 to 5 Same set of operands as per REMDPS 1
5 LED INDICATORS:
LED test
LED TEST IN PROGRESS An LED test has been initiated and has not finished
PASSWORD ACCESS LOC SETG OFF Asserted when local setting access is disabled
SECURITY ACCESS LOC SETG ON Asserted when local setting access is enabled
ACCESS LOC CMND OFF Asserted when local command access is disabled
ACCESS LOC CMND ON Asserted when local command access is enabled
ACCESS REM SETG OFF Asserted when remote setting access is disabled
ACCESS REM SETG ON Asserted when remote setting access is enabled
ACCESS REM CMND OFF Asserted when remote command access is disabled
ACCESS REM CMND ON Asserted when remote command access is enabled
UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS Asserted when a password entry fails while accessing a password protected
level of the M60
REMOTE DEVICES REMOTE DEVICE 1 On Flag is set, logic=1
REMOTE DEVICE 2 On Flag is set, logic=1
REMOTE DEVICE 3 On Flag is set, logic=1
REMOTE DEVICE 16 On Flag is set, logic=1
REMOTE DEVICE 1 Off Flag is set, logic=1
REMOTE DEVICE 2 Off Flag is set, logic=1
REMOTE DEVICE 3 Off Flag is set, logic=1
REMOTE DEVICE 16 Off Flag is set, logic=1
RESETTING RESET OP Reset command is operated (set by all three operands below)
RESET OP (COMMS) Communications source of the reset command
RESET OP (OPERAND) Operand (assigned in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS RESETTING menu) source
of the reset command
RESET OP (PUSHBUTTON) Reset key (pushbutton) source of the reset command
Some operands can be re-named by the user. These are the names of the breakers in the breaker control feature, the ID
(identification) of contact inputs and outputs, the ID of virtual inputs, and the ID of virtual outputs. If the user changes the
default name or ID of any of these operands, the assigned name will appear in the relay list of operands. The default names
are shown in the FlexLogic™ operands table above.
The characteristics of the logic gates are tabulated below, and the operators available in FlexLogic™ are listed in the Flex-
Logic™ operators table.
5 LATCH (S,R) Latch (set, reset): reset-dominant The parameter preceding LATCH(S,R) is
the reset input. The parameter preceding
the reset input is the set input.
Timer TIMER 1 Timer set with FlexLogic™ timer 1 settings. The timer is started by the preceding
parameter. The output of the timer is
TIMER 32 Timer set with FlexLogic™ timer 32 settings. TIMER #.
Assign = Virt Op 1 Assigns previous FlexLogic™ operand to virtual The virtual output is set by the preceding
virtual output 1. parameter
output = Virt Op 96
Assigns previous FlexLogic™ operand to virtual
output 96.
When forming a FlexLogic™ equation, the sequence in the linear array of parameters must follow these general rules:
1. Operands must precede the operator which uses the operands as inputs.
2. Operators have only one output. The output of an operator must be used to create a virtual output if it is to be used as
an input to two or more operators.
3. Assigning the output of an operator to a virtual output terminates the equation.
4. A timer operator (for example, "TIMER 1") or virtual output assignment (for example, " = Virt Op 1") may only be used
once. If this rule is broken, a syntax error will be declared.
Each equation is evaluated in the order in which the parameters have been entered.
FlexLogic provides built-in latches that by definition have a memory action, remaining in the set state after the set
input has been asserted. These built-in latches are reset dominant, meaning that if logical "1" is applied to both set
127(
and reset entries simultaneously, then the output of the latch is logical "0." However, they are volatile, meaning that
they reset upon removal of control power.
When making changes to FlexLogic entries in the settings, all FlexLogic equations are re-compiled whenever any
new FlexLogic entry value is entered, and as a result of the re-compile all latches are reset automatically.
This section provides an example of implementing logic for a typical application. The sequence of the steps is quite import-
ant as it should minimize the work necessary to develop the relay settings. Note that the example presented in the figure
below is intended to demonstrate the procedure, not to solve a specific application situation.
In the example below, it is assumed that logic has already been programmed to produce virtual outputs 1 and 2, and is only
a part of the full set of equations used. When using FlexLogic™, it is important to make a note of each virtual output used –
a virtual output designation (1 to 96) can only be properly assigned once.
Virtual output 1
state = On
Virtual output 2
Set
state = On
Latch
Virtual input 1 OR #1 Reset
state = On
XOR
Digital element 1 Timer 2
state = Pickup Time Delay Operate output
OR #2
on dropout relay H1
Digital element 2 Timer 1
(200 ms)
state = Operated Time delay
AND on pickup
(800 ms)
Contact input H1c
state = Closed 827025A2.CDR
Virtual output 1
state = On
Virtual output 2
Set
state = On
Latch
OR #1 Reset
Virtual input 1
state = On Timer 2
XOR Time delay
Digital element 1 OR #2 Virtual output 4
on dropout
state = Pickup
(200 ms)
827026A2.CDR
5 Digital element 2
state= Operated
Virtual output 1
state = On
Virtual output 2
Set
state = On
Latch
OR #1 Reset
Virtual input 1
state = On Timer 2
XOR Time delay
OR #2 Virtual output 4
Digital element 1 on dropout
state = Pickup
(200 ms)
Timer 1
Virtual output 3 Time delay
state = On on pickup
(800 ms)
Contact input H1c
state = Closed
827028A2.CDR
output end of the equation and work back towards the input, as shown in the following steps. It is also recommended to
list operator inputs from bottom to top. For demonstration, the final output will be arbitrarily identified as parameter 99,
and each preceding parameter decremented by one in turn. Until accustomed to using FlexLogic™, it is suggested that
a worksheet with a series of cells marked with the arbitrary parameter numbers be prepared, as shown below.
01
02
03
04
05
.....
97
98
99
827029A1.VSD
FlexLogic entry:
95
Dig Element 2 (DE2) OP
AND Virtual output 3
FlexLogic entry:
96
Cont Ip 2 On (H1c)
FlexLogic entry:
97
NOT
FlexLogic entry:
98
AND (2)
FlexLogic entry:
99
= Virt Op 3 (VO3)
827030A2.CDR
6. Repeating the process described for virtual output 3, select the FlexLogic™ parameters for Virtual Output 4.
99: The final output of the equation is virtual output 4 which is parameter “= Virt Op 4".
98: The operator preceding the output is timer 2, which is operand “TIMER 2". Note that the settings required for the
timer are established in the timer programming section.
97: The operator preceding timer 2 is OR #2, a 3-input OR, which is parameter “OR(3)”.
96: The lowest input to OR #2 is operand “Cont Ip H1c On”.
95: The center input to OR #2 is operand “TIMER 1".
94: The input to timer 1 is operand “Virt Op 3 On".
93: The upper input to OR #2 is operand “LATCH (S,R)”.
92: There are two inputs to a latch, and the input immediately preceding the latch reset is OR #1, a 4-input OR, which
is parameter “OR(4)”.
91: The lowest input to OR #1 is operand “Virt Op 3 On".
90: The input just above the lowest input to OR #1 is operand “XOR(2)”.
89: The lower input to the XOR is operand “DIG ELEM 1 PKP”.
88: The upper input to the XOR is operand “Virt Ip 1 On".
87: The input just below the upper input to OR #1 is operand “Virt Op 2 On".
86: The upper input to OR #1 is operand “Virt Op 1 On".
85: The last parameter is used to set the latch, and is operand “Virt Op 4 On".
FlexLogic entry:
85 Virt Op 4 On (VO4)
FlexLogic entry:
86 Virt Op 1 On (VO1)
FlexLogic entry:
87 Virt Op 2 On (VO2)
FlexLogic entry: Set
88 Latch
Virt Ip 1 On (VI1)
XOR OR Reset
FlexLogic entry:
89 Dig Element 1 (DE1) PKP
FlexLogic entry:
90 XOR (2 Input)
FlexLogic entry:
91 Virt Op 3 On (VO3)
OR T2 Virtual output 4
FlexLogic entry:
92 OR (4 Input)
FlexLogic entry:
93 Latch (Set, Reset)
FlexLogic entry:
94 Virt Op 3 On (VO3) T1
FlexLogic entry:
95 Timer 1
FlexLogic entry:
96 Cont Ip 2 On (H1c)
FlexLogic entry:
97 OR (3 Input)
FlexLogic entry:
98 Timer 2
FlexLogic entry:
99 =Virt Op 4 (VO4) 827031A2.CDR
8. The logic should always be tested after it is loaded into the relay, in the same fashion as has been used in the past.
Testing can be simplified by placing an "END" operator within the overall set of FlexLogic™ equations. The equations
will then only be evaluated up to the first "END" operator.
The "On" and "Off" operands can be placed in an equation to establish a known set of conditions for test purposes, and
the "INSERT" and "DELETE" commands can be used to modify equations.
There are 512 FlexLogic™ entries available, numbered from 1 to 512, with default END entry settings. If a "Disabled" Ele-
ment is selected as a FlexLogic™ entry, the associated state flag will never be set to ‘1’. The ‘+/–‘ key may be used when
editing FlexLogic™ equations from the keypad to quickly scan through the major parameter types.
There are 32 identical FlexLogic™ timers available. These timers can be used as operators for FlexLogic™ equations.
• TIMER 1 TYPE: This setting is used to select the time measuring unit.
• TIMER 1 PICKUP DELAY: Sets the time delay to pickup. If a pickup delay is not required, set this function to "0".
• TIMER 1 DROPOUT DELAY: Sets the time delay to dropout. If a dropout delay is not required, set this function to "0".
5.5.7 FLEXELEMENTS™
A FlexElement™ is a universal comparator that can be used to monitor any analog actual value calculated by the relay or a
net difference of any two analog actual values of the same type. The effective operating signal could be treated as a signed
number or its absolute value could be used as per user's choice.
FlexElements run every half power cycle (every four protection passes).
The element can be programmed to respond either to a signal level or to a rate-of-change (delta) over a pre-defined period
of time. The output operand is asserted when the operating signal is higher than a threshold or lower than a threshold as
per user's choice.
SETTING
SETTINGS
FLEXELEMENT 1
FUNCTION: FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT
MODE:
Enabled = 1
FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP
MODE:
Disabled = 0
FLEXELEMENT 1
DIRECTION:
SETTING
FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP:
FLEXELEMENT 1 BLK:
FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT
AND HYSTERESIS:
Off = 0
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt UNIT: SETTINGS
FxE 1 PKP
ACTUAL VALUE
The FLEXELEMENT 1 DIRECTION setting enables the relay to respond to either high or low values of the operating signal. The
following figure explains the application of the FLEXELEMENT 1 DIRECTION, FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP and FLEXELEMENT 1 HYS-
TERESIS settings.
)/(;(/(0(173.3
)/(;(/(0(17
',5(&7,21 2YHU
+<67(5(6,6 RI3,&.83
3,&.83
)OH[(OHPHQW 6LJ2S
)/(;(/(0(173.3
)/(;(/(0(17
',5(&7,21 2YHU
+<67(5(6,6 RI3,&.83
)OH[(OHPHQW 6LJ2S
3,&.83
$&'5
)/(;(/(0(173.3
)/(;(/(0(17
',5(&7,21 2YHU
5
)/(;(/(0(17,1387
02'( 6LJQHG
)OH[(OHPHQW2S6LJ
)/(;(/(0(173.3
)/(;(/(0(17
',5(&7,21 2YHU
)/(;(/(0(17,1387
02'( $EVROXWH
)OH[(OHPHQW2S6LJ
)/(;(/(0(173.3
)/(;(/(0(17
',5(&7,21 8QGHU
)/(;(/(0(17,1387
02'( 6LJQHG
)OH[(OHPHQW2S6LJ
)/(;(/(0(173.3
)/(;(/(0(17
',5(&7,21 8QGHU
)/(;(/(0(17,1387
02'( $EVROXWH
)OH[(OHPHQW2S6LJ
$&'5
The FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP setting specifies the operating threshold for the effective operating signal of the element. If set
to “Over”, the element picks up when the operating signal exceeds the FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP value. If set to “Under”, the
element picks up when the operating signal falls below the FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP value.
The FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS setting controls the element dropout. It should be noticed that both the operating signal
and the pickup threshold can be negative facilitating applications such as reverse power alarm protection. The FlexEle-
ment™ can be programmed to work with all analog actual values measured by the relay. The FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP set-
ting is entered in per-unit values using the following definitions of the base units:
5 SOURCE POWER
SOURCE VOLTAGE
PBASE = maximum value of VBASE IBASE for the +IN and –IN inputs
VBASE = maximum nominal primary RMS value of the +IN and –IN inputs
STATOR DIFFERENTIAL IBASE = maximum primary RMS value of the +IN and –IN inputs
CURRENT (CT primary for source currents, and bus reference primary current for bus differential currents)
(Stator Diff Iar, Ibr, and Icr)
STATOR RESTRAINING IBASE = maximum primary RMS value of the +IN and –IN inputs
CURRENT (CT primary for source currents, and bus reference primary current for bus differential currents)
(Stator Diff Iad, Ibd, and Icd)
THERMAL MODEL BASE =100%
(Model Capacity Used)
(Model Motor Unbalance)
THERMAL MODEL BASE = 10 minutes
(Model Lockout Time)
THERMAL MODEL BASE = 1.00 pu of FLA
(Thermal Model Load)
(Biased Motor Load)
THERMAL MODEL BASE = 10 seconds
(Trip Time on Overload)
The FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS setting defines the pickup–dropout relation of the element by specifying the width of the
hysteresis loop as a percentage of the pickup value as shown in the FlexElement™ Direction, Pickup, and Hysteresis dia-
gram.
The FLEXELEMENT 1 DT UNIT setting specifies the time unit for the setting FLEXELEMENT 1 dt. This setting is applicable only if
FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE is set to “Delta”. The FLEXELEMENT 1 DT setting specifies duration of the time interval for the
rate of change mode of operation. This setting is applicable only if FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE is set to “Delta”.
This FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP DELAY setting specifies the pickup delay of the element. The FLEXELEMENT 1 RST DELAY setting
specifies the reset delay of the element.
The non-volatile latches provide a permanent logical flag that is stored safely and will not reset upon reboot after the relay
is powered down. Typical applications include sustaining operator commands or permanently block relay functions, such as
Autorecloser, until a deliberate interface action resets the latch. The settings element operation is described below:
• LATCH 1 TYPE: This setting characterizes Latch 1 to be Set- or Reset-dominant.
• LATCH 1 SET: If asserted, the specified FlexLogic™ operands 'sets' Latch 1.
• LATCH 1 RESET: If asserted, the specified FlexLogic™ operand 'resets' Latch 1. 5
SETTING SETTING
LATCH N LATCH N LATCH N LATCH N LATCH N
TYPE SET RESET ON OFF LATCH 1 FUNCTION: LATCH 1 TYPE:
Each protection element can be assigned up to six different sets of settings according to setting group designations 1 to 6.
The performance of these elements is defined by the active setting group at a given time. Multiple setting groups allow the
user to conveniently change protection settings for different operating situations (for example, altered power system config-
uration, season of the year, etc.). The active setting group can be preset or selected via the SETTING GROUPS menu (see the
Control Elements section later in this chapter). See also the Introduction to Elements section at the beginning of this chap-
ter.
Each of the six setting group menus is identical. Setting group 1 (the default active group) automatically becomes active if
no other group is active (see the Control Elements section for additional details).
5.6.3 MOTOR
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) MOTOR
MOTOR ACCELERATION
See page 5-115.
TIME
THERMAL MODEL
MESSAGE See page 5-118.
AMP UNBALANCE 1
MESSAGE See page 5-138.
AMP UNBALANCE 2
MESSAGE See page 5-138.
UNDERCURRENT
MESSAGE See page 5-141.
MECHANICAL JAM
MESSAGE See page 5-139.
TWO-SPEED MOTOR
MESSAGE See page 5-142.
b) ACCELERATION TIME
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) MOTOR ACCELERATION TIME
5
ACCELERATION TIME ACCELERATION Range: Disabled, Enabled
FUNCTION: Disabled
ACCELERATION Range: 1.00 to 10.00 x FLC in steps of 0.01
MESSAGE
CURRENT: 6.00 x FLC
ACCELERATION TIME: Range: 0.50 to 180.00 s in steps of 0.01
MESSAGE
10.00 s
ACCELERATION MODE: Range: Definite Time, Adaptive
MESSAGE
Definite Time
ACCELERATION BLOCK: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
ACCLERATION TARGET: Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
MESSAGE
Self-reset
ACCLERATION EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
Disabled
Many motors have quite a time margin between acceleration-time and the stall limit. It is advantageous to detect stalling
during a start as early as possible to minimize re-starting delays once the cause of the stall is remedied, e.g. neglecting to
release a fan brake.
The acceleration time element compares actual starting time with a pre-determined time setting and operates when it is
exceeded. This element has the functionality to adapt the tripping time for starts with lower starting current, and it stores
acceleration time and current of the last five starts. The element uses currents configured under SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR
MOTOR LINE SOURCE and motor status asserted by the thermal model element. Both the signal source and thermal pro-
tection must be configured properly in order for the acceleration time protection to operate.
The figure below shows examples of constant and variable acceleration currents and explains measurement of the acceler-
ation time and current. Part A represents a constant current start and part B represents a variable current start.
The element stores the basic statistics for the last five successful starts. The following values are retained, available for dis-
play, and accessible via communications: date and time of starting, acceleration time (in seconds), effective acceleration
current (in multiplies of FLC), and peak acceleration current (in multiplies of FLC). Recorded effective acceleration current
and time could be used for fine-tuning of the relay settings.
L
$&&(/&855(17
L
L
L
L
FXUUHQW
FXUUHQW
L L LQ
$&&(/ &855(17
Q
L
)/$[6(59,&()$&725 )/$[6(59,&()$&725
D E
6(77,1*6
$&&(/(5$7,21
)81&7,21
(QDEOHG
$&&(/(5$7,21%/2&.
2II $1'
027252))/,1(
2Q
6(77,1* 6(77,1*6
$&&&(/(5$7,2102'( $&&(/(5$7,217,0(
'HILQLWH7LPH $&&(/(5$7,21
&855(17
$GDSWLYH 'HILQLWH7LPH
581
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
0272567$57,1*
027255811,1*
$&'5
c) THERMAL MODEL
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) MOTOR THERMAL MODEL
The thermal model is the primary protective function of the relay. It consists of five key functions:
• Thermal model curve (overload).
• Overload pickup level.
• Unbalance biasing of the motor current while the motor is running.
• Motor cooling time constants.
• Biasing of the thermal model based on hot/cold information and/or measured stator temperature.
The algorithm integrates both stator and rotor heating into a single model. The motor heating level is maintained in the ther-
mal capacity used register. If the motor has been stopped for a long time, it will be at ambient temperature and thermal
capacity used will be zero. If the motor is in overload, the output operand is set once the thermal capacity used reaches 5
100%.
Once the motor load current exceeds the overload level (FLA x overload factor), it enters an overload phase; that is, the
heat accumulation becomes greater than the heat dissipation. The M60 thermal model reacts by incrementing the thermal
capacity used (TCU) at a rate dependent on the selected thermal curve and overload level. When the thermal capacity
reaches 100%, the MOTOR THERMAL OP operand (typically configured to trip the motor) is set. This operand remains
asserted until TCU decays to the level that permits a new motor start. For additional details, see the description of the
START INHIBIT TCU MARGIN setting in this section.
• THERMAL MODEL CURVE: The thermal model curve determines the thermal limit overload conditions that can dam-
age the motor. This curve accounts for motor heating in both the stator and rotor during stall, acceleration, and running
conditions. The overload curve can take one of six formats: Motor, FlexCurve™ A, FlexCurve™ B, FlexCurve™ C,
FlexCurve™ D, or IEC. The selected curve can also serve as a base for a voltage dependent overload curve if the
VOLTAGE DEPENDENT FUNCTION setting is “Enabled”. The algorithm uses memory in the form of a register called Ther-
mal Capacity Used. This register is updated every power cycle using the following equation:
1 f (in ms)
TC used t = TC used (t – 1) + ------------------------------- 100% (EQ 5.7)
time_to_trip
where time_to_trip represents the time coordinate on the time-current overload curve, corresponding to the equivalent
motor current detected within any power cycle period of motor overload. Always set the overload curve slightly lower
than the thermal limits provided by the motor manufacturer. This ensures that the motor is tripped before the thermal
limit is reached.
The “Motor” curve is based on typical motor thermal limit curves and is normally used for standard motor applications
(see the Standard Motor Curves figure and Standard Curve Multipliers table below). The pickup level for the “Motor”
curve is calculated as MOTOR OVERLOAD FACTOR setting (OF) times the MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS setting (FLA). The
MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS (FLA) setting can be found in the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR menu.
5
5.50 2.99 5.98 8.97 11.96 14.95 17.94 20.93 23.91 26.90 29.89 32.88 35.87 38.86 41.85 44.84
6.00 2.50 5.00 7.49 9.99 12.49 14.99 17.49 19.99 22.48 24.98 27.48 29.98 32.48 34.97 37.47
6.50 2.12 4.24 6.36 8.48 10.60 12.72 14.84 16.96 19.08 21.20 23.32 25.44 27.55 29.67 31.79
7.00 1.82 3.64 5.46 7.29 9.11 10.93 12.75 14.57 16.39 18.21 20.04 21.86 23.68 25.50 27.32
7.50 1.58 3.16 4.75 6.33 7.91 9.49 11.08 12.66 14.24 15.82 17.41 18.99 20.57 22.15 23.74
8.00 1.39 2.78 4.16 5.55 6.94 8.33 9.71 11.10 12.49 13.88 15.27 16.65 18.04 19.43 20.82
10.00 1.39 2.78 4.16 5.55 6.94 8.33 9.71 11.10 12.49 13.88 15.27 16.65 18.04 19.43 20.82
15.00 1.39 2.78 4.16 5.55 6.94 8.33 9.71 11.10 12.49 13.88 15.27 16.65 18.04 19.43 20.82
20.00 1.39 2.78 4.16 5.55 6.94 8.33 9.71 11.10 12.49 13.88 15.27 16.65 18.04 19.43 20.82
If “IEC” is selected as the thermal model curve, the M60 can apply the IEC 255-8 hot and cold curve characteristics to
the thermal model. The M60 will evaluate the thermal capacity at motor start and choose the appropriate curve. The
hot curve characteristic is applied when the thermal capacity is greater than or equal to 5% (that is, a point above
where the motor is not at complete rest, or cold). Otherwise, the cold curve characteristic is applied.
The IEC255-8 cold curve trip time is defined as follows:
2
I
t = ln ------------------------------
2
-
2
(EQ 5.8)
I – k Ib
where:
– t = time to trip.
– τ = IEC time constant defined by IEC CURVE TIME CONSTANT setting.
– I = measured motor load current.
– Ip = Motor load current before overload occurs.
– k = k-factor (overload factor) defined by IEC CURVE K FACTOR setting applied to Ib.
– Ib = Motor rated current specified by the MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS setting.
• THERMAL MODEL CURVE EFFECT: This setting affects the time-to-trip thermal curves when the THERMAL MODEL
CURVE is selected as “Motor”. This setting takes into account the design of the machine with respect to overload capa-
bility as determined by the overload (service) factor. For motor designs where temperature rise above ambient is
based on full load current, this setting should be selected as “Cutoff”. The time to trip is then calculated using the fol-
lowing equation:
TD 2.2116623
trip time = ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2
(EQ 5.10)
I I motor
0.02530337 -------------- motor
– 1 + 0.05054758 -------------- – 1
FLA FLA
In the above equation, the motor stator current (Imotor) and motor rated current (FLA) are expressed in per units of
relay current.
For specialized motor designs where temperature rise above ambient is based on the product of the service factor and
full load current (OF × FLA), this setting should be selected as “Shifted”. The time to trip is then calculated using the
following equation:
TD 2.2116623
trip time = ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2
- (EQ 5.11)
I I motor
0.02530337 ------------------------- – 1 + 0.05054758 ------------------------- – 1
motor
OF FLA OF FLA
In the above equation, the motor stator current (Imotor) and motor rated current (FLA) are expressed in per units of
relay current.
In case of uncertainty, the more conservative “Cutoff” value should be used.
The following figure illustrates the impact of this setting on the time to trip thermal curves.
5
10000
1000
Trip time (seconds)
100
1
0 5 8
Stator current (multiples of FLA)
• IEC CURVE TIME CONSTANT: This setting specifies thermal time constant for IEC motor curves in the above equa-
tions per the IEC 255-8 standard. When the IEC motor curves are selected, the M60 calculates the time to trip using
the IEC255-8 cold curve and IEC255-8 hot curve equations and increases thermal capacity used as defined by the
thermal capacity used equation above. If the overload disappears or the motor is tripped (stopped), then the thermal
capacity used decreases as per the following equations to simulate motor cooling, depending on the motor status and
the values programmed for the COOL TIME CONSTANT RUNNING and COOL TIME CONSTANT STOPPED settings.
If the IEC curve is selected, then the following applies:
1. For two-speed motor applications, the IEC CURVE K FACTOR and IEC CURVE TIME CONSTANT settings are used at
both speeds.
2. Voltage dependent overload curves are not applicable.
3. The motor status is evaluated using motor FLA (Ib) and the IEC CURVE K FACTOR setting.
• THERMAL MODEL TD MULTIPLIER: This multiplier is used to shift the overload curve on the time axis to create a
family of the different curves. The TD multiplier value is used to select the curve that best matches the thermal charac-
teristics of the protected motor.
If thermal model curve is selected as “Motor”, then the THERMAL MODEL TD MULTIPLIER can be specified
between “1.00” and “15.00” as indicated in the Standard Motor Curves diagram below.
127(
OF x FLA 8 x OF x FLA
100000
10000
1000
Time To Trip in Seconds
100
5
x15
10
x1
1.00
0.10 1.00 10 100
833003A2.CDR
In some applications, the shape of the motor thermal damage curve substantially deviates from the standard. Further-
more, the characteristics of the starting (locked rotor and acceleration) and running thermal damage curves may not
correspond smoothly. In these cases, it may be necessary to use a custom curve so the motor can be started success-
fully and used to its full potential without compromising protection. For these conditions, it is recommended that the
FlexCurves™ be used. FlexCurves™ allows the user to program selected trip times for pre-determined current levels.
As seen below, if the running (2) and the locked rotor thermal limit curves were smoothed into one standard overload
curve, the motor could not start at 80% line voltage. A custom curve (1) is required.
For high inertia load applications (when the VOLTAGE DEPENDENT FUNCTION is enabled), the locked rotor thermal limit
section of the programmed motor or the FlexCurve™ overload curve is modified and becomes dynamically adaptive to
system voltage changes. The detailed explanation of this function is covered later in this section.
Typical FlexCurve™
6500 hp, 13800 volt induced draft fan motor
Full load current = 280 amps; CT ratio = 500/5
10000
1000
5 Motor current at 80% voltage
2
100
5
Time to trip (in seconds)
3
10
4
5
1.0
0.1
pu 0.56 5.6 56
Amp 280 2800 28000
FLA 1 10 100
833004A2.CDR
• UNBALANCE BIAS K FACTOR: Unbalanced phase currents will cause rotor heating that is not shown in the motor
thermal damage curve. When the motor is running, the rotor will rotate in the direction of the positive sequence current
at near synchronous speed. Negative sequence current, which has a phase rotation that is opposite to the positive
sequence current, and hence opposite to the direction of rotor rotation, will generate a rotor voltage that will produce a
substantial current in the rotor. This current will have a frequency that is approximately twice the line frequency: 100 Hz
for a 50 Hz system or 120 Hz for a 60 Hz system. Skin effect in the rotor bars at this frequency will cause a significant
increase in rotor resistance and therefore, a significant increase in rotor heating. This extra heating is not accounted for
in the thermal limit curves supplied by the motor manufacturer as these curves assume positive sequence currents
from a perfectly balanced supply voltage and motor design.
The thermal model may be biased to reflect the additional heating that is caused by negative sequence current when
the motor is running. This biasing is done by creating an equivalent motor heating current rather than simply using
average three phase RMS. This equivalent current is calculated using the equation shown below.
The motor derating as a function of voltage unbalance as recommended by NEMA (National Electrical Manufacturers
Association) is shown below. Assuming a typical induction motor with an inrush of 6 FLA and a negative sequence
impedance of 0.167, voltage unbalances of 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5% equals current unbalances of 6, 12, 18, 24, and 30%
respectively. Based on this assumption, the amount of motor derating for different values of k entered for setting
UNBALANCE BIAS K FACTOR is also shown below. Note that the curve created when k = 8 is almost identical to the
NEMA derating curve.
1.05 1.05
1.00 1.00
DERATING FACTOR
DERATING FACTOR
0.95 0.95
k=2
0.90 0.90
k=8
0.75 0.75
k=10
0.70 0.70
0 1 2 3 4 5 0 1 2 3 4 5
NEMA GE Multilin
808728A2.CDR
• COOL TIME CONSTANT RUNNING / STOPPED: The thermal capacity used value is reduced in an exponential man-
ner when the motor current is below the full load amps service factor settings to simulate motor cooling. The motor
cooling time constants should be entered for both the stopped and running cases. A stopped motor will normally cool
significantly slower than a running motor.
Motor cooling is calculated as follows:
–t
TCU = TCU start – TCU end e + TCU end (EQ 5.14)
I eq hot
TCU end = ------------------------------------------- 1 – ----------- 100% (EQ 5.15)
overload_pickup cold
where:
– TCU = thermal capacity used.
– TCUstart = TCU value caused by overload condition.
– TCUend= TCU value dictated by the hot/cold curve ratio when the motor is running. This value is 0 when the motor
is stopped).
– t = time in minutes.
– = cool time constant (running or stopped per current motor status and corresponding COOL TIME CONSTANT RUN-
NING and COOL TIME CONSTANT STOPPED settings).
– Ieq = equivalent motor heating current
– overload_pickup = overload pickup setpoint as a multiple of FLA
– hot / cold = hot/cold curve ratio
100 100
75 75
25 25
0 0
0 30 60 90 120 150 180 0 30 60 90 120 150 180
Time in Minutes Time in Minutes
100 100
75 75
Thermal Capacity Used
25 25
0 0
0 30 60 90 120 150 180 0 30 60 90 120 150 180
Time in Minutes Time in Minutes
hot
TCU end = I eq 1 – ----------- 100% (EQ 5.16)
cold
127(
• RTD BIAS MINIMUM / CENTER / MAXIMUM: The relay thermal replica operates as a complete and independent
model. The thermal overload curves however, are based solely on measured current, assuming a normal 40°C ambi-
ent and normal motor cooling. If there is an unusually high ambient temperature, or if motor cooling is blocked, motor
temperature will increase. If the motor stator has embedded RTDs, the RTD bias feature should be used to augment
the thermal model calculation of Thermal Capacity Used.
The RTD bias feature is a two-part curve (RTD Bias Thermal Capacity Used) constructed from three points: minimum,
center and maximum. If the maximum stator RTD temperature is below the RTD BIAS MINIMUM setting (typically 40°C),
no biasing occurs. If the maximum stator RTD temperature is above the RTD BIAS MAXIMUM setting (typically at the sta-
tor insulation rating or slightly higher), then the thermal memory is fully biased and RTD bias thermal capacity used is
forced to 100%. At values in between, the present RTD bias thermal capacity used created by other features of the
thermal model is compared to the RTD bias thermal capacity used. If the value of the RTD bias thermal capacity used
is higher, then this value is used from that point onward. The RTD BIAS CENTER setting should be selected to the rated
running temperature of the motor. The relay will automatically determine the RTD bias thermal capacity used value for
the center point using the HOT/COLD SAFE STALL RATIO setting.
hot
TCU at RTD_Bias_Center = 1 – ----------- 100% (EQ 5.17)
cold 5
At < RTD_Bias_Center temperature,
Temp actual – Temp min
RTD_Bias_TCU = -------------------------------------------------------- TCU at RTD_Bias_Center (EQ 5.18)
Temp center – Temp min
Hot/Cold = 0.85
60
40
20
RTD Bias Center Point
RTD Bias Minimum
0
–50 0 50 100 150 200 250
Maximum Stator RTD Temperature
808721A1.CDR
5 where TCUstart is the thermal capacity level when the MOTOR START INHIBIT operand is asserted, TCUend is the ther-
mal capacity level when MOTOR START INHIBIT operand is reset, and is the COOL TIME CONSTANT STOPPED setpoint.
To calculate the thermal lockout time for the case when MOTOR START INHIBIT MARGIN is set to “0”, the following TCU
values are to be applied to the above equation: TCUstart = 100% and TCUend = 15%.
If the motor is tripped or stopped by a means other than thermal protection (TCU < 100%), the MOTOR START
INHIBIT operand is not asserted and a new start is permitted. There is a potential risk in this situation to trip out
127( the motor by thermal protection during the new start.
If MOTOR START INHIBIT MARGIN is greater than “0”, the MOTOR START INHIBIT operand will be asserted either when
motor is tripped by thermal protection (TCU = 100%) or tripped/stopped by any other reason (TCU < 100%).
Each time motor is tripped/stopped by a means other than thermal protection (TCU < 100%) the available thermal
capacity (100% – TCU) is evaluated and compared to the TC required for starting the motor. If the available thermal
capacity is not sufficient to perform new motor start, then the MOTOR START INHIBIT operand will be asserted. The ther-
mal capacity required for starting the motor (TCUonStart) is defined from the following equation:
where TCUmargin is the relay setpoint, and TCmaxStart is the maximum thermal capacity value from the last five suc-
cessful motor starts. The relay monitors motor starting and captures the TCU for each successful start. The largest
value from the last five starts is used in the start inhibit calculation.
In this case, the MOTOR START INHIBIT operand resets when TCU decays to the level satisfying the following equation:
If MOTOR START INHIBIT MARGIN is greater than “0”, but relay does not contain records for five successful starts, then the
MOTOR START INHIBIT operand can be asserted again either when motor is tripped by thermal protection
(TCU = 100%) or tripped/stopped by any other reason (TCaccumulated < 100%). However, operand reset is evaluated
based on 15% level of thermal capacity. To calculate the thermal lockout time in this case, the following values of TCU
are to be applied to the above equation: TCUstart = thermal capacity accumulated from the moment the motor was
stopped, and TCUend = 15%.
• VOLTAGE DEPENDENT FUNCTION: If the motor is called upon to drive a high inertia load, it is quite possible and
acceptable for the acceleration time to exceed the safe stall time (keeping in mind that a locked rotor condition is differ-
ent than an acceleration condition). The voltage dependent overload curve feature is tailored to protect these types of
motors. This curve is composed of the three characteristic of thermal limit curve shapes as determined by the stall or
locked rotor condition, acceleration, and running overload. The figure below presents the typical thermal limit curve for
high inertia application.
g GE Multilin
HIGH INERTIA LOAD OVERLOAD CURVES
8800 HP, 13.2 kV, REACTOR COOLANT PUMP
1000
900
800
700
1- Running Overload Thermal Limit
600 1
2- Acceleration Thermal Limit at 80%V
500 3- Acceleration Thermal Limit at 100%V
4- Locked Rotor Thermal Limit
400 5- Motor Acceleration Curve at 80% V
6- Motor Acceleration Curve at 100%V
300
2
200
3
5
100
90
80
TIME TO TRIP (SECONDS)
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
9
8
7
4
6
5
4
5
3
6
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
MULTIPLES OF FULL LOAD AMPS 806821A4.CDR
Voltage dependent overload functionality is operational only if the selected MOTOR LINE SOURCE (see the SYS-
TEM MOTOR SETUP menu) is assigned to a valid three-phase VT.
127(
In this instance, each distinct portion of the thermal limit curve must be known and protection coordinated against that
curve. The relay protecting the motor must be able to distinguish between a locked rotor condition (curve 4) and an
accelerating condition for different levels of the system voltage (curves 2 and 3). Voltage is continually monitored
during motor starting and the acceleration thermal limit portion of the relay overload curve is dynamically adjusted
based on motor voltage variations.
The acceleration thermal limit is a function of motor speed during the start. The dynamically shifted voltage dependent
overload curve inherently accounts for the change in motor speed as a function of motor impedance. The change in
impedance is reflected by motor terminal voltage and line current. This method aids to set dynamically the appropriate
value of the thermal limit time for any given line current at any given terminal voltage.
The VOLTAGE DEPENDENT FUNCTION setpoint enables the voltage dependent feature and modifies the locked rotor por-
tion of the programmed relay overload curve with respect to the acceleration thermal limits. These thermal limits are
typically available from the machine specifications provided by motor manufacturer.
• VOLTAGE DEPENDENT MIN MOTOR VOLTS: This setting defines the minimum allowable line voltage applied to the
motor during the acceleration if VOLTAGE DEPENDENT FUNCTION is enabled. This voltage is expressed as a percentage
of the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR NAMEPLATE VOLTAGE setting. If the measured line voltage drops below
this setting during acceleration, the thermal curve is switched to one based on the programmed minimum voltage ther-
mal limit:
2
I1 t1
trip_time = --------------
2
- (EQ 5.24)
I
• VD VOLTAGE LOSS. This setting is used to address situations when the voltage input into thermal model has been
lost. In this case, the voltage dependent algorithm readjusts the voltage dependent curve to avoid an inadequate ther-
mal protection response. The VT fuse failure function is typically used to detect a voltage loss condition. If a voltage
5 loss has been detected while motor accelerates, the thermal curve is switched to one based on the programmed 100%
voltage thermal limit:
2
I3 t3
trip_time = --------------
2
- (EQ 5.25)
I
• VD STALL CURRENT @ MIN V: This setting defines the locked rotor current level at minimum motor voltage (I1).
• VD SAFE STALL TIME @ MIN V: This setting defines the maximum time that motor is allowed to withstand the locked
rotor current at minimum motor voltage (t1).
• VD ACCEL. INTERESECT @ MIN V: This setting defines the starting current level corresponding to the crossing point
between the acceleration thermal limit at minimum voltage and the programmed relay overload curve (I2). This value
can be typically determined from motor acceleration curves. The value at the breakdown torque for the minimum volt-
age start is recommended for this setting.
(##'!$1!34B
• VD STALL CURRENT @ 100% V: This setting defines the locked rotor current level at the rated motor voltage (I3).
• VD SAFE STALL TIME @ 100% V: This setting defines the maximum time the motor is allowed to withstand the
locked rotor current at rated motor voltage (t3).
• VD ACCEL. INTERESECT @ 100% V: This setting defines the starting current level corresponding to the crossing
point between the acceleration thermal limit at rated voltage and the programmed relay overload curve (I4). This value
can be typically determined from the motor acceleration curves. The current value at the breakdown torque for the
100% voltage start is recommended for this setting.
The voltage dependent overload curves are shown below.
7+(50$/02'(/&859(
$&&(/(5$7,21,17(56(&7#PLQ9
$&&(/(5$7,21,17(56(&7#9
$&&(/(5$7,21,17(56(&7#9
$
5
/2&.('527257+(50$//,0,7&859(
&
7,0( 72 75,3 6(&21'6
%
7+(50$//,0,7&859(6
)25$%1250$/&21',7,216
/(667+$19PLQ$
025(7+$19%
/2662)92/7$*(&
6$)(67$//32,17#PLQ9
6$)(67$//32,17#9
6$)(67$//32,17#9
3(581,7&855(17
$&'5
The following procedure, along with the figure above, illustrate the construction of the voltage overload curves.
1. Draw a curve for the running overload thermal limit. The curve is one that has been selected in the relay as a
THERMAL MODEL CURVE.
2. Determine the point of intersection between the THERMAL MODEL CURVE and the vertical line corresponding to the
per-unit current value of VD ACCEL. INTERESECT @ MIN V (see point 2).
3. Determine the locked rotor thermal limit point for the minimum voltage motor start. The coordinates of this point
are the per-unit current value of VD STALL CURRENT @ MIN VOLTS and the time value of VD SAFE STALL TIME @ MIN V
(see point 1).
4. The line connecting points 1 and 2 constructs the acceleration curve for the system voltage level defined by the
VOLTAGE DEPENDENT MIN MOTOR VOLTS setting. The acceleration time-current curve for the minimum voltage start-
ing is calculated from the following equation:
–I
trip_time = A FACTOR e
I1 – I2 I1
(EQ 5.26)
where = ----------------------- and A FACTOR = t 1 e
ln t 2 t 1
I is a variable multiplier of the motor rated current (values between I1 and I2),
I1 is a multiplier of the rated motor current (FLA) specified by the VD STALL CURRENT @ MIN V setting,
t1 is a time value specified by the VD SAFE STALL TIME @ MIN V setting,
I2 is a multiplier of the rated motor current (FLA) specified by the VD ACCEL. INTERESECT @ MIN V setting, and
t2 is a time coordinate of the intersection point between the thermal model curve and the vertical line correspond-
ing to the per-unit current value of the VD ACCEL. INTERESECT @ MIN V setting.
5. Determine the point of intersection between the thermal model curve and the vertical line corresponding to the
5 multiplier of the rated current value of the VD ACCEL. INTERESECT @ 100% V setting (see point 4).
6. Draw the locked rotor thermal limit point for the 100% voltage motor start. The coordinates of this point are the
multiplier of the rated current value (FLA) of the VD STALL CURRENT @ 100% V setting and the time value of the VD
SAFE STALL TIME @ 100% V setting (see point 3).
7. The line connecting points 3 and 4 constructs the acceleration curve for the motor rated system voltage. The
acceleration time-current curve for the rated voltage starting is calculated from the same equations, but the set-
points associated with the 100% voltage starting will be applied.
8. The line connecting points 1, 3 and 5 represent the motor safe stall conditions for any system voltage from the
minimum to 110% of rated. Ideally, all the points on this line are characterized by the same thermal limit (I2t), but
the equivalent starting impedance at reduced voltage is greater than the impedance at full voltage. As such, the
higher terminal voltages tend to reduce I2t. The rate of I2t reduction is dictated by the VD STALL CURRENT and VD
SAFE STALL TIME setpoints for rated and minimum voltage conditions. For voltage conditions above rated, the
locked rotor thermal limit and acceleration curve are extrapolated up to 110% of the terminal voltage. The point
coordinates (Is, Ts) for 110% are extrapolated based on the I1, T1, I3, and T3 values. For starting currents at volt-
ages higher than 110%, the trip time computed from 110% V thermal limit value will be used.
The voltage dependent curve for current values above 1.1 x VD STALL CURRENT @ 100% V will be clamped
and the time to trip will be frozen at the level calculated for the eight times pickup current.
127(
The following three figures illustrate the resultant overload protection curve for minimum, 100%, and maximum line
voltages. For voltages between these limits, the M60 will shift the acceleration curve linearly and constantly, based on
the measured line voltage during a motor start.
10000.00
1000.00
10.00
1.00
0 1 2 3 4
Per unit current
5 6 7 8
833716A2.CDR
5
Figure 5–57: VOLTAGE DEPENDENT OVERLOAD CURVE PROTECTION AT MINIMUM VOLTAGE
10000.00
1000.00
Time to trip (seconds)
100.00
10.00
1.00
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Per unit current
833717A2.CDR
10000.00
1000.00
100.00
10.00
1.00
5
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Per unit current
833718A2.CDR
1000.00
Time to trip (seconds)
100.00
10.00
1.00
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Per unit current
833719A2.CDR
Figure 5–60: VOLTAGE DEPENDENT OVERLOAD CURVE PROTECTION AT LESS THAN MINIMUM VOLTAGE
10000.00
1000.00
10.00
1.00
0 1 2 3 4
Per unit current
5 6 7 8
5
833720A2.CDR
Figure 5–61: VOLTAGE DEPENDENT OVERLOAD CURVE PROTECTION AT VOLTAGE LOSS CONDITION
10000.00
1000.00
Time to trip (seconds)
100.00
10.00
1.00
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Per unit current
833721A2.CDR
Figure 5–62: VOLTAGE DEPENDENT OVERLOAD CURVE PROTECTION AT MORE THAN 110% VOLTAGE
For the three abnormal voltage situations, the M60 makes a transition from the acceleration curve to Motor or Flex-
Curve when the MOTOR RUNNING or MOTOR OVERLOADED operands are asserted.
127(
6(77,1*
9ROWDJH'HSHQGHQW)XQFWLRQ
'LVDEOHG
$1' 0RWRUFXUYH
(QDEOHG
5% u
U *
6(77,1* u *
u *
&XUYH
0RWRU
$1' )OH[&XUYH
)OH[&XUYH
6(77,1*
9ROWDJH'HSHQGHQW9ROWDJH $1'
/RVV
2II
$1'
IURPWKH6\VWHP6HWXS!0RWRUPHQX
6(77,1*6
0RWRU/LQH6RXUFH
65& 9ROWDJHGHSHQGHQW
$1'
0RWRU1DPHSODWH9ROWDJH PRWRUFXUYH
9UDWHG
IURPWKH6\VWHP6HWXS
!$&,QSXWV!9ROWDJHPHQX
73.4 u 7SBUJP
6(77,1*6 7
7SBUFE
3KDVH975DWLR 9ROWDJHGHSHQGHQW
$1'
$X[LOLDU\975DWLR )OH[&XUYH
9UDWLR 7NJO 7 7
7 ! 7 YROWDJH
$1'
ORFNHGURWRUFXUYH
5 6(77,1*
9ROWDJH'HSHQGHQW0LQ
0RWRU9ROWV 77NJO
U *
* u U
*
9PLQ
0LQLPXPYROWDJH
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' $1'
ORFNHGURWRUFXUYH
027255811,1*
* u U
U *
25 *
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
0272529(5/2$'
YROWDJH
$1'
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' ORFNHGURWRUFXUYH
0272567$57,1* * u U
U *
* $&'5
In the event of a loss of control power to the relay while the motor status is not offline, the thermal capacity will remain
unchanged when control power is restored. If the motor status is offline when control power is lost, the thermal capacity will
decay for the duration of the loss of control power based on the stopped motor cooling rate.
SETTINGS
RTD BIAS:
RTD BIAS
MINIMUM:
RTD BIAS CENTER
POINT:
RTD BIAS
MAXIMUM:
TCU MARGIN:
THERMAL MODEL
CURVE:
THERMAL MODEL
SETTING
TD MULTIPLIER:
THERMAL MODEL
COOL TIME CONSTANT SETTING FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FUNCTION:
RUNNING:
Enabled=1 TC USED MARGIN: MOTOR START INHIBIT
COOL TIME CONSTANT
STOPPED: TCU Margin = 0% AND AND
SETTING
AND RUN TCU Margin > 0%
THERMAL MODEL THERMAL MEMORY
BLOCK : TC Used > 15%
Off=0 AND OR OR R
OR
AND
5 STARTS History Available AND
TC Used on START > TC available
(
TC Used on Start=TCMAX Start x TCU MARGIN(%)+100%
100% )
AND
TCU 100% Stop
Stop TC Used
on START AND
START INHIBIT
SETTING
5
THERM MOD OP
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS MOTOR STATUS
EMERGENCY
MOTOR OFFLINE FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
RESTART:
MOTOR STARTING MOTOR THERMAL OP
Off=0 Reset TC Used To 0% ACTUAL VALUES
MOTOR RUNNING
ACTUAL VALUE MOTOR OVERLOAD
IEq PICKUP MOTOR THERMAL PKP
MOTOR LINE
SOURCE: MOTOR THERMAL DPO
IA RMS
IB RMS t
IC RMS
TC used =
Pos Seq I
Neg Seq I TC used 100%
I
ACTUAL VALUE
STATOR TEMP SENSOR 1 AND S
TC OR
STATOR TEMP SENSOR 2
STATOR TEMP SENSOR 3
TC used RTD=
STATOR TEMP SENSOR 4
STATOR TEMP SENSOR 5 MAX STATOR RTD TC used 100%
STATOR TEMP SENSOR 6 Hottest RTD 833007A6.CDR
d) AMP UNBALANCE
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) MOTOR AMP UNBALANCE 1(2)
This element receives current inputs from the source selected by the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR
LINE SOURCE setting. Generally, this element compares the ratio of motor negative sequence current (I_2) to the positive
sequence current (I_1) times an adjustment factor to compensate for the actual motor load to a set threshold. The adjust-
ment factor is used to prevent nuisance alarms at light loads. If the motor is operating at an average current level equal to
5 or greater than the programmed full load current (FLA, as selected by the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR FULL LOAD
AMPS setting) the adjustment factor is one. If the motor is operating at an average current level less than the programmed
full load current (as selected by the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS setting) the adjustment factor is
the ratio of average current to full load current. It is intended that the Amp Unbalance 1 element is used to generate an
alarm and Amp Unbalance 2 element is used to generate a trip.
A declaration of a “single-phasing” condition is made 2 seconds after the unbalanced current level exceeds 40%, or the
average current is above 25% of FLA and the current in any one phase is less than 2% of FLA
• AMP UNBAL 1(2) PICKUP: This setting selects the level of unbalanced current that generates a stage 1 (intended to
alarm) output. Note that a supply voltage unbalance of 1% creates a current unbalance of 6% in a typical three-phase
induction motor; a supply voltage unbalance of 2% creates a current unbalance of 12%. As a 2% voltage unbalance is
common in most applications, a setting of 0.15 is often used as the alarm level, and AMP UNBAL 1 PICKUP is usually set
to this level or higher.
• AMP UNBAL 1(2) PICKUP DELAY: The alarm delay is often set from 5 to 10 seconds. A higher level of unbalance will
cause motor stress in a shorter period; thus, a reasonable setting is 3 to 10 seconds.
• AMP UNBAL 1(2) RESET DELAY: This timer can be used to maintain the output until other equipment or an operator
can react to the unbalance condition.
SETTING
AMP UNBAL 1
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
ACTUAL VALUES
AMP UNBALANCE
SETTING
AND
AMP UNBAL 1
BLK:
Off = 0 NOTE: SETTING
- FLA is programmed in
*SYSTEM SETUP / MOTOR / FULL LOAD AMPS
AMP UNBAL 1
SETTING SETTING PICKUP DELAY: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SYSTEM SETUP/MOTOR/ AMP UNBAL 1 AMP UNBAL 1 AMP UNBALANCE 1 PKP
MOTOR LINE SOURCE: PICKUP: PICKUP RESET: AMP UNBALANCE 1 DPO
I_1 RUN t PKP
I_2 I_2
Kx x100% UNBAL >
= PKP 1
IA I_1 t RST
If Iavg >
= FLA*, K=1
IA+IB+IC = Iavg Iavg FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
IB If Iavg < FLA*, K=
3 FLA*
IC OR AMP UNBALANCE 1 OP
Iavg >
= 0.25 FLA*
OR 2s
0
AND
AND
IA < 0.02 FLA*
AND OR
IB < 0.02 FLA*
AND
IC < 0.02 FLA* 833002A4.CDR
e) MECHANICAL JAM 5
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) MOTOR MECHANICAL JAM
A motor load can become constrained (mechanical jam) during starting or running. The starting current magnitude alone
cannot provide a definitive indication of a mechanical jam; however, the running current magnitude can. The Mechanical
Jam element is specifically designed to operate for running load jams. Starting load jams are detected by monitoring accel-
eration time and speed. The thermal element will also operate during mechanical jams but after a delay when the thermal
capacity reaches 100%. Not only is this ineffective due to the delay but it also implies the maximum waiting time for cooling
before a re-start, which could be restrictive.
This element is armed as long as the motor status is not “Starting”; this includes “Running”, “Overload”, and “Offline”. As
soon as any phase current exceeds the user-selectable threshold, the element picks up and operates after the pro-
grammed time delay. The element uses currents configured under SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR LINE SOURCE and
motor status asserted by the thermal model element. Both the signal source and thermal protection must be configured
properly in order for the mechanical jam protection to operate.
• MECH JAM OVERCURRENT PICKUP: This setting defines excessive current condition that identifies a mechanical
jam. As the element is not armed during start conditions, this threshold can be set below the starting current. Since the
element is armed during overload conditions, this setting should be higher than the maximum overload current. The
setting is entered in multiplies of FLA (defined in the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR menu).
• MECH JAM PICKUP DELAY: This setting specifies the pickup delay of the element. In the case of large motors that
could feed close-in feeder faults, this setting can coordinate with feeder protection to avoid false tripping due to exces-
sive fault currents fed by the motor.
• MECH JAM RESET DELAY: This setting defines the reset delay of the element. Typical application includes time seal-
in of the tripping command.
6(77,1*
0(&+-$0)81&7,21
'LVDEOHG
(QDEOHG
6(77,1*
6(77,1* 0(&+-$0
29(5&855(173,&.83
0(&+-$0%/.
$1' 581 6(77,1*6
2II 0(&+-$03,&.83
'(/$<
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' ,$3,&.8325 0(&+-$05(6(7
0272567$57,1* '(/$<
,%!3,&.8325 )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
W 3.3
5 W 567 0(&+$1,&$/-$023
6(77,1* ,&!3,&.83 0(&+$1,&$/-$0'32
6<67(06(78302725
0(&+$1,&$/-$03.3
02725/,1(6285&(
,$PDJ
,%PDJ
,&PDJ $&'5
f) UNDERCURRENT
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) MOTOR UNDERCURRENT
The undercurrent function uses the source defined by the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR LINE SOURCE setting.
Phase currents must be configured on this source; otherwise, the undercurrent function will not be operational. The ele-
ment responds to a per-phase current.
If the undercurrent function is enabled, a trip or alarm is initiated once the IA, IB or IC current magnitude falls below the
pickup level for a time specified by the delay setting For example, the undercurrent element may be used to detect loss-of-
load conditions. This may be especially useful for detecting process related problems.
The undercurrent element is active when the motor is running at speed 1; that is, when the motor status is running and
speed 2 is not employed or active.
• UNDERCURRENT START BLOCK DLY: This setting specifies the length of time to block the undercurrent function
when motor is starting. If not in the starting state, the motor status is indicated by the MOTOR OFFLINE operand. Refer
to the Motor Setup section for additional information on using the MOTOR OFFLINE operand for state determination.
The undercurrent element is active only when the motor is running and is blocked upon the initiation of a motor start for
a period of time specified by this setting. For example, this block delay may be used to allow pumps to build up head
before the undercurrent element trips or alarms. A value of 0 specifies that the feature is not blocked from start. For
values other than 0, the feature is disabled when the motor is stopped and also from the time a start is detected until
the time entered expires.
• UNDERCURRENT ALARM PICKUP: This setting specifies a pickup threshold for the alarm stage. The alarm pickup
threshold should be less than the motor load current during normal operations.
• UNDERCURRENT ALARM PICKUP DLY: This setting specifies a time delay for the alarm stage. The time delay
should long enough to overcome any short lowering of the current (for example, during system faults).
• UNDERCURRENT TRIP PICKUP: This setting specifies a pickup threshold for the trip stage. This setting should be
less than the corresponding setting for the alarm stage.
• UNDERCURRENT TRIP PICKUP DLY: This setting specifies a time delay for the trip stage. This time delay should be
long enough to overcome any short lowering of the current (for example, during system faults).
• UNDERCURRENT TRIP RESET DLY: This setting specifies a time delay to reset the trip command. This delay should
be set long enough to allow breaker or contactor to disconnect the motor.
• UNDERCURRENT BLOCK: This setting specifies an operand used to block the undercurrent function. A panel cutoff
switch or other user specified condition is typically used to block the function.
SETTINGS
UNDERCURRENT
FUNCTION
= Enabled
UNDERCURRENT BLOCK AND
= Off
SETTINGS
UNDERCURRENT START
BLOCK DLY AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND TPKP SETTINGS
MOTOR OFFLINE
SETTING UNDERCURRENT ALARM
0 PICKUP DLY
UNDERCURRENT ALARM
MOTOR STATUS PICKUP UNDERCURRENT TRIP
Running at speed 1 PICKUP DLY
RUN
UNDERCURRENT TRIP
magnitude Ia < PICKUP RESET DLY
TPKP FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
magnitude Ib < PICKUP OR U/CURR ALARM OP
0
magnitude IC < PICKUP TPKP FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
U/CURR TRIP OP
TRST
SETTING
UNDERCURRENT TRIP
PICKUP
RUN
SETTING magnitude Ia < PICKUP FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
MOTOR LINE SOURCE U/CURR ALARM PKP
= Ia magnitude Ib < PICKUP OR U/CURR TRIP PKP
5 = Ib
= Ic magnitude IC < PICKUP
833024A1.CDR
The two-speed motor menu appears only if two-speed motor functionality is enabled in the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP
MOTOR menu.
SPEED2 THERMAL MODEL Range: 0.00 to 16.00 in steps of 0.01 when speed 2
MESSAGE thermal model curve is Motor, otherwise 0.00 to
TD MULTIPLIER: 1.00
600.00 in steps of 0.01
SPEED2 VOLT DEPEND Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
FUNCTION: Disabled
SPEED2 VOLT DEPEND Range: 60 to 99% in steps of 1
MESSAGE
MIN MOTOR VOLTS: 80%
SPEED2 VD VOLT LOSS: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
SPEED2 VD STALL CURR Range: 1.50 to 20.00 FLA in steps of 0.01
MESSAGE
@ MIN V: 4.50 x FLA
SPEED2 VD SAFE STALL Range: 0.1 to 1000.0 s in steps of 0.1
MESSAGE
TIME @ MIN V: 20.0 s
SPEED2 VD ACCL INSCT Range: 1.50 to 20.00 FLA in steps of 0.01
MESSAGE
@ MIN V: 4.00 x FLA
SPEED2 VD STALL CURR Range: 1.50 to 20.00 FLA in steps of 0.01
MESSAGE
@ 100%V: 6.00 x FLA 5
SPEED2 VD SAFE STALL Range: 0.1 to 1000.0 s in steps of 0.1
MESSAGE
TIME @ 100%V: 20.0 s
SPEED2 VD ACCL INSCT Range: 1.50 to 20.00 FLA in steps of 0.01
MESSAGE
@ 100%V: 5.00 x FLA
When two-speed motor functionality is used, these settings allow the selection of proper parameters for the thermal model
when motor is switched to the second speed. There is one thermal model in the M60, and it has inputs for overload condi-
tions from calculations at both speeds. As such, the accumulated thermal capacity is calculated from overload contributions
at each speed.
Refer to the Thermal Model sub-section for details on settings for thermal model at the second motor speed.
SETTING
MOTOR LINE SOURCE
= Ia
Ia
= Ib
= Ic
Ib
VOLTAGE CONNECTION
Wye Delta Ic
Thermal model,
Vag Vab voltage dependent
Va
Vbg Vbc
Vcg Vca
Vb
SETTING
SPEED2 MOTOR SOURCE Vc
= Ia Thermal model Thermal model
= Ib settings, speed 1 settings, speed 2
= Ic
Off On
VOLTAGE CONNECTION
Wye Delta ACTIVE
Vag Vab
Vbg Vbc
Vcg Vca
SETTING
SPEED2 MOTOR SWITCH SETTING
Off = 0 SPEED2 SWITCH 2-1
DELAY
0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
AND MOTOR SPD2 TR 2-1 OP
2-SPEED MOTOR TRST
PROTECTION
5 Enabled = 1 833020A1.CDR
If the speed 2 acceleration time functionality is enabled, the element will read current from the source selected for speed 2
by the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR 2-SPEED MOTOR SOURCE setting when the motor is switched from
speed 1 to speed 2.
Acceleration time settings and functionality at speed 2 are identical to those of speed 1 and are described in the
Acceleration Time sub-section. This applies to the SPEED2 ACCELERATION CURRENT, SPEED2 ACCELERATION TIME
127(
and SPEED2 ACCEL MODE settings.
Two additional setting define the transition between speeds. A two-speed motor is usually started at a low speed (speed 1)
and then switched to a higher speed (speed 2) when required. When the motor starts directly at high speed, then the
SPEED2 ACCELERATION TIME setting specifies the maximum acceleration time at speed 2. When motor is switched from a
low-to-high speed setting, the SPEED2 TIMER FROM SPEED 1-2 setting specifies the acceleration time. When motor is
switched from high speed to low speed, the SPEED2 TRANS 2-1 OP FlexLogic™ operand is set for time defined by the
SPEED2 SWITCH 2-1 DELAY setting to allow inputs for control logic of contactors and breakers at both speeds. FlexLogic™
operands required for contactor and breaker control are provided. The acceleration time at speed 2 becomes functional
only if the acceleration time at speed 1 is enabled. When the acceleration time at any speed is not required, it can be per-
manently blocked.
• SPEED2 ACCEL TIME FROM SPEED 1-2: This setting is provide to select maximum accelerating time from speed 1
to speed 2 when motor is switched from low-to-high speed.
SETTING
SPEED 2 ACCEL BLOCK
= Off
AND SETTINGS
SPEED 2 MOTOR SWITCH
SPEED 2 ACCELERATION
= Off TIME
SPEED2 ACCELERATION
SETTING CURRENT
SPEED2 ACCEL MODE SPEED2 ACCEL TIME FROM
= Definite Time Definite Time SPEED 1-2
= Adaptive RUN
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
T > Acceleration time MOTOR SPD2 ACL t OP
Adaptive
OR MOTOR SPD2 ACL t DPO
RUN
5
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
MOTOR STARTING
MOTOR RUNNING 833021A1.CDR
The speed 2 undercurrent function uses the same source as other speed 2 motor functions as defined by the SYSTEM
SETUP MOTOR 2-SPEED MOTOR SOURCE setting. The phase currents must be configured on this source; otherwise,
the function will not be enabled. The element responds to per-phase currents.
If the speed 2 undercurrent function is enabled, a trip or alarm are initiated once the IA, IB or IC current magnitude falls
below the pickup level for a period of time specified by the delay. For example, undercurrent may be used to detect loss-of-
load conditions. This may be especially useful for detecting process related problems.
This element is active if the motor is running at speed 2. The undercurrent function at speed 2 becomes functional only if
undercurrent at speed 1 is enabled. When the undercurrent function at any speed is not required, it can be permanently
blocked.
• SPEED2 U/CURR START BLOCK DLY: This setting specifies a time to block the undercurrent function when motor is
starting directly at speed 2. Prior to starting, the motor state is determined from the MOTOR OFFLINE operand. Refer to
the Motor Setup section for additional information on the motor offline state determination. The speed 2 undercurrent
element is active only when the motor is running at speed 2 and is blocked upon the initiation of a motor start for a
period of time defined by the SPEED2 U/CURR START BLOCK DLY setting (for example, this block may be used to allow
pumps to build up head before the undercurrent element trips or alarms). A value of 0 specifies that the feature is not
blocked from start. For values other than 0, the feature is disabled when the motor is stopped and also from the time a
start is detected until the time entered expires.
• SPEED2 U/CURR ALARM PICKUP: This setting specifies a pickup threshold for the alarm stage. The alarm pickup
threshold should be less than the motor load current during normal operations.
• SPEED2 U/CURR ALARM PICKUP DLY: This setting specifies a time delay for the alarm stage. The time delay
should long enough to overcome any short lowering of the current (for example, during system faults).
• SPEED2 U/CURR TRIP PICKUP: This setting specifies a pickup threshold for the trip stage. This setting should be
less than the corresponding setting for the alarm stage.
• SPEED2 U/CURR TRIP PICKUP DLY: This setting specifies a time delay for the trip stage. This time delay should be
long enough to overcome any short lowering of the current (for example, during system faults).
5 • SPEED2 U/CURR TRIP RESET DLY: This setting specifies a time delay to reset the trip command. This time delay
should be long enough to allow the breaker or contactor to disconnect the motor.
• SPEED2 U/CURR BLOCK: This setting specifies an operand used to block the speed 2 undercurrent function. A panel
cutoff switch or other user specified condition is typically used to block the function.
SETTING
SPEED2 U/CURR BLOCK
= Off SETTINGS
SPEED2 U/CURR ALARM
SETTING PICKUP DLY
SPEED2 U/CURR START SETTING
SPEED2 U/CURR TRIP
BLOCK DLY SPEED2 U/CURR ALARM PICKUP DLY
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS PICKUP
TPKP SPEED2 U/CURR TRIP
MOTOR OFFLINE AND RUN RESET DLY
0 IA_mag < PICKUP FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TPKP
IB_mag < PICKUP OR U/CURR SP2 ALARM OP
IC_mag < PICKUP 0
TIMER
MOTOR STATUS TPKP FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
1 sec.
Switched to speed 2 U/CURR SP2 TRIP OP
0 TRST
SETTING
SPEED2 U/CURR TRIP
SETTING PICKUP
SPEED 2 MOTOR SOURCE RUN FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
= Ia magnitude IA_mag < PICKUP U/CURR SP2 ALARM PKP
= Ib magnitude IB_mag < PICKUP OR U/CURR SP2 TRIP PKP
= Ic magnitude IC_mag < PICKUP 833022A1.CDR
The stator differential protection element is intended for use on the stator windings of rotating machinery.
differential
Operate Block
Slope 2
Slope 1
Pickup
Break 1
Break 2
restraining
830735A1.CDR
This element has a dual slope characteristic. The main purpose of the percent-slope characteristic is to prevent a maloper-
ation caused by unbalances between CTs during external faults. CT unbalances arise as a result of the following factors:
1. CT accuracy errors
2. CT saturation
The characteristic allows for very sensitive settings when fault current is low and less sensitive settings when fault current is
high and CT performance may produce incorrect operate signals.
• STATOR DIFF LINE END SOURCE: This setting selects the source connected to CTs in the end of the machine stator
winding closest to the load and furthest from the winding neutral point. Both line and neutral-side CTs should be wired
to measure their currents in the same direction with respect to the neutral point of the winding.
If the two-speed motor functionality is employed with two separate CTs at each speed, the source which is sum of cur-
rents of two CT banks at line side should be assigned with this setting for proper differential functionality.
• STATOR DIFF NEUTRAL END SOURCE: This setting selects the source connected to CTs in the end of the machine
stator winding furthest from the load and closest to the winding neutral point. Both line and neutral-side CTs should be
wired to measure their currents in the same direction with respect to the neutral point of the winding.
• STATOR DIFF PICKUP: This setting defines the minimum differential current required for operation. This setting is
based on the amount of differential current that might be seen under normal operating conditions. A setting of 0.1 to
0.3 pu is generally recommended.
• STATOR DIFF SLOPE 1: This setting is applicable for restraint currents from zero to STATOR DIFF BREAK 1, and defines
the ratio of differential to restraint current above which the element will operate. This slope is set to ensure sensitivity to
internal faults at normal operating current levels. The criteria for setting this slope is to allow for maximum expected CT
mismatch error when operating at the maximum permitted current. This maximum error is generally in the range of 5 to
10% of CT rating.
5 • STATOR DIFF BREAK 1: This setting defines the end of the Slope 1 region and the start of the transition region. It
should be set just above the maximum normal operating current level of the machine.
• STATOR DIFF SLOPE 2: This setting is applicable for restraint currents above the STATOR DIFF BREAK 2 setting when
the element is applied to generator stator windings. This slope is set to ensure stability under heavy external fault con-
ditions that could lead to high differential currents as a result of CT saturation. A setting of 80 to 100% is recom-
mended. The transition region (as shown on the characteristic plot) is a cubic spline, automatically calculated by the
relay to result in a smooth transition between STATOR DIFF SLOPE 1 and STATOR DIFF SLOPE 2 with no discontinuities.
• STATOR DIFF BREAK 2: This setting defines the end of the transition region and the start of the Slope 2 region. It
should be set to the level at which any of the protection CTs are expected to begin to saturate.
SETTING
STATOR DIFF SETTINGS
FUNCTION:
STATOR DIFF
Disabled = 0 PICKUP:
Enabled = 1
STATOR DIFF
SLOPE 1:
SETTING
AND STATOR DIFF
BREAK 1:
STATOR DIFF BLOCK:
STATOR DIFF
Off = 0 SLOPE 2:
STATOR DIFF
SETTING BREAK 2:
STATOR DIFF RUN
LINE END SOURCE: Differential Phasors Iad FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
IA Iad STATOR DIFF PKP A
IB Ibd STATOR DIFF DPO A
IC Icd Iar
RUN
DC Offset
Ibd FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Removal
D.F.T. STATOR DIFF PKP B
SETTING
and STATOR DIFF DPO B
STATOR DIFF Differential Ibr
NEUTRAL END SOURCE: and Restraint Restraint Phasors RUN
IA Iar Icd FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
IB Ibr STATOR DIFF PKP C
IC Icr STATOR DIFF DPO C
Icr
SAT := 1
DIF = 0
for 100 ms
EXTERNAL FAULT
AND CT SATURATION
SAT := 1
830736A1.CDR
else DIR = 1
where: IR = restraining current, DIR = flag indicating that the phase comparison principle is satisfied
BL = breakpoint 1 setting, ITS, INS = current at the terminal and neutral sources, respectively
K = factory constant of 0.25
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4C
CD1D?B4966@;@1 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
CD1D?B4966C1D1 1>4 CD1D?B4966?@1
?B
CD1D?B496649B1
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4C
CD1D?B4966@;@2 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
CD1D?B4966C1D2 1>4 CD1D?B4966?@2
?B
CD1D?B496649B2
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4C
CD1D?B4966@;@3 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
CD1D?B4966C1D3 1>4 CD1D?B4966?@3
?B
CD1D?B496649B3
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
?B CD1D?B4966?@
($"' '1!34B
5.6.5 POWER
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) POWER
POWER SENSITIVE
See page 5-151.
DIRECTIONAL POWER
UNDERPOWER
MESSAGE See page 5-155.
MESSAGE
DIR POWER 1 STG1
SMIN: 0.100 pu
Range: –1.200 to 1.200 pu in steps of 0.001
5
DIR POWER 1 STG1 Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
MESSAGE
DELAY: 0.50 s
DIR POWER 1 STG2 Range: –1.200 to 1.200 pu in steps of 0.001
MESSAGE
SMIN: 0.100 pu
DIR POWER 1 STG2 Range: 0.00 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
MESSAGE
DELAY: 20.00 s
DIR POWER 1 BLK: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
DIR POWER 1 Range: Self-Reset, Latched, Disabled
MESSAGE
TARGET: Self-Reset
DIR POWER 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
EVENTS: Disabled
The sensitive directional power element responds to three-phase directional power and is designed for reverse power and
low forward power applications for synchronous machines or interconnections involving co-generation. The relay measures
the three-phase power from either full set of wye-connected VTs or full-set of delta-connected VTs. In the latter case, the
two-wattmeter method is used. Refer to the Metering Conventions section in chapter 6 for details regarding the active and
reactive powers used by the sensitive directional power element.
The element has an adjustable characteristic angle and minimum operating power as shown in the Directional Power Char-
acteristic diagram. The element responds to the following condition:
P cos + Q sin SMIN (EQ 5.28)
where: P and Q are active and reactive powers as measured per the UR-series metering convention,
is a sum of the element characteristic (DIR POWER 1 RCA) and calibration (DIR POWER 1 CALIBRATION) angles, and
SMIN is the minimum operating power
The operating quantity is displayed in the ACTUAL VALUES METERING SENSITIVE DIRECTIONAL POWER 1(2) actual
value. The element has two independent (as to the pickup and delay settings) stages for alarm and trip, respectively.
^
Y_
Sd
bU
4Y
?@5B1D5
B31
31<92B1D9?>
C=9>
@
B5CDB19>
D 4 E 4
5(675$,1
23(5$7( 5(675$,1 23(5$7(
3 3
F 4 G 4
23(5$7( 23(5$7(
3 3
5(675$,1 5(675$,1
5&$ R 5&$ R
60,1 60,1!
5
H 4
23(5$7(
I 4
5(675$,1
5(675$,1 23(5$7(
3 3
($"' "1!34B
• DIR POWER 1 STG1 SMIN: This setting specifies the minimum power as defined along the relay characteristic angle
(RCA) for the stage 1 of the element. The positive values imply a shift towards the operate region along the RCA line;
the negative values imply a shift towards the restrain region along the RCA line. Refer to the Directional Power Sample
Applications figure for details. Together with the RCA, this setting enables a wide range of operating characteristics.
This setting applies to three-phase power and is entered in per-unit (pu) values. The base quantity is 3-phase power
on primary side, which is calculated as √3 x Phase CT Primary x Phase VT Ratio x Phase VT Secondary in case of
delta connected VTs; and 3 x Phase CT Primary x Phase VT Ratio x Phase VT Secondary in case of wye connected
VTs.
For example, a setting of 2% for a 200 MW machine is 0.02 200 MW = 4 MW. If 7.967 kV is a primary VT voltage and
10 kA is a primary CT current, the source pu quantity is 239 MVA, and thus, SMIN should be set at 4 MW / 239 MVA =
0.0167 pu 0.017 pu. If the reverse power application is considered, RCA = 180° and SMIN = 0.017 pu.
The element drops out if the magnitude of the positive-sequence current becomes virtually zero, that is, it drops below
the cutoff level.
• DIR POWER 1 STG1 DELAY: This setting specifies a time delay for stage 1. For reverse power or low forward power
applications for a synchronous machine, stage 1 is typically applied for alarming and stage 2 for tripping.
SETTING
DIR POWER 1
FUNCTION:
Enabled = 1
SETTINGS SETTING
SETTING DIR POWER 1 RCA: DIR POWER 1 STG1
DIR POWER 1 BLK: DELAY:
AND
OR
DIR POWER 1 OP
Three-phase reactive power (Q)
DIR POWER 1 STG2 DPO
DIR POWER 1 STG2 OP
SETTING
DIR POWER 1 STG2
DELAY:
tPKP
100 ms
842003A3.CDR
c) UNDERPOWER
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) POWER UNDERPOWER UNDERPOWER 1(2)
The underpower function uses the source selected by the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR LINE SOURCE setting.
Phase currents and voltages must configured on that source, otherwise the underpower function will not be functional. The
underpower element responds to total three-phase apparent power measured from the phase current and voltages.
When the underpower element is enabled, a trip or alarm are initiated once the magnitude of three-phase apparent power
falls below the pickup level for a period of time specified by the delay. For example, underpower may be used to detect
loss-of-load conditions. Loss of load conditions will not always cause a significant loss of current. Power is a more accurate
representation of loading and may be used for more sensitive detection of load loss or pump cavitations. This may be espe-
cially useful for detecting process related problems.
• UNDERPOWER 1 START BLOCK DELAY: This setting specifies the length of time to block the underpower function
when motor is starting. If not in the starting state, the motor status is indicated by the MOTOR OFFLINE operand. Refer
to the Motor Setup section for additional information on using the MOTOR OFFLINE operand for state determination.
The underpower element is active only when the motor is running and is blocked upon the initiation of a motor start for
a period of time specified by this setting. For example, this block may be used to allow pumps to build up head before
the underpower element trips or alarms. A value of 0 specifies that the feature is not blocked from start. For values
other than 0, the feature is disabled when the motor is stopped and also from the time a start is detected until the time
entered expires.
• UNDERPOWER 1 ALARM PWR PICKUP: This setting specifies a pickup threshold for the alarm stage. The base
quantity is 3-phase power on primary side, which should be calculated as √3 x Phase CT Primary x Phase VT Ratio x
Phase VT Secondary in case of delta connected VTs; and 3 x Phase CT Primary x Phase VT Ratio x Phase VT Sec-
ondary in case of wye connected VTs. The alarm pickup threshold should be less than the motor load current during
normal operations.
• UNDERPOWER 1 ALARM PICKUP DLY: This setting specifies a time delay for the alarm stage. The time delay
should long enough to overcome any short lowering of the current (for example, during system faults).
• UNDERPOWER 1 TRIP PWR PICKUP: This setting specifies a pickup threshold for the trip stage. The base quantity
is 3-phase power on primary side, which should be calculated as √3 x Phase CT Primary x Phase VT Ratio x Phase
VT Secondary in case of delta connected VTs; and 3 x Phase CT Primary x Phase VT Ratio x Phase VT Secondary in
case of wye connected VTs. This setting should be less than the corresponding setting for the alarm stage.
• UNDERPOWER 1 TRIP PICKUP DLY: This setting specifies a time delay for the trip stage. This time delay should be
long enough to overcome any short lowering of the current (for example, during system faults).
• UNDERPOWER 1 TRIP RESET DLY: This setting specifies a time delay to reset the trip command. This delay should
be set long enough to allow breaker or contactor to disconnect the motor.
• UNDERPOWER 1 BLOCK: This setting specifies an operand used to block the underpower function. A panel cutoff
switch or other user specified condition is typically used to block the function.
SETTINGS
UNDERPOWER 1 ALARM
SETTINGS PICKUP DLY
SETTING CALCULATE UNDERPOWER 1 ALARM UNDERPOWER 1 TRIP
MOTOR LINE SOURCE
PWR PICKUP PICKUP DLY
= Ia
UNDERPOWER 1 TRIP UNDERPOWER 1 TRIP
= Ib PWR PICKUP RESET DLY
= Ic RUN TPKP FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Sop < ALARM PICKUP UNDERPWR 1 ALARM OP
Sop = sum (Sa + Sb + Sc) 0
VOLTAGE CONNECTION
Wye Delta RUN TPKP FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Vag Vab UNDERPWR 1 TRIP OP
Sop < TRIP PICKUP
Vbg Vbc TRST
Vcg Vca
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
UNDERPWR 1 ALARM PKP
UNDERPWR 1 ALARM DPO
COMPARATORS UNDERPWR 1 TRIP PKP
magnitude Ia > 0.1 × FLA UNDERPWR 1 TRIP DPO
magnitude Ib > 0.1 × FLA AND
magnitude Ic > 0.1 × FLA
magnitude Va > 0.25 pu
SETTINGS
magnitude Vb > 0.25 pu AND
5
UNDERPOWER 1
magnitude Vc > 0.25 pu
FUNCTION
= Enabled
AND
UNDERPOWER 1 BLOCK AND
= Off
SETTING
UNDERPOWER 1 START
BLOCK DLY
TPKP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
MOTOR OFFLINE 0 833025A1.CDR
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) PHASE CURRENT
MESSAGE
PHASE
See page 5-160. 5
DIRECTIONAL 1
PHASE
MESSAGE See page 5-160.
DIRECTIONAL 2
The M60 Motor Protection System has up to eight phase instantaneous overcurrent elements (dependent on CT/VT mod-
ules ordered) and two phase directional overcurrent elements.
The phase instantaneous overcurrent element may be used as an instantaneous element with no intentional delay or as a
definite time element. The input current is the fundamental phasor magnitude. The phase instantaneous overcurrent timing
curves are shown below for form-A contacts in a 60 Hz system.
0LOOLVHFRQGV
0D[LPXP
0LQLPXP
0XOWLSOHRISLFNXS $&'5 5
Figure 5–79: PHASE INSTANTANEOUS OVERCURRENT TIMING CURVES
The TARGET setting is not user-selectable and forced to "Disabled". If Targets are required from directional ele-
5 127(
ments, it can be achieved by assigning directional element output to a digital element, where targets selection can
be used as required.
The phase directional elements (one for each of phases A, B, and C) determine the phase current flow direction for steady
state and fault conditions and can be used to control the operation of the phase overcurrent elements via the BLOCK inputs
of these elements.
DC
D@E
?E P
)
F17E^VQe\dUT 6Qe\dQ^W\U
cUd0& P<QW
F@_\
F176Qe\dUT 91
531
cUd0# P
F23
F23
F37 F27 ) P
@XQc_bcV_b@XQcU1@_\QbYjQdY_^*
F@_\-F23!O531-`_\QbYjY^Wf_\dQWU
5
91-_`UbQdY^WSebbU^d
531-5\U]U^d3XQbQSdUbYcdYS1^W\U0#P
("'( 1"34B
MODE OF OPERATION:
• When the function is “Disabled”, or the operating current is below 5% CT nominal, the element output is “0”.
• When the function is “Enabled”, the operating current is above 5% CT nominal, and the polarizing voltage is above
the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL value, the element output is dependent on
the phase angle between the operating and polarizing signals:
– The element output is logic “0” when the operating current is within polarizing voltage ±90°.
– For all other angles, the element output is logic “1”.
• Once the voltage memory has expired, the phase overcurrent elements under directional control can be set to block or
trip on overcurrent as follows:
– When BLOCK WHEN V MEM EXP is set to “Yes”, the directional element will block the operation of any phase
overcurrent element under directional control when voltage memory expires.
– When BLOCK WHEN V MEM EXP is set to “No”, the directional element allows tripping of phase overcurrent elements
under directional control when voltage memory expires.
In all cases, directional blocking will be permitted to resume when the polarizing voltage becomes greater than the ‘polariz-
ing voltage threshold’.
SETTINGS:
• PHASE DIR 1 SIGNAL SOURCE: This setting is used to select the source for the operating and polarizing signals.
The operating current for the phase directional element is the phase current for the selected current source. The polar-
izing voltage is the line voltage from the phase VTs, based on the 90° or ‘quadrature’ connection and shifted in the
leading direction by the element characteristic angle (ECA).
• PHASE DIR 1 ECA: This setting is used to select the element characteristic angle, i.e. the angle by which the polariz-
5 ing voltage is shifted in the leading direction to achieve dependable operation. In the design of the UR-series elements,
a block is applied to an element by asserting logic 1 at the blocking input. This element should be programmed via the
ECA setting so that the output is logic 1 for current in the non-tripping direction.
• PHASE DIR 1 POL V THRESHOLD: This setting is used to establish the minimum level of voltage for which the phase
angle measurement is reliable. The setting is based on VT accuracy. The default value is “0.700 pu”.
• PHASE DIR 1 BLOCK WHEN V MEM EXP: This setting is used to select the required operation upon expiration of
voltage memory. When set to "Yes", the directional element blocks the operation of any phase overcurrent element
under directional control, when voltage memory expires; when set to "No", the directional element allows tripping of
phase overcurrent elements under directional control.
The phase directional element responds to the forward load current. In the case of a following reverse fault, the ele-
ment needs some time – in the order of 8 ms – to establish a blocking signal. Some protection elements such as
127(
instantaneous overcurrent may respond to reverse faults before the blocking signal is established. Therefore, a
coordination time of at least 10 ms must be added to all the instantaneous protection elements under the supervi-
sion of the phase directional element. If current reversal is of a concern, a longer delay – in the order of 20 ms –
may be needed.
6(77,1*
3+$6(',5
)81&7,21
'LVDEOHG
(QDEOHG
6(77,1*
$1'
3+$6(',5
%/2&.
2II
6(77,1*
6(77,1* 3+$6(',5(&$
6(77,1* 86($&78$/92/7$*(
3+$6(',5%/2&.2&
:+(190(0(;3
86(0(025,=('92/7$*(
1R
<HV
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
3+$6(%/2*,&6,0,/$5723+$6($
5
3+',5%/.%
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
3+$6(&/2*,&6,0,/$5723+$6($ 3+',5%/.&
$&'5
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) NEUTRAL CURRENT
NEUTRAL IOC8
MESSAGE See page 5-164.
NEUTRAL
MESSAGE See page 5-165.
DIRECTIONAL OC1
NEUTRAL
MESSAGE See page 5-165.
DIRECTIONAL OC2
The M60 Motor Protection System has up to eight neutral instantaneous overcurrent elements (dependent on CT/VT mod-
ules ordered) and two neutral directional overcurrent elements.
The neutral instantaneous overcurrent element may be used as an instantaneous function with no intentional delay or as a
5 definite time function. The element essentially responds to the magnitude of a neutral current fundamental frequency pha-
sor calculated from the phase currents. A positive-sequence restraint is applied for better performance. A small portion
(6.25%) of the positive-sequence current magnitude is subtracted from the zero-sequence current magnitude when forming
the operating quantity of the element as follows:
I op = 3 I_0 – Kx I_1 where K = 1 16 (EQ 5.29)
The positive-sequence restraint allows for more sensitive settings by counterbalancing spurious zero-sequence currents
resulting from:
• System unbalances under heavy load conditions
• Transformation errors of current transformers (CTs) during double-line and three-phase faults.
• Switch-off transients during double-line and three-phase faults.
The positive-sequence restraint must be considered when testing for pickup accuracy and response time (multiple of
pickup). The operating quantity depends on how test currents are injected into the relay (single-phase injection):
1
I op = --- 3 – K x I injected (EQ 5.30)
3
6(77,1*
1(875$/,2&)81&7,21 6(77,1*6
'LVDEOHG 1(875$/,2&
6(77,1* 3,&.83'(/$<
(QDEOHG )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
1(875$/,2&
1(875$/,2&3,&.83 1(875$/,2&3.3
5(6(7'(/$<
6(77,1* 1(875$/,2&'32
$1' 581 W3.3
W567 1(875$/,2&23
1(875$/,2&%/2&. ,B.,B3,&.83
2II
6(77,1*
1(875$/,2&6285&(
,B $&'5
The neutral directional overcurrent element provides both forward and reverse fault direction indications the NEUTRAL DIR
OC1 FWD and NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV operands, respectively. The output operand is asserted if the magnitude of the oper-
ating current is above a pickup level (overcurrent unit) and the fault direction is seen as forward or reverse, respectively
(directional unit).
The overcurrent unit responds to the magnitude of a fundamental frequency phasor of the either the neutral current calcu-
lated from the phase currents or the ground current. There are separate pickup settings for the forward-looking and
reverse-looking functions. If set to use the calculated 3I_0, the element applies a positive-sequence restraint for better per-
formance: a small user-programmable portion of the positive-sequence current magnitude is subtracted from the zero-
sequence current magnitude when forming the operating quantity.
I op = 3 I_0 – K I_1 (EQ 5.31)
The positive-sequence restraint allows for more sensitive settings by counterbalancing spurious zero-sequence currents
resulting from:
• System unbalances under heavy load conditions.
• Transformation errors of current transformers (CTs) during double-line and three-phase faults.
• Switch-off transients during double-line and three-phase faults.
The positive-sequence restraint must be considered when testing for pickup accuracy and response time (multiple of
pickup). The operating quantity depends on the way the test currents are injected into the relay (single-phase injection:
Iop = (1 – K) Iinjected ; three-phase pure zero-sequence injection: Iop = 3 Iinjected).
The positive-sequence restraint is removed for low currents. If the positive-sequence current is below 0.8 pu, the restraint is
removed by changing the constant K to zero. This facilitates better response to high-resistance faults when the unbalance
is very small and there is no danger of excessive CT errors as the current is low.
5 The directional unit uses the zero-sequence current (I_0) or ground current (IG) for fault direction discrimination and may
be programmed to use either zero-sequence voltage (“Calculated V0” or “Measured VX”), ground current (IG), or both for
polarizing. The zero-sequence current (I_0) must be greater than the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES CUR-
RENT CUT-OFF LEVEL setting value and IG must be greater than 0.5 pu to be validated as the operating quantity for direc-
tional current. The following tables define the neutral directional overcurrent element.
1
where: V_0 = --- VAG + VBG + VCG = zero sequence voltage ,
3
1 1
I_0 = --- IN = --- IA + IB + IC = zero sequence current ,
3 3
ECA = element characteristic angle and IG = ground current
When NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POL VOLT is set to “Measured VX”, one-third of this voltage is used in place of V_0. The following
figure explains the usage of the voltage polarized directional unit of the element.
The figure below shows the voltage-polarized phase angle comparator characteristics for a phase A to ground fault, with:
• ECA = 90° (element characteristic angle = centerline of operating characteristic)
• FWD LA = 80° (forward limit angle = the ± angular limit with the ECA for operation)
• REV LA = 80° (reverse limit angle = the ± angular limit with the ECA for operation)
The above bias should be taken into account when using the neutral directional overcurrent element to directionalize other
protection elements.
#FO \Y^U
B5F<1 6G4<1
\Y^U \Y^U
F17
bUVUbU^SU
B5F?`UbQdY^W 6G4?`UbQdY^W
BUWY_^ BUWY_^
5
<1 <1
#9O \Y^U
531
531\Y^U
531\Y^U
F37 <1
F27
B5F<1 6G4<1
\Y^U \Y^U
#FO \Y^U
("'( %1!34B
The calculated V_0 can be used as polarizing voltage only if the voltage transformers are connected in Wye. The
auxiliary voltage can be used as the polarizing voltage provided SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK
AUXILIARY VT CONNECTION is set to “Vn” and the auxiliary voltage is connected to a zero-sequence voltage
source (such as open delta connected secondary of VTs).
The zero-sequence (V_0) or auxiliary voltage (V_X), accordingly, must be greater than the VOLTAGE CUTOFF
LEVEL setting specified in the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES menu to be validated for use as a polariz-
ing signal. If the polarizing signal is invalid, neither forward nor reverse indication is given.
– If “Current” polarizing is selected, the element uses the ground current angle connected externally and configured
under NEUTRAL OC1 SOURCE for polarization. The ground CT must be connected between the ground and neutral
point of an adequate local source of ground current. The ground current must be greater than 0.05 pu to be vali-
dated as a polarizing signal. If the polarizing signal is not valid, neither forward nor reverse indication is given. In
addition, the zero-sequence current (I_0) must be greater than the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES
CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL setting value.
For a choice of current polarizing, it is recommended that the polarizing signal be analyzed to ensure that a known
direction is maintained irrespective of the fault location. For example, if using an autotransformer neutral current
as a polarizing source, it should be ensured that a reversal of the ground current does not occur for a high-side
fault. The low-side system impedance should be assumed minimal when checking for this condition. A similar sit-
uation arises for a wye/delta/wye transformer, where current in one transformer winding neutral may reverse when
faults on both sides of the transformer are considered.
– If “Dual” polarizing is selected, the element performs both directional comparisons as described above. A given
direction is confirmed if either voltage or current comparators indicate so. If a conflicting (simultaneous forward
and reverse) indication occurs, the forward direction overrides the reverse direction.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POL VOLT: Selects the polarizing voltage used by the directional unit when "Voltage" or "Dual"
5 polarizing mode is set. The polarizing voltage can be programmed to be either the zero-sequence voltage calculated
from the phase voltages ("Calculated V0") or supplied externally as an auxiliary voltage ("Measured VX").
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 OP CURR: This setting indicates whether the 3I_0 current calculated from the phase currents, or
the ground current shall be used by this protection. This setting acts as a switch between the neutral and ground
modes of operation (67N and 67G). If set to “Calculated 3I0” the element uses the phase currents and applies the pos-
itive-sequence restraint; if set to “Measured IG” the element uses ground current supplied to the ground CT of the CT
bank configured as NEUTRAL DIR OC1 SOURCE. If this setting is “Measured IG”, then the NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POLARIZING
setting must be “Voltage”, as it is not possible to use the ground current as an operating and polarizing signal simulta-
neously.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POS-SEQ RESTRAINT: This setting controls the amount of the positive-sequence restraint. Set
to 0.063 for backward compatibility with firmware revision 3.40 and older. Set to zero to remove the restraint. Set
higher if large system unbalances or poor CT performance are expected.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 OFFSET: This setting specifies the offset impedance used by this protection. The primary appli-
cation for the offset impedance is to guarantee correct identification of fault direction on series compensated lines. In
regular applications, the offset impedance ensures proper operation even if the zero-sequence voltage at the relaying
point is very small. If this is the intent, the offset impedance shall not be larger than the zero-sequence impedance of
the protected circuit. Practically, it shall be several times smaller. The offset impedance shall be entered in secondary
ohms.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD ECA: This setting defines the characteristic angle (ECA) for the forward direction in the
"Voltage" polarizing mode. The "Current" polarizing mode uses a fixed ECA of 0°. The ECA in the reverse direction is
the angle set for the forward direction shifted by 180°.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD LIMIT ANGLE: This setting defines a symmetrical (in both directions from the ECA) limit
angle for the forward direction.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD PICKUP: This setting defines the pickup level for the overcurrent unit of the element in the
forward direction. When selecting this setting it must be kept in mind that the design uses a ‘positive-sequence
restraint’ technique for the “Calculated 3I0” mode of operation.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV LIMIT ANGLE: This setting defines a symmetrical (in both directions from the ECA) limit
angle for the reverse direction.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV PICKUP: This setting defines the pickup level for the overcurrent unit of the element in the
reverse direction. When selecting this setting it must be kept in mind that the design uses a positive-sequence restraint
technique for the “Calculated 3I0” mode of operation.
6(77,1*
1(875$/',52&):'
3,&.83
1(875$/',52&23
&855
1(875$/',52&326
6(77,1* 6(45(675$,17
581
1(875$/',52&
)81&7,21 ,B.,B3,&.83
'LVDEOHG 25
(QDEOHG ,*3,&.83 $1'
6(77,1*
$1' 6(77,1*6
1(875$/',52&%/. $1'
1(875$/',52&):'
(&$
2II
1(875$/',52&):' )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
/,0,7$1*/(
6(77,1* $1' 1(875$/',52&):'
1(875$/',52& 1(875$/',52&5(9
6285&( /,0,7$1*/(
1(875$/',52&32/ 1(875$/',52&
92/7 2))6(7
581
1(875$/',52&23
&855
):'
`
0HDVXUHG9; 25
&DOFXODWHG9B ):'
F\
9B $1'
=HUR6HT&UW,B
*URXQG&UW,* ` 5(9
,B 5(9
F\
5
9ROWDJH3RODUL]DWLRQ
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) GROUND CURRENT
GROUND TOC4
MESSAGE See page 5-175.
GROUND IOC1
MESSAGE See page 5-176.
GROUND IOC8
MESSAGE See page 5-176.
A time dial multiplier setting allows selection of a multiple of the base curve shape (where the time dial multiplier = 1) with
the curve shape (CURVE) setting. Unlike the electromechanical time dial equivalent, operate times are directly proportional
to the time multiplier (TD MULTIPLIER) setting value. For example, all times for a multiplier of 10 are 10 times the multiplier 1
or base curve values. Setting the multiplier to zero results in an instantaneous response to all current levels above pickup.
Time overcurrent time calculations are made with an internal energy capacity memory variable. When this variable indi-
cates that the energy capacity has reached 100%, a time overcurrent element will operate. If less than 100% energy capac-
5 ity is accumulated in this variable and the current falls below the dropout threshold of 97 to 98% of the pickup value, the
variable must be reduced. Two methods of this resetting operation are available: “Instantaneous” and “Timed”. The “Instan-
taneous” selection is intended for applications with other relays, such as most static relays, which set the energy capacity
directly to zero when the current falls below the reset threshold. The “Timed” selection can be used where the relay must
coordinate with electromechanical relays.
IEEE CURVES:
The IEEE time overcurrent curve shapes conform to industry standards and the IEEE C37.112-1996 curve classifications
for extremely, very, and moderately inverse. The IEEE curves are derived from the formulae:
A tr
---------------------------------- + B -----------------------------------
-
I p
T = TDM --------------- , T TDM I 2 (EQ 5.32)
1 – ----------------
- =
I pickup – 1
RESET
I pickup
where: T = operate time (in seconds), TDM = Multiplier setting, I = input current, Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
A, B, p = constants, TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is “Timed”),
tr = characteristic constant
IEC CURVES
For European applications, the relay offers three standard curves defined in IEC 255-4 and British standard BS142. These
are defined as IEC Curve A, IEC Curve B, and IEC Curve C. The formulae for these curves are:
K tr
--------------------------------------- --------------------------------------
-
T = TDM I I pickup E – 1 , T RESET = TDM 1 – I I 2 (EQ 5.33)
pickup
where: T = operate time (in seconds), TDM = Multiplier setting, I = input current, Ipickup = Pickup Current setting, K, E =
constants, tr = characteristic constant, and TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100%
and RESET is “Timed”)
IAC CURVES:
The curves for the General Electric type IAC relay family are derived from the formulae:
B D E tr
T = TDM A + ------------------------------ + -------------------------------------2- + -------------------------------------3- , T RESET = TDM -------------------------------
- (EQ 5.34)
I I pkp – C I I – C I I – C 2
pkp pkp 1 – I I pkp
where: T = operate time (in seconds), TDM = Multiplier setting, I = Input current, Ipkp = Pickup Current setting, A to E =
constants, tr = characteristic constant, and TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100%
and RESET is “Timed”)
I2t CURVES:
The curves for the I2t are derived from the formulae:
100 100
-------------------------- ----------------------------
T = TDM ---------------
I 2 , T RESET = TDM I – 2
- ---------------- (EQ 5.35)
I pickup I pickup
where: T = Operate Time (sec.); TDM = Multiplier Setting; I = Input Current; Ipickup = Pickup Current Setting;
TRESET = Reset Time in sec. (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET: Timed)
FLEXCURVES™:
The custom FlexCurves™ are described in detail in the FlexCurves™ section of this chapter. The curve shapes for the
FlexCurves™ are derived from the formulae:
5 I
T = TDM FlexCurve Time at ----------------
I
when ---------------- 1.00 (EQ 5.36)
I pickup I pickup
I I
T RESET = TDM FlexCurve Time at ---------------- when ---------------- 0.98 (EQ 5.37)
I pickup I pickup
This element can provide a desired time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied current or be used as a simple
definite time element. The ground current input value is the quantity measured by the ground input CT and is the funda-
mental phasor or RMS magnitude. Two methods of resetting operation are available: “Timed” and “Instantaneous” (refer to
the Inverse Time Overcurrent Curve Characteristics section for details). When the element is blocked, the time accumulator
will reset according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to “Instantaneous” and
the element is blocked, the time accumulator will be cleared immediately.
These elements measure the current that is connected to the ground channel of a CT/VT module. The conversion
range of a standard channel is from 0.02 to 46 times the CT rating.
127(
This channel may be also equipped with a sensitive input. The conversion range of a sensitive channel is from
0.002 to 4.6 times the CT rating.
127(
SETTINGS
GROUND TOC1
SETTING INPUT:
GROUND TOC1 GROUND TOC1
FUNCTION: PICKUP:
Disabled = 0 GROUND TOC1
Enabled = 1 CURVE:
GROUND TOC1
TD MULTIPLIER:
GROUND TOC 1 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING
RESET: GROUND TOC1 PKP
GROUND TOC1
AND RUN IG t PICKUP GROUND TOC1 DPO
SOURCE:
GROUND TOC1 OP
IG t
I
SETTING
GROUND TOC1
BLOCK:
827036A3.VSD
Off = 0
The ground instantaneous overcurrent element may be used as an instantaneous element with no intentional delay or as a
5 definite time element. The ground current input is the quantity measured by the ground input CT and is the fundamental
phasor magnitude.
These elements measure the current that is connected to the ground channel of a CT/VT module. The conversion
range of a standard channel is from 0.02 to 46 times the CT rating.
127(
This channel may be equipped with a standard or sensitive input. The conversion range of a sensitive channel is
from 0.002 to 4.6 times the CT rating.
127(
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING GROUND IOC1 PKP
GROUND IOC1
GROUND IOIC DPO
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0 SETTINGS GROUND IOC1 OP
Enabled = 1 GROUND IOC1 PICKUP
SETTING DELAY:
GROUND IOC1 GROUND IOC1 RESET
SETTING
PICKUP: DELAY:
GROUND IOC1
AND RUN tPKP
SOURCE:
IG
IG t PICKUP tRST
SETTING
GROUND IOC1
BLOCK:
827037A4.VSD
Off = 0
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) BREAKER FAILURE BREAKER FAILURE 1(2)
In general, a breaker failure scheme determines that a breaker signaled to trip has not cleared a fault within a definite time,
so further tripping action must be performed. Tripping from the breaker failure scheme should trip all breakers, both local
and remote, that can supply current to the faulted zone. Usually operation of a breaker failure element will cause clearing of
a larger section of the power system than the initial trip. Because breaker failure can result in tripping a large number of
breakers and this affects system safety and stability, a very high level of security is required.
Two schemes are provided: one for three-pole tripping only (identified by the name “3BF”) and one for three pole plus sin-
gle-pole operation (identified by the name “1BF”). The philosophy used in these schemes is identical. The operation of a
breaker failure element includes three stages: initiation, determination of a breaker failure condition, and output.
INITIATION STAGE:
A FlexLogic™ operand representing the protection trip signal initially sent to the breaker must be selected to initiate the
scheme. The initiating signal should be sealed-in if primary fault detection can reset before the breaker failure timers have
finished timing. The seal-in is supervised by current level, so it is reset when the fault is cleared. If desired, an incomplete
sequence seal-in reset can be implemented by using the initiating operand to also initiate a FlexLogic™ timer, set longer
than any breaker failure timer, whose output operand is selected to block the breaker failure scheme.
Schemes can be initiated either directly or with current level supervision. It is particularly important in any application to
decide if a current-supervised initiate is to be used. The use of a current-supervised initiate results in the breaker failure ele-
ment not being initiated for a breaker that has very little or no current flowing through it, which may be the case for trans-
former faults. For those situations where it is required to maintain breaker fail coverage for fault levels below the BF1 PH
AMP SUPV PICKUP or the BF1 N AMP SUPV PICKUP setting, a current supervised initiate should not be used. This feature
should be utilized for those situations where coordinating margins may be reduced when high speed reclosing is used.
Thus, if this choice is made, fault levels must always be above the supervision pickup levels for dependable operation of
the breaker fail scheme. This can also occur in breaker-and-a-half or ring bus configurations where the first breaker closes
into a fault; the protection trips and attempts to initiate breaker failure for the second breaker, which is in the process of
closing, but does not yet have current flowing through it.
When the scheme is initiated, it immediately sends a trip signal to the breaker initially signaled to trip (this feature is usually
described as re-trip). This reduces the possibility of widespread tripping that results from a declaration of a failed breaker.
DETERMINATION OF A BREAKER FAILURE CONDITION:
The schemes determine a breaker failure condition via three paths. Each of these paths is equipped with a time delay, after
which a failed breaker is declared and trip signals are sent to all breakers required to clear the zone. The delayed paths are
associated with breaker failure timers 1, 2, and 3, which are intended to have delays increasing with increasing timer num-
bers. These delayed paths are individually enabled to allow for maximum flexibility.
Timer 1 logic (early path) is supervised by a fast-operating breaker auxiliary contact. If the breaker is still closed (as indi-
cated by the auxiliary contact) and fault current is detected after the delay interval, an output is issued. Operation of the
breaker auxiliary switch indicates that the breaker has mechanically operated. The continued presence of current indicates
that the breaker has failed to interrupt the circuit.
Timer 2 logic (main path) is not supervised by a breaker auxiliary contact. If fault current is detected after the delay interval,
an output is issued. This path is intended to detect a breaker that opens mechanically but fails to interrupt fault current; the
logic therefore does not use a breaker auxiliary contact.
The timer 1 and 2 paths provide two levels of current supervision, high-set and low-set, that allow the supervision level to
change from a current which flows before a breaker inserts an opening resistor into the faulted circuit to a lower level after
resistor insertion. The high-set detector is enabled after timeout of timer 1 or 2, along with a timer that will enable the low-
set detector after its delay interval. The delay interval between high-set and low-set is the expected breaker opening time.
Both current detectors provide a fast operating time for currents at small multiples of the pickup value. The overcurrent
detectors are required to operate after the breaker failure delay interval to eliminate the need for very fast resetting overcur-
rent detectors.
Timer 3 logic (slow path) is supervised by a breaker auxiliary contact and a control switch contact used to indicate that the
breaker is in or out-of-service, disabling this path when the breaker is out-of-service for maintenance. There is no current
level check in this logic as it is intended to detect low magnitude faults and it is therefore the slowest to operate. 5
OUTPUT:
The outputs from the schemes are:
• FlexLogic™ operands that report on the operation of portions of the scheme
• FlexLogic™ operand used to re-trip the protected breaker
• FlexLogic™ operands that initiate tripping required to clear the faulted zone. The trip output can be sealed-in for an
adjustable period.
• Target message indicating a failed breaker has been declared
• Illumination of the faceplate Trip LED (and the Phase A, B or C LED, if applicable)
MAIN PATH SEQUENCE:
FAULT cycles
OCCURS
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
827083A6.CDR
0.8
Margin
Maximum
0.4
0.2
0
0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140
Mulitple of pickup fault current
threshold setting 836769A4.CDR
• BF1 BKR POS1 A/3P: This setting selects the FlexLogic™ operand that represents the protected breaker early-type
auxiliary switch contact (52/a). When using the single-pole breaker failure scheme, this operand represents the pro-
tected breaker early-type auxiliary switch contact on pole A. This is normally a non-multiplied form-A contact. The con-
tact may even be adjusted to have the shortest possible operating time.
• BF1 BKR POS2 A/3P: This setting selects the FlexLogic™ operand that represents the breaker normal-type auxiliary
switch contact (52/a). When using the single-pole breaker failure scheme, this operand represents the protected
breaker auxiliary switch contact on pole A. This may be a multiplied contact.
• BF1 BREAKER TEST ON: This setting is used to select the FlexLogic™ operand that represents the breaker in-ser-
vice/out-of-service switch set to the out-of-service position.
• BF1 PH AMP HISET PICKUP: This setting sets the phase current output supervision level. Generally this setting
should detect the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker, before a breaker opening resistor is inserted.
• BF1 N AMP HISET PICKUP: This setting sets the neutral current output supervision level. Generally this setting
should detect the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker, before a breaker opening resistor is inserted.
Neutral current supervision is used only in the three pole scheme to provide increased sensitivity. This setting is valid
only for three-pole breaker failure schemes.
• BF1 PH AMP LOSET PICKUP: This setting sets the phase current output supervision level. Generally this setting
should detect the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker, after a breaker opening resistor is inserted
(approximately 90% of the resistor current).
• BF1 N AMP LOSET PICKUP: This setting sets the neutral current output supervision level. Generally this setting
should detect the lowest expected fault current on the protected breaker, after a breaker opening resistor is inserted
(approximately 90% of the resistor current). This setting is valid only for three-pole breaker failure schemes.
• BF1 LOSET TIME DELAY: Sets the pickup delay for current detection after opening resistor insertion.
• BF1 TRIP DROPOUT DELAY: This setting is used to set the period of time for which the trip output is sealed-in. This
timer must be coordinated with the automatic reclosing scheme of the failed breaker, to which the breaker failure ele-
5
ment sends a cancel reclosure signal. Reclosure of a remote breaker can also be prevented by holding a transfer trip
signal on longer than the reclaim time.
• BF1 PH A INITIATE / BF1 PH B INITIATE / BF 1 PH C INITIATE: These settings select the FlexLogic™ operand to ini-
tiate phase A, B, or C single-pole tripping of the breaker and the phase A, B, or C portion of the scheme, accordingly.
This setting is only valid for single-pole breaker failure schemes.
• BF1 BKR POS1 B / BF1 BKR POS 1 C: These settings select the FlexLogic™ operand to represents the protected
breaker early-type auxiliary switch contact on poles B or C, accordingly. This contact is normally a non-multiplied Form-
A contact. The contact may even be adjusted to have the shortest possible operating time. This setting is valid only for
single-pole breaker failure schemes.
• BF1 BKR POS2 B: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand that represents the protected breaker normal-type auxiliary
switch contact on pole B (52/a). This may be a multiplied contact. This setting is valid only for single-pole breaker fail-
ure schemes.
• BF1 BKR POS2 C: This setting selects the FlexLogic™ operand that represents the protected breaker normal-type
auxiliary switch contact on pole C (52/a). This may be a multiplied contact. For single-pole operation, the scheme has
the same overall general concept except that it provides re-tripping of each single pole of the protected breaker. The
approach shown in the following single pole tripping diagram uses the initiating information to determine which pole is
supposed to trip. The logic is segregated on a per-pole basis. The overcurrent detectors have ganged settings. This
setting is valid only for single-pole breaker failure schemes.
Upon operation of the breaker failure element for a single pole trip command, a three-pole trip command should be
given via output operand BKR FAIL 1 TRIP OP.
6(77,1*6
)XQFWLRQ
(QDEOHG
'LVDEOHG 25 ,QLWLDWHG
$1' WREUHDNHUIDLOXUH
%ORFN
VLQJOHSROHORJLFVKHHW
2II
6(77,1*
3KDVH$,QLWLDWH
2II
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
6(77,1* 25
$1' %.5)$,/5(75,3$
7KUHH3ROH,QLWLDWH
2II 25
$1' ,QLWLDWHGSKDVH$
6(77,1*
WREUHDNHUIDLOXUH
8VH6HDO,Q VLQJOHSROHORJLFVKHHW
<HV 6HDOLQSDWK
1R
$1' 25
6(77,1* 25
8VH$PS6XSHUYLVLRQ
<HV
1R 25
$1' )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
6(77,1*
$1' %.5)$,/5(75,3%
3KDVH%,QLWLDWH 25 6HDOLQSDWK
2II
,QLWLDWHGSKDVH%
25
6(77,1* WREUHDNHUIDLOXUH
3KDVH&,QLWLDWH 25 VLQJOHSROHORJLFVKHHW
2II
25
$1'
6(77,1*
5
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
3KDVH&XUUHQW
6XSHUYLVLRQ3LFNXS 6HDOLQSDWK $1' %.5)$,/5(75,3&
581
,$3LFNXS
6(77,1*
6(77,1*
6RXUFH 581
,$ ,%3LFNXS 25 ,QLWLDWHGSKDVH&
,% WREUHDNHUIDLOXUH
581
VLQJOHSROHORJLFVKHHW
,& ,&3LFNXS
,&
WREUHDNHUIDLOXUH
,% VLQJOHSROHORJLFVKHHW
,$
$&'5
GE Multilin
%UHDNHU3RV3KDVH$3 )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
2II 25 %.5)$,/723
8VH7LPHU
5 SETTINGS
6(77,1* 6(77,1*
1R 7LPHU3LFNXS'HOD\ $1' 3KDVH&XUUHQW+L6HW3LFNXS
<HV 581
25
$1' ,$ 3LFNXS
,QLWLDWHGSKDVH$
IURPVLQJOHSROHEUHDNHU 6(77,1*
IDLOXUHORJLFVKHHW 6(77,1*
7LPHU3LFNXS'HOD\ /R6HW7LPH'HOD\ 6(77,1*
3KDVH&XUUHQW/R6HW3LFNXS
6(77,1*
$1' 581
8VH7LPHU
<HV ,$ 3LFNXS
1R
6(77,1*
6(77,1*6
7LPHU3LFNXS'HOD\ $1' 6(77,1*
%UHDNHU3RV3KDVH%
3KDVH&XUUHQW+L6HW3LFNXS
2II
$1' 25 581
,QLWLDWHGSKDVH% ,% 3LFNXS
IURPVLQJOHSROHEUHDNHU 6(77,1*
IDLOXUHORJLFVKHHW 6(77,1*
6(77,1* 7ULS'URSRXW'HOD\
7LPHU3LFNXS'HOD\
/R6HW7LPH'HOD\ 6(77,1* )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
3KDVH&XUUHQW/R6HW3LFNXS 25 %.5)$,/75,323
$1'
6(77,1*6 581
%UHDNHU3RV3KDVH%
,% 3LFNXS
2II
6(77,1*
6(77,1*
$1' 3KDVH&XUUHQW+L6HW3LFNXS
7LPHU3LFNXS'HOD\
581
,$
,%
,&
,QLWLDWHG
IURPVLQJOHSROHEUHDNHUIDLOXUHORJLFVKHHW $&'5
5.6 GROUPED ELEMENTS
5-183
5
5.6 GROUPED ELEMENTS 5 SETTINGS
SETTING
BF1 FUNCTION:
Disable=0
Enable=1
SETTING AND
BF1 BLOCK:
Off=0
SETTING
BF1 INITIATE:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
TO SHEET 2 OF 2
SETTING (Initiated)
BF1 USE SEAL-IN:
YES=1
NO=0
AND
Seal In Path
AND
OR
5 SETTING
BF1 USE AMP SUPV:
YES=1
NO=0 OR
SETTINGS
BF1 PH AMP SUPV
PICKUP:
RUN
IA ³ PICKUP
IA
RUN
IB IB ³ PICKUP
OR
RUN
IC IC ³ PICKUP
RUN
IN ³ PICKUP
IN
TO SHEET 2 OF 2
(827068.cdr)
827067A5.cdr
GE Multilin
YES=1 AND 0 BKR FAIL 1 T1 OP
5 SETTINGS
NO=0
SETTING
BF1 BKR POS1 ΦA/3P:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING
BF1 TIMER2 PICKUP
SETTING DELAY:
OR
BF1 USE TIMER 2:
AND 0
YES=1
NO=0
SETTINGS
BF1 PH AMP HISET
PICKUP:
RUN
IB
IB ³ PICKUP
RUN
IC
IC ³ PICKUP
RUN
IN
IN ³ PICKUP
Off=0 RUN
SETTING IN ³ PICKUP
827068A7.cdr
5-185
5
5.6 GROUPED ELEMENTS 5 SETTINGS
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) VOLTAGE ELEMENTS
5 MESSAGE
NEG SEQ OV 2
See page 5-191.
NEG SEQ OV 3
MESSAGE See page 5-191.
AUXILIARY UV1
MESSAGE See page 5-192.
AUXILIARY UV2
MESSAGE See page 5-192.
AUXILIARY OV1
MESSAGE See page 5-193.
AUXILIARY OV2
MESSAGE See page 5-193.
These protection elements can be used for a variety of applications such as:
• Undervoltage Protection: For voltage sensitive loads, such as induction motors, a drop in voltage increases the
drawn current which may cause dangerous overheating in the motor. The undervoltage protection feature can be used
to either cause a trip or generate an alarm when the voltage drops below a specified voltage setting for a specified time
delay.
• Permissive Functions: The undervoltage feature may be used to block the functioning of external devices by operat-
ing an output relay when the voltage falls below the specified voltage setting. The undervoltage feature may also be
used to block the functioning of other elements through the block feature of those elements.
• Source Transfer Schemes: In the event of an undervoltage, a transfer signal may be generated to transfer a load
from its normal source to a standby or emergency power source.
The undervoltage elements can be programmed to have a definite time delay characteristic. The definite time curve oper-
ates when the voltage drops below the pickup level for a specified period of time. The time delay is adjustable from 0 to
600.00 seconds in steps of 0.01. The undervoltage elements can also be programmed to have an inverse time delay char-
acteristic.
The undervoltage delay setting defines the family of curves shown below.
D
T = ---------------------------------- (EQ 5.40)
V
1 – ------------------
V pickup
Time (seconds)
5
% of voltage pickup
842788A1.CDR
127(
This element may be used to give a desired time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied fundamental voltage
(phase-to-ground or phase-to-phase for wye VT connection, or phase-to-phase for delta VT connection) or as a definite
time element. The element resets instantaneously if the applied voltage exceeds the dropout voltage. The delay setting
selects the minimum operating time of the phase undervoltage. The minimum voltage setting selects the operating voltage
below which the element is blocked (a setting of “0” will allow a dead source to be considered a fault condition).
6(77,1* 6(77,1*
3+$6(89 3+$6(89
)81&7,21 3,&.83
'LVDEOHG 3+$6(89
(QDEOHG &859(
3+$6(89
6(77,1* '(/$< )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
$1'
3+$6(89 $1'
581 9$*RU9$%3,&.83 3+$6(89$3.3
%/2&. W 3+$6(89$'32
2II 3+$6(89$23
9
6(77,1*
6(77,1* $1'
581 9%*RU9%&3,&.83 3+$6(89%3.3
3+$6(89
W 3+$6(89%'32
3+$6(896285&( 0,1,08092/7$*(
3+$6(89%23
9$*RU9$%0LQLPXP
6RXUFH97 'HOWD 9
`
9%*RU9%&0LQLPXP
9$% $1'
581 9&*RU9&$3,&.83 3+$6(89&3.3
9&*RU9&$0LQLPXP
9%& W 3+$6(89&'32
9&$ 3+$6(89&23
6RXUFH97 :\H 9
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
6(77,1* 25 3+$6(893.3
3+$6(8902'(
$%&'5
The phase overvoltage element may be used as an instantaneous element with no intentional time delay or as a definite
time element. The input voltage is the phase-to-phase voltage, either measured directly from delta-connected VTs or as cal-
culated from phase-to-ground (wye) connected VTs. The specific voltages to be used for each phase are shown below. 5
SETTINGS
SETTING
PHASE OV1 PICKUP
PHASE OV1 SETTING DELAY:
FUNCTION: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
PHASE OV1 PHASE OV1 RESET
Disabled = 0 PICKUP: DELAY: PHASE OV1 A PKP
Enabled = 1 PHASE OV1 A DPO
RUN tPKP
VAB ≥ PICKUP PHASE OV1 A OP
tRST
PHASE OV1 B PKP
SETTING
AND RUN tPKP PHASE OV1 B DPO
PHASE OV1 VBC ≥ PICKUP
BLOCK: PHASE OV1 B OP
tRST
RUN PHASE OV1 C PKP
Off = 0
VCA ≥ PICKUP tPKP PHASE OV1 C DPO
PHASE OV1 C OP
tRST
SETTING
PHASE OV1
SOURCE: FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Source VT = Delta OR PHASE OV1 OP
VAB
VBC
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
VCA
AND PHASE OV1 DPO
Source VT = Wye
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR PHASE OV1 PKP
827066A7.CDR
SETTING
NEG SEQ OV1
FUNCTION:
SETTING
Enabled = 1
NEG SEQ OV1 PICKUP: SETTINGS
SETTING NEG SEQ OV1 PICKUP
AND RUN DELAY:
NEG SEQ OV1 BLOCK: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
NEG SEQ OV1 RESET
NEG SEQ OV1 PKP
DELAY:
Off = 0 NEG SEQ OV1 DPO
t PKP
t RST NEG SEQ OV1 OP
SETTING V_2 > PICKUP
NEG SEQ OV1 SIGNAL
SOURCE:
NEG SEQ VOLTAGE V_2
827839A4.CDR
SETTING
AUX UV1
FUNCTION: SETTING
Disabled=0
AUX UV1 PICKUP:
Enabled=1
827849A2.CDR
The M60 contains one auxiliary overvoltage element for each VT bank. This element is intended for monitoring overvoltage
conditions of the auxiliary voltage. The nominal secondary voltage of the auxiliary voltage channel entered under SYSTEM
SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK X5 AUXILIARY VT X5 SECONDARY is the per-unit (pu) base used when setting the 5
pickup level.
A typical application for this element is monitoring the zero-sequence voltage (3V_0) supplied from an open-corner-delta
VT connection.
6(77,1*
$8;29
)81&7,21
'LVDEOHG
6(77,1*
(QDEOHG
$8;293,&.83 6(77,1*
6(77,1*
$1' 581 $8;293,&.83
'(/$<
$8;29%/2&.
$8;295(6(7
2II '(/$<
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
9[3LFNXS W3.3
6(77,1* W567 $8;2923
$8;29'32
$8;296,*1$/
6285&( $8;293.3
$8;,/,$5<92/79[
$&'5
Control elements are generally used for control rather than protection. See the Introduction to Elements section at the
beginning of this chapter for further information.
The trip bus element allows aggregating outputs of protection and control elements without using FlexLogic™ and assign-
ing them a simple and effective manner. Each trip bus can be assigned for either trip or alarm actions. Simple trip condition-
ing such as latch, delay, and seal-in delay are available.
The easiest way to assign element outputs to a trip bus is through the EnerVista UR Setup software A protection summary
is displayed by navigating to a specific protection or control protection element and checking the desired bus box. Once the
desired element is selected for a specific bus, a list of element operate-type operands are displayed and can be assigned
to a trip bus. If more than one operate-type operand is required, it may be assigned directly from the trip bus menu.
SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 1
SETTINGS
= Off
TRIP BUS 1 PICKUP
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 2
DELAY
= Off Non-volatile,
TRIP BUS 1 RESET
OR set-dominant
***
DELAY
AND S TPKP FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
TRIP BUS 1 INPUT 16 TRIP BUS 1 OP
Latch
= Off TRST
R
SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
FUNCTION
TRIP BUS 1 PKP
= Enabled
TRIP BUS 1 BLOCK AND
= Off
SETTINGS
TRIP BUS 1
LATCHING
= Enabled
TRIP BUS 1 RESET
= Off
OR
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
RESET OP 842023A1.CDR
5 MESSAGE
GROUP 6 NAME: Range: up to 16 alphanumeric characters
The setting groups menu controls the activation and deactivation of up to six possible groups of settings in the GROUPED
ELEMENTS settings menu. The faceplate Settings In Use LEDs indicate which active group (with a non-flashing energized
LED) is in service.
The SETTING GROUPS BLK setting prevents the active setting group from changing when the FlexLogic™ parameter is set to
"On". This can be useful in applications where it is undesirable to change the settings under certain conditions, such as the
breaker being open.
The GROUP 2 ACTIVATE ON to GROUP 6 ACTIVATE ON settings select a FlexLogic™ operand which, when set, will make the
particular setting group active for use by any grouped element. A priority scheme ensures that only one group is active at a
given time – the highest-numbered group which is activated by its ACTIVATE ON parameter takes priority over the lower-
numbered groups. There is no activate on setting for group 1 (the default active group), because group 1 automatically
becomes active if no other group is active.
The SETTING GROUP 1 NAME to SETTING GROUP 6 NAME settings allows to user to assign a name to each of the six settings
groups. Once programmed, this name will appear on the second line of the GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6)
menu display.
The relay can be set up via a FlexLogic™ equation to receive requests to activate or de-activate a particular non-default
settings group. The following FlexLogic™ equation (see the figure below) illustrates requests via remote communications
(for example, VIRTUAL INPUT 1 ON) or from a local contact input (for example, CONTACT IP 1 ON) to initiate the use of a par-
ticular settings group, and requests from several overcurrent pickup measuring elements to inhibit the use of the particular
settings group. The assigned VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 operand is used to control the “On” state of a particular settings group.
1 VIRT IP 1 ON (VI1)
OR (2)
2 CONT IP 1 ON (H5A)
3 OR (2)
AND (3) = VIRT OP 1 (VO1)
4 PHASE TOC1 PKP
5 NOT
7 NOT
8 AND (3)
9 = VIRT OP 1 (VO1)
10 END
842789A1.CDR
5
MESSAGE
RANGE: 7
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT: Range: 3.0 to 60.0 s in steps of 0.1
MESSAGE
5.0 s
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP Range: Time-out, Acknowledge
MESSAGE
MODE: Time-out
SELECTOR 1 ACK: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A1: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
SELECTOR 1 3BIT A2: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
SELECTOR 1 3BIT Range: Time-out, Acknowledge
MESSAGE
MODE: Time-out
SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP Range: Restore, Synchronize, Sync/Restore
MESSAGE
MODE: Restore
SELECTOR 1 TARGETS: Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
MESSAGE
Self-reset
SELECTOR 1 EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
Disabled
The selector switch element is intended to replace a mechanical selector switch. Typical applications include setting group
control or control of multiple logic sub-circuits in user-programmable logic.
The element provides for two control inputs. The step-up control allows stepping through selector position one step at a
time with each pulse of the control input, such as a user-programmable pushbutton. The three-bit control input allows set-
ting the selector to the position defined by a three-bit word.
The element allows pre-selecting a new position without applying it. The pre-selected position gets applied either after time-
out or upon acknowledgement via separate inputs (user setting). The selector position is stored in non-volatile memory.
Upon power-up, either the previous position is restored or the relay synchronizes to the current three-bit word (user set-
ting). Basic alarm functionality alerts the user under abnormal conditions; for example, the three-bit control input being out
of range.
A selector switch runs every two power cycles.
• SELECTOR 1 FULL RANGE: This setting defines the upper position of the selector. When stepping up through avail-
able positions of the selector, the upper position wraps up to the lower position (position 1). When using a direct three-
bit control word for programming the selector to a desired position, the change would take place only if the control word
is within the range of 1 to the SELECTOR FULL RANGE. If the control word is outside the range, an alarm is established
by setting the SELECTOR ALARM FlexLogic™ operand for three seconds.
• SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT: This setting defines the time-out period for the selector. This value is used by the relay in
the following two ways. When the SELECTOR STEP-UP MODE is “Time-out”, the setting specifies the required period of
inactivity of the control input after which the pre-selected position is automatically applied. When the SELECTOR STEP-
UP MODE is “Acknowledge”, the setting specifies the period of time for the acknowledging input to appear. The timer is
re-started by any activity of the control input. The acknowledging input must come before the SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT
timer expires; otherwise, the change will not take place and an alarm will be set.
• SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP: This setting specifies a control input for the selector switch. The switch is shifted to a new
5 position at each rising edge of this signal. The position changes incrementally, wrapping up from the last (SELECTOR 1
FULL RANGE) to the first (position 1). Consecutive pulses of this control operand must not occur faster than every
50 ms. After each rising edge of the assigned operand, the time-out timer is restarted and the SELECTOR SWITCH 1:
POS Z CHNG INITIATED target message is displayed, where Z the pre-selected position. The message is displayed for
the time specified by the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting. The pre-selected position is applied after the selector times out
(“Time-out” mode), or when the acknowledging signal appears before the element times out (“Acknowledge” mode).
When the new position is applied, the relay displays the SELECTOR SWITCH 1: POSITION Z IN USE message. Typically,
a user-programmable pushbutton is configured as the stepping up control input.
• SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP MODE: This setting defines the selector mode of operation. When set to “Time-out”, the
selector will change its position after a pre-defined period of inactivity at the control input. The change is automatic and
does not require any explicit confirmation of the intent to change the selector's position. When set to “Acknowledge”,
the selector will change its position only after the intent is confirmed through a separate acknowledging signal. If the
acknowledging signal does not appear within a pre-defined period of time, the selector does not accept the change
and an alarm is established by setting the SELECTOR STP ALARM output FlexLogic™ operand for three seconds.
• SELECTOR 1 ACK: This setting specifies an acknowledging input for the stepping up control input. The pre-selected
position is applied on the rising edge of the assigned operand. This setting is active only under “Acknowledge” mode of
operation. The acknowledging signal must appear within the time defined by the SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT setting after the
last activity of the control input. A user-programmable pushbutton is typically configured as the acknowledging input.
• SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0, A1, and A2: These settings specify a three-bit control input of the selector. The three-bit con-
trol word pre-selects the position using the following encoding convention:
A2 A1 A0 POSITION
0 0 0 rest
0 0 1 1
0 1 0 2
0 1 1 3
1 0 0 4
1 0 1 5
1 1 0 6
1 1 1 7
The “rest” position (0, 0, 0) does not generate an action and is intended for situations when the device generating the
three-bit control word is having a problem. When SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE is “Time-out”, the pre-selected position is
applied in SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT seconds after the last activity of the three-bit input. When SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE is
“Acknowledge”, the pre-selected position is applied on the rising edge of the SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK acknowledging
input.
The stepping up control input (SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP) and the three-bit control inputs (SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0 through A2)
lock-out mutually: once the stepping up sequence is initiated, the three-bit control input is inactive; once the three-bit
control sequence is initiated, the stepping up input is inactive.
• SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE: This setting defines the selector mode of operation. When set to “Time-out”, the selector
changes its position after a pre-defined period of inactivity at the control input. The change is automatic and does not
require explicit confirmation to change the selector position. When set to “Acknowledge”, the selector changes its posi-
tion only after confirmation via a separate acknowledging signal. If the acknowledging signal does not appear within a
pre-defined period of time, the selector rejects the change and an alarm established by invoking the SELECTOR BIT
ALARM FlexLogic™ operand for 3 seconds.
• SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK: This setting specifies an acknowledging input for the three-bit control input. The pre-
selected position is applied on the rising edge of the assigned FlexLogic™ operand. This setting is active only under
the “Acknowledge” mode of operation. The acknowledging signal must appear within the time defined by the SELEC-
TOR TIME-OUT setting after the last activity of the three-bit control inputs. Note that the stepping up control input and
three-bit control input have independent acknowledging signals (SELECTOR 1 ACK and SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK, accord-
ingly).
• SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP MODE: This setting specifies the element behavior on power up of the relay.
When set to “Restore”, the last position of the selector (stored in the non-volatile memory) is restored after powering up
the relay. If the position restored from memory is out of range, position 0 (no output operand selected) is applied and
an alarm is set (SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM).
5
When set to “Synchronize” selector switch acts as follows. For two power cycles, the selector applies position 0 to the
switch and activates SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM. After two power cycles expire, the selector synchronizes to the position
dictated by the three-bit control input. This operation does not wait for time-out or the acknowledging input. When the
synchronization attempt is unsuccessful (that is, the three-bit input is not available (0,0,0) or out of range) then the
selector switch output is set to position 0 (no output operand selected) and an alarm is established (SELECTOR 1 PWR
ALARM).
The operation of “Synch/Restore” mode is similar to the “Synchronize” mode. The only difference is that after an
unsuccessful synchronization attempt, the switch will attempt to restore the position stored in the relay memory. The
“Synch/Restore” mode is useful for applications where the selector switch is employed to change the setting group in
redundant (two relay) protection schemes.
• SELECTOR 1 EVENTS: If enabled, the following events are logged:
The following figures illustrate the operation of the selector switch. In these diagrams, “T” represents a time-out setting.
7,0(28702'(2)23(5$7,21
67(383
7 7
%,7$
%,7$
%,7$
7 7
326
326
326
326
5 326
326
326
%,7
%,7
%,7
673$/$50
%,7$/$50
$/$50
($"'#'1!34B
$&.12:/('*(02'(2)23(5$7,21
67(383
$&.
%,7$
%,7$
%,7$
%,7$&.
326
326
326
326
326
326
5
326
%,7
%,7
%,7
673$/$50
%,7$/$50
$/$50
($"'#&1!34B
Now, assign the contact output operation (assume the H6E module) to the selector switch element by making the following
changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS menu:
OUTPUT H1 OPERATE: “SELECTOR 1 BIT 0"
OUTPUT H2 OPERATE: “SELECTOR 1 BIT 1"
OUTPUT H3 OPERATE: “SELECTOR 1 BIT 2"
Finally, assign configure user-programmable pushbutton 1 by making the following changes in the SETTINGS PRODUCT
SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS USER PUSHBUTTON 1 menu:
6(77,1*6
6(/(&725)8//5$1*(
6(/(&72567(38302'(
6(/(&725%,702'(
$&78$/9$/8(
5
6(/(&7257,0(287
6(77,1*6
6(/(&725326,7,21
6(/(&725)81&7,21 6(/(&72532:(58302'(
(QDEOHG 581
6(/(&72567(383 )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
2II VWHSXS 6(/(&725326
6(/(&725$&. 6(/(&725326
2II DFNQRZOHGJH 6(/(&725326
6(/(&725%,7$
6(/(&725326
WKUHHELWFRQWUROLQSXW
2II 6(/(&725326
21
6(/(&725%,7$
6(/(&725326
2II
6(/(&725326
6(/(&725%,7$
2II )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
6(/(&725%,7$&.
6(/(&725673$/$50
2II ELWDFNQRZOHGJH
6(/(&725%,7$/$50
ELWSRVLWLRQRXW
25
6(/(&725$/$50
6(/(&7253:5$/$50
6(/(&725%,7
6(/(&725%,7
6(/(&725%,7
$&'5
5.7.5 UNDERFREQUENCY
6(77,1*
81'(5)5(4)81&7,21
'LVDEOHG
(QDEOHG
5.7.6 OVERFREQUENCY
SETTING
OVERFREQ 1 FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
SETTING
Enabled = 1
OVERFREQ 1 PICKUP : SETTING
SETTING OVERFREQ 1 PICKUP
AND RUN DELAY :
OVERFREQ 1 BLOCK: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OVERFREQ 1 RESET
OVERFREQ 1 PKP
DELAY :
Off = 0 OVERFREQ 1 DPO
tPKP
tRST OVERFREQ 1 OP
SETTING f ≥ PICKUP
OVERFREQ 1 SOURCE:
Frequency 827832A5.CDR
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS START SUPERVISION
The motor start supervision feature consists of three elements that guard against excessive starting duty. These elements
are in addition to the start inhibit that could be imposed by the thermal model. A method to prevent starting is by wiring an
M60 output contact actuated by motor start supervision elements in the motor energizing control circuit. The output contact
changes state only when the motor is stopped to accommodate control circuits that must be continuously energized such
as a contactor.
The three elements of motor start supervision are:
1. Maximum starting rate (starts per hour): This element defines the number of starts attempts allowed in a program-
mable time interval. Only the number of re-start attempts during the interval is controlled and not the time in between.
The latter is controlled by the time between starts element. When the motor is stopped after the last allowed start the
energizing or closing control circuit is disabled until the end of the defined interval. Every start initiate a new interval in
which the start number is limited A typical starting frequency is three starts per hour.
2. Time between starts: This function enforces a programmable minimum time duration between two successive starts
attempts. A time delay is initiated with every start and if the motor is stopped a restart is not allowed until the specified
interval has lapsed.
3. Restart Delay: The restart delay function defines a programmable delay after a motor has stopped before it can be
started again. It allows load interruption transient conditions such as down-hole pump applications where gravitational
force causes reverse rotation to subside. Starting when the load is reversing could cause damage to the motor or
pump.
The element can be programmed to perform classical monitoring function of Starts Per Hour. However, time interval units
specified by the START/HR TIME INTERVAL setting are in minutes for increased flexibility. The STARTS/HR MAX NUMBER OF
STARTS setting specifies start attempt number limit during the interval. The time unit and ranges accommodate the starting
requirements of large direct-on-line motors.
The element asserts the following three FlexLogic™ operands:
• The STARTS-PER-HOUR PKP operand indicates that the maximum permitted starting rate has been reached. When
5 stopped, the motor should not be restarted until the lockout time elapses.
• The STARTS-PER-HOUR OP operand indicates the motor stopped when the maximum permitted starting rate has been
already reached. This operand should be used to inhibit the start command.
• The STARTS-PER-HOUR DPO operand indicates that the maximum permitted starting rate has not been reached. When
stopped, the motor could be restarted immediately.
The element uses motor status asserted by the Thermal Model element. The thermal protection must be configured prop-
erly in order for this function to operate.
6(77,1*6
6(77,1*6
67$576+5)81&7,21 67$576+57,0(,17(59$/
(QDEOHG 67$576+50$;180%(52)67$576
$1'
67$57
67$57
6723
6723
6723
67$5763(5+28523
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6 $&78$/9$/8(
3.3 23 '32
0272567$57,1*
67$576+5/2&.287
027252))/,1( /2&.2877,0(
UHVHW IURP
6(77,1*6
ORFNRXW
6(77,1*66<67(0
6(78302725
(0(5*(1&<5(67$57
2II
(## !%1"34B
The time between starts element prevents restart attempts in quick succession. It requires that the minimum duration spec-
ified by the TIME BETWEEN STARTS MIN TIME setting expires before a subsequent start attempt is allowed. The time between
starts supervising element complements the maximum starting rate element in that the former controls the time spacing
between starts and the latter limits the number of starts.
The element asserts the following three FlexLogic™ operands:
• The TIME-BTWN-STARTS PKP operand indicates that the time since the last start was too short. When stopped, the
motor should not be restarted until the lockout time elapses.
• The TIME-BTWN-STARTS OP operand indicates the motor stopped when the time since the last start was too short. This
operand should be used to inhibit the start command. 5
• The TIME-BTWN-STARTS DPO operand indicates that the time between last two starts was long enough. When stopped,
the motor could be restarted immediately.
The element uses motor status asserted by the thermal model element. The thermal protection must be configured properly
in order for this function to operate.
6(77,1*6
7,0(%(7:((167$576 6(77,1*
)81&7,21
7,0(%(7:((167$576
(QDEOHG 0,17,0(
7,0(%:167$576%/.
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1'6
2II
$1'
7,0(%7:167$5763.3
W 567
)/(;/2*,&23(5$1' 7,0(%7:167$576'32
$1'
0272567$57,1* 7,0(%7:167$57623
027252))/,1(
$&78$/9$/8(
6(77,1*6
UHVHW IURP
ORFNRXW
%7:167$576/2&.287
6(77,1*66<67(0
6(78302725
(0(5*(1&<5(67$57
2II
(## !&1"34B
d) RESTART DELAY
PATH: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS START SUPERVISION RESTART DELAY
The RESTART DELAY MIN TIME setting specifies the lockout time to start the motor after motor was stopped. The restart delay
element asserts the RESTART DELAY OP FlexLogic™ operand for RESTART DELAY MIN TIME after the motor stopped. The
element uses motor status asserted by the thermal model element. The thermal protection must be configured properly in
order for this function to operate.
6(77,1*
)XQFWLRQ
(QDEOHG 6(77,1*
'LVDEOHG 0LQLPXP7LPH
%ORFN )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
5 )/(;/2*,&23(5$1'
2II $1'
75(6(7
5(67$57'(/$<23
027252))/,1(
$&78$/9$/8(
6(77,1* 5HVWDUW'HOD\/RFNRXW
(PHUJHQF\5HVWDUW
UHVWDUWIURPORFNRXW
2II
IURPWKHPRWRUVHWXSVHWWLQJV $&'5
The M60 can control the transition of a motor start from reduced to full voltage. This feature uses motor load and a supervi-
sory timer to initiate a one second control signal (the REDUCED VOLT CTRL operand) that can be used to switch to full volt-
age. The feature can also assert a trip signal (the REDUCED VOLT OP operand) from the starting logic if the current or timer
transitions do not occur as expected. This transition may be defined as current only, current or timer, or current and timer as
described below.
signifies an
open transition
time
FlexLogic™
operand
states
MOTOR STARTING 5
REDUCED VOLT CTRL
MOTOR RUNNING
833752A1.CDR
• REDUCED VOLT FLA: This setting specifies the current level used when determining the transition mode and initiat-
ing the REDUCED VOLT CTRL operand. This setting should be greater than the product of the MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS
setting and the MOTOR OVERLOAD FACTOR setting. See the Motor Setup section for details.
• REDUCED VOLT TIMER: This setting specifies the timeout value of the transition timer used in the selected transition
mode.
SETTING
REDUCED VOLT FLA
RUN TIMER
0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Motor load < PICKUP
AND REDUCED VOLT OP
50 ms
SETTING OR
TRANSITION MODE
= Current Only AND
= Current or Timer
= Current and Timer TIMER
0 FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND
OR REDUCED VOLT CTRL
1 sec.
OR
SETTING
AND
REDUCED VOLTAGE
STARTING
= Enabled
REDUCED VOLT BLOCK SETTING
= Off REDUCED VOLT TIMER
TPKP
AND
SETTING 0
REDUCED VOLT TIMER
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND 0
MOTOR STARTING
TPKP
833023A1.CDR
127(
As such they can easily fail to react to an input signal or a block signal with a duration less than one power system
cycle. This also means that digital element output can react up to one power system cycle later than the pickup and
reset delay settings indicate.
Do not use digital elements with transient signals, such as communications commands. Do not use digital elements
where random delays of up to one cycle cannot be tolerated, such as in high speed protection.
There are 48 identical digital elements available, numbered 1 to 48. A digital element can monitor any FlexLogic™ operand
and present a target message and/or enable events recording depending on the output operand state. The digital element
settings include a name which will be referenced in any target message, a blocking input from any selected FlexLogic™
operand, and a timer for pickup and reset delays for the output operand.
• DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 INPUT: Selects a FlexLogic™ operand to be monitored by the digital element.
• DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 PICKUP DELAY: Sets the required time delay from element pickup to element operation. If a
pickup delay is not required, set to "0". To avoid nuisance alarms, set the delay greater than the operating time of the
breaker.
• DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 RESET DELAY: Sets the time delay to reset. If a reset delay is not required, set to “0”.
• DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 PICKUP LED: This setting enables or disabled the digital element pickup LED. When set to
“Disabled”, the operation of the pickup LED is blocked.
SETTING
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0 SETTINGS
Enabled = 1 DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
5
SETTING PICKUP DELAY:
DIGITAL ELEMENT DIGITAL ELEMENT 01 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING
01 NAME: RESET DELAY:
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01 DIG ELEM 01 DPO
AND RUN tPKP
INPUT: DIG ELEM 01 PKP
Off = 0 DIG ELEM 01 OP
INPUT = 1 tRST
SETTING
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
BLOCK:
827042A1.VSD
Off = 0
85VHULHVGHYLFH
ZLWKIRUP$FRQWDFWV
+D
,
+E '&²
9 '&
+F D 7ULSFRLO
, FXUUHQWPRQLWRU
9 YROWDJHPRQLWRU $&'5
85VHULHVGHYLFH
ZLWKIRUP$FRQWDFWV
9DOXHVIRUUHVLVWRU´5µ
+D
3RZHUVXSSO\ 5HVLVWDQFH 3RZHU
,
9'& ű :
+E '&² 9'& ű :
9'& ű :
9 '&
9'& ű :
+F D 7ULSFRLO
9'& ű :
5
9'& ű :
%\SDVV
, FXUUHQWPRQLWRU UHVLVWRU
9 YROWDJHPRQLWRU $&'5
There are eight identical digital counters, numbered from 1 to 8. A digital counter counts the number of state transitions
from Logic 0 to Logic 1. The counter is used to count operations such as the pickups of an element, the changes of state of
an external contact (e.g. breaker auxiliary switch), or pulses from a watt-hour meter.
• COUNTER 1 UNITS: Assigns a label to identify the unit of measure pertaining to the digital transitions to be counted.
The units label will appear in the corresponding actual values status.
• COUNTER 1 PRESET: Sets the count to a required preset value before counting operations begin, as in the case
where a substitute relay is to be installed in place of an in-service relay, or while the counter is running.
• COUNTER 1 COMPARE: Sets the value to which the accumulated count value is compared. Three FlexLogic™ output
operands are provided to indicate if the present value is ‘more than (HI)’, ‘equal to (EQL)’, or ‘less than (LO)’ the set
value.
• COUNTER 1 UP: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand for incrementing the counter. If an enabled UP input is received
when the accumulated value is at the limit of +2,147,483,647 counts, the counter will rollover to –2,147,483,648.
• COUNTER 1 DOWN: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand for decrementing the counter. If an enabled DOWN input is
received when the accumulated value is at the limit of –2,147,483,648 counts, the counter will rollover to
+2,147,483,647.
• COUNTER 1 BLOCK: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand for blocking the counting operation. All counter operands are
blocked.
• CNT1 SET TO PRESET: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand used to set the count to the preset value. The counter will
be set to the preset value in the following situations:
1. When the counter is enabled and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value 1 (when the counter is enabled
and CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand is 0, the counter will be set to 0).
2. When the counter is running and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand changes the state from 0 to 1 (CNT1 SET TO
PRESET changing from 1 to 0 while the counter is running has no effect on the count).
3. When a reset or reset/freeze command is sent to the counter and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value
5 1 (when a reset or reset/freeze command is sent to the counter and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the
value 0, the counter will be set to 0).
• COUNTER 1 RESET: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand for setting the count to either “0” or the preset value depending
on the state of the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand.
• COUNTER 1 FREEZE/RESET: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand for capturing (freezing) the accumulated count value
into a separate register with the date and time of the operation, and resetting the count to “0”.
• COUNTER 1 FREEZE/COUNT: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand for capturing (freezing) the accumulated count value
into a separate register with the date and time of the operation, and continuing counting. The present accumulated
value and captured frozen value with the associated date/time stamp are available as actual values. If control power is
interrupted, the accumulated and frozen values are saved into non-volatile memory during the power down operation.
SETTING
COUNTER 1 FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
SETTINGS
Enabled = 1
COUNTER 1 NAME:
SETTING AND COUNTER 1 UNITS:
COUNTER 1 PRESET:
COUNTER 1 UP:
RUN
Off = 0 SETTING
FLEXLOGIC
COUNTER 1 COMPARE: OPERANDS
SETTING
CALCULATE Count more than Comp. COUNTER 1 HI
COUNTER 1 DOWN: VALUE Count equal to Comp. COUNTER 1 EQL
Off = 0 Count less than Comp. COUNTER 1 LO
SETTING
COUNTER 1 BLOCK:
Off = 0 SET TO PRESET VALUE
5
827065A1.VSD
SETTING
COUNT1 FREEZE/COUNT:
Off = 0
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS MONITORING ELEMENTS
MONITORING BREAKER
See page 5–217.
ELEMENTS FLASHOVER 1
BREAKER
MESSAGE See page 5–217.
FLASHOVER 2
VT FUSE FAILURE 1
MESSAGE See page 5–222.
VT FUSE FAILURE 2
MESSAGE See page 5–222.
VT FUSE FAILURE 3
MESSAGE See page 5–222.
VT FUSE FAILURE 4
MESSAGE See page 5–222.
BROKEN ROTOR BAR
MESSAGE See page 5–223.
b) BREAKER FLASHOVER
PATH: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS MONITORING ELEMENTS BREAKER FLASHOVER 1(2)
%XV
&7V %UHDNHU
/LQH)HHGHU
5
%XV97V
$&'5
The source 1 (SRC1) phase currents are feeder CTs and phase voltages are bus VTs, and Contact Input 1 is set as Breaker
52a contact. The conditions prior to flashover detection are:
1. 52a status = 0.
2. VAg, VBg, or VCg is greater than the pickup setting.
3. IA, IB, IC = 0; no current flows through the breaker.
4. VA is greater than pickup (not applicable in this scheme).
The conditions at flashover detection are:
1. 52a status = 0.
2. VAg, VBg, or VCg is lower than the pickup setting.
3. IA, IB, or IC is greater than the pickup current flowing through the breaker.
4. VA is greater than pickup (not applicable in this scheme).
SIX VT BREAKER FLASHOVER APPLICATION
The per-phase voltage difference approaches zero when the breaker is closed. The is well below any typical minimum
pickup voltage. Select the level of the BRK 1 FLSHOVR DIFF V PKP setting to be less than the voltage difference measured
across the breaker when the close or open breaker resistors are left in service. Prior to flashover, the voltage difference is
larger than BRK 1 FLSHOVR DIFF V PKP. This applies to either the difference between two live voltages per phase or when the
voltage from one side of the breaker has dropped to zero (line de-energized), at least one per-phase voltage is larger than
the BRK 1 FLSHOVR V PKP setting, and no current flows through the breaker poles. During breaker flashover, the per-phase
voltages from both sides of the breaker drops below the pickup value defined by the BRK 1 FLSHOVR V PKP setting, the volt-
age difference drops below the pickup setting, and flashover current is detected. These flashover conditions initiate Flex-
Logic™ pickup operands and start the BRK 1 FLSHOVR PKP DELAY timer.
This application does not require detection of breaker status via a 52a contact, as it uses a voltage difference larger than
the BRK 1 FLSHOVR DIFF V PKP setting. However, monitoring the breaker contact will ensure scheme stability.
%XV
&7V %UHDNHU
/LQH)HHGHU
97V
97V
$&'5
The source 1 (SRC1) phase currents are CTs and phase voltages are bus VTs. The source 2 (SRC2) phase voltages are
line VTs. Contact input 1 is set as the breaker 52a contact (optional).
The conditions prior to flashover detection are:
1. VA is greater than pickup
2. VAg, VBg, or VCg is greater than the pickup setting
3. IA, IB, IC = 0; no current flows through the breaker
4. 52a status = 0 (optional)
The conditions at flashover detection are:
1. VA is less than pickup
2. VAg, VBg, or VCg is lower than the pickup setting 5
3. IA, IB, or IC is greater than the pickup current flowing through the breaker
4. 52a status = 0 (optional)
The element is operational only when phase-to-ground voltages are connected to relay terminals. The flashover
element will not operate if delta voltages are applied.
127(
• BRK 1 FLSHOVR SPV A to BRK 1 FLSHOVR SPV C: These settings specify FlexLogic™ operands (per breaker
pole) that supervise the operation of the element per phase. Supervision can be provided by operation of other protec-
tion elements, breaker failure, and close and trip commands. A six-cycle time delay applies after the selected Flex-
Logic™ operand resets.
• BRK FLSHOVR PKP DELAY: This setting specifies the time delay to operate after a pickup condition is detected.
C5DD9>7C
2B;!6<C8?FBCE@F1*
6\Uh<_WYS_`UbQ^T*?VV-
&SiS\U
2B;!6<C8?FBCE@F2* @XQcU2
\_WYS
6\Uh<_WYS_`UbQ^T*?VV-
2B;!6<C8?FBCE@F3* @XQcU3
\_WYS 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4C
6\Uh<_WYS_`UbQ^T*?VV- 2B;!6<C8?FB@;@1 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4C
2B;!6<C8?FB@;@2 ?B 2B;!6<C8?FB@;@
C5DD9>7
C5DD9>7 2B;!6<C8?FB@;@3 2B;!6<C8?FB4@?
2B51;5B6<1C8?F5B
6E>3D9?>* 2B;!6<C8?FBF@;@*
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4C
5^QR\U-!
1>4 BE> 2B;!6<C8?FB4@?1
2\_S[*?66-
F1.@;@ 2B;!6<C8?FB4@?2
1>4 2B;!6<C8?FB4@?3
?B C5D
%SiS\U
T_]Y^Q^d
FQ.@;@ @XQcU3\_WYS
@XQcU2\_WYS
B5C5D
C5DD9>7C
%SiS\U
2B;!CD1DEC3<C41*
?B
C5D C5DD9>7
BE> T_]Y^Q^d
2B;!6<C8?FB@;@
6\Uh<_WYS_`UbQ^T*?^-!
45<1I*
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4C
2B;!CD1DEC3<C42* @XQcU2 d@;@
\_WYS 2B;!6<C8?FB?@1
BE>
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
6\Uh<_WYS_`UbQ^T*?^-!
@XQcU2\_WYS 2B;!6<C8?FB?@2 ?B 2B;!6<C8?FB?@
2B;!CD1DEC3<C43* @XQcU3 B5C5D
\_WYS ?B @XQcU3\_WYS 2B;!6<C8?FB?@3
C5DD9>7C BE>
2B;!6<C8?FBC945! 6\Uh<_WYS_`UbQ^T*?^-!
CB3*
5-221
5
5.7 CONTROL ELEMENTS 5 SETTINGS
c) VT FUSE FAILURE
PATH: SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS MONITORING ELEMENTS VT FUSE FAILURE 1(4)
5 AND
Reset-dominant
OR SET
FAULT
Latch
AND
RESET
SETTING
Function
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
AND
COMPARATORS
SOURCE 1 Run
V_2 V_2 > 0.1 pu
V_1 Run
OR OR SET
I_1 V_1 < 0.05 pu FUSE
FAIL
Run AND
I_1 > 0.075 pu
Run AND
TIMER
V_1 < 0.80 pu
2 cycles
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Run AND
I_1 < 0.05 pu Latch SRC1 VT FUSE FAIL OP
20 cycles
SRC1 VT FUSE FAIL DPO
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SRC1 50DD OP
OPEN POLE OP
The OPEN POLE OP operand applies
AND
to the C60, D60, L60, L90, and N60
RESET
OR
Reset-dominant
AND
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND SRC1 VT FUSE FAIL VOL LOSS
827093AM.CDR
The broken rotor bar detection function uses the same source as other motor protection functions. This source is defined by
the SYSTEM SETUP MOTOR MOTOR LINE SOURCE setting. The following items must addressed for the broken rotor
bar detection function to operate:
• Phase currents must be configured on this source for the broken rotor bar detection function.
• The AC INPUT WAVEFORMS oscillography setting must not be “Off”.
• The thermal model must be enabled.
This function monitors only phase A current.
When the broken rotor bar detection function is enabled, an alarm is initiated once the value of ratio of the broken bar
related sideband component versus the system fundamental component is greater than the pickup level for two consecu-
tive measurements. To reduce probability of a false alarm (caused by impairments other than a rotor bar failure), the ele-
ment is active only if the following conditions hold.
• The motor status is “Running” and the motor load is between preset minimum acceptable value and a value just below
the overload (defined by MOTOR FULL LOAD AMPS × MOTOR OVERLOAD FACTOR).
Trying to detect the broken rotor bar during a motor start will return an incorrect result because of the rapid movement
of broken rotor bar components and a heavy change in the motor current. On the other hand, while the motor load is
small, there is not enough resolution to accurately calculate a miniscule spectral component caused by a rotor bar fail-
ure.
If the upper sideband is to be measured, this setting should be programmed as follows, where f1 is the system fre-
quency and s is the motor slip at full load.
f start_offset = 2sf 1 – max 0.3 min 2sf 1 – 0.4 1.0 (EQ 5.42)
For example, if the full load slip is 0.01, program this setting as follows for a 60 Hz power system.
f start_offset = 2sf 1 – max 0.3 min 2sf 1 – 0.4 1.0
(EQ 5.43)
5 = 2 0.01 60 Hz – 0.8 = 0.40 Hz
If the lower sideband is to be measured, this setting should be programmed as follows, where f1 is the system fre-
quency and s is the motor slip at full load.
f start_offset = – 2 sf 1 – max 0.3 min 2sf 1 – 0.4 1.0 (EQ 5.44)
Using the same values from previous example, this value should be programmed as follows.
f start_offset = – 2 sf 1 – max 0.3 min 2sf 1 – 0.4 1.0
(EQ 5.45)
= – 2 0.01 60 Hz – 0.8 = – 2.00 Hz
• END OF BRB OFFSET: This setting specifies the end of the frequency range where the spectral component due to a
rotor bar failure will be searched. The end of the frequency range is defined as follows, where f1 is the system fre-
quency and fend_offset is this setting
f end = f 1 + f end_offset (EQ 5.46)
If the upper sideband is to be measured, this setting should be programmed as follows, where f1 is the system fre-
quency and s is the motor slip at full load.
f end_offset = 2sf 1 + max 0.3 min 2sf 1 – 0.4 1.0 (EQ 5.47)
For example, if the full load slip is 0.01, program this setting as follows for a 60 Hz power system.
f end_offset = 2sf 1 + max 0.3 min 2sf 1 – 0.4 1.0
(EQ 5.48)
= 2 0.01 60 Hz + 0.8 = 2.00 Hz
If the lower sideband is to be measured, this setting should be programmed as follows, where f1 is the system fre-
quency and s is the motor slip at full load.
f end_offset = – 2 sf 1 + max 0.3 min 2sf 1 – 0.4 1.0 (EQ 5.49)
Using the same values from previous example, this value should be programmed as follows.
f end_offset = – 2 sf 1 + max 0.3 min 2sf 1 – 0.4 1.0
(EQ 5.50)
= – 2 0.01 60 Hz + 0.8 = – 0.40 Hz
• BRB START BLOCK DELAY: This setting is used to block the broken rotor bar detection function while the motor is
starting for the specified time. This ensures that the broken rotor bar element is active only when the motor is running.
• MINIMUM MOTOR LOAD: When the motor load is less than the value specified by this setting, the data acquisition of
the broken rotor bar detection function is blocked. The broken rotor bar detection algorithm cannot accurately deter-
mine the broken rotor bar spectral component when a motor is lightly loaded.
• MAX. LOAD DEVIATION: When the standard deviation of the motor load is greater than the value specified by this
setting, the data acquisition of the broken rotor bar detection function is blocked. The broken rotor bar detection algo-
rithm cannot accurately determine the broken rotor bar spectral component when the motor load varies.
• MAXIMUM CURRENT UNBALANCE: When the current unbalance is greater than the value specified by this setting,
the data acquisition of the broken rotor bar detection function is blocked. The broken rotor bar detection algorithm can-
not accurately determine the broken rotor bar spectral component in a current unbalance situation.
• BROKEN ROTOR BAR PICKUP: This setting specifies the pickup threshold for the broken rotor bar detection feature.
The pickup threshold should normally be set to a level between –54 dB (very likely, a cracked rotor bar) and –50 dB
(probably a broken rotor bar).
• BROKEN ROTOR BAR RESET DLY: This setting specifies a time delay to reset the broken rotor bar detection fea-
ture. This setting can be left at its default value since the element updates its state one to two times per minute.
• BRB BLOCK: This setting selects a FlexLogic™ operand used to block the broken rotor bar detection feature. Typi-
cally, a panel cut-off switch or other user-specified conditions blocks this function.
CONTACT INPUTS
CONTACT INPUT
THRESHOLDS
5 THRESHOLD: 33 Vdc
The contact inputs menu contains configuration settings for each contact input as well as voltage thresholds for each group
of four contact inputs. Upon startup, the relay processor determines (from an assessment of the installed modules) which
contact inputs are available and then display settings for only those inputs.
An alphanumeric ID may be assigned to a contact input for diagnostic, setting, and event recording purposes. The CON-
TACT IP X On” (Logic 1) FlexLogic™ operand corresponds to contact input “X” being closed, while CONTACT IP X Off corre-
sponds to contact input “X” being open. The CONTACT INPUT DEBNCE TIME defines the time required for the contact to
overcome ‘contact bouncing’ conditions. As this time differs for different contact types and manufacturers, set it as a maxi-
mum contact debounce time (per manufacturer specifications) plus some margin to ensure proper operation. If CONTACT
INPUT EVENTS is set to “Enabled”, every change in the contact input state will trigger an event.
A raw status is scanned for all Contact Inputs synchronously at the constant rate of 0.5 ms as shown in the figure below.
The DC input voltage is compared to a user-settable threshold. A new contact input state must be maintained for a user-
settable debounce time in order for the M60 to validate the new contact state. In the figure below, the debounce time is set
at 2.5 ms; thus the 6th sample in a row validates the change of state (mark no. 1 in the diagram). Once validated (de-
bounced), the contact input asserts a corresponding FlexLogic™ operand and logs an event as per user setting.
A time stamp of the first sample in the sequence that validates the new state is used when logging the change of the con-
tact input into the Event Recorder (mark no. 2 in the diagram).
Protection and control elements, as well as FlexLogic™ equations and timers, are executed eight times in a power system
cycle. The protection pass duration is controlled by the frequency tracking mechanism. The FlexLogic™ operand reflecting
the debounced state of the contact is updated at the protection pass following the validation (marks no. 3 and 4 on the fig-
ure below). The update is performed at the beginning of the protection pass so all protection and control functions, as well
as FlexLogic™ equations, are fed with the updated states of the contact inputs.
The FlexLogic™ operand response time to the contact input change is equal to the debounce time setting plus up to one
protection pass (variable and depending on system frequency if frequency tracking enabled). If the change of state occurs
just after a protection pass, the recognition is delayed until the subsequent protection pass; that is, by the entire duration of
the protection pass. If the change occurs just prior to a protection pass, the state is recognized immediately. Statistically a
delay of half the protection pass is expected. Owing to the 0.5 ms scan rate, the time resolution for the input contact is
below 1msec.
For example, 8 protection passes per cycle on a 60 Hz system correspond to a protection pass every 2.1 ms. With a con-
tact debounce time setting of 3.0 ms, the FlexLogic™ operand-assert time limits are: 3.0 + 0.0 = 3.0 ms and 3.0 + 2.1 = 5.1
ms. These time limits depend on how soon the protection pass runs after the debouncing time.
Regardless of the contact debounce time setting, the contact input event is time-stamped with a 1 s accuracy using the
time of the first scan corresponding to the new state (mark no. 2 below). Therefore, the time stamp reflects a change in the
DC voltage across the contact input terminals that was not accidental as it was subsequently validated using the debounce
timer. Keep in mind that the associated FlexLogic™ operand is asserted/de-asserted later, after validating the change.
The debounce algorithm is symmetrical: the same procedure and debounce time are used to filter the LOW-HIGH (marks
no.1, 2, 3, and 4 in the figure below) and HIGH-LOW (marks no. 5, 6, 7, and 8 below) transitions.
92/7$*(
,1387
86(5352*5$00$%/(7+5(6+2/'
7LPHVWDPSRIWKHILUVW
70
7LPHVWDPSRIWKHILUVW $WWKLVWLPHWKH 7KH)OH[/RJLF VFDQFRUUHVSRQGLQJWRWKH
$WWKLVWLPHWKHQHZ
VFDQFRUUHVSRQGLQJWR QHZ+,*+ RSHUDQGLVJRLQJWR
5
QHZYDOLGDWHGVWDWHLV
/2:FRQWDFWVWDWHLV
WKHQHZYDOLGDWHGVWDWHLV FRQWDFWVWDWHLV EHDVVHUWHGDWWKLV ORJJHGLQWKH62(UHFRUG
YDOLGDWHG
ORJJHGLQWKH62(UHFRUG YDOLGDWHG SURWHFWLRQSDVV
5$: &217$&7
7KH)OH[/RJLF70
RSHUDQGLVJRLQJWREH
67$7(
GHDVVHUWHGDWWKLV
SURWHFWLRQSDVV
'(%281&(7,0(
XVHUVHWWLQJ
7KH)OH[/RJLF70RSHUDQG
'(%281&(7,0(
7KH)OH[/RJLF70RSHUDQG FKDQJHVUHIOHFWLQJWKH
6&$17,0( XVHUVHWWLQJ
FKDQJHVUHIOHFWLQJWKH YDOLGDWHGFRQWDFWVWDWH
)/(;/2*,&70
PVHF YDOLGDWHGFRQWDFWVWDWH
23(5$1'
3527(&7,213$66
WLPHVDF\FOHFRQWUROOHGE\WKH
IUHTXHQF\WUDFNLQJPHFKDQLVP
$FGU
Figure 5–120: INPUT CONTACT DEBOUNCING MECHANISM AND TIME-STAMPING SAMPLE TIMING
Contact inputs are isolated in groups of four to allow connection of wet contacts from different voltage sources for each
group. The CONTACT INPUT THRESHOLDS determine the minimum voltage required to detect a closed contact input. This
value should be selected according to the following criteria: 17 for 24 V sources, 33 for 48 V sources, 84 for 110 to 125 V
sources and 166 for 250 V sources.
For example, to use contact input H5a as a status input from the breaker 52b contact to seal-in the trip relay and record it in
the Event Records menu, make the following settings changes:
CONTACT INPUT H5A ID: "Breaker Closed (52b)"
CONTACT INPUT H5A EVENTS: "Enabled"
Note that the 52b contact is closed when the breaker is open and open when the breaker is closed.
There are 64 virtual inputs that can be individually programmed to respond to input signals from the keypad (via the COM-
MANDS menu) and communications protocols. All virtual input operands are defaulted to “Off” (logic 0) unless the appropri-
ate input signal is received.
If the VIRTUAL INPUT x FUNCTION is to “Disabled”, the input will be forced to off (logic 0) regardless of any attempt to alter the
input. If set to “Enabled”, the input operates as shown on the logic diagram and generates output FlexLogic™ operands in
response to received input signals and the applied settings.
There are two types of operation: self-reset and latched. If VIRTUAL INPUT x TYPE is “Self-Reset”, when the input signal tran-
sits from off to on, the output operand will be set to on for only one evaluation of the FlexLogic™ equations and then return
to off. If set to “Latched”, the virtual input sets the state of the output operand to the same state as the most recent received
input.
5 The self-reset operating mode generates the output operand for a single evaluation of the FlexLogic™ equations. If
the operand is to be used anywhere other than internally in a FlexLogic™ equation, it will likely have to be length-
127(
ened in time. A FlexLogic™ timer with a delayed reset can perform this function.
6(77,1*
9,578$/,1387
)81&7,21
'LVDEOHG
(QDEOHG 6
$1'
/DWFK
´9LUWXDO,QSXWWR21 µ
6(77,1*
´9LUWXDO,QSXWWR2)) µ 5 9,578$/,1387,'
$1'
6(77,1* )OH[ORJLF2SHUDQG
25
9LUW,S
9,578$/,1387
7<3(
/DWFKHG $1'
6HOI5HVHW $&'5
a) DIGITAL OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1
Upon startup of the relay, the main processor will determine from an assessment of the modules installed in the chassis
which contact outputs are available and present the settings for only these outputs. Where the contact input is non-latching,
the settings are as shown.
An ID may be assigned to each contact output. The signal that can OPERATE a contact output may be any FlexLogic™
operand (virtual output, element state, contact input, or virtual input). An additional FlexLogic™ operand may be used to
SEAL-IN the relay. Any change of state of a contact output can be logged as an Event if programmed to do so.
For example, the trip circuit current is monitored by providing a current threshold detector in series with some Form-A con-
tacts (see the trip circuit example in the Digital Elements section). The monitor will set a flag (see the specifications for
Form-A). The name of the FlexLogic™ operand set by the monitor, consists of the output relay designation, followed by the
name of the flag; for example, CONT OP 1 ION. 5
In most breaker control circuits, the trip coil is connected in series with a breaker auxiliary contact used to interrupt current
flow after the breaker has tripped, to prevent damage to the less robust initiating contact. This can be done by monitoring
an auxiliary contact on the breaker which opens when the breaker has tripped, but this scheme is subject to incorrect oper-
ation caused by differences in timing between breaker auxiliary contact change-of-state and interruption of current in the
trip circuit. The most dependable protection of the initiating contact is provided by directly measuring current in the tripping
circuit, and using this parameter to control resetting of the initiating relay. This scheme is often called trip seal-in.
This can be realized using the CONT OP 1 ION FlexLogic™ operand to seal-in the contact output as follows:
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 ID: “Cont Op 1"
OUTPUT H1 OPERATE: any suitable FlexLogic™ operand
OUTPUT H1 SEAL-IN: “Cont Op 1 IOn”
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 EVENTS: “Enabled”
SETTING
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 OPERATE
= On FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR Cont Op 1 Closed
Cont Op 1 Ion
Cont Op 1 Von
Cont Op 1 Voff
SETTING
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 SEAL-IN AND H1a
= On
H1b
859743A1.vsd H1c
b) LATCHING OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a
The latching output contacts are mechanically bi-stable and controlled by two separate (open and close) coils. As such they
retain their position even if the relay is not powered up. The relay recognizes all latching output contact cards and populates
the setting menu accordingly. On power up, the relay reads positions of the latching contacts from the hardware before exe-
cuting any other functions of the relay (such as protection and control features or FlexLogic™).
The latching output modules, either as a part of the relay or as individual modules, are shipped from the factory with all
latching contacts opened. It is highly recommended to double-check the programming and positions of the latching con-
tacts when replacing a module.
Since the relay asserts the output contact and reads back its position, it is possible to incorporate self-monitoring capabili-
ties for the latching outputs. If any latching outputs exhibits a discrepancy, the LATCHING OUTPUT ERROR self-test error is
declared. The error is signaled by the LATCHING OUT ERROR FlexLogic™ operand, event, and target message.
• OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: This setting specifies a FlexLogic™ operand to operate the ‘close coil’ of the contact. The
relay will seal-in this input to safely close the contact. Once the contact is closed and the RESET input is logic 0 (off),
any activity of the OPERATE input, such as subsequent chattering, will not have any effect. With both the OPERATE and
5 •
RESET inputs active (logic 1), the response of the latching contact is specified by the OUTPUT H1A TYPE setting.
OUTPUT H1a RESET: This setting specifies a FlexLogic™ operand to operate the ‘trip coil’ of the contact. The relay
will seal-in this input to safely open the contact. Once the contact is opened and the OPERATE input is logic 0 (off), any
activity of the RESET input, such as subsequent chattering, will not have any effect. With both the OPERATE and RESET
inputs active (logic 1), the response of the latching contact is specified by the OUTPUT H1A TYPE setting.
• OUTPUT H1a TYPE: This setting specifies the contact response under conflicting control inputs; that is, when both the
OPERATE and RESET signals are applied. With both control inputs applied simultaneously, the contact will close if set to
“Operate-dominant” and will open if set to “Reset-dominant”.
SETTING
CONTACT OUTPUT H1a Non-volatile,
OPERATE = On Set-dominant
AND S
SETTING OR Latch On
CONTACT OUTPUT H1a TYPE Close
= Operate-dominant R
H1b
= Reset-dominant
Non-volatile,
SETTING OR Set-dominant
H1a
CONTACT OUTPUT H1a RESET AND S
= On Open
Latch
R
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
859744A1.vsd Cont Op 1 Closed
Application Example 1:
A latching output contact H1a is to be controlled from two user-programmable pushbuttons (buttons number 1 and 2). The
following settings should be applied.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUT-
PUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a menu (assuming an H4L module):
Program the pushbuttons by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUT-
TONS USER PUSHBUTTON 1 and USER PUSHBUTTON 2 menus:
Application Example 2:
A relay, having two latching contacts H1a and H1c, is to be programmed. The H1a contact is to be a Type-a contact, while
the H1c contact is to be a Type-b contact (Type-a means closed after exercising the operate input; Type-b means closed
after exercising the reset input). The relay is to be controlled from virtual outputs: VO1 to operate and VO2 to reset.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUT-
PUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a and CONTACT OUTPUT H1c menus (assuming an H4L module):
Since the two physical contacts in this example are mechanically separated and have individual control inputs, they will not
operate at exactly the same time. A discrepancy in the range of a fraction of a maximum operating time may occur. There-
fore, a pair of contacts programmed to be a multi-contact relay will not guarantee any specific sequence of operation (such
as make before break). If required, the sequence of operation must be programmed explicitly by delaying some of the con-
trol inputs as shown in the next application example.
Application Example 3:
A make before break functionality must be added to the preceding example. An overlap of 20 ms is required to implement
this functionality as described below:
Write the following FlexLogic™ equation (EnerVista UR Setup example shown):
5
Both timers (Timer 1 and Timer 2) should be set to 20 ms pickup and 0 ms dropout.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUT-
PUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a and CONTACT OUTPUT H1c menus (assuming an H4L module):
Application Example 4:
A latching contact H1a is to be controlled from a single virtual output VO1. The contact should stay closed as long as VO1
is high, and should stay opened when VO1 is low. Program the relay as follows.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUT-
PUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a menu (assuming an H4L module):
5 EVENTS: Disabled
There are 96 virtual outputs that may be assigned via FlexLogic™. If not assigned, the output will be forced to ‘OFF’ (Logic
0). An ID may be assigned to each virtual output. Virtual outputs are resolved in each pass through the evaluation of the
FlexLogic™ equations. Any change of state of a virtual output can be logged as an event if programmed to do so.
For example, if Virtual Output 1 is the trip signal from FlexLogic™ and the trip relay is used to signal events, the settings
would be programmed as follows:
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 ID: "Trip"
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 EVENTS: "Disabled"
The sharing of digital point state information between GSSE/GOOSE equipped relays is essentially an extension to Flex-
Logic™, allowing distributed FlexLogic™ by making operands available to/from devices on a common communications net-
work. In addition to digital point states, GSSE/GOOSE messages identify the originator of the message and provide other
information required by the communication specification. All devices listen to network messages and capture data only from
messages that have originated in selected devices.
IEC 61850 GSSE messages are compatible with UCA GOOSE messages and contain a fixed set of digital points. IEC
61850 GOOSE messages can, in general, contain any configurable data items. When used by the remote input/output fea-
ture, IEC 61850 GOOSE messages contain the same data as GSSE messages.
Both GSSE and GOOSE messages are designed to be short, reliable, and high priority. GOOSE messages have additional
advantages over GSSE messages due to their support of VLAN (virtual LAN) and Ethernet priority tagging functionality.
The GSSE message structure contains space for 128 bit pairs representing digital point state information. The IEC 61850
specification provides 32 “DNA” bit pairs that represent the state of two pre-defined events and 30 user-defined events. All
remaining bit pairs are “UserSt” bit pairs, which are status bits representing user-definable events. The M60 implementation
provides 32 of the 96 available UserSt bit pairs.
The IEC 61850 specification includes features that are used to cope with the loss of communication between transmitting
and receiving devices. Each transmitting device will send a GSSE/GOOSE message upon a successful power-up, when
the state of any included point changes, or after a specified interval (the default update time) if a change-of-state has not
occurred. The transmitting device also sends a ‘hold time’ which is set greater than three times the programmed default
time required by the receiving device.
Receiving devices are constantly monitoring the communications network for messages they require, as recognized by the
identification of the originating device carried in the message. Messages received from remote devices include the mes-
sage time allowed to live. The receiving relay sets a timer assigned to the originating device to this time interval, and if it
has not received another message from this device at time-out, the remote device is declared to be non-communicating, so
it will use the programmed default state for all points from that specific remote device. If a message is received from a
remote device before the time allowed to live expires, all points for that device are updated to the states contained in the
message and the hold timer is restarted. The status of a remote device, where “Offline” indicates non-communicating, can
be displayed.
The remote input/output facility provides for 32 remote inputs and 64 remote outputs.
Likewise, the device ID that represents the IEC 61850 GSSE application ID name string sent as part of each GSSE mes-
sage is programmed in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE
CONFIGURATION TRANSMISSION GSSE GSSE ID setting.
5
In M60 releases previous to 5.0x, these name strings were represented by the RELAY NAME setting.
Remote devices are available for setting purposes. A receiving relay must be programmed to capture messages from only
those originating remote devices of interest. This setting is used to select specific remote devices by entering (bottom row)
the exact identification (ID) assigned to those devices.
For REMOTE DEVICE 1 ID, restart the unit when you change this setting to ensure that the Online or Offline status displays
correctly.
The REMOTE DEVICE 1 ETYPE APPID setting is only used with GOOSE messages; they are not applicable to GSSE mes-
sages. This setting identifies the Ethernet application identification in the GOOSE message. It should match the corre-
sponding settings on the sending device.
The REMOTE DEVICE 1 DATASET setting provides for the choice of the M60 fixed (DNA/UserSt) dataset (that is, containing
DNA and UserSt bit pairs), or one of the configurable datasets.
Note that the dataset for the received data items must be made up of existing items in an existing logical node. For this rea-
son, logical node GGIO3 is instantiated to hold the incoming data items. GGIO3 is not necessary to make use of the
received data. The remote input data item mapping takes care of the mapping of the inputs to remote input FlexLogic™
operands. However, GGIO3 data can be read by IEC 61850 clients.
Remote Inputs that create FlexLogic™ operands at the receiving relay are extracted from GSSE/GOOSE messages origi-
nating in remote devices. Each remote input can be selected from a list consisting of: DNA-1 through DNA-32, UserSt-1
through UserSt-32, and Dataset Item 1 through Dataset Item 32. The function of DNA inputs is defined in the IEC 61850
specification and is presented in the IEC 61850 DNA Assignments table in the Remote Outputs section. The function of
UserSt inputs is defined by the user selection of the FlexLogic™ operand whose state is represented in the GSSE/GOOSE
message. A user must program a DNA point from the appropriate FlexLogic™ operand.
Remote input 1 must be programmed to replicate the logic state of a specific signal from a specific remote device for local
use. This programming is performed via the three settings shown above.
5 The REMOTE INPUT 1 ID setting allows the user to assign descriptive text to the remote input. The REMOTE IN 1 DEVICE setting
selects the remote device which originates the required signal, as previously assigned to the remote device via the setting
REMOTE DEVICE (16) ID (see the Remote Devices section). The REMOTE IN 1 ITEM setting selects the specific bits of the
GSSE/GOOSE message required.
The REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE setting selects the logic state for this point if the local relay has just completed startup or
the remote device sending the point is declared to be non-communicating. The following choices are available:
• Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to “On” value defaults the input to logic 1.
• Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to “Off” value defaults the input to logic 0.
• Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to “Latest/On” freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is
not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to logic 1.
When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
• Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to “Latest/Off” freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is
not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to logic 0.
When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
For additional information on GSSE/GOOOSE messaging, refer to the Remote Devices section in this chapter.
127(
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE DPS INPUTS REMOTE DPS INPUT 1(5)
Remote double-point status inputs are extracted from GOOSE messages originating in the remote device. Each remote
double point status input must be programmed to replicate the logic state of a specific signal from a specific remote device
for local use. This functionality is accomplished with the five remote double-point status input settings.
• REM DPS IN 1 ID: This setting assigns descriptive text to the remote double-point status input.
• REM DPS IN 1 DEV: This setting selects a remote device ID to indicate the origin of a GOOSE message. The range is
selected from the remote device IDs specified in the Remote Devices section.
• REM DPS IN 1 ITEM: This setting specifies the required bits of the GOOSE message.
The configurable GOOSE dataset items must be changed to accept a double-point status item from a GOOSE dataset
(changes are made in the SETTINGS COMMUNICATION IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION
RECEPTION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE 1(16) CONFIG GSE 1 DATASET ITEMS menus). Dataset
items configured to receive any of “GGIO3.ST.IndPos1.stV” to “GGIO3.ST.IndPos5.stV” will accept double-point status
5
information that will be decoded by the remote double-point status inputs configured to this dataset item.
The remote double point status is recovered from the received IEC 61850 dataset and is available as through the RemDPS
Ip 1 BAD, RemDPS Ip 1 INTERM, RemDPS Ip 1 OFF, and RemDPS Ip 1 ON FlexLogic™ operands. These operands can then be
used in breaker or disconnect control schemes.
Remote outputs (1 to 32) are FlexLogic™ operands inserted into GSSE/GOOSE messages that are transmitted to remote
devices on a LAN. Each digital point in the message must be programmed to carry the state of a specific FlexLogic™ oper-
and. The above operand setting represents a specific DNA function (as shown in the following table) to be transmitted.
Remote outputs 1 to 32 originate as GSSE/GOOSE messages to be transmitted to remote devices. Each digital point in the
message must be programmed to carry the state of a specific FlexLogic™ operand. The setting above is used to select the
operand which represents a specific UserSt function (as selected by the user) to be transmitted.
The following setting represents the time between sending GSSE/GOOSE messages when there has been no change of
state of any selected digital point. This setting is located in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS IEC 61850 PROTO-
COL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION settings menu.
5.8.9 RESETTING
Some events can be programmed to latch the faceplate LED event indicators and the target message on the display. Once
set, the latching mechanism will hold all of the latched indicators or messages in the set state after the initiating condition
has cleared until a RESET command is received to return these latches (not including FlexLogic™ latches) to the reset
state. The RESET command can be sent from the faceplate Reset button, a remote device via a communications channel,
or any programmed operand.
When the RESET command is received by the relay, two FlexLogic™ operands are created. These operands, which are
stored as events, reset the latches if the initiating condition has cleared. The three sources of RESET commands each cre-
ate the RESET OP FlexLogic™ operand. Each individual source of a RESET command also creates its individual operand
RESET OP (PUSHBUTTON), RESET OP (COMMS) or RESET OP (OPERAND) to identify the source of the command. The setting
shown above selects the operand that will create the RESET OP (OPERAND) operand.
a) DIRECT INPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS DIRECT INPUTS DIRECT INPUT 1(32)
These settings specify how the direct input information is processed. The DIRECT INPUT 1 NAME setting allows the user to
assign a descriptive name to the direct input. The DIRECT INPUT 1 DEVICE ID represents the source of direct input 1. The
specified direct input is driven by the device identified here.
The DIRECT INPUT 1 BIT NUMBER is the bit number to extract the state for direct input 1. Direct Input 1 is driven by the bit
identified as DIRECT INPUT 1 BIT NUMBER. This corresponds to the direct output number of the sending device.
DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT represents the state of the direct input when the associated direct device is offline. The following
choices are available:
• Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT to “On” value defaults the input to Logic 1.
• Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT to “Off” value defaults the input to Logic 0.
• Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT to “Latest/On” freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is not
known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to Logic 1.
When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
• Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT to “Latest/Off” freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is not
known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to Logic 0.
When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
b) DIRECT OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS DIRECT OUTPUTS DIRECT OUTPUT 1(32)
The DIRECT OUT 1 NAME setting allows the user to assign a descriptive name to the direct output. The DIR OUT 1 OPERAND is
the FlexLogic™ operand that determines the state of this direct output.
c) APPLICATION EXAMPLES
The examples introduced in the earlier Direct Inputs and Outputs section (part of the Product Setup section) are continued
below to illustrate usage of the direct inputs and outputs.
EXAMPLE 1: EXTENDING INPUT/OUTPUT CAPABILITIES OF A M60 RELAY
Consider an application that requires additional quantities of digital inputs or output contacts or lines of programmable logic
that exceed the capabilities of a single UR-series chassis. The problem is solved by adding an extra UR-series IED, such
as the C30, to satisfy the additional inputs/outputs and programmable logic requirements. The two IEDs are connected via
single-channel digital communication cards as shown below.
7;
85,('
5;
7;
85,('
5;
$&'5
Figure 5–124: INPUT AND OUTPUT EXTENSION VIA DIRECT INPUTS AND OUTPUTS
Assume contact input 1 from UR IED 2 is to be used by UR IED 1. The following settings should be applied (Direct Input 5
and bit number 12 are used, as an example):
UR IED 1: DIRECT INPUT 5 DEVICE ID = “2” UR IED 2: DIRECT OUT 12 OPERAND = “Cont Ip 1 On”
DIRECT INPUT 5 BIT NUMBER = “12”
The Cont Ip 1 On operand of UR IED 2 is now available in UR IED 1 as DIRECT INPUT 5 ON.
EXAMPLE 2: INTERLOCKING BUSBAR PROTECTION
A simple interlocking busbar protection scheme can be accomplished by sending a blocking signal from downstream
devices, say 2, 3 and 4, to the upstream device that monitors a single incomer of the busbar, as shown in the figure below.
85,(' %/2&.
($"'!"1!34B
5 Assume that Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 is used by Devices 2, 3, and 4 to block Device 1. If not blocked, Device 1
would trip the bus upon detecting a fault and applying a short coordination time delay.
The following settings should be applied (assume Bit 3 is used by all 3 devices to send the blocking signal and Direct Inputs
7, 8, and 9 are used by the receiving device to monitor the three blocking signals):
UR IED 2: DIRECT OUT 3 OPERAND: "PHASE IOC1 OP"
85,(' 85,('
85,(' ($"'!#1!34B
5; 5
85,('
7;
($"'!$1!34B
85,(' 85,('
',5(&7287 +<%32777; ',5(&7,1387
',5(&7,1387 ',5(&7287 +<%32777;
',5(&7,1387 ',5(&7287 ',5(&7,1387
',5(&7287 ',5(&7,1387
',5(&7,1387
85,(' ',5(&7,1387
',5(&7,1387
',5(&7287 +<%32777;
($"'!'1!34B
Figure 5–128: SIGNAL FLOW FOR DIRECT INPUT AND OUTPUT – EXAMPLE 3
In three-terminal applications, both the remote terminals must grant permission to trip. Therefore, at each terminal, direct
inputs 5 and 6 should be ANDed in FlexLogic™ and the resulting operand configured as the permission to trip (HYB POTT
RX1 setting).
a) OVERVIEW
5 The relay provides 16 teleprotection inputs on communications channel 1 (numbered 1-1 through 1-16) and 16 teleprotec-
tion inputs on communications channel 2 (on two-terminals two-channel and three-terminal systems only, numbered 2-1
through 2-16). The remote relay connected to channels 1 and 2 of the local relay is programmed by assigning FlexLogic™
operands to be sent via the selected communications channel. This allows the user to create distributed protection and
control schemes via dedicated communications channels. Some examples are directional comparison pilot schemes and
direct transfer tripping. It should be noted that failures of communications channels will affect teleprotection functionality.
The teleprotection function must be enabled to utilize the inputs.
b) TELEPROTECTION INPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS TELEPROTECTION TELEPROT INPUTS
TELEPROT INPUTS TELEPROT INPUT 1-1 Range: Off, On, Latest/Off, Latest/On
DEFAULT: Off
TELEPROT INPUT 1-2 Range: Off, On, Latest/Off, Latest/On
MESSAGE
DEFAULT: Off
Setting the TELEPROT INPUT ~~ DEFAULT setting to “On” defaults the input to logic 1 when the channel fails. A value of “Off”
defaults the input to logic 0 when the channel fails.
The “Latest/On” and “Latest/Off” values freeze the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is not known,
such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, then the input defaults to logic 1 for “Latest/On”
and logic 0 for “Latest/Off”.
c) TELEPROTECTION OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS TELEPROTECTION TELEPROT OUTPUTS
As the following figure demonstrates, processing of the teleprotection inputs/outputs is dependent on the number of com- 5
munication channels and terminals. On two-terminal two-channel systems, they are processed continuously on each chan-
nel and mapped separately per channel. Therefore, to achieve redundancy, the user must assign the same operand on
both channels (teleprotection outputs at the sending end or corresponding teleprotection inputs at the receiving end). On
three-terminal two-channel systems, redundancy is achieved by programming signal re-transmittal in the case of channel
failure between any pair of relays.
EB! EB"
13DE1<F1<E5C C5DD9>7
381>>5<!CD1DEC* D5<5@B?D9>@ED!!
4561E<D*
C5DD9>7 cQ]UV_b!"!!&
D5<5@B?D?ED@ED!!*
cQ]UV_b!"!!& ?^ 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
6QY\
?VV6\Uh\_WYS?`UbQ^T ?VV D5<5@B?9>@ED!!?^
?; ?B
cQ]UV_b!"!!&
13DE1<F1<E5C
C5DD9>7
381>>5<!CD1DEC*
D5<5@B?D9>@ED!! 3_]]e^YSQdY_^SXQ^^U\!
4561E<D*
cQ]UV_b!"!!& DU\U`b_dUSdY_^9?5^QR\UT C5DD9>7
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4 D5<5@B?D?ED@ED!!*
?^ cQ]UV_b!"!!&
6QY\
D5<5@B?9>@ED!!?^ ?VV
?B ?; ?VV6\Uh\_WYS?`UbQ^T
cQ]UV_b!"!!&
EB"_bEB#
13DE1<F1<E5C C5DD9>7
381>>5<"CD1DEC* D5<5@B?D9>@ED"!
4561E<D*
C5DD9>7 cQ]UV_b"""!&
D5<5@B?D?ED@ED"!*
cQ]UV_b!"!!& ?^ 6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
6QY\
?VV D5<5@B?9>@ED"!?^
?VV6\Uh\_WYS?`UbQ^T ?; ?B
cQ]UV_b"""!&
13DE1<F1<E5C
C5DD9>7
381>>5<"CD1DEC*
D5<5@B?D9>@ED"! 3_]]e^YSQdY_^SXQ^^U\"
4561E<D*
cQ]UV_b!"!!& ?^#dUb]Y^Q\cicdU]_b"dUb]Y^Q\ C5DD9>7
6<5H<?793?@5B1>4
gYdXbUTe^TQ^dSXQ^^U\
D5<5@B?D?ED@ED"!*
?^ cQ]UV_b"""!&
6QY\
D5<5@B?9>@ED"!?^ ?VV
?B ?; ?VV6\Uh\_WYS?`UbQ^T
cQ]UV_b!"!!&
($"'% 1"34B
Figure 5–129: TELEPROTECTION INPUT/OUTPUT PROCESSING
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS IEC 61850 GOOSE ANALOGS GOOSE ANALOG INPUT 1(32)
The IEC 61850 GOOSE analog inputs feature allows the transmission of analog values between any two UR-series
devices. The following settings are available for each GOOSE analog input.
• ANALOG 1 DEFAULT: This setting specifies the value of the GOOSE analog input when the sending device is offline
and the ANALOG 1 DEFAULT MODE is set to “Default Value”.This setting is stored as an IEEE 754 / IEC 60559 floating
point number. Because of the large range of this setting, not all possible values can be stored. Some values may be
rounded to the closest possible floating point number.
• ANALOG 1 DEFAULT MODE: When the sending device is offline and this setting is “Last Known”, the value of the
GOOSE analog input remains at the last received value. When the sending device is offline and this setting value is
“Default Value”, then the value of the GOOSE analog input is defined by the ANALOG 1 DEFAULT setting.
5 • GOOSE ANALOG 1 UNITS: This setting specifies a four-character alphanumeric string that can is used in the actual
values display of the corresponding GOOSE analog input value.
GOOSE Analogs are floating-point values, with no units. The GOOSE UNIT and PU base settings allow the user to
configure GOOSE Analog, so that it can be used in a FlexElement.
GOOSE Analogs that represent current, voltage, power, frequency, angles, or power factor can be used in a FlexEle-
ment. The following text must be used in the UNITS setting, to represent these types of analogs: A, V, W, var, VA, Hz,
deg, and no text (blank setting) for power factor.
GOOSE Analogs can be compared to other GOOSE Analogs with any character string or no string.
• GOOSE ANALOG 1PU: This setting specifies the per-unit base factor when using the GOOSE analog input FlexAna-
log™ values in other M60 features, such as FlexElements™. The base factor is applied to the GOOSE analog input
FlexAnalog quantity to normalize it to a per-unit quantity. The base units are described in the following table.
The per-unit base setting represents thousands, not single units. For example, a PU base of 1.000 is actually 1000 and
a PU base of 0.001 is 1.
When using GOOSE Analogs and PU base in FlexElements, the largest value that can be displayed in the FlexEle-
ment actual values is 2,140,000.000.
The GOOSE analog input FlexAnalog™ values are available for use in other M60 functions that use FlexAnalog™ values.
The IEC 61850 GOOSE uinteger inputs feature allows the transmission of FlexInteger™ values between any two UR-
series devices. The following settings are available for each GOOSE uinteger input.
• UINTEGER 1 DEFAULT: This setting specifies the value of the GOOSE uinteger input when the sending device is
offline and the UINTEGER 1 DEFAULT MODE is set to “Default Value”.This setting is stored as a 32-bit unsigned integer
number.
• UINTEGER 1 DEFAULT MODE: When the sending device is offline and this setting is “Last Known”, the value of the
GOOSE uinteger input remains at the last received value. When the sending device is offline and this setting value is
“Default Value”, then the value of the GOOSE uinteger input is defined by the UINTEGER 1 DEFAULT setting.
The GOOSE integer input FlexInteger™ values are available for use in other M60 functions that use FlexInteger™ values.
Hardware and software is provided to receive signals from external transducers and convert these signals into a digital for-
mat for use as required. The relay will accept inputs in the range of –1 to +20 mA DC, suitable for use with most common
transducer output ranges; all inputs are assumed to be linear over the complete range. Specific hardware details are con-
tained in chapter 3.
Before the DCmA input signal can be used, the value of the signal measured by the relay must be converted to the range
5 and quantity of the external transducer primary input parameter, such as DC voltage or temperature. The relay simplifies
this process by internally scaling the output from the external transducer and displaying the actual primary parameter.
DCmA input channels are arranged in a manner similar to CT and VT channels. The user configures individual channels
with the settings shown here.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered from 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up,
the relay will automatically generate configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same general
manner that is used for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8 inclu-
sive, which is used as the channel number. The relay generates an actual value for each available input channel.
Settings are automatically generated for every channel available in the specific relay as shown above for the first channel of
a type 5F transducer module installed in slot H.
The function of the channel may be either “Enabled” or “Disabled”. If “Disabled”, no actual values are created for the chan-
nel. An alphanumeric “ID” is assigned to each channel; this ID will be included in the channel actual value, along with the
programmed units associated with the parameter measured by the transducer, such as volts, °C, megawatts, etc. This ID is
also used to reference the channel as the input parameter to features designed to measure this type of parameter. The
DCMA INPUT H1 RANGE setting specifies the mA DC range of the transducer connected to the input channel.
The DCMA INPUT H1 MIN VALUE and DCMA INPUT H1 MAX VALUE settings are used to program the span of the transducer in
primary units. For example, a temperature transducer might have a span from 0 to 250°C; in this case the DCMA INPUT H1
MIN VALUE value is “0” and the DCMA INPUT H1 MAX VALUE value is “250”. Another example would be a watts transducer with
a span from –20 to +180 MW; in this case the DCMA INPUT H1 MIN VALUE value would be “–20” and the DCMA INPUT H1 MAX
VALUE value “180”. Intermediate values between the min and max values are scaled linearly.
The RTD inputs convert values of input resistance into temperature for further operations. These channels are intended to
be connected to any of the RTD types in common use. Specific hardware details are contained in chapter 3.
RTD input channels are arranged in a manner similar to CT and VT channels. The user configures individual channels with
the settings shown here.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered from 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up,
the relay will automatically generate configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same general
manner that is used for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8 inclu-
sive, which is used as the channel number. The relay generates an actual value for each available input channel.
Settings are automatically generated for every channel available in the specific relay as shown above for the first channel of
a type 5C transducer module installed in the first available slot.
• RTD INPUT H1 FUNCTION: The function of the channel may be either “Enabled” or “Disabled”. If set to “Disabled”,
there will not be an actual value created for the channel.
• RTD INPUT H1 ID: An alphanumeric ID is assigned to the channel. This ID will be included in the channel actual val-
ues. It is also used to reference the channel as the input parameter to features designed to measure this type of
parameter.
• RTD INPUT H1 TYPE: This setting specifies the RTD type. Four different RTD types are available: 100 Nickel, 10
Copper, 100 Platinum, and 120 Nickel. Refer the table below for reference temperature values for each type.
5 100
110
212
230
138.50
142.29
200.64
209.85
167.20
174.87
12.90
13.28
120 248 146.06 219.29 182.75 13.67
130 266 149.82 228.96 190.80 14.06
140 284 153.58 238.85 199.04 14.44
150 302 157.32 248.95 207.45 14.83
160 320 161.04 259.30 216.08 15.22
170 338 164.76 269.91 224.92 15.61
180 356 168.47 280.77 233.97 16.00
190 374 172.46 291.96 243.30 16.39
200 392 175.84 303.46 252.88 16.78
210 410 179.51 315.31 262.76 17.17
220 428 183.17 327.54 272.94 17.56
230 446 186.82 340.14 283.45 17.95
240 464 190.45 353.14 294.28 18.34
250 482 194.08 366.53 305.44 18.73
• RTD INPUT H1 APPLICATION: This setting allows each individual RTD to be assigned to a group application. This is
useful for applications that require group measurement for voting. A value of “None” specifies that the RTD will operate
individually and not part of any RTD group. All RTDs programmed to “Stator” are used for RTD biasing of the M60 ther-
mal model. Common groups are provided for rotating machines applications such as ambient, bearing, group 1, or
group 2. If the RTD INPUT H1 TRIP VOTING setting value is “Group”, then it is allowed to issue a trip if N – 1 RTDs from the
same group also pick up, where N is the number of enabled RTDs from the group.
• RTD INPUT H1 ALARM TEMPERATURE: This setting specifies the temperature pickup level for the alarm stage.
• RTD INPUT H1 ALARM PKP DELAY: This setting specifies time delay for the alarm stage until the output can be
asserted.
• RTD INPUT H1 TRIP TEMPERATURE: This setting specifies the temperature pickup level for the trip stage.
• RTD INPUT H1 TRIP PKP DELAY: This setting specifies time delay for the trip stage until the output can be asserted.
• RTD INPUT H1 TRIP RST DELAY: This setting specifies the reset delay to seal-in the trip signal.
• RTD INPUT H1 TRIP VOTING: This setting allows securing trip signal by voting with other RTDs. A value of “None”
indicates that element operates individually and no voting takes place.
A value of “Group” indicates that element is allowed to issue a trip if N – 1 of other RTDs of the same group pick up as
well (where N is the number of enabled RTDs from the group). For example, if three RTDs are assigned to the same
group, there should be at least one additional RTD of the same group picked up to issue a trip command.
The “RTD Inp H1” through “RTD Inp W8” values indicate that element is allowed to issue a trip if the corresponding
peer RTD is also picked up.
• RTD INPUT H1 OPEN: This setting allows monitoring an open RTD sensor circuit. If this functionality is not required,
then a value of “None” will disable monitoring and assertion of output operands.
If set to “Alarm”, the monitor will set an alarm when a broken sensor is detected.
If set to “Block”, the monitor will set an alarm and simultaneously block RTD operation when a broken sensor is
detected.
If targets are enabled, a message will appear on the display identifying the broken RTD. If this feature is used, it is rec-
ommended that the alarm be programmed as latched so that intermittent RTDs are detected and corrective action may
be taken.
• RTD INPUT H1 BLOCK: This setting is used to block RTD operation.
SETTINGS
RTD INPUT H1 FUNCTION
= Enabled
RTD INPUT H1 BLOCK AND To other RTDs for voting
Off = 0
SETTINGS
SETTINGS
RTD INPUT H1 TRIP
PKP DELAY SETTINGS
5
SETTINGS RTD INPUT H1 TRIP RTD INPUT H1 TRIP RTD INPUT H1
RTD INPUT H1 ID TEMPERATURE RST DELAY APPLICATION
= RTD Inp H1 RTD INPUT H1 ALARM RTD INPUT H1 ALARM RTD INPUT H1 TRIP
TEMPERATURE PKP DELAY VOTING
RTD INPUT H1 TYPE
RUN TPKP FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Resistance to Voting logic RTD Ip TRIP OP
temperature > TRIP PICKUP TDPO
temperature conversion
RUN TPKP
AND temperature > ALARM PICKUP From other RTDs for voting FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
0
RTD Ip ALARM OP
SETTING
RTD Ip TRIP PKP
RTD INPUT H1 OPEN
Block RTD Ip TRIP DPO
RUN
Alarm RTD Ip ALARM PKP
R ³ 250°C OR
None RTD Ip ALARM DPO
RUN RTD Ip OPEN
RTD Ip SHORTED
R £ –50°C
833019A2.CDR
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS TRANSDUCER I/O RRTD INPUTS
RRTD 12
MESSAGE See page 5-248.
It is recommended to use the M60 to configure the RRTD parameters. If the RRTDPC software is used to change the
RRTD settings directly (the application and type settings), then one of the following two operations is required for changes
to be reflected in the M60.
• Cycle power to M60.
• Break then re-establish the communication link between the RRTD unit and the M60. This will cause the RRTD COMM
FAIL operand to be asserted then de-asserted.
The remote RTD inputs convert values of input resistance into temperature for further operations. These inputs are
intended to be connected to any of the RTD types in common use. Specific hardware details are contained in chapter 3.
On power up, the M60 reads and saves all application and type settings from the RRTD. This synchronizes the RRTD and
M60. Any changes to RRTD settings (function, application, or type) from the M60 interface are immediately reflected in the
RRTD. The following rules are followed.
• If the RRTD 1 FUNCTION setting is “Enabled”, then the RRTD 1 APPLICATION setting value will be written to RRTD device.
• If the RRTD 1 FUNCTION setting is “Disabled”, then RRTD1 APPLICATION setting value is set as “None”.
• If the RRTD 1 APPLICATION or RRTD 1 TYPE settings are changes, then these settings are immediately written to the
RRTD device.
• If the RRTD 1 APPLICATION setting is “Group 1” or “Group 2”, then a value of “Other” is written to the RRTD device.
An RRTD actual value of –43°C implies that the RRTD 1 FUNCTION setting is “Enabled” but the corresponding RRTD 1 APPLI-
CATION setting is “None”.
If the RRTD communication link with the M60 is broken, then the last temperature actual values are retained until the RRTD
communication failure is detected. When this occurs, a RRTD COMM FAILURE self-test alarm and target message is gen-
erated, and an event is logged in the event recorder and the temperature actual values reset to 0. When the link is re-estab-
lished, the RRTD 1 APPLICATION and RRTD 1 TYPE settings are read from the RRTD to re-synchronize the device.
• RRTD 1 FUNCTION: This setting enables and disables the remote RTD. If set to “Disabled”, no actual value is created
for the remote RTD.
• RRTD 1 ID: This setting is used to assign alphanumeric ID is assigned to the remote RTD. This ID will be included in
the remote RTD actual values. It is also used to reference the remote RTD input to features using the remote RTD.
• RRTD 1 TYPE: This setting specifies the remote RTD type. Four different RTD types are available: 100 Nickel, 10
Copper, 100 Platinum, and 120 Nickel.
The RRTD converts resistance to temperature as per the values in the following table. The M60 reads the RTD tem-
peratures from the RRTD once every five seconds and applies protection accordingly. The RRTDs can be used to pro-
vide RTD bias in the existing thermal model.
An RRTD open condition is detected when actual RRTD resistance is greater than 1000 ohms and RRTD open is dis-
played as “250°C” in the M60.
An RRTD short condition is detected when actual RRTD temperature is less than –40°C and RRTD short is displayed
as is “–50°C”. in the M60.
• RRTD 1 APPLICATION: This setting allows each remote RTD to be assigned to a group application. This is useful for
applications that require group measurement for voting. A value of “None” specifies that the remote RTD will operate
individually and not part of any RTD group. All remote RTDs programmed to “Stator” are used for RTD biasing of the
M60 thermal model. Common groups are provided for rotating machines applications such as ambient, bearing, group
1, or group 2. If the REMOTE RTD 1 TRIP VOTING setting value is “Group”, then it is allowed to issue a trip if N – 1 RTDs
from the same group also pick up, where N is the number of enabled RTDs from the group.
• RRTD 1 ALARM TEMPERATURE: This setting specifies the temperature pickup level for the alarm stage. The range
of 1 to 200°C differs from the existing RTD settings to correspond to the range of the RRTD unit.
• RRTD 1 ALARM PKP DELAY: This setting specifies time delay for the alarm stage until the output can be asserted.
The range of 5 to 600 seconds differs from the existing RTD settings to correspond to the range of the RRTD unit.
• RRTD 1 TRIP TEMPERATURE: This setting specifies the temperature pickup level for the trip stage. The range of 1 to
200°C differs from the existing RTD settings to correspond to the range of the RRTD unit.
• RRTD 1 TRIP PKP DELAY: This setting specifies time delay for the trip stage until the output can be asserted. The
range of 5 to 600 seconds differs from the existing RTD settings to correspond to the range of the RRTD unit.
• RRTD 1 TRIP RST DELAY: This setting specifies the reset delay to seal-in the trip signal.
• RRTD 1 TRIP VOTING: This setting allows securing trip signal by voting with other RTDs. A value of “None” indicates
that element operates individually and no voting takes place.
A value of “Group” indicates that element is allowed to issue a trip if N – 1 of other RTDs of the same group pick up as
well (where N is the number of enabled RTDs from the group). For example, if three RTDs are assigned to the same
group, there should be at least one additional RTD of the same group picked up to issue a trip command.
5 The “Remote RTD 1” through “Remote RTD 12” values indicate that element is allowed to issue a trip if the corre-
sponding peer RTD is also picked up.
• RRTD 1 OPEN: This setting allows monitoring an open remote RTD sensor circuit. If this functionality is not required,
then a value of “None” will disable monitoring and assertion of output operands.
If set to “Alarm”, the monitor will set an alarm when a broken sensor is detected.
If set to “Block”, the monitor will set an alarm and simultaneously block remote RTD operation when a broken sensor is
detected.
If targets are enabled, a message will appear on the display identifying the broken RTD. If this feature is used, it is rec-
ommended that the alarm be programmed as latched so that intermittent RTDs are detected and corrective action may
be taken.
• RRTD 1 BLOCK: This setting is used to block remote RTD operation.
SETTINGS
Function
Enabled = 1
Block AND
Off = 0
SETTINGS
SETTINGS Trip Pickup Delay SETTINGS
AND
Trip Temperature Trip Reset Delay Application
SETTING
Alarm Temperature Alarm Pickup Delay Trip Voting
Type
RUN TPKP FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
Temperature read Voting logic REMOTE RTD 1 TRIP OP
temperature > Trip Pickup TDPO
from RRTD
RUN TPKP
temperature > Alarm Pickup From other remote FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
0 RTDs for voting
RRTD 1 ALARM OP
SETTING
RRTD 1 TRIP PKP
Open
Block RRTD 1 TRIP DPO
RUN
Alarm RRTD 1 ALARM PKP
R > 1000 ohms OR
None RRTD 1 ALARM DPO
RUN RRTD 1 OPEN
RRTD 1 SHORTED
T £ –40°C
833026A1.CDR
DCMA OUTPUT H1 DCMA OUTPUT H1 Range: Off, any analog actual value parameter
5
SOURCE: Off
DCMA OUTPUT H1 Range: –1 to 1 mA, 0 to 1 mA, 4 to 20 mA
MESSAGE
RANGE: –1 to 1 mA
DCMA OUTPUT H1 Range: –90.000 to 90.000 pu in steps of 0.001
MESSAGE
MIN VAL: 0.000 pu
DCMA OUTPUT H1 Range: –90.000 to 90.000 pu in steps of 0.001
MESSAGE
MAX VAL: 1.000 pu
Hardware and software is provided to generate DCmA signals that allow interfacing with external equipment. Specific hard-
ware details are contained in chapter 3. The DCmA output channels are arranged in a manner similar to transducer input or
CT and VT channels. The user configures individual channels with the settings shown below.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up, the
relay automatically generates configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same manner used
for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8 inclusive, which is used as
the channel number.
Both the output range and a signal driving a given output are user-programmable via the following settings menu (an exam-
ple for channel M5 is shown).
The relay checks the driving signal (x in equations below) for the minimum and maximum limits, and subsequently re-
scales so the limits defined as MIN VAL and MAX VAL match the output range of the hardware defined as RANGE. The follow-
ing equation is applied:
The feature is intentionally inhibited if the MAX VAL and MIN VAL settings are entered incorrectly, e.g. when MAX VAL – MIN
VAL< 0.1 pu. The resulting characteristic is illustrated in the following figure.
9]Qh
?ED@ED3EBB5>D
9]Y^
4B9F9>7C97>1<
($"'#)1!34B =9>F1< =1HF1<
Figure 5–132: DCMA OUTPUT CHARACTERISTIC
The base unit for power (refer to the FlexElements section in this chapter for additional details) is:
P BASE = 115 V 120 1.2 kA = 16.56 MW (EQ 5.55)
The minimum and maximum power values to be monitored (in pu) are:
– 20.65 MW 20.65 MW
minimum power = ------------------------------ = – 1.247 pu, maximum power = --------------------------- = 1.247 pu (EQ 5.56)
16.56 MW 16.56 MW
The following settings should be entered:
DCMA OUTPUT H1 SOURCE: “SRC 1 P”
DCMA OUTPUT H1 RANGE: “–1 to 1 mA”
DCMA OUTPUT H1 MIN VAL: “–1.247 pu”
DCMA OUTPUT H1 MAX VAL: “1.247 pu”
With the above settings, the output will represent the power with the scale of 1 mA per 20.65 MW. The worst-case error for
this application can be calculated by superimposing the following two sources of error:
• ±0.5% of the full scale for the analog output module, or 0.005 1 – – 1 20.65 MW = 0.207 MW
• ±1% of reading error for the active power at power factor of 0.9
For example at the reading of 20 MW, the worst-case error is 0.01 20 MW + 0.207 MW = 0.407 MW.
EXAMPLE: CURRENT MONITORING
The phase A current (true RMS value) is to be monitored via the H2 current output working with the range from 4 to 20 mA.
The CT ratio is 5000:5 and the maximum load current is 4200 A. The current should be monitored from 0 A upwards, allow-
ing for 50% overload.
The phase current with the 50% overload margin is:
5
I max = 1.5 4.2 kA = 6.3 kA (EQ 5.57)
The base unit for current (refer to the FlexElements section in this chapter for additional details) is:
I BASE = 5 kA (EQ 5.58)
The minimum and maximum power values to be monitored (in pu) are:
0 kA 6.3 kA
minimum current = ------------ = 0 pu, maximum current = ----------------- = 1.26 pu (EQ 5.59)
5 kA 5 kA
The following settings should be entered:
DCMA OUTPUT H2 SOURCE: “SRC 1 Ia RMS”
DCMA OUTPUT H2 RANGE: “4 to 20 mA”
DCMA OUTPUT H2 MIN VAL: “0.000 pu”
DCMA OUTPUT H2 MAX VAL: “1.260 pu”
The worst-case error for this application could be calculated by superimposing the following two sources of error:
• ±0.5% of the full scale for the analog output module, or 0.005 20 – 4 6.3 kA = 0.504 kA
• ±0.25% of reading or ±0.1% of rated (whichever is greater) for currents between 0.1 and 2.0 of nominal
For example, at the reading of 4.2 kA, the worst-case error is max(0.0025 4.2 kA, 0.001 5 kA) + 0.504 kA = 0.515 kA.
EXAMPLE: VOLTAGE MONITORING
A positive-sequence voltage on a 400 kV system measured via source 2 is to be monitored by the DCmA H3 output with a
range of 0 to 1 mA. The VT secondary setting is 66.4 V, the VT ratio setting is 6024, and the VT connection setting is
“Delta”. The voltage should be monitored in the range from 70% to 110% of nominal.
The minimum and maximum positive-sequence voltages to be monitored are:
400 kV 400 kV
V min = 0.7 ------------------- = 161.66 kV, V max = 1.1 ------------------- = 254.03 kV (EQ 5.60)
3 3
The base unit for voltage (refer to the FlexElements section in this chapter for additional details) is:
The minimum and maximum voltage values to be monitored (in pu) are:
161.66 kV 254.03 kV
minimum voltage = --------------------------- = 0.404 pu, maximum voltage = --------------------------- = 0.635 pu (EQ 5.62)
400 kV 400 kV
The following settings should be entered:
DCMA OUTPUT H3 SOURCE: “SRC 2 V_1 mag”
DCMA OUTPUT H3 RANGE: “0 to 1 mA”
DCMA OUTPUT H3 MIN VAL: “0.404 pu”
DCMA OUTPUT H3 MAX VAL: “0.635 pu”
The limit settings differ from the expected 0.7 pu and 1.1 pu because the relay calculates the positive-sequence quantities
scaled to the phase-to-ground voltages, even if the VTs are connected in “Delta” (refer to the Metering Conventions section
in chapter 6), while at the same time the VT nominal voltage is 1 pu for the settings. Consequently the settings required in
this example differ from naturally expected by the factor of 3 .
The worst-case error for this application could be calculated by superimposing the following two sources of error:
• ±0.5% of the full scale for the analog output module, or 0.005 1 – 0 254.03 kV = 1.27 kV
• ±0.5% of reading
For example, under nominal conditions, the positive-sequence reads 230.94 kV and the worst-case error is
0.005 x 230.94 kV + 1.27 kV = 2.42 kV.
The M60 provides a test facility to verify the functionality of contact inputs and outputs, some communication functions and
the phasor measurement unit (where applicable), using simulated conditions. The test mode is indicated on the relay face-
plate by a Test Mode LED indicator.
The test mode may be in any of three states: disabled, isolated, or forcible.
In the “Disabled” mode, M60 operation is normal and all test features are disabled.
In the “Isolated” mode, the M60 is prevented from performing certain control actions, including tripping via contact outputs.
All relay contact outputs, including latching outputs, are disabled. Channel tests and phasor measurement unit tests remain
usable on applicable UR-series models.
In the “Forcible” mode, the operand selected by the TEST MODE FORCING setting controls the relay inputs and outputs. If the
test mode is forcible, and the operand assigned to the TEST MODE FORCING setting is “Off”, the M60 inputs and outputs
operate normally. If the test mode is forcible, and the operand assigned to the TEST MODE FORCING setting is “On”, the M60
contact inputs and outputs are forced to the values specified in the following sections. Forcing may be controlled by manu-
ally changing the operand selected by the TEST MODE FORCING setting between on and off, or by selecting a user-program-
mable pushbutton, contact input, or communication-based input operand. Channel tests and phasor measurement unit
tests remain usable on applicable UR-series models.
5
Communications based inputs and outputs remain fully operational in test mode. If a control action is programmed
using direct inputs and outputs or remote inputs and outputs, then the test procedure must take this into account.
127(
When in “Forcible” mode, the operand selected by the TEST MODE FORCING setting dictates further response of the M60 to
testing conditions. To force contact inputs and outputs through relay settings, set TEST MODE FORCING to “On”. To force con-
tact inputs and outputs through a user-programmable condition, such as FlexLogic™ operand (pushbutton, digital input,
communication-based input, or a combination of these), set TEST MODE FORCING to the desired operand. The contact input
or output is forced when the selected operand assumes a logic 1 state.
The M60 remains fully operational in test mode, allowing for various testing procedures. In particular, the protection and
control elements, FlexLogic™, and communication-based inputs and outputs function normally.
The only difference between the normal operation and the test mode is the behavior of the input and output contacts. The
contact inputs can be forced to report as open or closed or remain fully operational, whereas the contact outputs can be
forced to open, close, freeze, or remain fully operational. The response of the digital input and output contacts to the test
mode is programmed individually for each input and output using the force contact inputs and force contact outputs test
functions described in the following sections.
The test mode state is indicated on the relay faceplate by a combination of the Test Mode LED indicator, the In-Service LED
indicator, and by the critical fail relay, as shown in the following table.
The TEST MODE FUNCTION setting can only be changed by a direct user command. Following a restart, power up, settings
upload, or firmware upgrade, the test mode will remain at the last programmed value. This allows a M60 that has been
placed in isolated mode to remain isolated during testing and maintenance activities. On restart, the TEST MODE FORCING
setting and the force contact input and force contact output settings all revert to their default states.
5.10.2 FORCE CONTACT INPUTS
5 FORCE CONTACT
INPUTS
FORCE Cont Ip 1
:Disabled
Range: Disabled, Open, Closed
The relay digital inputs (contact inputs) could be pre-programmed to respond to the test mode in the following ways:
• If set to “Disabled”, the input remains fully operational. It is controlled by the voltage across its input terminals and can
be turned on and off by external circuitry. This value should be selected if a given input must be operational during the
test. This includes, for example, an input initiating the test, or being a part of a user pre-programmed test sequence.
• If set to “Open”, the input is forced to report as opened (Logic 0) for the entire duration of the test mode regardless of
the voltage across the input terminals.
• If set to “Closed”, the input is forced to report as closed (Logic 1) for the entire duration of the test mode regardless of
the voltage across the input terminals.
The force contact inputs feature provides a method of performing checks on the function of all contact inputs. Once
enabled, the relay is placed into test mode, allowing this feature to override the normal function of contact inputs. The Test
Mode LED will be on, indicating that the relay is in test mode. The state of each contact input may be programmed as “Dis-
abled”, “Open”, or “Closed”. All contact input operations return to normal when all settings for this feature are disabled.
The relay contact outputs can be pre-programmed to respond to the test mode.
If set to “Disabled”, the contact output remains fully operational. If operates when its control operand is logic 1 and will
resets when its control operand is logic 0. If set to “Energized”, the output will close and remain closed for the entire dura-
tion of the test mode, regardless of the status of the operand configured to control the output contact. If set to “De-ener-
gized”, the output will open and remain opened for the entire duration of the test mode regardless of the status of the
operand configured to control the output contact. If set to “Freeze”, the output retains its position from before entering the
test mode, regardless of the status of the operand configured to control the output contact.
These settings are applied two ways. First, external circuits may be tested by energizing or de-energizing contacts. Sec-
ond, by controlling the output contact state, relay logic may be tested and undesirable effects on external circuits avoided.
Example 1: Initiating test mode through user-programmable pushbutton 1
For example, the test mode can be initiated from user-programmable pushbutton 1. The pushbutton will be programmed as
“Latched” (pushbutton pressed to initiate the test, and pressed again to terminate the test). During the test, digital input 1
5
should remain operational, digital inputs 2 and 3 should open, and digital input 4 should close. Also, contact output 1 should
freeze, contact output 2 should open, contact output 3 should close, and contact output 4 should remain fully operational.
The required settings are shown below.
To enable user-programmable pushbutton 1 to initiate the test mode, make the following changes in the SETTINGS
TESTING TEST MODE menu: TEST MODE FUNCTION: “Enabled” and TEST MODE INITIATE: “PUSHBUTTON 1 ON”
Make the following changes to configure the contact inputs and outputs. In the SETTINGS TESTING FORCE CONTACT
INPUTS and FORCE CONTACT OUTPUTS menus, set:
FORCE Cont Ip 1: “Disabled”, FORCE Cont Ip 2: “Open”, FORCE Cont Ip 3: “Open”, and FORCE Cont Ip 4: “Closed”
FORCE Cont Op 1: “Freeze”, FORCE Cont Op 2: “De-energized”, FORCE Cont Op 3: “Energized”,
and FORCE Cont Op 4: “Disabled”
Example 2: Initiating a test from user-programmable pushbutton 1 or through remote input 1
In this example, the test can be initiated locally from user-programmable pushbutton 1 or remotely through remote input 1.
Both the pushbutton and the remote input will be programmed as “Latched”. Write the following FlexLogic™ equation:
Set the user-programmable pushbutton as latching by changing SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE
PUSHBUTTONS USER PUSHBUTTON 1 PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION to “Latched”. To enable either pushbutton 1 or remote
input 1 to initiate the Test mode, make the following changes in the SETTINGS TESTING TEST MODE menu:
TEST MODE FUNCTION: “Enabled” and TEST MODE INITIATE: “VO1”
IEC 61850
See page 6-22.
GOOSE ANALOGS
TRANSDUCER I/O
See page 6-22.
6 DCMA INPUTS
TRANSDUCER I/O
See page 6-22.
RTD INPUTS
6.2STATUS
For status reporting, ‘On’ represents Logic 1 and ‘Off’ represents Logic 0.
127(
6.2.1 MOTOR
The MOTOR STATUS value reflects operating state of the motor. The MOTOR THERMAL CAPACITY USED represents the thermal
model accumulated thermal capacity used as a percentage value. The ESTIMATED TRIP TIME ON OVERLOAD value rep-
resents the estimated time to trip (in seconds) from the thermal model assuming that the motor current remains at its cur-
rent level. It is obtained from the thermal model curve and takes into account that some percent of the thermal capacity has
6
already been used.
The THERMAL LOCKOUT TIME reflects the calculated time required for the thermal capacity used to decay from its current
value to the level when thermal start inhibit is removed and new motor start is permitted. The THERMAL LOCKOUT TIME value
is displayed only when motor is offline. For details of lockout time calculations see the Thermal Model section of Chapter 5.
The START/HOUR LOCKOUT TIME, TIME-BTWN-STARTS LO TIME, and RESTART DELAY LO TIME lockout time values are calcu-
lated from the Maximum Starting Rate, Time Between Starts, and Restart Delay elements, respectively. The TOTAL MOTOR
LOCKOUT TIME value is calculated as the maximum of all lockout times shown in this menu.
The present status of the contact inputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the contact
input. For example, ‘Cont Ip 1’ refers to the contact input in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of the
display indicates the logic state of the contact input.
The present status of the 64 virtual inputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the virtual
input. For example, ‘Virt Ip 1’ refers to the virtual input in terms of the default name. The second line of the display indicates
the logic state of the virtual input.
REMOTE DPS INPUTS REMOTE DPS INPUT 1 Range: On, Off, Intermediate, Bad
STATUS: BAD
REMOTE DPS INPUT 2 Range: On, Off, Intermediate, Bad
MESSAGE
STATUS: BAD
The present state of the remote double-point status inputs is shown here. The actual values indicate if the remote double-
point status inputs are in the on (close), off (open), intermediate, or bad state.
The present state of teleprotection inputs from communication channels 1 and 2 are shown here. The state displayed will
be that of corresponding remote output unless the channel is declared failed.
CONTACT OUTPUTS Cont Op 1 Range: On, Off, VOff, VOn, IOn, IOff
Off
Cont Op 2 Range: On, Off, VOff, VOn, IOn, IOff 6
MESSAGE
Off
The present state of the contact outputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the contact
output. For example, ‘Cont Op 1’ refers to the contact output in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of
the display indicates the logic state of the contact output.
For form-A contact outputs, the state of the voltage and current detectors is displayed as Off, VOff, IOff, On, IOn,
and VOn. For form-C contact outputs, the state is displayed as Off or On.
127(
The present state of up to 96 virtual outputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the virtual
output. For example, ‘Virt Op 1’ refers to the virtual output in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of the
display indicates the logic state of the virtual output, as calculated by the FlexLogic™ equation for that output.
a) STATUS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS REMOTE DEVICES STATUS
6 MESSAGE
REMOTE DEVICE 16
STATUS: Offline
Range: Online, Offline
The present state of the programmed remote devices is shown here. The ALL REMOTE DEVICES ONLINE message indicates
whether or not all programmed remote devices are online. If the corresponding state is "No", then at least one required
remote device is not online.
a) STATISTICS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS REMOTE DEVICES STATISTICS REMOTE DEVICE 1(16)
Statistical data (two types) for up to 16 programmed remote devices is shown here.
The StNum number is obtained from the indicated remote device and is incremented whenever a change of state of at
least one DNA or UserSt bit occurs. The SqNum number is obtained from the indicated remote device and is incremented
whenever a GSSE message is sent. This number will rollover to zero when a count of 4 294 967 295 is incremented.
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIGITAL COUNTERS DIGITAL COUNTERS Counter 1(8)
The present status of the eight digital counters is shown here. The status of each counter, with the user-defined counter
name, includes the accumulated and frozen counts (the count units label will also appear). Also included, is the date and
time stamp for the frozen count. The COUNTER 1 MICROS value refers to the microsecond portion of the time stamp.
The display shows both the current position and the full range. The current position only (an integer from 0 through 7) is the
actual value.
There are 256 FlexState bits available. The second line value indicates the state of the given FlexState bit.
6.2.13 ETHERNET
These values indicate the status of the primary and secondary Ethernet links.
The AVERAGE MSG RETURN TIME is the time taken for direct output messages to return to the sender in a direct input/output
ring configuration (this value is not applicable for non-ring configurations). This is a rolling average calculated for the last
ten messages. There are two return times for dual-channel communications modules.
The UNRETURNED MSG COUNT values (one per communications channel) count the direct output messages that do not
make the trip around the communications ring. The CRC FAIL COUNT values (one per communications channel) count the
direct output messages that have been received but fail the CRC check. High values for either of these counts may indicate
on a problem with wiring, the communication channel, or one or more relays. The UNRETURNED MSG COUNT and CRC FAIL
COUNT values can be cleared using the CLEAR DIRECT I/O COUNTERS command.
The DIRECT INPUT 1 to DIRECT INPUT (32) values represent the state of each direct input.
These actual values represent the state of direct devices 1 through 16.
UINT INPUT 16
MESSAGE
0
The M60 Motor Protection System is provided with optional IEC 61850 communications capability. This
feature is specified as a software option at the time of ordering. Refer to the Ordering section of chapter 2
for additional details. The IEC 61850 protocol features are not available if CPU type E is ordered.
The IEC 61850 GGIO5 integer input data points are displayed in this menu. The GGIO5 integer data values are received
via IEC 61850 GOOSE messages sent from other devices.
a) FAST EXCHANGE
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS EGD PROTOCOL STATUS PRODUCER STATUS FAST EXCHANGE 1
These values provide information that may be useful for debugging an EGD network. The EGD signature and packet size
for the fast EGD exchange is displayed.
b) SLOW EXCHANGE
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS EGD PROTOCOL STATUS PRODUCER STATUS SLOW EXCHANGE 1(2)
These values provide information that may be useful for debugging an EGD network. The EGD signature and packet size
for the slow EGD exchanges are displayed.
• VALIDITY OF CHANNEL CONFIGURATION: This value displays the current state of the communications channel
identification check, and hence validity. If a remote relay ID does not match the programmed ID at the local relay, the
“FAIL” message will be displayed. The “N/A” value appears if the local relay ID is set to a default value of “0”, the chan-
nel is failed, or if the teleprotection inputs/outputs are not enabled.
These actual values appear only if the M60 is ordered with an Ethernet switch module (type 2S or 2T). The status informa-
tion for the Ethernet switch is shown in this menu.
• SWITCH 1 PORT STATUS to SWITCH 6 PORT STATUS: These values represents the receiver status of each port on
the Ethernet switch. If the value is “OK”, then data is being received from the remote terminal; If the value is “FAIL”,
then data is not being received from the remote terminal or the port is not connected.
• SWITCH MAC ADDRESS: This value displays the MAC address assigned to the Ethernet switch module.
3(5,(((&219(17,216
*HQHUDWRU
3DUDPHWHUVDVVHHQE\
* WKH85VHULHVUHOD\V
9ROWDJH 4
9&*
:DWWV 3RVLWLYH ,&
3) /HDG 3) /DJ
9DUV 3RVLWLYH
3) /DJ ,$
9$* ²3 3
&XUUHQW ,% ,$
3) /DJ 3) /HDG
856(5,(6,('
9%*
²4
0 /2$' ²š
,QGXFWLYH 5HVLVWLYH 6 9,
*HQHUDWRU
*
9&* 4
9ROWDJH
3) /HDG 3) /DJ
:DWWV 3RVLWLYH ,$
9DUV 1HJDWLYH ,&
3) /HDG 9$* ²3 3
,$
&XUUHQW
3) /DJ 3) /HDG
,%
856(5,(6,('
9%* ²4
6 9,
/2$'
²š
6
5HVLVWLYH
,QGXFWLYH 5HVLVWLYH
0 /2$'
9&* 4
4
9&*
9ROWDJH ,%
3) /HDG 3) /DJ
:DWWV 1HJDWLYH ,$
9DUV 3RVLWLYH 9$* ²3 3
3) /HDG
,$ ,&
Figure 6–1: FLOW DIRECTION OF SIGNED VALUES FOR WATTS AND VARS
R
R R
SRVLWLYH
DQJOH
GLUHFWLRQ
R R
85SKDVHDQJOH
UHIHUHQFH
R R
6
R
$&'5
The zero-sequence voltage is not measurable under the Delta connection of instrument transformers and is defaulted to
zero. The table below shows an example of symmetrical components calculations for the ABC phase rotation.
Table 6–1: SYMMETRICAL COMPONENTS CALCULATION EXAMPLE
SYSTEM VOLTAGES, SEC. V * VT RELAY INPUTS, SEC. V SYMM. COMP, SEC. V
CONN.
VAG VBG VCG VAB VBC VCA F5AC F6AC F7AC V0 V1 V2
13.9 76.2 79.7 84.9 138.3 85.4 WYE 13.9 76.2 79.7 19.5 56.5 23.3
0° –125° –250° –313° –97° –241° 0° –125° –250° –192° –7° –187°
UNKNOWN (only V1 and V2 84.9 138.3 85.4 DELTA 84.9 138.3 85.4 N/A 56.5 23.3
can be determined) 0° –144° –288° 0° –144° –288° –54° –234°
* The power system voltages are phase-referenced – for simplicity – to VAG and VAB, respectively. This, however, is a
relative matter. It is important to remember that the M60 displays are always referenced as specified under SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP POWER SYSTEM FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE.
The example above is illustrated in the following figure.
6\VWHPYROWDJHV 6\PPHWULFDO
FRPSRQHQWV
85VHULHVSKDVH
DQJOHUHIHUHQFH
6
85VHULHVSKDVH
DQJOHUHIHUHQFH
$
:\H97V
&
%
85
DQ V
JO HUL
H HV
UH S
IH KD
UH V
QF H
H
8
$ DQ 5V
JO HUL
H HV
UH S
IH KD
UH V
'HOWD97V QF H
H
&
%
$&'5
The phasors of differential and restraint currents are displayed in primary amperes.
6.3.3 MOTOR
6.3.4 SOURCES
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING SOURCE SRC1
This menu displays the metered values available for each source.
Metered values presented for each source depend on the phase and auxiliary VTs and phase and ground CTs assignments
for this particular source. For example, if no phase VT is assigned to this source, then any voltage, energy, and power val-
ues will be unavailable.
The metered phase current values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text will be replaced by whatever name was
programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
The metered ground current values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text will be replaced by whatever name was
programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
The metered phase voltage values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text will be replaced by whatever name was
programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
The metered auxiliary voltage values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text will be replaced by whatever name was
programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
f) POWER METERING
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING SOURCE SRC 1 POWER
6
SRC 1 REAL POWER
MESSAGE
b: 0.000 W
SRC 1 REAL POWER
MESSAGE
c: 0.000 W
SRC 1 REACTIVE PWR
MESSAGE
3: 0.000 var
SRC 1 REACTIVE PWR
MESSAGE
a: 0.000 var
SRC 1 REACTIVE PWR
MESSAGE
b: 0.000 var
SRC 1 REACTIVE PWR
MESSAGE
c: 0.000 var
SRC 1 APPARENT PWR
MESSAGE
3: 0.000 VA
SRC 1 APPARENT PWR
MESSAGE
a: 0.000 VA
SRC 1 APPARENT PWR
MESSAGE
b: 0.000 VA
SRC 1 APPARENT PWR
MESSAGE
c: 0.000 VA
The metered values for real, reactive, and apparent power, as well as power factor, are displayed in this menu. The "SRC
1" text is replaced by whatever name was programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM
SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
When VTs are configured in wye, the M60 calculates power in each phase and three-phase power is measured as
S = VA x ÎA + VB x ÎB + VC x ÎC (EQ 6.1)
When VTs are configured in delta, the M60 does not calculate power in each phase and three-phase power is measured as
S = VAB x ÎA + VCB x ÎC (EQ 6.2)
where
S is the apparent power
VA, VB, VC, IA, IB, IC are phase voltage and phase current phasors
VAB and VCB are phase-to-phase voltage phasors
Î is the conjugate of I
g) ENERGY METERING
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING SOURCE SRC 1 ENERGY
The metered values for real and reactive energy are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text will be replaced by whatever
name was programmed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
Because energy values are accumulated, these values should be recorded and then reset immediately prior to changing
CT or VT characteristics.
h) FREQUENCY METERING
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING SOURCE SRC 1 FREQUENCY
The metered frequency values are displayed in this menu. The "SRC 1" text will be replaced by whatever name was pro-
grammed by the user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
SOURCE FREQUENCY is measured via software-implemented zero-crossing detection of an AC signal. The signal is either a
Clarke transformation of three-phase voltages or currents, auxiliary voltage, or ground current as per source configuration
(see the SYSTEM SETUP POWER SYSTEM settings). The signal used for frequency estimation is low-pass filtered. The
final frequency measurement is passed through a validation filter that eliminates false readings due to signal distortions and
transients.
The effective operating quantities of the sensitive directional power elements are displayed here. The display may be useful
to calibrate the feature by compensating the angular errors of the CTs and VTs with the use of the RCA and CALIBRATION
settings.
6 MESSAGE
LOAD DEV.AT BRB
CALC.: 0.01 x FLA
TIME OF BRB CALC.:
MESSAGE
2009/03/05 10:22:39
MAXIMUM COMPONENT
MESSAGE
LEVEL: -58.3 dB
MAXIMUM COMPONENT
MESSAGE
FREQ.: 62.05 Hz
MOTOR LOAD AT BRB
MESSAGE
MAX: 0.95 x FLA
LOAD DEV. AT BRB
MESSAGE
MAX: 0.02 x FLA
TIME OF MAXIMUM BRB:
MESSAGE
2009/03/04 11:32:18
The following metered values are available for the broken rotor bar detection feature.
• COMPONENT LEVEL: This value indicates the level of the broken rotor bar spectral component relative to the spec-
tral component of the system frequency.
• COMPONENT FREQ.: This value indicates the frequency of the broken rotor bar spectral component.
• MOTOR LOAD AT BRB CALC.: This value indicates the average motor load at the time of the broken rotor bar data
acquisition stage.
• LOAD DEV.AT BRB CALC.: This value indicates the motor load standard deviation at the time of the broken rotor bar
data acquisition stage.
• TIME OF BRB CALC.: This value indicates the time stamp of the broken rotor bar calculation.
• MAXIMUM COMPONENT LEVEL: This value indicates the learned maximum level of the broken rotor bar spectral
component since the last data clear.
• MAXIMUM COMPONENT FREQ.: This value indicates the frequency of the learned maximum broken rotor bar spec-
tral component.
• MOTOR LOAD AT BRB MAX: This value indicates the average motor load at the time when data for the maximum
broken rotor bar was acquired.
• LOAD DEV. AT BRB MAX: This value indicates the motor load standard deviation at the time when data for the maxi-
mum broken rotor bar was acquired.
• TIME OF MAXIMUM BRB: This value indicates the time stamp of the maximum broken rotor bar component level.
The tracking frequency is displayed here. The frequency is tracked based on the selection of the reference source with the
FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE setting in the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP POWER SYSTEM menu. Refer to the
Power System section of chapter 5 for additional details.
6.3.8 FLEXELEMENTS™
FLEXELEMENT 1 FLEXELEMENT 1
OpSig: 0.000
6
The operating signals for the FlexElements™ are displayed in pu values using the following definitions of the base units.
ANALOG INPUT 32
MESSAGE
0.000
The M60 is provided with optional IEC 61850 communications capability. This feature is specified as a
6 software option at the time of ordering. Refer to the Ordering section of chapter 2 for additional details.
The IEC 61850 protocol features are not available if CPU type E is ordered.
The IEC 61850 GGIO3 analog input data points are displayed in this menu. The GGIO3 analog data values are received
via IEC 61850 GOOSE messages sent from other devices.
Actual values for each DCmA input channel that is enabled are displayed with the top line as the programmed channel ID
and the bottom line as the value followed by the programmed units.
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING TRANSDUCER I/O RTD INPUTS RTD INPUT xx
Actual values for each RTD input channel that is enabled are displayed with the top line as the programmed channel ID and
the bottom line as the value.
b) RRTD INPUTS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING TRANSDUCER I/O RRTD INPUTS RRTD INPUT 1(12)
Actual values for each RRTD input channel that is enabled are displayed this menu. The top line the programmed RRTD ID
and the bottom line displays the metered value.
This menu displays the user-programmable fault report actual values. See the User-Programmable Fault Report section in
chapter 5 for additional information on this feature.
NO STARTING RECORDS
TO REPORT
or
Up to five motor starts are displayed. When the buffer is full, the newest record overwrites the oldest record.
The NUMBER OF RECORDS value indicates how many records are available to the user through the EnerVista UR Setup soft-
ware or via HTTP with Internet Explorer. The LAST CLEARED DATE value indicates the last time that learned data records
were cleared.
The values for the last motor start-running-stop cycle are available in this menu. The LAST AVRG MOTOR LOAD LEARNED
value is computed during motor running conditions at intervals defined by the MOTOR LOAD AVERAGE CALC. PERIOD setting.
This value is updated whenever new values become available.
Up to 250 motor learned data records are stored and accessible via the EnerVista UR Setup software through the following
methods.
• Select the Actual Values > Records > Motor Learned Data menu item. 6
• Select the Maintenance > Retrieve File menu item and open the “MotorLD.htm” file.
• Select the Maintenance> Retrieve File menu item and open the “MotorLD.txt” file.
The following historical data is displayed in the motor learned data records.
• Report number.
• Report date.
• Learned acceleration time (in seconds).
• Learned starting current (in multiples of full load current).
• Learned starting capacity (in percent).
• Learned average motor load (in multiples of full load current).
• Learned run time after start (in hours).
The learned values for acceleration time and effective starting current are the maximum of the individual values acquired
for the last N successful starts, where N is defined by the NUMBER OF STARTS TO LEARN setting.
The learned value for the starting thermal capacity is calculated using the maximum of the last motor start measurements
and incorporates a security margin defined by the SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) MOTOR
THERMAL MODEL START INHIBIT TCU MARGIN setting. For example, if the thermal capacity used for the last five starts is
24, 23, 27, 26, and 21%, respectively, with the START INHIBIT TCU MARGIN = 25%, then the LEARNED STARTING CAPACITY is
27% × 1.25 = 33.75%.
Learned values associated with motor acceleration require the acceleration time function to be enabled. The
learned features are not be used until at least N + 1 successful motor starts have occurred.
127(
The starting capacity, starting current, and acceleration time values for the last start are displayed in ACTUAL VALUES STA-
TUS MOTOR menu. Clearing the motor data (refer to the Clear Records section in chapter 7) resets these values to their
default.
Idle
Motor starting
(status)
Capture starting
thermal capacity
11 12 1
10 2
9
8 4
3
Acceleration time
7 6 5
No
I > 0 and
I < overload PKP
Yes Successful start
Motor running
(status)
−N
Capture thermal TC learned = max TC nlearned ,..., TC nlearned Store learned thermal capacity used
capacity used × Start TCU margin
11 12 1
10
9
8
2
4
3
1 minute Store last thermal capacity used
7 6 5
n n− N
Every 1 minute - sum Iload ,..., Iload
Iload = Store average load current every
6
capture load current tavg tavg interval and update display
Motor stopped
(status)
833724A1.CDR
EVENT: 3 EVENT 3
MESSAGE
POWER ON DATE: 2000/07/14
EVENT: 2 EVENT 3
MESSAGE
POWER OFF TIME: 14:53:00.03405
EVENT: 1
MESSAGE Date and Time Stamps
EVENTS CLEARED
The event records menu shows the contextual data associated with up to the last 1024 events, listed in chronological order
from most recent to oldest. If all 1024 event records have been filled, the oldest record will be removed as a new record is
added. Each event record shows the event identifier/sequence number, cause, and date/time stamp associated with the
event trigger. See the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing event records.
Only major output operands generate events, not every operand. Elements that assert output per phase, for example, log
operating phase output only without asserting the common three-phase operand event.
6.4.5 OSCILLOGRAPHY
This menu allows the user to view the number of triggers involved and number of oscillography traces available. The
CYCLES PER RECORD value is calculated to account for the fixed amount of data storage for oscillography. See the Oscillog-
raphy section of chapter 5 for additional details.
A trigger can be forced here at any time by setting “Yes” to the FORCE TRIGGER? command. Refer to the COMMANDS
CLEAR RECORDS menu for information on clearing the oscillography records.
The OLDEST SAMPLE TIME represents the time at which the oldest available samples were taken. It will be static until the log
gets full, at which time it will start counting at the defined sampling rate. The NEWEST SAMPLE TIME represents the time the
most recent samples were taken. It counts up at the defined sampling rate. If the data logger channels are defined, then
both values are static.
Refer to the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing data logger records.
MODEL INFORMATION ORDER CODE LINE 1: Range: standard GE order code format;
M60-A00-HCH-F8A-H6A example order code shown
The order code, serial number, Ethernet MAC address, date and time of manufacture, and operating time are shown here.
The shown data is illustrative only. A modification file number of 0 indicates that, currently, no modifications have been
installed.
COMMANDS
COMMANDS
MESSAGE
VIRTUAL INPUTS
COMMANDS
MESSAGE
CLEAR RECORDS
COMMANDS
MESSAGE
SET DATE AND TIME
COMMANDS
MESSAGE
RELAY MAINTENANCE
The commands menu contains relay directives intended for operations personnel. All commands can be protected from
unauthorized access via the command password; see the Security section of chapter 5 for details. The following flash mes-
sage appears after successfully command entry:
COMMAND
EXECUTED
MESSAGE
Virt Ip 64
Off
Range: Off, On
7
The states of up to 64 virtual inputs are changed here. The first line of the display indicates the ID of the virtual input. The
second line indicates the current or selected status of the virtual input. This status will be a state off (logic 0) or on (logic 1).
This menu contains commands for clearing historical data such as the event records. Data is cleared by changing a com-
mand setting to “Yes” and pressing the ENTER key. After clearing data, the command setting automatically reverts to “No”.
The date and time can be entered here via the faceplate keypad only if the IRIG-B or SNTP signal is not in use. The time
setting is based on the 24-hour clock. The complete date, as a minimum, must be entered to allow execution of this com-
mand. The new time will take effect at the moment the ENTER key is clicked.
This menu contains commands for relay maintenance purposes. Commands for the lamp test and order code are activated
by changing a command setting to “Yes” and pressing the ENTER key. The command setting will then automatically revert
to “No”. The service command is activated by entering a numerical code and pressing the ENTER key.
The PERFORM LAMP TEST command turns on all faceplate LEDs and display pixels for a short duration. The UPDATE
ORDER CODE command causes the relay to scan the backplane for the hardware modules and update the order code to
match. If an update occurs, the following message is shown.
UPDATING...
PLEASE WAIT
There is no impact if there have been no changes to the hardware modules. When an update does not occur, the ORDER
CODE NOT UPDATED message will be shown.
The SERVICE COMMAND is used to perform specific M60 service actions. Presently, there is only one service action avail-
able. Code “101” is used to clear factory diagnostic information stored in the non-volatile memory. If a code other than “101”
is entered, the command will be ignored and no actions will be taken. Various self-checking diagnostics are performed in
the background while the M60 is running, and diagnostic information is stored on the non-volatile memory from time to time
based on the self-checking result. Although the diagnostic information is cleared before the M60 is shipped from the factory,
the user may want to clear the diagnostic information for themselves under certain circumstances. For example, it may be
desirable to clear diagnostic information after replacement of hardware. Once the diagnostic information is cleared, all self-
checking variables are reset to their initial state and diagnostics will restart from scratch.
TARGETS
PHASE TOC4 Displayed only if targets for this element are active.
MESSAGE Example shown.
OP: A B -
DIGITAL ELEMENT 48: Displayed only if targets for this element are active.
MESSAGE Example shown.
LATCHED
MESSAGE
Each M60 element with a TARGET setting has a target message that when activated by its element is displayed in
sequence with any other currently active target messages in the TARGETS menu. In the example shown, the Phase TOC4
and Digital Element 48 target settings are active and so have their targets displayed. The down arrow below the two ele-
ments indicates that there can be other active elements beyond these two.
For more information, see the description of target messages in the next section, and the Introduction to Elements section
in the Settings chapter for instructions on TARGET setting.
When no targets are active, the display reads NO ACTIVE TARGETS.
When there are no active targets, the first target to become active will cause the display to immediately default to that mes-
sage. If there are active targets and the user is navigating through other messages, and when the default message timer
times out (i.e. the keypad has not been used for a determined period of time), the display will again default back to the tar-
get message.
The range of variables for the target messages is described below. Phase information will be included if applicable. If a tar-
get message status changes, the status with the highest priority will be displayed.
If a self test error is detected, a message appears indicating the cause of the error. For example UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED
indicates that the minimal relay settings have not been programmed.
a) DESCRIPTION
The relay performs a number of self-test diagnostic checks to ensure device integrity. The two types of self-tests (major and
minor) are listed in the tables below. When either type of self-test error occurs, the Trouble LED Indicator will turn on and a
target message displayed. All errors record an event in the event recorder. Latched errors can be cleared by pressing the
RESET key, providing the condition is no longer present.
Major self-test errors also result in the following:
• The critical fail relay on the power supply module is de-energized.
• All other output relays are de-energized and are prevented from further operation.
• The faceplate In Service LED indicator is turned off.
INCOMPATIBLE H/W:
Contact Factory (xxx)
EQUIPMENT MISMATCH:
with 2nd line detail
• Latched target message: No.
• Description of problem: The configuration of modules does not match the order code stored in the M60. For example,
"Card F8L Missing" means that hardware module 8L is missing from slot F inside the UR device.
• How often the test is performed: On power up. Afterwards, the backplane is checked for missing cards every five sec-
onds.
• What to do: Check all modules against the order code, ensure they are inserted properly, and cycle control power. If
the problem persists, contact the factory.
FLEXLOGIC ERROR:
with 2nd line detail
• Latched target message: No.
• Description of problem: A FlexLogic™ equation is incorrect.
• How often the test is performed: The test is event driven, performed whenever FlexLogic™ equations are modified.
• What to do: Finish all equation editing and use self tests to debug any errors.
MODULE FAILURE___:
Contact Factory (xxx)
• Latched target message: Yes.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
Replace Battery
• Latched target message: Yes.
• Description of problem: The battery is not functioning.
• How often the test is performed: The battery is monitored every five seconds. The error message displays after 60 sec-
onds if the problem persists.
• What to do: Return the power supply module to GE Grid Solutions for battery replacement.
7 MAINTENANCE ALERT:
Direct I/O Ring Break
• Latched target message: No.
• Description of problem: Direct input and output settings are configured for a ring, but the connection is not in a ring.
• How often the test is performed: Every second.
• What to do: Check direct input and output configuration and wiring.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
ENET MODULE OFFLINE
• Latched target message: No.
• Description of problem: The M60 has failed to detect the Ethernet switch.
• How often the test is performed: Monitored every five seconds. An error is issued after five consecutive failures.
• What to do: Check the M60 device and switch IP configuration settings. Check for incorrect UR port (port 7) settings on
the Ethernet switch. Check the power to the switch.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
ENET PORT # OFFLINE
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
Bad IRIG-B Signal
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
Port ## Failure
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
SNTP Failure 7
• Latched target message: No.
• Description of problem: The SNTP server is not responding.
• How often the test is performed: Every 10 to 60 seconds.
• What to do: Check SNTP configuration and network connections.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
4L Discrepancy
• Latched target message: No.
• Description of problem: A discrepancy has been detected between the actual and desired state of a latching contact
output of an installed type “4L” module.
• How often the test is performed: Upon initiation of a contact output state change.
• What to do: Verify the state of the output contact and contact the factory if the problem persists.
MAINTENANCE ALERT:
GGIO Ind xxx oscill
TEMP MONITOR:
OVER TEMPERATURE
• Latched target message: Yes.
• Description of problem: The ambient temperature is greater than the maximum operating temperature (+80°C).
7 •
•
How often the test is performed: Every hour.
What to do: Remove the M60 from service and install in a location that meets operating temperature standards.
UNEXPECTED RESTART:
Press “RESET” key
• Latched target message: Yes.
• Description of problem: Abnormal restart from modules being removed or inserted while the M60 is powered-up, when
there is an abnormal DC supply, or as a result of internal relay failure.
• How often the test is performed: Event driven.
• What to do: Contact the factory.
• How often the test is performed: Runs only if "Com2 Usage" is set to RRTD or RRTD&GPM-F. Checked every five sec-
onds.
• What to do: Check COM2 port settings, check RS485 cables.
VOLTAGE MONITOR:
with 2nd line detail
• Description of problem: The relay detected a problem with the internal voltage rails for longer than 25 seconds.
• Latched target message: Yes.
• How often the test is performed: Every five seconds.
• What to do: Contact GE customer service.
For the ACCESS LEVEL, the "Restricted" option means both settings and commands can be accessed, but there is no
access to factory configuration.
The "Factory Service" level is not available and intended for factory use only.
Two levels of password security are provided via the ACCESS LEVEL setting, setting and command, for which you set a
password for each. Use of a password for each level controls whether users can enter commands or change settings.
Another option is to specify setting and/or command access for individual user accounts.
The following operations are under command password supervision:
• Changing the state of virtual inputs.
• Clearing the event records.
• Clearing the oscillography records.
• Changing the date and time.
• Clearing energy records.
• Clearing the data logger.
• Clearing the user-programmable pushbutton states.
The following operations are under setting password supervision:
• Changing any setting.
• Test mode operation.
The command and setting passwords are defaulted to “0” when the relay is shipped from the factory. When a password is
set to “0”, the password security feature is disabled.
The M60 supports password entry from a local or remote connection.
Local access is defined as any access to settings or commands via the faceplate interface. This includes both keypad entry
and the through the faceplate RS232 port. Remote access is defined as any access to settings or commands via any rear
communications port. This includes both Ethernet and RS485 connections. Any changes to the local or remote passwords
enables this functionality.
When entering a settings or command password via EnerVista or any serial interface, the user must enter the correspond-
ing connection password. If the connection is to the back of the M60, the remote password must be used. If the connection
is to the RS232 port of the faceplate, the local password must be used.
The PASSWORD ACCESS EVENTS settings allows recording of password access events in the event recorder.
The local setting and command sessions are initiated by the user through the front panel display and are disabled either by
the user or by timeout (via the setting and command level access timeout settings). The remote setting and command ses-
sions are initiated by the user through the EnerVista UR Setup software and are disabled either by the user or by timeout.
The state of the session (local or remote, setting or command) determines the state of the following FlexLogic™ operands.
• ACCESS LOC SETG OFF: Asserted when local setting access is disabled. 8
• ACCESS LOC SETG ON: Asserted when local setting access is enabled.
• ACCESS LOC CMND OFF: Asserted when local command access is disabled.
• ACCESS LOC CMND ON: Asserted when local command access is enabled.
• ACCESS REM SETG OFF: Asserted when remote setting access is disabled.
• ACCESS REM SETG ON: Asserted when remote setting access is enabled.
• ACCESS REM CMND OFF: Asserted when remote command access is disabled.
• ACCESS REM CMND ON: Asserted when remote command access is enabled.
The appropriate events are also logged in the Event Recorder as well. The FlexLogic™ operands and events are updated
every five seconds.
A command or setting write operation is required to update the state of all the remote and local security operands
shown above. Changing the password, or any other setting, does not take the relay out of service. The relay is
127(
taken out of service when a settings file is written to it.
CHANGE LOCAL
MESSAGE See page 8–2.
PASSWORDS
ACCESS
MESSAGE See page 8–4.
SUPERVISION
DUAL PERMISSION
MESSAGE See page 8–5.
SECURITY ACCESS
PASSWORD ACCESS Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
EVENTS: Disabled
Proper password codes are required to enable each access level. A password consists of 1 to 10 numerical characters.
When a CHANGE COMMAND PASSWORD or CHANGE SETTING PASSWORD setting is programmed to “Yes” via the front panel
interface, the following message sequence is invoked:
1. ENTER NEW PASSWORD: ____________.
2. VERIFY NEW PASSWORD: ____________.
3. NEW PASSWORD HAS BEEN STORED.
8 To gain write access to a “Restricted” setting, program the ACCESS LEVEL setting in the main security menu to “Setting” and
then change the setting, or attempt to change the setting and follow the prompt to enter the programmed password. If the
password is correctly entered, access will be allowed. Accessibility automatically reverts to the “Restricted” level according
to the access level timeout setting values.
If an entered password is lost (or forgotten), consult the factory with the corresponding ENCRYPTED PASSWORD.
If the setting and command passwords are identical, then this one password allows access to both commands and
settings.
127(
If a remote connection is established, local passcodes are not visible.
This menu displays when the ACCESS LEVEL setting is other than Restricted or Command.
Otherwise, in EnerVista, select the Settings > Product Setup > Password Security menu item to open the remote pass-
word settings window.
5. The new password is accepted and a value is assigned to the ENCRYPTED PASSWORD item. 8
If a command or setting password is lost (or forgotten), consult the factory with the corresponding Encrypted Password
value.
If you establish a local connection to the relay (serial), you cannot view remote passcodes.
127(
This menu displays when the ACCESS LEVEL setting is other than Restricted or Command.
The following access supervision settings are available.
• INVALID ATTEMPTS BEFORE LOCKOUT: This setting specifies the number of times an incorrect password can be
entered within a three-minute time span before lockout occurs. When lockout occurs, the LOCAL ACCESS DENIED or
REMOTE ACCESS DENIED FlexLogic™ operands are set to “On”. These operands are returned to the “Off” state upon
expiration of the lockout.
• PASSWORD LOCKOUT DURATION: This setting specifies the time that the M60 will lockout password access after
the number of invalid password entries specified by the INVALID ATTEMPTS BEFORE LOCKOUT setting has occurred.
The M60 provides a means to raise an alarm upon failed password entry. Should password verification fail while accessing
a password-protected level of the relay (either settings or commands), the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS FlexLogic™ operand is
asserted. The operand can be programmed to raise an alarm via contact outputs or communications. This feature can be
used to protect against both unauthorized and accidental access attempts.
The UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS operand is reset with the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS RESET UNAUTHORIZED
ALARMS command. Therefore, to apply this feature with security, the command level should be password-protected. The
operand does not generate events or targets.
If events or targets are required, the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS operand can be assigned to a digital element programmed
with event logs or targets enabled.
The access level timeout settings are shown below.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY ACCESS SUPERVISION ACCESS LEVEL TIMEOUTS
These settings allow the user to specify the length of inactivity required before returning to the restricted access level. Note
that the access level will set as restricted if control power is cycled.
8 • COMMAND LEVEL ACCESS TIMEOUT: This setting specifies the length of inactivity (no local or remote access)
required to return to restricted access from the command password level.
• SETTING LEVEL ACCESS TIMEOUT: This setting specifies the length of inactivity (no local or remote access)
required to return to restricted access from the command password level.
DUAL PERMISSION LOCAL SETTING AUTH: Range: selected FlexLogic™ operands (see below)
SECURITY ACCESS On
REMOTE SETTING AUTH: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
On
ACCESS AUTH Range: 5 to 480 minutes in steps of 1
MESSAGE
TIMEOUT: 30 min
This menu displays when the ACCESS LEVEL setting is other than Restricted or Command.
The dual permission security access feature provides a mechanism for customers to prevent unauthorized or unintended
upload of settings to a relay through the local or remote interfaces interface.
The following settings are available through the local (front panel) interface only.
• LOCAL SETTING AUTH: This setting is used for local (front panel or RS232 interface) setting access supervision.
Valid values for the FlexLogic™ operands are either “On” (default) or any physical “Contact Input ~~ On” value.
If this setting is “On“, then local setting access functions as normal; that is, a local setting password is required. If this
setting is any contact input on FlexLogic™ operand, then the operand must be asserted (set as on) prior to providing
the local setting password to gain setting access.
If setting access is not authorized for local operation (front panel or RS232 interface) and the user attempts to obtain
setting access, then the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS message is displayed on the front panel.
If this setting is "Off," firmware upgrades are blocked. If this setting is "On," firmware upgrades are allowed.
• REMOTE SETTING AUTH: This setting is used for remote (Ethernet or RS485 interfaces) setting access supervision.
If this setting is “On” (the default setting), then remote setting access functions as normal; that is, a remote password is
required). If this setting is “Off”, then remote setting access is blocked even if the correct remote setting password is
provided. If this setting is any other FlexLogic™ operand, then the operand must be asserted (set as on) prior to pro-
viding the remote setting password to gain setting access.
If this setting is "Off," firmware upgrades are blocked. If this setting is "On," firmware upgrades are allowed.
• ACCESS AUTH TIMEOUT: This setting represents the timeout delay for local setting access. This setting is applicable
when the LOCAL SETTING AUTH setting is programmed to any operand except “On”. The state of the FlexLogic™ oper-
and is continuously monitored for an off-to-on transition. When this occurs, local access is permitted and the timer pro-
grammed with the ACCESS AUTH TIMEOUT setting value is started. When this timer expires, local setting access is
immediately denied. If access is permitted and an off-to-on transition of the FlexLogic™ operand is detected, the time-
out is restarted. The status of this timer is updated every five seconds.
The following settings are available through the remote (EnerVista UR Setup) interface only. Select the Settings > Product
Setup > Security menu item to display the security settings window.
The Remote Settings Authorization setting is used for remote (Ethernet or RS485 interfaces) setting access supervision.
If this setting is “On” (the default setting), then remote setting access functions as normal; that is, a remote password is
required. If this setting is “Off”, then remote setting access is blocked even if the correct remote setting password is pro-
vided. If this setting is any other FlexLogic™ operand, then the operand must be asserted (set as on) prior to providing the
remote setting password to gain setting access.
The Access Authorization Timeout setting represents the timeout delay remote setting access. This setting is applicable
when the Remote Settings Authorization setting is programmed to any operand except “On” or “Off”. The state of the
FlexLogic™ operand is continuously monitored for an off-to-on transition. When this occurs, remote setting access is per-
mitted and the timer programmed with the Access Authorization Timeout setting value is started. When this timer
expires, remote setting access is immediately denied. If access is permitted and an off-to-on transition of the FlexLogic™
operand is detected, the timeout is restarted. The status of this timer is updated every five seconds.
Setting file templates simplify the configuration and commissioning of multiple relays that protect similar assets. An exam-
ple of this is a substation that has ten similar feeders protected by 10 UR-series F60 relays.
In these situations, typically 90% or greater of the settings are identical between all devices. The templates feature allows
engineers to configure and test these common settings, then lock them so they are not available to users. For example,
these locked down settings can be hidden from view for field engineers, allowing them to quickly identify and concentrate
on the specific settings.
The remaining settings (typically 10% or less) can be specified as editable and be made available to field engineers install-
ing the devices. These will be settings such as protection element pickup values and CT and VT ratios.
The settings template mode allows the user to define which settings will be visible in EnerVista UR Setup. Settings tem-
plates can be applied to both settings files (settings file templates) and online devices (online settings templates). The func-
tionality is identical for both purposes.
The settings template feature requires that both the EnerVista UR Setup software and the M60 firmware are at ver-
sions 5.40 or higher.
127(
The software will prompt for a template password. This password is required to use the template feature and must be
at least four characters in length.
3. Enter and re-enter the new password, then click OK to continue. 8
The online settings template is now enabled. The device is now in template editing mode.
By default, all settings are specified as locked and displayed against a grey background. The icon on the upper right of
the settings window also indicates that the EnerVista software is in EDIT mode. The following example shows the
phase time overcurrent settings window in edit mode.
The software will prompt for a template password. This password must be at least four characters in length.
8
The template specifies that only the Pickup and Curve
Phase time overcurrent settings window without template applied.
settings be available.
842858A1.CDR
Figure 8–4: APPLYING TEMPLATES VIA THE VIEW IN TEMPLATE MODE COMMAND
Viewing the settings in template mode also modifies the settings tree, showing only the settings categories that contain
editable settings. The effect of applying the template to a typical settings tree view is shown below.
Typical settings tree view without template applied. Typical settings tree view with template applied via
the Template Mode > View In Template Mode
command.
842860A1.CDR
Figure 8–5: APPLYING TEMPLATES VIA THE VIEW IN TEMPLATE MODE SETTINGS COMMAND
Use the following procedure to display settings available for editing and settings locked by the template.
1. Right-click the device in the Online or Offline Window area and apply the template by selecting the Template Mode >
View All Settings option.
2. Enter the template password then click OK to apply the template.
Once the template has been applied, users will only be able to edit the settings specified by the template, but all settings
will be shown. The effect of applying the template to the phase time overcurrent settings is shown below.
8 Phase time overcurrent settings window without template applied. Phase time overcurrent window with template applied via
the Template Mode > View All Settings command.
The template specifies that only the Pickup and Curve
settings be available.
842859A1.CDR
Figure 8–6: APPLYING TEMPLATES VIA THE VIEW ALL SETTINGS COMMAND
3. Verify one more time that you wish to remove the template by clicking Yes.
The EnerVista software will remove all template information and all settings will be available.
The UR allows users to secure parts or all of a FlexLogic™ equation, preventing unauthorized viewing or modification of
critical FlexLogic™ applications. This is accomplished using the settings template feature to lock individual entries within
FlexLogic™ equations.
Secured FlexLogic™ equations will remain secure when files are sent to and retrieved from any UR-series device.
Once the template has been applied, users will only be able to view and edit the FlexLogic™ entries not locked by the tem-
plate. The effect of applying the template to the FlexLogic™ entries in the above procedure is shown below.
Typical FlexLogic™ entries without template applied. Typical FlexLogic™ entries locked with template via
the Template Mode > View In Template Mode command.
842861A1.CDR
8
Figure 8–9: SECURED FLEXLOGIC™ IN GRAPHICAL VIEW
1. Right-click the setting file in the Offline Window area and select the Edit Settings File Properties option. The window
opens.
A traceability feature for settings files allows the user to quickly determine if the settings in a M60 device have been
changed since the time of installation from a settings file. When a settings file is transferred to a M60 device, the date, time,
and serial number of the M60 are sent back to EnerVista UR Setup and added to the settings file on the local computer.
This information can be compared with the M60 actual values at any later date to determine if security has been compro-
mised.
The traceability information is only included in the settings file if a complete settings file is either transferred to the M60
device or obtained from the M60 device. Any partial settings transfers by way of drag and drop do not add the traceability
information to the settings file.
The serial number of the UR-series device and the file transfer
date are added to the settings file when settings files
are transferred to the device.
842863A1.CDR
Traceability data
in settings report
842862A1.CDR
842865A1.CDR
The EnerVista security management system is a role-based access control (RBAC) system that allows a security adminis-
trator to easily manage the security privileges of multiple users. This allows for access control of URPlus-series devices by
multiple personnel within a substation and conforms to the principles of RBAC as defined in ANSI INCITS 359-2004. The
EnerVista security management system is disabled by default to allow the administrator direct access to the EnerVista soft-
ware after installation. It is recommended that security be enabled before placing the device in service.
The EnerVista security management system is disabled by default. This allows access to the device immediately after
installation. When security is disabled, all users are granted administrator access.
1. Select the Security > User Management menu item to open the user management configuration window.
2. Check the Enable Security box in the lower-left corner to enable the security management system.
Security is now enabled for the EnerVista UR Setup software. It will now be necessary to enter a username and password
upon starting the software.
The following pre-requisites are required to add new users to the EnerVista security management system.
• The user adding the new user must have administrator rights.
3. Select the user access rights by checking one or more of the fields shown.
The following pre-requisites are required to modify user privileges in the EnerVista security management system.
• The user modifying the privileges must have administrator rights. 8
• The EnerVista security management system must be enabled.
The following procedure describes how to modify user privileges.
1. Select the Security > User Management menu item to open the user management configuration window.
2. Locate the username in the User field.
3. Modify the user access rights by checking or clearing one or more of the fields shown.
The saturation detector of the M60 takes advantage of the fact that any CT operates correctly for a short period of time
even under very large primary currents that would subsequently cause a very deep saturation. As a result of that, in the
case of an external fault, the differential current stays very low during the initial period of linear operation of the CTs while
the restraining signal develops rapidly. Once one or more CTs saturate, the differential current will increase. The restraining
signal, however, yields by at least a few milliseconds. During internal faults, both the differential and restraining currents
develop simultaneously. This creates characteristic patterns for the differential - restraining trajectory as depicted below.
N
differential
TTER
RN
TTE
A
ULT P
OPERATE
A
LT P
FA
FAU
RNAL
BLOCK
AL
ERN
INTE
EXT
ERN
EXTERNAL FAULT PATT
restraining
836728A1.CDR
NORMAL
SAT := 0
The differential
current below the saturation
first slope for a condition
certain period of
time
EXTERNAL
FAULT
SAT := 1
The differential-
The differential restraining trajectory
characteristic out of the differential
entered characteristic for a
certain period of time
EXTERNAL
FAULT and CT
SATURATION
SAT := 1
836729A1.CDR
Underfrequency and overfrequency protection requires techniques with subtle testing implications. Whereas most protec-
tion is designed to detect changes from normal to fault conditions that occur virtually instantaneously, power system inertia
requires frequency protection to pickup while the frequency is changing slowly. Frequency measurement is inherently sen-
sitive to noise, making high precision in combination with high speed challenging for both relays and test equipment.
Injection to a particular M60 frequency element must be to its configured source and to the channels the source uses for
frequency measurement. For frequency measurement, a source will use the first quantity configured in the following order:
1. Phase voltages.
2. Auxiliary voltage.
3. Phase currents.
4. Ground current.
For example, if only auxiliary voltage and phase currents are configured, the source will use the auxiliary voltage, not the
phase voltages or any of the currents.
When phase voltages or phase currents are used, the source applies a filter that rejects the zero-sequence component. As
such, the same signal must not be injected to all three phases, or the injected signal will be completely filtered out. For an
underfrequency element using phase quantities, the phase A signal must be above the MIN VOLT/AMP setting value. There-
fore, either inject into phase A only, or inject a balanced three-phase signal.
Frequency
Injection frequency
Source frequency
Tracking frequency
Pickup
frequency
Time
Underfrequency element detection time
To accurately measure the time delay of a frequency element, a test emulating realistic power system dynamics is required.
The injected frequency should smoothly ramp through the set threshold, with the ramp starting frequency sufficiently out-
side the threshold so the relay becomes conditioned to the trend before operation. For typical interconnected power sys-
tems, the recommended testing ramp rate is 0.20 Hz/s.
The desired delay time is the interval from the point the frequency crosses the set threshold to the point the element oper-
ates. Some test sets can measure only the time from the ramp start to element operation, necessitating the subtraction of
the pre-threshold ramp time from the reading. For example, with a ramp rate of 0.20 Hz/s, start the ramp 0.20 Hz before the
threshold and subtract 1 second from test set time reading of ramp start to relay operation.
Note that the M60 event records only show the “pickup delay” component, a definite time timer. This is exclusive of the time
taken by the frequency responding component to pickup.
The M60 oscillography can be used to measure the time between the calculated source frequency crossing the threshold
and element operation; however, this method omits the delay in the calculated source frequency. The security features of
the source frequency measurement algorithm result in the calculated frequency being delayed by 2 to 4 cycles (or longer
with noise on the input). In addition, oscillography resolution is 0.004 Hz, which at 0.20 Hz/s corresponds to a delay of
20 ms. The tracking frequency should not be used in timing measurements, as its algorithm involves phase locking, which
purposely sets its frequency high or low to allow the M60 sample clock to catch-up or wait as necessary to reach synchro-
nism with the power system.
10
11 MAINTENANCE 11.1UNINSTALL AND CLEAR FILES AND DATA 11.1.1 UNINSTALL AND CLEAR FILES AND
DATA
11
The unit can be decommissioned by turning off power to the unit and disconnecting the wires to it.
To clear files and settings in the UR:
1. Download the latest version 6.x firmware from the GE Multilin website. Install it on the UR device using the EnerVista
UR Setup software under Maintenance > Update Firmware.
2. On the UR front panel, navigate to COMMANDS RELAY MAINTENANCE SERVICE COMMAND, enter the value
20511, and press the ENTER key. The relay restarts and clears the UR.
Upgrading the firmware overwrites the flash memory. If you already had version 6.x firmware installed, clear the flash
memory using the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP CLEAR RELAY RECORDS command.
11 The battery and modules inside the case can be replaced without return of the device to the factory. The firmware and soft-
ware can be upgraded without return of the device to the factory.
Fuses in 1H and 1L power supply modules are field-replaceable. Fuses in SH, SL, RH, and RL power supply modules are
not field-replaceable.
For issues not solved by troubleshooting, the process to return the device to the factory for repair is as follows:
• Contact a GE Grid Solutions Technical Support Center. Contact information is found in the first chapter.
• Obtain a Return Materials Authorization (RMA) number from the Technical Support Center.
• Verify that the RMA and Commercial Invoice received have the correct information.
• Tightly pack the unit in a box with bubble wrap, foam material, or styrofoam inserts or packaging peanuts to cushion
the item(s). You may also use double boxing whereby you place the box in a larger box that contains at least 5 cm of
cushioning material.
• Ship the unit by courier or freight forwarder, along with the Commercial Invoice and RMA, to the factory.
GE GRID SOLUTIONS
650 MARKLAND STREET
MARKHAM, ONTARIO
CANADA L6C 0M1
ATTN: SERVICE DEPT.
RMA# : ______________
Customers are responsible for shipping costs to the factory, regardless of whether the unit is under warranty.
• Fax a copy of the shipping information to the GE Grid Solutions service department in Canada at +1 905 927 5098.
Use the detailed return procedure outlined at
https://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/support/ret_proc.htm
The current warranty and return information are outlined at
https://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/warranty.htm
Store the unit indoors in a cool, dry place. If possible, store in the original packaging. Follow the storage temperature range
11
outlined in the Specifications.
To avoid deterioration of electrolytic capacitors, power up units that are stored in a de-energized
NOTICE state once per year, for one hour continuously.
11 Other than the battery, there are no special requirements for disposal of the unit at the end its service life. For customers
located in the European Union, dispose of the battery as outlined earlier. To prevent non-intended use of the unit, remove
the modules as outlined earlier, dismantle the unit, and recycle the metal when possible.
A ADDRESS
6225
FLEXANALOG NAME
SRC 2 In Mag
UNITS
Amps
DESCRIPTION
Source 2 neutral current magnitude
6227 SRC 2 In Angle Degrees Source 2 neutral current angle
6228 SRC 2 Ig RMS Amps Source 2 ground current RMS
6230 SRC 2 Ig Mag Amps Source 2 ground current magnitude
6232 SRC 2 Ig Angle Degrees Source 2 ground current angle
6233 SRC 2 I_0 Mag Amps Source 2 zero-sequence current magnitude
6235 SRC 2 I_0 Angle Degrees Source 2 zero-sequence current angle
6236 SRC 2 I_1 Mag Amps Source 2 positive-sequence current magnitude
6238 SRC 2 I_1 Angle Degrees Source 2 positive-sequence current angle
6239 SRC 2 I_2 Mag Amps Source 2 negative-sequence current magnitude
6241 SRC 2 I_2 Angle Degrees Source 2 negative-sequence current angle
6242 SRC 2 Igd Mag Amps Source 2 differential ground current magnitude
6244 SRC 2 Igd Angle Degrees Source 2 differential ground current angle
6272 SRC 3 Ia RMS Amps Source 3 phase A current RMS
6274 SRC 3 Ib RMS Amps Source 3 phase B current RMS
6276 SRC 3 Ic RMS Amps Source 3 phase C current RMS
6278 SRC 3 In RMS Amps Source 3 neutral current RMS
6280 SRC 3 Ia Mag Amps Source 3 phase A current magnitude
6282 SRC 3 Ia Angle Degrees Source 3 phase A current angle
6283 SRC 3 Ib Mag Amps Source 3 phase B current magnitude
6285 SRC 3 Ib Angle Degrees Source 3 phase B current angle
6286 SRC 3 Ic Mag Amps Source 3 phase C current magnitude
6288 SRC 3 Ic Angle Degrees Source 3 phase C current angle
6289 SRC 3 In Mag Amps Source 3 neutral current magnitude
6291 SRC 3 In Angle Degrees Source 3 neutral current angle
6292 SRC 3 Ig RMS Amps Source 3 ground current RMS
6294 SRC 3 Ig Mag Amps Source 3 ground current magnitude
6296 SRC 3 Ig Angle Degrees Source 3 ground current angle
6297 SRC 3 I_0 Mag Amps Source 3 zero-sequence current magnitude
6299 SRC 3 I_0 Angle Degrees Source 3 zero-sequence current angle
6300 SRC 3 I_1 Mag Amps Source 3 positive-sequence current magnitude
6302 SRC 3 I_1 Angle Degrees Source 3 positive-sequence current angle
6303 SRC 3 I_2 Mag Amps Source 3 negative-sequence current magnitude
6305 SRC 3 I_2 Angle Degrees Source 3 negative-sequence current angle
6306 SRC 3 Igd Mag Amps Source 3 differential ground current magnitude
6308 SRC 3 Igd Angle Degrees Source 3 differential ground current angle
6336 SRC 4 Ia RMS Amps Source 4 phase A current RMS
6338 SRC 4 Ib RMS Amps Source 4 phase B current RMS
6340 SRC 4 Ic RMS Amps Source 4 phase C current RMS
6342 SRC 4 In RMS Amps Source 4 neutral current RMS
6344 SRC 4 Ia Mag Amps Source 4 phase A current magnitude
6346 SRC 4 Ia Angle Degrees Source 4 phase A current angle
6347 SRC 4 Ib Mag Amps Source 4 phase B current magnitude
6349 SRC 4 Ib Angle Degrees Source 4 phase B current angle
6350 SRC 4 Ic Mag Amps Source 4 phase C current magnitude
6352 SRC 4 Ic Angle Degrees Source 4 phase C current angle
6353 SRC 4 In Mag Amps Source 4 neutral current magnitude
A ADDRESS
6734
FLEXANALOG NAME
SRC 2 Vcg Angle
UNITS
Degrees
DESCRIPTION
Source 2 phase CG voltage angle
6735 SRC 2 Vab RMS Volts Source 2 phase AB voltage RMS
6737 SRC 2 Vbc RMS Volts Source 2 phase BC voltage RMS
6739 SRC 2 Vca RMS Volts Source 2 phase CA voltage RMS
6741 SRC 2 Vab Mag Volts Source 2 phase AB voltage magnitude
6743 SRC 2 Vab Angle Degrees Source 2 phase AB voltage angle
6744 SRC 2 Vbc Mag Volts Source 2 phase BC voltage magnitude
6746 SRC 2 Vbc Angle Degrees Source 2 phase BC voltage angle
6747 SRC 2 Vca Mag Volts Source 2 phase CA voltage magnitude
6749 SRC 2 Vca Angle Degrees Source 2 phase CA voltage angle
6750 SRC 2 Vx RMS Volts Source 2 auxiliary voltage RMS
6752 SRC 2 Vx Mag Volts Source 2 auxiliary voltage magnitude
6754 SRC 2 Vx Angle Degrees Source 2 auxiliary voltage angle
6755 SRC 2 V_0 Mag Volts Source 2 zero-sequence voltage magnitude
6757 SRC 2 V_0 Angle Degrees Source 2 zero-sequence voltage angle
6758 SRC 2 V_1 Mag Volts Source 2 positive-sequence voltage magnitude
6760 SRC 2 V_1 Angle Degrees Source 2 positive-sequence voltage angle
6761 SRC 2 V_2 Mag Volts Source 2 negative-sequence voltage magnitude
6763 SRC 2 V_2 Angle Degrees Source 2 negative-sequence voltage angle
6784 SRC 3 Vag RMS Volts Source 3 phase AG voltage RMS
6786 SRC 3 Vbg RMS Volts Source 3 phase BG voltage RMS
6788 SRC 3 Vcg RMS Volts Source 3 phase CG voltage RMS
6790 SRC 3 Vag Mag Volts Source 3 phase AG voltage magnitude
6792 SRC 3 Vag Angle Degrees Source 3 phase AG voltage angle
6793 SRC 3 Vbg Mag Volts Source 3 phase BG voltage magnitude
6795 SRC 3 Vbg Angle Degrees Source 3 phase BG voltage angle
6796 SRC 3 Vcg Mag Volts Source 3 phase CG voltage magnitude
6798 SRC 3 Vcg Angle Degrees Source 3 phase CG voltage angle
6799 SRC 3 Vab RMS Volts Source 3 phase AB voltage RMS
6801 SRC 3 Vbc RMS Volts Source 3 phase BC voltage RMS
6803 SRC 3 Vca RMS Volts Source 3 phase CA voltage RMS
6805 SRC 3 Vab Mag Volts Source 3 phase AB voltage magnitude
6807 SRC 3 Vab Angle Degrees Source 3 phase AB voltage angle
6808 SRC 3 Vbc Mag Volts Source 3 phase BC voltage magnitude
6810 SRC 3 Vbc Angle Degrees Source 3 phase BC voltage angle
6811 SRC 3 Vca Mag Volts Source 3 phase CA voltage magnitude
6813 SRC 3 Vca Angle Degrees Source 3 phase CA voltage angle
6814 SRC 3 Vx RMS Volts Source 3 auxiliary voltage RMS
6816 SRC 3 Vx Mag Volts Source 3 auxiliary voltage magnitude
6818 SRC 3 Vx Angle Degrees Source 3 auxiliary voltage angle
6819 SRC 3 V_0 Mag Volts Source 3 zero-sequence voltage magnitude
6821 SRC 3 V_0 Angle Degrees Source 3 zero-sequence voltage angle
6822 SRC 3 V_1 Mag Volts Source 3 positive-sequence voltage magnitude
6824 SRC 3 V_1 Angle Degrees Source 3 positive-sequence voltage angle
6825 SRC 3 V_2 Mag Volts Source 3 negative-sequence voltage magnitude
6827 SRC 3 V_2 Angle Degrees Source 3 negative-sequence voltage angle
6848 SRC 4 Vag RMS Volts Source 4 phase AG voltage RMS
A ADDRESS
7210
FLEXANALOG NAME
SRC 2 Qa
UNITS
Vars
DESCRIPTION
Source 2 phase A reactive power
7212 SRC 2 Qb Vars Source 2 phase B reactive power
7214 SRC 2 Qc Vars Source 2 phase C reactive power
7216 SRC 2 S VA Source 2 three-phase apparent power
7218 SRC 2 Sa VA Source 2 phase A apparent power
7220 SRC 2 Sb VA Source 2 phase B apparent power
7222 SRC 2 Sc VA Source 2 phase C apparent power
7224 SRC 2 PF --- Source 2 three-phase power factor
7225 SRC 2 Phase A PF --- Source 2 phase A power factor
7226 SRC 2 Phase B PF --- Source 2 phase B power factor
7227 SRC 2 Phase C PF --- Source 2 phase C power factor
7232 SRC 3 P Watts Source 3 three-phase real power
7234 SRC 3 Pa Watts Source 3 phase A real power
7236 SRC 3 Pb Watts Source 3 phase B real power
7238 SRC 3 Pc Watts Source 3 phase C real power
7240 SRC 3 Q Vars Source 3 three-phase reactive power
7242 SRC 3 Qa Vars Source 3 phase A reactive power
7244 SRC 3 Qb Vars Source 3 phase B reactive power
7246 SRC 3 Qc Vars Source 3 phase C reactive power
7248 SRC 3 S VA Source 3 three-phase apparent power
7250 SRC 3 Sa VA Source 3 phase A apparent power
7252 SRC 3 Sb VA Source 3 phase B apparent power
7254 SRC 3 Sc VA Source 3 phase C apparent power
7256 SRC 3 PF --- Source 3 three-phase power factor
7257 SRC 3 Phase A PF --- Source 3 phase A power factor
7258 SRC 3 Phase B PF --- Source 3 phase B power factor
7259 SRC 3 Phase C PF --- Source 3 phase C power factor
7264 SRC 4 P Watts Source 4 three-phase real power
7266 SRC 4 Pa Watts Source 4 phase A real power
7268 SRC 4 Pb Watts Source 4 phase B real power
7270 SRC 4 Pc Watts Source 4 phase C real power
7272 SRC 4 Q Vars Source 4 three-phase reactive power
7274 SRC 4 Qa Vars Source 4 phase A reactive power
7276 SRC 4 Qb Vars Source 4 phase B reactive power
7278 SRC 4 Qc Vars Source 4 phase C reactive power
7280 SRC 4 S VA Source 4 three-phase apparent power
7282 SRC 4 Sa VA Source 4 phase A apparent power
7284 SRC 4 Sb VA Source 4 phase B apparent power
7286 SRC 4 Sc VA Source 4 phase C apparent power
7288 SRC 4 PF --- Source 4 three-phase power factor
7289 SRC 4 Phase A PF --- Source 4 phase A power factor
7290 SRC 4 Phase B PF --- Source 4 phase B power factor
7291 SRC 4 Phase C PF --- Source 4 phase C power factor
7552 SRC 1 Frequency Hz Source 1 frequency
7554 SRC 2 Frequency Hz Source 2 frequency
7556 SRC 3 Frequency Hz Source 3 frequency
7558 SRC 4 Frequency Hz Source 4 frequency
A ADDRESS
13574
FLEXANALOG NAME
RTD Inputs 23 Value
UNITS
---
DESCRIPTION
RTD input 23 actual value
13575 RTD Inputs 24 Value --- RTD input 24 actual value
13576 RTD Inputs 25 Value --- RTD input 25 actual value
13577 RTD Inputs 26 Value --- RTD input 26 actual value
13578 RTD Inputs 27 Value --- RTD input 27 actual value
13579 RTD Inputs 28 Value --- RTD input 28 actual value
13580 RTD Inputs 29 Value --- RTD input 29 actual value
13581 RTD Inputs 30 Value --- RTD input 30 actual value
13582 RTD Inputs 31 Value --- RTD input 31 actual value
13583 RTD Inputs 32 Value --- RTD input 32 actual value
13584 RTD Inputs 33 Value --- RTD input 33 actual value
13585 RTD Inputs 34 Value --- RTD input 34 actual value
13586 RTD Inputs 35 Value --- RTD input 35 actual value
13587 RTD Inputs 36 Value --- RTD input 36 actual value
13588 RTD Inputs 37 Value --- RTD input 37 actual value
13589 RTD Inputs 38 Value --- RTD input 38 actual value
13590 RTD Inputs 39 Value --- RTD input 39 actual value
13591 RTD Inputs 40 Value --- RTD input 40 actual value
13592 RTD Inputs 41 Value --- RTD input 41 actual value
13593 RTD Inputs 42 Value --- RTD input 42 actual value
13594 RTD Inputs 43 Value --- RTD input 43 actual value
13595 RTD Inputs 44 Value --- RTD input 44 actual value
13596 RTD Inputs 45 Value --- RTD input 45 actual value
13597 RTD Inputs 46 Value --- RTD input 46 actual value
13598 RTD Inputs 47 Value --- RTD input 47 actual value
13599 RTD Inputs 48 Value --- RTD input 48 actual value
24448 Communications Group --- Groups communications group
24459 Active Setting Group --- Current setting group
26177 Therm Mdl Cap Used --- Thermal model capacity used
26179 Therm Mdl Trip Time seconds Thermal model trip time on overload
26180 Therm Mdl LkOut Time seconds Thermal model lockout time
26184 Therm Mdl Load × FLA Thermal model load
26186 Therm Mdl Curr Unbal --- Thermal model motor unbalance
26187 Therm Mdl Bias Load × FLA Thermal model biased motor load
26188 Starts/hr Lockout seconds Starts per hour lockout time
26189 Btwn Starts Lockout seconds Time between starts lockout time
26190 Restrt Delay Lockout seconds Restart delay lockout time
26191 Total Motor Lockout seconds Total motor lockout time
32768 Tracking Frequency Hz Tracking frequency
34752 RRTD RTD 1 Value °C Remote RTD input 1 actual value
34753 RRTD RTD 2 Value °C Remote RTD input 2 actual value
34754 RRTD RTD 3 Value °C Remote RTD input 3 actual value
34755 RRTD RTD 4 Value °C Remote RTD input 4 actual value
34756 RRTD RTD 5 Value °C Remote RTD input 5 actual value
34757 RRTD RTD 6 Value °C Remote RTD input 6 actual value
34758 RRTD RTD 7 Value °C Remote RTD input 7 actual value
34759 RRTD RTD 8 Value °C Remote RTD input 8 actual value
A ADDRESS
45620
FLEXANALOG NAME
GOOSE Analog In 19
UNITS
---
DESCRIPTION
IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 19
45622 GOOSE Analog In 20 --- IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 20
45624 GOOSE Analog In 21 --- IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 21
45626 GOOSE Analog In 22 --- IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 22
45628 GOOSE Analog In 23 --- IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 23
45630 GOOSE Analog In 24 --- IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 24
45632 GOOSE Analog In 25 --- IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 25
45634 GOOSE Analog In 26 --- IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 26
45636 GOOSE Analog In 27 --- IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 27
45638 GOOSE Analog In 28 --- IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 28
45640 GOOSE Analog In 29 --- IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 29
45642 GOOSE Analog In 30 --- IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 30
45644 GOOSE Analog In 31 --- IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 31
45646 GOOSE Analog In 32 --- IEC 61850 GOOSE analog input 32
FlexInteger items are also viewable in a web browser. In the browser, enter the IP address of the UR, access the Device
A
Information Menu option, then the FlexInteger Parameter Listing option.
Table A–2: FLEXINTEGER DATA ITEMS
ADDRESS FLEXINTEGER NAME UNITS DESCRIPTION
9968 GOOSE UInt Input 1 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 1
9970 GOOSE UInt Input 2 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 2
9972 GOOSE UInt Input 3 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 3
9974 GOOSE UInt Input 4 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 4
9976 GOOSE UInt Input 5 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 5
9978 GOOSE UInt Input 6 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 6
9980 GOOSE UInt Input 7 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 7
9982 GOOSE UInt Input 8 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 8
9984 GOOSE UInt Input 9 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 9
9986 GOOSE UInt Input 10 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 10
9988 GOOSE UInt Input 11 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 11
9990 GOOSE UInt Input 12 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 12
9992 GOOSE UInt Input 13 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 13
9994 GOOSE UInt Input 14 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 14
9996 GOOSE UInt Input 15 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 15
9998 GOOSE UInt Input 16 --- IEC61850 GOOSE UInteger input 16
The UR-series relays support a number of communications protocols to allow connection to equipment such as personal
computers, Remote Terminal Units (RTUs), SCADA masters, and programmable logic controllers. The Modicon Modbus
protocol is the most basic protocol supported by the UR. Modbus RTU is available via the RS232 and RS485 serial links,
and Modbus TCP/IP is available over Ethernet. The following description is intended primarily for users who want to
develop their own master communication drivers. Note that:
• The UR always acts as a slave device, meaning that it never initiates communications; it only listens and responds to B
requests issued by a master computer.
• A subset of the Modbus RTU and Modbus TCP/IP protocol format is supported that allows extensive monitoring, pro-
gramming, and control functions using read and write register commands.
The Modbus RTU protocol is hardware-independent so that the physical layer can be any of a variety of standard hardware
configurations including RS232 and RS485. The relay includes a faceplate (front panel) RS232 port and rear terminal
RS485 port. Data flow is half-duplex in all configurations. See chapter 3 for details on communications wiring.
Each data byte is transmitted in an asynchronous format consisting of 1 start bit, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit, and possibly 1 parity
bit. This produces a 10 or 11 bit data frame. This can be important for transmission through modems at high bit rates (11 bit
data frames are not supported by many modems at baud rates greater than 300).
The faceplate RS232 port is for local use and is fixed at 19200 bit/s baud and even parity. The rear terminal RS485 port can
be set for baud rates of 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 14400, 19200, 28800, 33600, 38400, 57600, or 115200 bps, and
even, odd, and no parity options are available. See the Communications section of chapter 5 for further details.
The Modbus TCP/IP protocol is available on each of the rear Ethernet ports. Depending on the relay's order code, these
ports can be 10/100Base-TX or 100Base-FX.
Modbus RTU communications takes place in packets which are groups of asynchronously framed byte data. The master
transmits a packet to the slave and the slave responds with a packet. The following describes general format for both trans-
mit and receive packets. For exact details on packet formatting, refer to subsequent sections describing each function
code.
• SLAVE ADDRESS: This is the address of the slave device that is intended to receive the packet sent by the master
and to perform the desired action. Each slave device on a communications bus must have a unique address to prevent
bus contention. All of the relay’s ports have the same address which is programmable from 1 to 254; see chapter 5 for
details. Only the addressed slave will respond to a packet that starts with its address. Note that the faceplate port is an
exception to this rule; it will act on a message containing any slave address.
A master transmit packet with slave address 0 indicates a broadcast command. All slaves on the communication link
take action based on the packet, but none respond to the master.
• FUNCTION CODE: This is one of the supported functions codes of the unit which tells the slave what action to per-
form. See the Supported Function Codes section for complete details. An exception response from the slave is indi-
cated by setting the high order bit of the function code in the response packet. See the Exception Responses section
for further details.
• DATA: This will be a variable number of bytes depending on the function code. This may include actual values, set-
tings, or addresses sent by the master to the slave or by the slave to the master.
• CRC: This is a two byte error checking code. The RTU version of Modbus® includes a 16-bit cyclic redundancy check
(CRC-16) with every packet which is an industry standard method used for error detection. If a Modbus slave device
receives a packet in which an error is indicated by the CRC, the slave device does not act upon or respond to the
packet thus preventing any erroneous operations. See the CRC-16 Algorithm section for details on calculating the
CRC.
B • DEAD TIME: A packet is terminated when no data is received for a period of 3.5 byte transmission times (about 15 ms
at 2400 bps, 2 ms at 19200 bps, and 300 µs at 115200 bps). Consequently, the transmitting device must not allow gaps
between bytes longer than this interval. Once the dead time has expired without a new byte transmission, all slaves
start listening for a new packet from the master except for the addressed slave.
Modbus-TCP/IP communications takes place in ADUs (Application Data Units), which are wrapped in the TCP/IP/Ethernet
protocols. Ethernet provides layer 2 addressing and CRC-32 error checking. IP provides layer 3 addressing. TCP provides
communication establishment and ending and manages data flow. The Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP) can also be
used to provide seamless data flow in case of a single failure in the network, by using a combination of LAN duplication and
frame duplication. See chapter 5 for information on setting up TCP for Modbus (in the Modbus section), IP, and PRP (Net-
work section).
The following describes the ADU.
Table B–2: MODBUS TCP/IP FORMAT
DESCRIPTION SIZE
MBAP header Transaction identifier 2 bytes
Protocol identifier 2 bytes
Length 2 bytes
Unit identifier 1 byte
FUNCTION CODE 1 byte
DATA N bytes
MBAP header: This Modbus Application Protocol header contains the following fields:
• Transaction Identifier: Used for transaction pairing. The Modbus server copies in the response the transaction identifier
of the request.
• Protocol Identifier: Used for intra-system multiplexing. The Modbus protocol is identified by the value 0.
• Length: The length field is a byte count of the following fields, including the Unit Identifier and data fields.
– Unit Identifier: For the purposes of the UR, this field is equivalent to the Modbus RTU SLAVE ADDRESS
field. The client must use the same value here as programmed in the UR setting MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS.
FUNCTION CODE: This is the same as the Modbus RTU function code field described above.
DATA: This is the same as the Modbus RTU data field described above.
The Modbus TPC/IP CRC-32 algorithm is universally executed in hardware, so there is no need to describe it here.
The Modbus RTU CRC-16 algorithm essentially treats the entire data stream (data bits only; start, stop and parity ignored)
as one continuous binary number. This number is first shifted left 16 bits and then divided by a characteristic polynomial
(11000000000000101b). The 16-bit remainder of the division is appended to the end of the packet, MSByte first. The result-
ing packet including CRC, when divided by the same polynomial at the receiver will give a zero remainder if no transmis-
sion errors have occurred. This algorithm requires the characteristic polynomial to be reverse bit ordered. The most
significant bit of the characteristic polynomial is dropped, since it does not affect the value of the remainder.
A C programming language implementation of the CRC algorithm will be provided upon request.
Modbus® officially defines function codes from 1 to 127 though only a small subset is generally needed. The relay supports
some of these functions, as summarized in the following table. Subsequent sections describe each function code in detail.
B HEX
03
DEC
3 Read holding registers Read actual values or settings
04 4 Read holding registers Read actual values or settings
05 5 Force single coil Execute operation
06 6 Preset single register Store single setting
10 16 Preset multiple registers Store multiple settings
This function code allows the master to read one or more consecutive data registers (actual values or settings) from a relay.
The maximum number of registers that can be read in a single packet is 125. See the Modbus Memory Map table for exact
details on the data registers.
Since some PLC implementations of Modbus only support one of function codes 03h and 04h. The UR interpretation allows
either function code to be used for reading one or more consecutive data registers. The data starting address will determine
the type of data being read. Function codes 03h and 04h are therefore identical.
The following table shows the format of the master and slave packets in Modbus RTU. Modbus TCP/IP ADUs have a
MBAP instead of slave address, and CRC is in another stack layer. The example shows a master device requesting three
register values starting at address 4050h from slave device 11h (17 decimal); the slave device responds with the values 40,
300, and 0 from registers 4050h, 4051h, and 4052h, respectively.
This function code allows the master to perform various operations in the relay. Available operations are shown in the Sum-
mary of Operation Codes table below.
The following table shows the format of the master and slave packets in Modbus RTU. Modbus TCP/IP ADUs have a
MBAP instead of slave address, and CRC is in another stack layer. The example shows a master device requesting the
slave device 11h (17 decimal) to perform a reset. The high and low code value bytes always have the values “FF” and “00”
respectively and are a remnant of the original Modbus definition of this function code. B
Table B–5: MASTER AND SLAVE DEVICE PACKET TRANSMISSION EXAMPLE
MASTER TRANSMISSION SLAVE RESPONSE
PACKET FORMAT EXAMPLE (HEX) PACKET FORMAT EXAMPLE (HEX)
SLAVE ADDRESS 11 SLAVE ADDRESS 11
FUNCTION CODE 05 FUNCTION CODE 05
OPERATION CODE - high 00 OPERATION CODE - high 00
OPERATION CODE - low 01 OPERATION CODE - low 01
CODE VALUE - high FF CODE VALUE - high FF
CODE VALUE - low 00 CODE VALUE - low 00
CRC - low DF CRC - low DF
CRC - high 6A CRC - high 6A
This function code allows the master to modify the contents of a single setting register in an relay. Setting registers are
always 16 bit (two byte) values transmitted high order byte first. The following table shows the format of the master and
slave packets in Modbus RTU. Modbus TCP/IP ADUs have a MBAP instead of slave address, and CRC is in another stack
layer. The example shows a master device storing the value 200 at memory map address 4051h to slave device 11h (17
dec).
This function code allows the master to modify the contents of a one or more consecutive setting registers in a relay. Setting
registers are 16-bit (two byte) values transmitted high order byte first. The maximum number of setting registers that can be
stored in a single packet is 123. The following table shows the format of the master and slave packets in Modbus RTU.
Modbus TCP/IP ADUs have a MBAP instead of slave address, and CRC is in another stack layer. The example shows a
master device storing the value 200 at memory map address 4051h, and the value 1 at memory map address 4052h to
B slave device 11h (17 decimal).
Programming or operation errors usually happen because of illegal data in a packet. These errors result in an exception
response from the slave. The slave detecting one of these errors sends a response packet to the master with the high order
bit of the function code set to 1.
The following table shows the format of the master and slave packets in Modbus RTU. Modbus TCP/IP ADUs have a
MBAP instead of slave address, and CRC is in another stack layer. The example shows a master device sending the
unsupported function code 39h to slave device 11h.
a) DESCRIPTION
The UR relay has a generic file transfer facility, meaning that you use the same method to obtain all of the different types of
files from the unit. The Modbus registers that implement file transfer are found in the "Modbus File Transfer (Read/Write)"
and "Modbus File Transfer (Read Only)" modules, starting at address 3100h in the Modbus Memory Map. To read a file
from the UR relay, use the following steps:
1. Write the filename to the "Name of file to read" register using a write multiple registers command. If the name is shorter B
than 80 characters, you may write only enough registers to include all the text of the filename. Filenames are not case
sensitive.
2. Repeatedly read all the registers in "Modbus File Transfer (Read Only)" using a read multiple registers command. It is
not necessary to read the entire data block, since the UR relay will remember which was the last register you read. The
"position" register is initially zero and thereafter indicates how many bytes (2 times the number of registers) you have
read so far. The "size of..." register indicates the number of bytes of data remaining to read, to a maximum of 244.
3. Keep reading until the "size of..." register is smaller than the number of bytes you are transferring. This condition indi-
cates end of file. Discard any bytes you have read beyond the indicated block size.
4. If you need to re-try a block, read only the "size of.." and "block of data", without reading the position. The file pointer is
only incremented when you read the position register, so the same data block will be returned as was read in the pre-
vious operation. On the next read, check to see if the position is where you expect it to be, and discard the previous
block if it is not (this condition would indicate that the UR relay did not process your original read request).
The UR relay retains connection-specific file transfer information, so files may be read simultaneously on multiple Modbus
connections.
b) OTHER PROTOCOLS
All the files available via Modbus may also be retrieved using the standard file transfer mechanisms in other protocols (for
example, TFTP or MMS).
B To read from a specific record to another specific record, use the following filename:
EVT.TXT xxxxx yyyyy (replace xxxxx with the starting record number and yyyyy with the ending record number)
The table provides the Modbus memory map. The addresses in the table are expressed in hexadecimal. The particular reg-
isters actually present depend on the UR product and on the order codes software and module options.
The map is also viewable in a web browser. In the browser, enter the IP address of the UR and click the option.
In the table, "Grouped Setting" refers to content in the Settings > Grouped Elements > Group menus.
The data format tables that follow the memory map provide more information for some entries. B
Table B–10: MODBUS MEMORY MAP (Sheet 1 of 58)
ADDR REGISTER NAME RANGE UNITS STEP FORMAT DEFAULT
Product Information (Read Only)
0000 UR Product Type 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
0002 Product Version 0 to 655.35 --- 0.01 F001 1
0003 Boot Configuration Register 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
Product Information (Read Only -- Written by Factory)
0010 Serial Number --- --- --- F203 “0”
0020 Manufacturing Date 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F050 0
0022 Modification Number 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
0040 Order Code --- --- --- F204 “Order Code x”
0090 Ethernet MAC Address --- --- --- F072 0
0093 Reserved (13 items) --- --- --- F001 0
00A0 CPU Module Serial Number --- --- --- F203 (none)
00B0 CPU Supplier Serial Number --- --- --- F203 (none)
00C0 Ethernet Sub Module Serial Number (8 items) --- --- --- F203 (none)
Self Test Targets (Read Only)
0200 Self Test States (2 items) 0 to 4294967295 0 1 F143 0
Front Panel (Read Only)
0204 LED Column n State, n = 1 to 10 (10 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F501 0
0220 Display Message --- --- --- F204 (none)
0248 Last Key Pressed 0 to 47 --- 1 F530 0 (None)
Keypress Emulation (Read/Write)
0280 Simulated keypress -- write zero before each keystroke 0 to 46 --- 1 F190 0 (No key -- use
between real keys)
Virtual Input Commands (Read/Write Command) (64 modules)
0400 Virtual Input 1 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0401 Virtual Input 2 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0402 Virtual Input 3 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0403 Virtual Input 4 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0404 Virtual Input 5 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0405 Virtual Input 6 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0406 Virtual Input 7 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0407 Virtual Input 8 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0408 Virtual Input 9 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0409 Virtual Input 10 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
040A Virtual Input 11 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
040B Virtual Input 12 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
040C Virtual Input 13 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
040D Virtual Input 14 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
040E Virtual Input 15 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
040F Virtual Input 16 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0410 Virtual Input 17 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0411 Virtual Input 18 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0412 Virtual Input 19 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0413 Virtual Input 20 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0414 Virtual Input 21 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
B 041A
041B
Virtual Input 27 State
Virtual Input 28 State
0 to 1
0 to 1
---
---
1
1
F108
F108
0 (Off)
0 (Off)
041C Virtual Input 29 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
041D Virtual Input 30 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
041E Virtual Input 31 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
041F Virtual Input 32 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0420 Virtual Input 33 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0421 Virtual Input 34 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0422 Virtual Input 35 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0423 Virtual Input 36 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0424 Virtual Input 37 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0425 Virtual Input 38 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0426 Virtual Input 39 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0427 Virtual Input 40 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0428 Virtual Input 41 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0429 Virtual Input 42 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
042A Virtual Input 43 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
042B Virtual Input 44 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
042C Virtual Input 45 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
042D Virtual Input 46 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
042E Virtual Input 47 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
042F Virtual Input 48 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0430 Virtual Input 49 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0431 Virtual Input 50 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0432 Virtual Input 51 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0433 Virtual Input 52 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0434 Virtual Input 53 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0435 Virtual Input 54 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0436 Virtual Input 55 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0437 Virtual Input 56 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0438 Virtual Input 57 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
0439 Virtual Input 58 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
043A Virtual Input 59 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
043B Virtual Input 60 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
043C Virtual Input 61 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
043D Virtual Input 62 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
043E Virtual Input 63 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
043F Virtual Input 64 State 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
Digital Counter States Actual Values (Read Only Non-Volatile) (8 modules)
0800 Digital Counter 1 Value -2147483647 to --- 1 F004 0
2147483647
0802 Digital Counter 1 Frozen -2147483647 to --- 1 F004 0
2147483647
0804 Digital Counter 1 Frozen Time Stamp 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F050 0
0806 Digital Counter 1 Frozen Time Stamp µs (microsecond 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 0
part of time stamp)
0808 ...Repeated for Digital Counter 2
0810 ...Repeated for Digital Counter 3
0818 ...Repeated for Digital Counter 4
0820 ...Repeated for Digital Counter 5
B 160B
160C
Field Latching Output Physical States
Field Unit Online/Offline States
0 to 65535
0 to 65535
---
---
1
1
F500
F500
0
0
160D Reserved 0 to 65535 --- 1 F500 0
160E Reserved 0 to 65535 --- 1 F500 0
Ethernet Fibre Channel Status (Read/Write)
1610 Ethernet Primary Fibre Channel Status 0 to 2 --- 1 F134 0 (Fail)
1611 Ethernet Secondary Fibre Channel Status 0 to 2 --- 1 F134 0 (Fail)
Data Logger Actual Values (Read Only)
1618 Data Logger Channel Count 0 to 16 channel 1 F001 0
1619 Time of Oldest Available Samples 0 to 4294967295 seconds 1 F050 0
161B Time of Newest Available Samples 0 to 4294967295 seconds 1 F050 0
161D Data Logger Duration 0 to 999.9 days 0.1 F001 0
Stator Differential Actual Values (Read Only)
1660 Generator Differential Iad 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1662 Generator Restraint Iar 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1664 Generator Differential Ibd 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1666 Generator Restraint Ibr 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1668 Generator Differential Icd 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
166A Generator Restraint Icr 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
166C Stator Differential CT Primary 0 to 50000 --- 1 F060 1
Sensitive Directional Power Actual Values (Read Only) (2 modules)
1680 Sensitive Directional Power 1 Power -2147483647 to 2147483647 W 1 F060 0
1682 Sensitive Directional Power 2 Power -2147483647 to 2147483647 W 1 F060 0
Field Unit RTD Actuals (Read Only) (8 modules)
16C0 Field RTD 1 Value -32768 to 32767 °C 1 F002 0
16C1 ...Repeated for Field RTD 2
16C2 ...Repeated for Field RTD 3
16C3 ...Repeated for Field RTD 4
16C4 ...Repeated for Field RTD 5
16C5 ...Repeated for Field RTD 6
16C6 ...Repeated for Field RTD 7
16C7 ...Repeated for Field RTD 8
Field Unit Transducer Actuals (Read Only) (8 modules)
16C8 Field Transducer 1 Value -32.768 to 32.767 --- 0.001 F004 0
16CA ...Repeated for Field Transducer 2
16CC ...Repeated for Field Transducer 3
16CE ...Repeated for Field Transducer 4
16D0 ...Repeated for Field Transducer 5
16D2 ...Repeated for Field Transducer 6
16D4 ...Repeated for Field Transducer 7
16D6 ...Repeated for Field Transducer 8
Source Current (Read Only) (4 modules)
1800 Source 1 Phase A Current RMS 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1802 Source 1 Phase B Current RMS 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1804 Source 1 Phase C Current RMS 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1806 Source 1 Neutral Current RMS 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1808 Source 1 Phase A Current Magnitude 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
180A Source 1 Phase A Current Angle -359.9 to 0 degrees 0.1 F002 0
180B Source 1 Phase B Current Magnitude 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
B
1C04 Source 1 Phase B Real Power -1000000000000 to W 0.001 F060 0
1000000000000
1C06 Source 1 Phase C Real Power -1000000000000 to W 0.001 F060 0
1000000000000
1C08 Source 1 Three Phase Reactive Power -1000000000000 to var 0.001 F060 0
1000000000000
1C0A Source 1 Phase A Reactive Power -1000000000000 to var 0.001 F060 0
1000000000000
1C0C Source 1 Phase B Reactive Power -1000000000000 to var 0.001 F060 0
1000000000000
1C0E Source 1 Phase C Reactive Power -1000000000000 to var 0.001 F060 0
1000000000000
1C10 Source 1 Three Phase Apparent Power -1000000000000 to VA 0.001 F060 0
1000000000000
1C12 Source 1 Phase A Apparent Power -1000000000000 to VA 0.001 F060 0
1000000000000
1C14 Source 1 Phase B Apparent Power -1000000000000 to VA 0.001 F060 0
1000000000000
1C16 Source 1 Phase C Apparent Power -1000000000000 to VA 0.001 F060 0
1000000000000
1C18 Source 1 Three Phase Power Factor -0.999 to 1 --- 0.001 F013 0
1C19 Source 1 Phase A Power Factor -0.999 to 1 --- 0.001 F013 0
1C1A Source 1 Phase B Power Factor -0.999 to 1 --- 0.001 F013 0
1C1B Source 1 Phase C Power Factor -0.999 to 1 --- 0.001 F013 0
1C1C Reserved (4 items) --- --- --- F001 0
1C20 ...Repeated for Source 2
1C40 ...Repeated for Source 3
1C60 ...Repeated for Source 4
Source Energy Metering (Read Only Non-Volatile) (4 modules)
1D00 Source 1 Positive Watthour 0 to 1000000000000 Wh 0.001 F060 0
1D02 Source 1 Negative Watthour 0 to 1000000000000 Wh 0.001 F060 0
1D04 Source 1 Positive Varhour 0 to 1000000000000 varh 0.001 F060 0
1D06 Source 1 Negative Varhour 0 to 1000000000000 varh 0.001 F060 0
1D08 Reserved (8 items) --- --- --- F001 0
1D10 ...Repeated for Source 2
1D20 ...Repeated for Source 3
1D30 ...Repeated for Source 4
Energy Commands (Read/Write Command)
1D60 Energy Clear Command 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
Source Frequency (Read Only) (4 modules)
1D80 Frequency for Source 1 2 to 90 Hz 0.001 F003 0
1D82 Frequency for Source 2 2 to 90 Hz 0.001 F003 0
1D84 Frequency for Source 3 2 to 90 Hz 0.001 F003 0
1D86 Frequency for Source 4 2 to 90 Hz 0.001 F003 0
Breaker Flashover (Read/Write Setting) (2 modules)
21A6 Breaker Flashover 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
21A7 Breaker Flashover 1 Side 1 Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
21A8 Breaker Flashover 1 Side 2 Source 0 to 6 --- 1 F211 0 (None)
21A9 Breaker Flashover 1 Status Closed A 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
21AA Breaker Flashover 1 Status Closed B 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
21AB Breaker Flashover 1 Status Closed C 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
21AC Breaker Flashover 1 Voltage Pickup Level 0 to 1.5 pu 0.001 F001 850
21AD Breaker Flashover 1 Voltage Difference Pickup Level 0 to 100000 V 1 F060 1000
2D00 Contact Input States, one per register (96 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
2D80 Contact Output States, one per register (64 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
2E00 Virtual Output States, one per register (96 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
Expanded Remote Input/Output Status (Read Only)
2F00 Remote Device States, one per register (32 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F155 0 (Offline)
2F80 Remote Input States, one per register (64 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
Oscillography Values (Read Only)
3000 Oscillography Number of Triggers 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
3001 Oscillography Available Records 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
3002 Oscillography Last Cleared Date 0 to 400000000 --- 1 F050 0
3004 Oscillography Number of Cycles Per Record 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
Oscillography Commands (Read/Write Command)
3005 Oscillography Force Trigger 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
3011 Oscillography Clear Data 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
Oscillography Analog Values (Read Only)
3012 Oscillography Number of Triggers 0 to 32767 --- 1 F001 0
User Programmable Fault Report Commands (Read/Write Command)
3060 User Fault Report Clear 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
User Programmable Fault Report Actual Values (Read Only)
3070 Newest Record Number 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
3071 Cleared Date 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F050 0
3073 Report Date (10 items) 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F050 0
User Programmable Fault Report (Read/Write Setting) (2 modules)
3090 Fault Report 1 Fault Trigger 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
3091 Fault Report 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
3092 Fault Report 1 Prefault Trigger 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
3093 Fault Report Analog Channel 1 (32 items) 0 to 65536 --- 1 F600 0
30B3 Reserved (5 items) --- --- --- F001 0
30B8 ...Repeated for Fault Report 2
Modbus File Transfer (Read/Write)
3100 Name of file to read --- --- --- F204 (none)
Modbus File Transfer Values (Read Only)
3200 Character position of current block within file 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 0
3202 Size of currently-available data block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
3203 Block of data from requested file (122 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
Event Recorder (Read Only)
3400 Events Since Last Clear 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 0
3402 Number of Available Events 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 0
3404 Event Recorder Last Cleared Date 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F050 0
Event Recorder Commands (Read/Write Command)
3406 Event Recorder Clear Command 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
DCmA Input Values (Read Only) (24 modules)
34C0 DCmA Inputs 1 Value -9999.999 to 9999.999 --- 0.001 F004 0
34C2 DCmA Inputs 2 Value -9999.999 to 9999.999 --- 0.001 F004 0
34C4 DCmA Inputs 3 Value -9999.999 to 9999.999 --- 0.001 F004 0
34C6 DCmA Inputs 4 Value -9999.999 to 9999.999 --- 0.001 F004 0
34C8 DCmA Inputs 5 Value -9999.999 to 9999.999 --- 0.001 F004 0
B 3517
3518
RTD Input 40 Value
RTD Input 41 Value
-32768 to 32767
-32768 to 32767
°C
°C
1
1
F002
F002
0
0
3519 RTD Input 42 Value -32768 to 32767 °C 1 F002 0
351A RTD Input 43 Value -32768 to 32767 °C 1 F002 0
351B RTD Input 44 Value -32768 to 32767 °C 1 F002 0
351C RTD Input 45 Value -32768 to 32767 °C 1 F002 0
351D RTD Input 46 Value -32768 to 32767 °C 1 F002 0
351E RTD Input 47 Value -32768 to 32767 °C 1 F002 0
351F RTD Input 48 Value -32768 to 32767 °C 1 F002 0
Ohm Input Values (Read Only) (2 modules)
3520 Ohm Inputs 1 Value 0 to 65535 Ohm 1 F001 0
3521 Ohm Inputs 2 Value 0 to 65535 Ohm 1 F001 0
Expanded Direct Input/Output Status (Read Only)
3560 Direct Device States, one per register (16 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F155 0 (Offline)
3570 Direct Input States, one per register (96 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
Field Units (Read/Write Setting) (8 modules)
3800 Field Unit 1 ID 0 to 1 --- 1 F205 "U1"
3806 Field Unit 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
3807 Field Unit 1 Type 0 to 3 --- 1 F243 0 (CC-05)
3808 Field Unit 1 Serial Number 1 to 1 --- 1 F205 "000000000000"
380E Field Unit 1 Port 1 to 4 --- 1 F001 1
380F ...Repeated for Field Unit 2
381E ...Repeated for Field Unit 3
382D ...Repeated for Field Unit 4
383C ...Repeated for Field Unit 5
384B ...Repeated for Field Unit 6
385A ...Repeated for Field Unit 7
3869 ...Repeated for Field Unit 8
Field Unit Process Card Ports (Read/Write Setting)
3878 Field Unit 1 Process Card Port 0 to 7 --- 1 F244 6 (H1a)
3879 Field Unit 2 Process Card Port 0 to 7 --- 1 F244 4 (H2a)
387A Field Unit3 Process Card Port 0 to 7 --- 1 F244 2 (H3a)
387B Field Unit 4 Process Card Port 0 to 7 --- 1 F244 0 (H4a)
387C Field Unit 5 Process Card Port 0 to 7 --- 1 F244 7 (H1b)
387D Field Unit 6 Process Card Port 0 to 7 --- 1 F244 5 (H2b)
387E Field Unit 7 Process Card Port 0 to 7 --- 1 F244 3 (H3b)
387F Field Unit 8 Process Card Port 0 to 7 --- 1 F244 1 (H4b)
Field Unit CT VT Settings (Read/Write Setting) (6 modules)
3890 Remote Phase CT x Origin 1 0 to 16 --- 1 F247 0 (None)
3891 Remote Phase CT x Origin 2 0 to 16 --- 1 F247 0 (None)
3892 Remote Ground CT x Origin 1 0 to 16 --- 1 F248 0 (None)
3893 Remote Ground CT x Origin 2 0 to 16 --- 1 F248 0 (None)
3894 AC Bank Redundancy Type 0 to 2 --- 1 F261 1 (Dependability
Biased)
3895 Remote Phase CT 1 Primary 1 to 65000 --- 1 F001 1
3896 Remote Phase CT 1 Secondary 0 to 1 --- 1 F123 0 (1 A)
3897 Remote Ground CT 1 Primary 1 to 65000 --- 1 F001 1
3898 Remote Ground CT 1 Secondary 0 to 1 --- 1 F123 0 (1 A)
3899 Remote Phase VT 1 Connection 0 to 1 --- 1 F100 0 (Wye)
B 3B07
3B08
Field Shared Input 1 Channel Origin 1
Field Shared Input 1 Events
1 to 15
0 to 1
---
---
1
1
F001
F102
1
1 (Enabled)
3B09 ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 2
3B12 ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 3
3B1B ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 4
3B24 ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 5
3B2D ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 6
3B36 ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 7
3B3F ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 8
3B48 ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 9
3B51 ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 10
3B5A ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 11
3B63 ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 12
3B6C ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 13
3B75 ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 14
3B7E ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 15
3B87 ...Repeated for Field Shared Input 16
Field Unit Contact Outputs (Read/Write Setting) (8 modules)
3BB0 Field Contact Output 1 ID (6 items) --- --- --- F205 "FCO U /OUT"
3BD4 Field Output 1 Operate (6 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
3BDA Field Output 1 Seal In (6 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
3BE0 Field Output 1 Events (6 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 1 (Enabled)
3BE6 ...Repeated for Field Contact Output 2
3C1C ...Repeated for Field Contact Output 3
3C52 ...Repeated for Field Contact Output 4
3C88 ...Repeated for Field Contact Output 5
3CBE ...Repeated for Field Contact Output 6
3CF4 ...Repeated for Field Contact Output 7
3D2A ...Repeated for Field Contact Output 8
Field Unit Latching Outputs (Read/Write Setting) (8 modules)
3D60 Field Latching Output 1 ID 0 to 1 --- 1 F205 "FLO Ux /LO"
3D66 Field Latching Output 1 Open 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
3D67 Field Latching Output 1 Close 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
3D68 Field Latching Output 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 1 (Enabled)
3D69 Reserved (2 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F001 0
3D6B ...Repeated for Field Latching Output 2
3D76 ...Repeated for Field Latching Output 3
3D81 ...Repeated for Field Latching Output 4
3D8C ...Repeated for Field Latching Output 5
3D97 ...Repeated for Field Latching Output 6
3DA2 ...Repeated for Field Latching Output 7
3DAD ...Repeated for Field Latching Output 8
Field Unit Shared Outputs (Read/Write Setting) (16 modules)
3DC0 Field Shared Output 1 ID 0 to 65535 --- 1 F205 "SO 1"
3DC6 Field Shared Output 1 Operate 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
3DC7 Field Shared Output 1 Unit Dest 1 0 to 8 --- 1 F256 0 (None)
3DC8 Field Shared Output 1 Channel Dest 1 1 to 15 --- 1 F001 1
3DC9 Field Shared Output 1 Unit Dest 2 0 to 8 --- 1 F256 0 (None)
3DCA Field Shared Output 1 Channel Dest 2 1 to 15 --- 1 F001 1
B 4008
400A
Command Password Entry
Setting Password Entry
0 to 4294967295
0 to 4294967295
---
---
1
1
F003
F003
0
0
Passwords (Read Only Actual Values)
4010 Command Password Status 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
4011 Setting Password Status 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
Passwords (Read/Write Settings)
4012 Command Password Access Timeout 5 to 480 minutes 1 F001 5
4013 Setting Password Access Timeout 5 to 480 minutes 1 F001 30
4014 Invalid Password Attempts (before lockout) 2 to 5 --- 1 F001 3
4015 Password Lockout Duration 5 to 60 minutes 1 F001 5
4016 Password Access Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
4017 Local Setting Authorization 1 to 65535 --- 1 F300 1
4018 Remote Setting Authorization 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 1
4019 Access Authorization Timeout 5 to 480 minutes 1 F001 30
User Display Invoke (Read/Write Setting)
4040 Invoke and Scroll Through User Display Menu Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
LED Test (Read/Write Setting)
4048 LED Test Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
4049 LED Test Control 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
Preferences (Read/Write Setting)
404F Language 0 to 3 --- 1 F531 0 (English)
4050 Flash Message Time 0.5 to 10 s 0.1 F001 10
4051 Default Message Timeout 10 to 900 s 1 F001 300
4052 Default Message Intensity 0 to 3 --- 1 F101 0 (25%)
4053 Screen Saver Feature 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
4054 Screen Saver Wait Time 1 to 65535 min 1 F001 30
4055 Current Cutoff Level 0.002 to 0.02 pu 0.001 F001 20
4056 Voltage Cutoff Level 0.1 to 1 V 0.1 F001 10
Remote RTD Communications (Read/Write Setting)
407A RRTD Slave Address 1 to 254 --- 1 F001 254
407B RRTD Baud Rate 0 to 4 --- 1 F602 4 (19200)
Communications (Read/Write Setting)
407D COM2 Selection 0 to 3 --- 1 F601 0 (RS485)
407E COM1 Minimum Response Time 0 to 1000 ms 10 F001 0
407F COM2 Minimum Response Time 0 to 1000 ms 10 F001 0
4080 Modbus Slave Address 1 to 254 --- 1 F001 254
4083 RS485 Com1 Baud Rate 0 to 11 --- 1 F112 8 (115200)
4084 RS485 Com1 Parity 0 to 2 --- 1 F113 0 (None)
4085 RS485 Com2 Baud Rate 0 to 11 --- 1 F112 8 (115200)
4086 RS485 Com2 Parity 0 to 2 --- 1 F113 0 (None)
4087 IP Address 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 56554706
4089 IP Subnet Mask 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 4294966272
408B Gateway IP Address 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 56554497
408D Network Address NSAP --- --- --- F074 0
409A DNP Channel 1 Port 0 to 5 --- 1 F177 0 (None)
409B DNP Channel 2 Port 0 to 5 --- 1 F177 0 (None)
409C DNP Address 0 to 65519 --- 1 F001 1
409E DNP Client Addresses (2 items) 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 0
40A3 TCP Port Number for the Modbus Protocol 1 to 65535 --- 1 F001 502
B 414D
414E
Ethernet Switch Port 3 Events
Ethernet Switch Port 4 Events
0 to 1
0 to 1
---
---
1
1
F102
F102
0 (Disabled)
0 (Disabled)
414F Ethernet Switch Port 5 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
4150 Ethernet Switch Port 6 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
Ethernet Switch (Read Only Actual Values)
4151 Ethernet Switch MAC Address --- --- --- F072 0
4154 Ethernet Switch Port 1 Status 0 to 2 --- 1 F134 0 (Fail)
4155 Ethernet Switch Port 2 Status 0 to 2 --- 1 F134 0 (Fail)
4156 Ethernet Switch Port 3 Status 0 to 2 --- 1 F134 0 (Fail)
4157 Ethernet Switch Port 4 Status 0 to 2 --- 1 F134 0 (Fail)
4158 Ethernet Switch Port 5 Status 0 to 2 --- 1 F134 0 (Fail)
4159 Ethernet Switch Port 6 Status 0 to 2 --- 1 F134 0 (Fail)
415A Switch Firmware Version 0 to 99.99 --- 0.01 F001 0
Simple Network Time Protocol (Read/Write Setting)
4168 Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
4169 Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Server IP Address 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 0
416B Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) UDP Port Number 1 to 65535 --- 1 F001 123
Data Logger Commands (Read/Write Command)
4170 Data Logger Clear 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
Data Logger (Read/Write Setting)
4181 Data Logger Channel Settings (16 items) --- --- --- F600 0
4191 Data Logger Mode 0 to 1 --- 1 F260 0 (Continuous)
4192 Data Logger Trigger 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
4193 Data Logger Rate 15 to 3600000 ms 1 F003 60000
Clock (Read/Write Command)
41A0 Real Time Clock Set Time 0 to 235959 --- 1 F050 0
Clock (Read/Write Setting)
41A2 SR Date Format 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F051 0
41A4 SR Time Format 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F052 0
41A6 IRIG-B Signal Type 0 to 2 --- 1 F114 0 (None)
41A7 Clock Events Enable / Disable 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
41A8 Time Zone Offset from UTC –24 to 24 hours 0.5 F002 0
41A9 Daylight Savings Time (DST) Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
41AA Daylight Savings Time (DST) Start Month 0 to 11 --- 1 F237 0 (January)
41AB Daylight Savings Time (DST) Start Day 0 to 6 --- 1 F238 0 (Sunday)
41AC Daylight Savings Time (DST) Start Day Instance 0 to 4 --- 1 F239 0 (First)
41AD Daylight Savings Time (DST) Start Hour 0 to 23 --- 1 F001 2
41AE Daylight Savings Time (DST) Stop Month 0 to 11 --- 1 F237 0 (January)
41AF Daylight Savings Time (DST) Stop Day 0 to 6 --- 1 F238 0 (Sunday)
41B0 Daylight Savings Time (DST) Stop Day Instance 0 to 4 --- 1 F239 0 (First)
41B1 Daylight Savings Time (DST) Stop Hour 0 to 23 --- 1 F001 2
Oscillography (Read/Write Setting)
41C0 Oscillography Number of Records 1 to 64 --- 1 F001 5
41C1 Oscillography Trigger Mode 0 to 1 --- 1 F118 0 (Auto. Overwrite)
41C2 Oscillography Trigger Position 0 to 100 % 1 F001 50
41C3 Oscillography Trigger Source 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
41C4 Oscillography AC Input Waveforms 0 to 4 --- 1 F183 2 (16 samples/cycle)
41D0 Oscillography Analog Channel n (16 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F600 0
4200 Oscillography Digital Channel n (63 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
B 4442
4443
User Programmable Direct Device Off Function
User Programmable Remote Device Off Function
0 to 1
0 to 1
---
---
1
1
F102
F102
1 (Enabled)
1 (Enabled)
4444 User Programmable Primary Ethernet Fail Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
4445 User Programmable Secondary Ethernet Fail Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
4446 User Programmable Battery Fail Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 1 (Enabled)
4447 User Programmable SNTP Fail Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 1 (Enabled)
4448 User Programmable IRIG-B Fail Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 1 (Enabled)
4449 User Programmable Ethernet Switch Fail Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 1 (Enabled)
444A Process Bus Failure Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
CT Settings (Read/Write Setting) (6 modules)
4480 Phase CT 1 Primary 1 to 65000 A 1 F001 1
4481 Phase CT 1 Secondary 0 to 1 --- 1 F123 0 (1 A)
4482 Ground CT 1 Primary 1 to 65000 A 1 F001 1
4483 Ground CT 1 Secondary 0 to 1 --- 1 F123 0 (1 A)
4484 ...Repeated for CT Bank 2
4488 ...Repeated for CT Bank 3
448C ...Repeated for CT Bank 4
4490 ...Repeated for CT Bank 5
4494 ...Repeated for CT Bank 6
VT Settings (Read/Write Setting) (6 modules)
4500 Phase VT 1 Connection 0 to 1 --- 1 F100 0 (Wye)
4501 Phase VT 1 Secondary 25 to 240 V 0.1 F001 664
4502 Phase VT 1 Ratio 1 to 24000 :1 1 F060 1
4504 Auxiliary VT 1 Connection 0 to 6 --- 1 F166 1 (Vag)
4505 Auxiliary VT 1 Secondary 25 to 240 V 0.1 F001 664
4506 Auxiliary VT 1 Ratio 1 to 24000 :1 1 F060 1
4508 ...Repeated for VT Bank 2
4510 ...Repeated for VT Bank 3
4518 ...Repeated for VT Bank 4
4520 ...Repeated for VT Bank 5
4528 ...Repeated for VT Bank 6
Source Settings (Read/Write Setting) (4 modules)
4580 Source 1 Name 0 to 1 --- 1 F206 “SRC 1"
4583 Source 1 Phase CT 0 to 63 --- 1 F400 0
4584 Source 1 Ground CT 0 to 63 --- 1 F400 0
4585 Source 1 Phase VT 0 to 63 --- 1 F400 0
4586 Source 1 Auxiliary VT 0 to 63 --- 1 F400 0
4587 ...Repeated for Source 2
458E ...Repeated for Source 3
4595 ...Repeated for Source 4
Power System (Read/Write Setting)
4600 Nominal Frequency 25 to 60 Hz 1 F001 60
4601 Phase Rotation 0 to 1 --- 1 F106 0 (ABC)
4602 Frequency and Phase Reference 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
4603 Frequency Tracking Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 1 (Enabled)
Breaker Control (Read/Write Settings) (4 modules)
4700 Breaker 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
4701 Breaker 1 Name --- --- --- F206 “Bkr 1"
4704 Breaker 1 Mode 0 to 1 --- 1 F157 0 (3-Pole)
B 4E12
4E14
Raw Field Data AC7 Mag
Raw Field Data AC7 Angle
0 to 0.001
0 to 0.1
A/V
degree
0.001
0.1
F003
F002
0
0
4E15 Raw Field Data AC8 Mag 0 to 0.001 A/V 0.001 F003 0
4E17 Raw Field Data AC8 Angle 0 to 0.1 degree 0.1 F002 0
4E18 Raw Field Data DC1 0 to 0.001 V 0.001 F002 0
4E19 Raw Field Data DC2 0 to 0.001 V 0.001 F002 0
4E1A Raw Field Data DC3 0 to 0.001 V 0.001 F002 0
4E1B Raw Field Data FCI States (2 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F500 0
4E1D Raw Field Data SI States 0 to 1 --- 1 F500 0
4E1E Raw Field Data SI Test States 0 to 1 --- 1 F500 0
4E1F Raw Field Data Brick ADC Temperature 0 to 1 degree 1 F002 0
4E20 Raw Field Data Brick Transceiver Temperature 0 to 1 degree 1 F002 0
4E21 Raw Field Data Brick Transceiver Voltage 0 to 0.01 V 0.01 F001 0
4E22 Raw Field Data Brick Transceiver Current 0 to 1 mA 1 F001 0
4E23 Raw Field Data Brick Tx Power 0 to 0.1 dBm 0.1 F002 0
4E24 Raw Field Data Brick Rx Power 0 to 0.1 dBm 0.1 F002 0
4E25 Raw Field Data Brick Diagnostics (2 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F500 0
4E27 Raw Field Data Local Transceiver Temperature 0 to 1 degree 1 F002 0
4E28 Raw Field Data Local Transceiver Voltage 0 to 0.01 V 0.01 F001 0
4E29 Raw Field Data Local Transceiver Current 0 to 1 mA 1 F001 0
4E2A Raw Field Data Local Tx Power 0 to 0.1 dBm 0.1 F002 0
4E2B Raw Field Data Local Rx Power 0 to 0.1 dBm 0.1 F002 0
4E2C Repeated for Field Unit 2
4E58 Repeated for Field Unit 3
4E84 Repeated for Field Unit 4
4EB0 Repeated for Field Unit 5
4EDC Repeated for Field Unit 6
4F08 Repeated for Field Unit 7
4F34 Repeated for Field Unit 8
FlexLogic (Read/Write Setting)
5000 FlexLogic™ Entry (512 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 8192
RTD Inputs (Read/Write Setting) (48 modules)
5400 RTD Input 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
5401 RTD Input 1 ID --- --- --- F205 “RTD Ip 1“
5407 RTD Input 1 Type 0 to 3 --- 1 F174 0 (100 ohm Platinum)
5408 RTD Input 1 Application 0 to 5 --- 1 F550 0 (None)
5409 RTD Input 1 Alarm Temperature 1 to 249 °C 1 F001 130
540A RTD Input 1 Alarm Pickup Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 0
540B RTD Input 1 Trip Temperature 1 to 249 °C 1 F001 130
540C RTD Input 1 Trip Pickup Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 0
540D RTD Input 1 Trip Reset Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 0
540E RTD Input 1 Trip Voting 0 to 48 --- 1 F551 0
540F RTD Input 1 Open 0 to 2 --- 1 F552 0 (None)
5410 RTD Input 1 Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
5411 RTD Input 1 Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
5412 RTD Input 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
5413 ...Repeated for RTD Input 2
5426 ...Repeated for RTD Input 3
5439 ...Repeated for RTD Input 4
B 5858
5860
...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 12
...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 13
5868 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 14
5870 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 15
5878 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 16
5880 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 17
5888 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 18
5890 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 19
5898 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 20
58A0 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 21
58A8 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 22
58B0 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 23
58B8 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 24
58C0 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 25
58C8 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 26
58D0 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 27
58D8 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 28
58E0 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 29
58E8 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 30
58F0 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 31
58F8 ...Repeated for FlexLogic™ Timer 32
Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent (Read/Write Grouped Setting) (8 modules)
5A00 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
5A01 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Signal Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
5A02 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Pickup 0 to 30 pu 0.001 F001 1000
5A03 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 0
5A04 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Reset Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 0
5A05 Phase IOC1 Block For Phase A 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
5A06 Phase IOC1 Block For Phase B 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
5A07 Phase IOC1 Block For Phase C 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
5A08 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
5A09 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
5A0A Reserved (6 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F001 0
5A10 ...Repeated for Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 2
5A20 ...Repeated for Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 3
5A30 ...Repeated for Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 4
5A40 ...Repeated for Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 5
5A50 ...Repeated for Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 6
5A60 ...Repeated for Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 7
5A70 ...Repeated for Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 8
Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent (Read/Write Grouped Setting) (8 modules)
5C00 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
5C01 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Signal Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
5C02 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Pickup 0 to 30 pu 0.001 F001 1000
5C03 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 0
5C04 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Reset Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 0
5C05 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
5C06 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
5C07 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
B 6442
6443
Current Unbalance 1 Pickup Delay
Current Unbalance 1 Reset Delay
0 to 600
0 to 600
s
s
0.01
0.01
F001
F001
0
0
6444 Current Unbalance 1 Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
6445 Current Unbalance 1 Targets 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
6446 Current Unbalance 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
6447 Reserved (5 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F001 0
644C ...Repeated for Current Unbalance 2
Stator Differential (Read/Write Grouped Setting)
6470 Stator Differential Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
6471 Stator Differential Pickup 0.05 to 1 pu 0.001 F001 100
6472 Stator Differential Slope 1 1 to 100 % 1 F001 10
6473 Stator Differential Slope 2 1 to 100 % 1 F001 80
6474 Stator Differential Break 1 1 to 1.5 pu 0.01 F001 115
6475 Stator Differential Break 2 1.5 to 30 pu 0.01 F001 800
6476 Stator Differential Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
6477 Stator Differential Targets 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
6478 Stator Differential Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
6479 Stator Differential Line End Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
647A Stator Differential Neutral End Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
Negative Sequence Overvoltage (Read/Write Grouped Setting) (3 modules)
64A0 Negative Sequence Overvoltage 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
64A1 Negative Sequence Overvoltage 1 Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
64A2 Negative Sequence Overvoltage 1 Pickup 0 to 1.25 pu 0.001 F001 300
64A3 Negative Sequence Overvoltage 1 Pickup Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 50
64A4 Negative Sequence Overvoltage 1 Reset Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 50
64A5 Negative Sequence Overvoltage 1 Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
64A6 Negative Sequence Overvoltage 1 Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
64A7 Negative Sequence Overvoltage 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
64A8 ...Repeated for Negative Sequence Overvoltage 2
64B0 ...Repeated for Negative Sequence Overvoltage 3
Overfrequency (Read/Write Setting) (4 modules)
64D0 Overfrequency 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
64D1 Overfrequency 1 Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
64D2 Overfrequency 1 Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
64D3 Overfrequency 1 Pickup 20 to 65 Hz 0.01 F001 6050
64D4 Overfrequency 1 Pickup Delay 0 to 65.535 s 0.001 F001 500
64D5 Overfrequency 1 Reset Delay 0 to 65.535 s 0.001 F001 500
64D6 Overfrequency 1 Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
64D7 Overfrequency 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
64D8 Reserved (4 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F001 0
64DC ...Repeated for Overfrequency 2
64E8 ...Repeated for Overfrequency 3
64F4 ...Repeated for Overfrequency 4
Motor Setup (Read/Write Setting)
6600 Thermal Model Motor Full Load Amps (FLA) 0.05 to 1 pu 0.001 F001 1000
6601 Thermal Model Motor Service (Overload) Factor 1 to 1.5 --- 0.01 F001 100
6602 Thermal Model Line Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
6603 Thermal Model Motor Offline 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
6604 Thermal Model RTD 1 0 to 48 --- 1 F151 0 (NONE)
B 7B2E
7B2F
Speed 2 VD Acceleration Intersect at Minimum Volts
Speed 2 VD Overload Stall Current at 100% Voltage
1.5 to 20
1.5 to 20
FLA
FLA
0.01
0.01
F001
F001
400
600
7B30 Speed 2 VD Overload Safe Stall Time at 100% Voltage 0.1 to 1000 s 0.1 F001 200
7B31 Speed 2 VD Acceleration Intersect at 100% Voltage 1.5 to 20 FLA 0.01 F001 500
Motor Acceleration Time (Read/Write Grouped Setting)
7B40 Motor Acceleration Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
7B41 Motor Acceleration Current 1 to 10 FLA 0.01 F001 600
7B42 Motor Acceleration Time 0.05 to 180 s 0.01 F001 1000
7B43 Motor Acceleration Mode 0 to 1 --- 1 F097 0 (Definite Time)
7B44 Motor Acceleration Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
7B45 Motor Acceleration Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
7B46 Motor Acceleration Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
7B47 Speed 2 Motor Acceleration Current 1 to 10 x FLA 0.01 F001 600
7B48 Speed 2 Motor Acceleration Time 0.05 to 180 s 0.01 F001 1000
7B49 Speed 2 Motor Acceleration Mode 0 to 1 --- 1 F097 0 (Definite Time)
7B4A Speed 2 Motor Acceleration Speed 1-2 0.05 to 180 s 0.01 F001 1000
7B4B Speed 2 Motor Acceleration Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
7B4C Reserved (9 items) --- --- --- F001 0
User Programmable Pushbuttons (Read/Write Setting) (16 modules)
7B60 User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Function 0 to 2 --- 1 F137 0 (Disabled)
7B61 User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Top Line --- --- --- F202 (none)
7B6B User Programmable Pushbutton 1 On Text --- --- --- F202 (none)
7B75 User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Off Text --- --- --- F202 (none)
7B7F User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Drop-Out Time 0 to 60 s 0.05 F001 0
7B80 User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
7B81 User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
7B82 User Programmable Pushbutton 1 LED Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
7B83 User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Autoreset Delay 0.2 to 600 s 0.1 F001 10
7B84 User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Autoreset Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
7B85 User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Local Lock Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
7B86 User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Message Priority 0 to 2 --- 1 F220 0 (Disabled)
7B87 User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Remote Lock Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
7B88 User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Reset Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
7B89 User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Set Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
7B8A User Programmable Pushbutton 1 Hold 0 to 10 s 0.1 F001 1
7B8B ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 2
7BB6 ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 3
7BE1 ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 4
7C0C ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 5
7C37 ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 6
7C62 ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 7
7C8D ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 8
7CB8 ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 9
7CE3 ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 10
7D0E ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 11
7D39 ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 12
7D64 ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 13
7D8F ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 14
7DBA ...Repeated for User Programmable Pushbutton 15
B 8A01
8A09
Digital Element 1 Name
Digital Element 1 Input
---
0 to 65535
---
---
---
1
F203
F300
“Dig Element 1“
0
8A0A Digital Element 1 Pickup Delay 0 to 999999.999 s 0.001 F003 0
8A0C Digital Element 1 Reset Delay 0 to 999999.999 s 0.001 F003 0
8A0E Digital Element 1 Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
8A0F Digital Element 1 Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
8A10 Digital Element 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
8A11 Digital Element 1 Pickup LED 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 1 (Enabled)
8A12 Reserved (2 items) --- --- --- F001 0
8A14 ...Repeated for Digital Element 2
8A28 ...Repeated for Digital Element 3
8A3C ...Repeated for Digital Element 4
8A50 ...Repeated for Digital Element 5
8A64 ...Repeated for Digital Element 6
8A78 ...Repeated for Digital Element 7
8A8C ...Repeated for Digital Element 8
8AA0 ...Repeated for Digital Element 9
8AB4 ...Repeated for Digital Element 10
8AC8 ...Repeated for Digital Element 11
8ADC ...Repeated for Digital Element 12
8AF0 ...Repeated for Digital Element 13
8B04 ...Repeated for Digital Element 14
8B18 ...Repeated for Digital Element 15
8B2C ...Repeated for Digital Element 16
8B40 ...Repeated for Digital Element 17
8B54 ...Repeated for Digital Element 18
8B68 ...Repeated for Digital Element 19
8B7C ...Repeated for Digital Element 20
8B90 ...Repeated for Digital Element 21
8BA4 ...Repeated for Digital Element 22
8BB8 ...Repeated for Digital Element 23
8BCC ...Repeated for Digital Element 24
8BE0 ...Repeated for Digital Element 25
8BF4 ...Repeated for Digital Element 26
8C08 ...Repeated for Digital Element 27
8C1C ...Repeated for Digital Element 28
8C30 ...Repeated for Digital Element 29
8C44 ...Repeated for Digital Element 30
8C58 ...Repeated for Digital Element 31
8C6C ...Repeated for Digital Element 32
8C80 ...Repeated for Digital Element 33
8C94 ...Repeated for Digital Element 34
8CA8 ...Repeated for Digital Element 35
8CBC ...Repeated for Digital Element 36
8CD0 ...Repeated for Digital Element 37
8CE4 ...Repeated for Digital Element 38
8CF8 ...Repeated for Digital Element 39
8D0C ...Repeated for Digital Element 40
8D20 ...Repeated for Digital Element 41
B 9064
9078
...Repeated for FlexElement™ 6
...Repeated for FlexElement™ 7
908C ...Repeated for FlexElement™ 8
90A0 ...Repeated for FlexElement™ 9
90B4 ...Repeated for FlexElement™ 10
90C8 ...Repeated for FlexElement™ 11
90DC ...Repeated for FlexElement™ 12
90F0 ...Repeated for FlexElement™ 13
9104 ...Repeated for FlexElement™ 14
9118 ...Repeated for FlexElement™ 15
912C ...Repeated for FlexElement™ 16
DCmA Outputs (Read/Write Setting) (24 modules)
9300 DCmA Output 1 Source 0 to 65535 --- 1 F600 0
9301 DCmA Output 1 Range 0 to 2 --- 1 F522 0 (–1 to 1 mA)
9302 DCmA Output 1 Minimum –90 to 90 pu 0.001 F004 0
9304 DCmA Output 1 Maximum –90 to 90 pu 0.001 F004 1000
9306 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 2
930C ...Repeated for DCmA Output 3
9312 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 4
9318 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 5
931E ...Repeated for DCmA Output 6
9324 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 7
932A ...Repeated for DCmA Output 8
9330 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 9
9336 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 10
933C ...Repeated for DCmA Output 11
9342 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 12
9348 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 13
934E ...Repeated for DCmA Output 14
9354 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 15
935A ...Repeated for DCmA Output 16
9360 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 17
9366 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 18
936C ...Repeated for DCmA Output 19
9372 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 20
9378 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 21
937E ...Repeated for DCmA Output 22
9384 ...Repeated for DCmA Output 23
938A ...Repeated for DCmA Output 24
Direct Input/Output Names (Read/Write Setting) (32 modules)
9400 Direct Input 1 Name 0 to 96 --- 1 F205 “Dir Ip 1”
9406 Direct Output 1 Name 1 to 96 --- 1 F205 “Dir Out 1”
940C ...Repeated for Direct Input/Output 2
9418 ...Repeated for Direct Input/Output 3
9424 ...Repeated for Direct Input/Output 4
9430 ...Repeated for Direct Input/Output 5
943C ...Repeated for Direct Input/Output 6
9448 ...Repeated for Direct Input/Output 7
9454 ...Repeated for Direct Input/Output 8
B A704
A705
Non-Volatile Latch 1 Target
Non-Volatile Latch 1 Events
0 to 2
0 to 1
---
---
1
1
F109
F102
0 (Self-reset)
0 (Disabled)
A706 Reserved (4 items) --- --- --- F001 0
A70A ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 2
A714 ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 3
A71E ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 4
A728 ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 5
A732 ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 6
A73C ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 7
A746 ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 8
A750 ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 9
A75A ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 10
A764 ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 11
A76E ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 12
A778 ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 13
A782 ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 14
A78C ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 15
A796 ...Repeated for Non-Volatile Latch 16
Digital Counter (Read/Write Setting) (8 modules)
A800 Digital Counter 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
A801 Digital Counter 1 Name --- --- --- F205 “Counter 1"
A807 Digital Counter 1 Units --- --- --- F206 (none)
A80A Digital Counter 1 Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
A80B Digital Counter 1 Up 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
A80C Digital Counter 1 Down 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
A80D Digital Counter 1 Preset –2147483647 to --- 1 F004 0
2147483647
A80F Digital Counter 1 Compare –2147483647 to --- 1 F004 0
2147483647
A811 Digital Counter 1 Reset 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
A812 Digital Counter 1 Freeze/Reset 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
A813 Digital Counter 1 Freeze/Count 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
A814 Digital Counter 1 Set To Preset 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
A815 Reserved (11 items) --- --- --- F001 0
A820 ...Repeated for Digital Counter 2
A840 ...Repeated for Digital Counter 3
A860 ...Repeated for Digital Counter 4
A880 ...Repeated for Digital Counter 5
A8A0 ...Repeated for Digital Counter 6
A8C0 ...Repeated for Digital Counter 7
A8E0 ...Repeated for Digital Counter 8
IEC 61850 Received Analog Settings (Read/Write Setting) (32 modules)
AA00 IEC 61850 GOOSE Analog 1 Default Value –1000000 to 1000000 --- 0.001 F060 1000
AA02 IEC 61850 GOOSE Analog Input 1 Mode 0 to 1 --- 1 F491 0 (Default Value)
AA03 IEC 61850 GOOSE Analog Input 1 Units --- --- --- F207 (none)
AA05 IEC 61850 GOOSE Analog Input 1 Per-Unit Base 0 to 999999999.999 --- 0.001 F060 1
AA07 ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GOOSE Analog Input 2
AA0E ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GOOSE Analog Input 3
AA15 ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GOOSE Analog Input 4
AA1C ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GOOSE Analog Input 5
B AE3C IEC 61850 Logical Node XSWIx Name Prefix (24 items) 0 to 65534
IEC 61850 XSWI Configuration (Read/Write Settings and Commands) (24 modules)
--- 1 F206 (none)
AECF FlexLogic Operand for IEC 61850 XSWI1.ST.Loc Status 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
AED0 Command to Clear XSWI1 OpCnt (Operation Counter) 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
AED1 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI2
AED3 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI3
AED5 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI4
AED7 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI5
AED9 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI6
AEDB Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI7
AEDD Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI8
AEDF Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI9
AEE1 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI10
AEE3 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI11
AEE5 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI12
AEE7 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI13
AEE9 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI14
AEEB Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI15
AEED Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI16
AEEF Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI17
AEF1 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI18
AEF3 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI19
AEF5 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI20
AEF7 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI21
AEF9 Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI22
AEFB Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI23
AEFD Repeated for IEC 61850 XSWI24
IEC 61850 GGIO4 General Analog Configuration Settings (Read/Write Setting)
AF00 Number of Analog Input Points in GGIO4 4 to 32 --- 4 F001 4
IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input Points Configuration Settings (Read/Write Setting) (32 modules)
AF10 IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 1 Value --- --- --- F600 0
AF11 IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 1 Deadband 0.001 to 100 % 0.001 F003 100000
AF13 IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 1 Minimum –1000000000000 to --- 0.001 F060 0
1000000000000
AF15 IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 1 Maximum –1000000000000 to --- 0.001 F060 1000000
1000000000000
AF17 ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 2
AF1E ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 3
AF25 ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 4
AF2C ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 5
AF33 ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 6
AF3A ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 7
AF41 ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 8
AF48 ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 9
AF4F ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 10
AF56 ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 11
AF5D ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 12
AF64 ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 13
AF6B ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 14
AF72 ...Repeated for IEC 61850 GGIO4 Analog Input 15
B B0EA
B0EC
IEC 61850 MMXU VA.phsA Deadband 1
IEC 61850 MMXU VA.phsB Deadband 1
0.001 to 100
0.001 to 100
%
%
0.001
0.001
F003
F003
10000
10000
B0EE IEC 61850 MMXU VA.phsC Deadband 1 0.001 to 100 % 0.001 F003 10000
B0F0 IEC 61850 MMXU PF.phsA Deadband 1 0.001 to 100 % 0.001 F003 10000
B0F2 IEC 61850 MMXU PF.phsB Deadband 1 0.001 to 100 % 0.001 F003 10000
B0F4 IEC 61850 MMXU PF.phsC Deadband 1 0.001 to 100 % 0.001 F003 10000
B0F6 ...Repeated for Deadband 2
B12C ...Repeated for Deadband 3
B162 ...Repeated for Deadband 4
B198 ...Repeated for Deadband 5
B1CE ...Repeated for Deadband 6
IEC 61850 Received Analogs (Read Only) (32 modules)
B210 IEC 61850 Received Analog 1 -1000000000000 to --- 0.001 F060 0
1000000000000
B212 ...Repeated for Received Analog 2
B214 ...Repeated for Received Analog 3
B216 ...Repeated for Received Analog 4
B218 ...Repeated for Received Analog 5
B21A ...Repeated for Received Analog 6
B21C ...Repeated for Received Analog 7
B21E ...Repeated for Received Analog 8
B220 ...Repeated for Received Analog 9
B222 ...Repeated for Received Analog 10
B224 ...Repeated for Received Analog 11
B226 ...Repeated for Received Analog 12
B228 ...Repeated for Received Analog 13
B22A ...Repeated for Received Analog 14
B22C ...Repeated for Received Analog 15
B22E ...Repeated for Received Analog 16
B230 ...Repeated for Received Analog 17
B232 ...Repeated for Received Analog 18
B234 ...Repeated for Received Analog 19
B236 ...Repeated for Received Analog 20
B238 ...Repeated for Received Analog 21
B23A ...Repeated for Received Analog 22
B23C ...Repeated for Received Analog 23
B23E ...Repeated for Received Analog 24
B240 ...Repeated for Received Analog 25
B242 ...Repeated for Received Analog 26
B244 ...Repeated for Received Analog 27
B246 ...Repeated for Received Analog 28
B248 ...Repeated for Received Analog 29
B24A ...Repeated for Received Analog 30
B24C ...Repeated for Received Analog 31
B24E ...Repeated for Received Analog 32
IEC 61850 Configurable Report Settings (Read/Write Setting)
B290 IEC 61850 Configurable Reports Dataset Items (64 0 to 848 --- 1 F615 0 (None)
items)
IEC 61850 GGIO1 Configuration Settings (Read/Write Setting)
B500 Number of Status Indications in GGIO1 8 to 128 --- 8 F001 8
B BB90
BB98
...Repeated for Contact Input 19
...Repeated for Contact Input 20
BBA0 ...Repeated for Contact Input 21
BBA8 ...Repeated for Contact Input 22
BBB0 ...Repeated for Contact Input 23
BBB8 ...Repeated for Contact Input 24
BBC0 ...Repeated for Contact Input 25
BBC8 ...Repeated for Contact Input 26
BBD0 ...Repeated for Contact Input 27
BBD8 ...Repeated for Contact Input 28
BBE0 ...Repeated for Contact Input 29
BBE8 ...Repeated for Contact Input 30
BBF0 ...Repeated for Contact Input 31
BBF8 ...Repeated for Contact Input 32
BC00 ...Repeated for Contact Input 33
BC08 ...Repeated for Contact Input 34
BC10 ...Repeated for Contact Input 35
BC18 ...Repeated for Contact Input 36
BC20 ...Repeated for Contact Input 37
BC28 ...Repeated for Contact Input 38
BC30 ...Repeated for Contact Input 39
BC38 ...Repeated for Contact Input 40
BC40 ...Repeated for Contact Input 41
BC48 ...Repeated for Contact Input 42
BC50 ...Repeated for Contact Input 43
BC58 ...Repeated for Contact Input 44
BC60 ...Repeated for Contact Input 45
BC68 ...Repeated for Contact Input 46
BC70 ...Repeated for Contact Input 47
BC78 ...Repeated for Contact Input 48
BC80 ...Repeated for Contact Input 49
BC88 ...Repeated for Contact Input 50
BC90 ...Repeated for Contact Input 51
BC98 ...Repeated for Contact Input 52
BCA0 ...Repeated for Contact Input 53
BCA8 ...Repeated for Contact Input 54
BCB0 ...Repeated for Contact Input 55
BCB8 ...Repeated for Contact Input 56
BCC0 ...Repeated for Contact Input 57
BCC8 ...Repeated for Contact Input 58
BCD0 ...Repeated for Contact Input 59
BCD8 ...Repeated for Contact Input 60
BCE0 ...Repeated for Contact Input 61
BCE8 ...Repeated for Contact Input 62
BCF0 ...Repeated for Contact Input 63
BCF8 ...Repeated for Contact Input 64
BD00 ...Repeated for Contact Input 65
BD08 ...Repeated for Contact Input 66
BD10 ...Repeated for Contact Input 67
B BF44
BF50
...Repeated for Virtual Input 24
...Repeated for Virtual Input 25
BF5C ...Repeated for Virtual Input 26
BF68 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 27
BF74 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 28
BF80 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 29
BF8C ...Repeated for Virtual Input 30
BF98 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 31
BFA4 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 32
BFB0 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 33
BFBC ...Repeated for Virtual Input 34
BFC8 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 35
BFD4 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 36
BFE0 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 37
BFEC ...Repeated for Virtual Input 38
BFF8 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 39
C004 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 40
C010 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 41
C01C ...Repeated for Virtual Input 42
C028 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 43
C034 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 44
C040 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 45
C04C ...Repeated for Virtual Input 46
C058 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 47
C064 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 48
C070 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 49
C07C ...Repeated for Virtual Input 50
C088 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 51
C094 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 52
C0A0 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 53
C0AC ...Repeated for Virtual Input 54
C0B8 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 55
C0C4 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 56
C0D0 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 57
C0DC ...Repeated for Virtual Input 58
C0E8 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 59
C0F4 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 60
C100 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 61
C10C ...Repeated for Virtual Input 62
C118 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 63
C124 ...Repeated for Virtual Input 64
Virtual Outputs (Read/Write Setting) (96 modules)
C130 Virtual Output 1 Name --- --- --- F205 “Virt Op 1 “
C136 Virtual Output 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
C137 Reserved --- --- --- F001 0
C138 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 2
C140 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 3
C148 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 4
C150 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 5
B C330
C338
...Repeated for Virtual Output 65
...Repeated for Virtual Output 66
C340 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 67
C348 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 68
C350 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 69
C358 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 70
C360 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 71
C368 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 72
C370 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 73
C378 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 74
C380 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 75
C388 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 76
C390 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 77
C398 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 78
C3A0 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 79
C3A8 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 80
C3B0 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 81
C3B8 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 82
C3C0 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 83
C3C8 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 84
C3D0 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 85
C3D8 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 86
C3E0 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 87
C3E8 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 88
C3F0 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 89
C3F8 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 90
C400 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 91
C408 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 92
C410 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 93
C418 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 94
C420 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 95
C428 ...Repeated for Virtual Output 96
Mandatory (Read/Write Setting or Command)
C430 Test Mode Function 0 to 2 --- 1 F245 0 (Disabled)
C431 Force VFD and LED 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
C432 Test Mode Initiate (Forcing) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 1
Clear Commands (Read/Write)
C433 Clear All Relay Records Command 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
Mandatory (Read Only)
C434 DSP Advanced Diagnostics Active 0 to 1 -- 1 F126 0 (No)
C435 Synchrophasor Feature Active 0 to 1 -- 1 F126 0 (No)
Contact Outputs (Read/Write Setting) (64 modules)
C440 Contact Output 1 Name --- --- --- F205 “Cont Op 1"
C446 Contact Output 1 Operation 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
C447 Contact Output 1 Seal In 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
C448 Latching Output 1 Reset 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
C449 Contact Output 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 1 (Enabled)
C44A Latching Output 1 Type 0 to 1 --- 1 F090 0 (Operate-dominant)
C44B Reserved --- --- --- F001 0
B C710
C71C
...Repeated for Contact Output 61
...Repeated for Contact Output 62
C728 ...Repeated for Contact Output 63
C734 ...Repeated for Contact Output 64
Reset (Read/Write Setting)
C750 FlexLogic™ operand which initiates a reset 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
Control Pushbuttons (Read/Write Setting) (7 modules)
C760 Control Pushbutton 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
C761 Control Pushbutton 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
C762 ...Repeated for Control Pushbutton 2
C764 ...Repeated for Control Pushbutton 3
C766 ...Repeated for Control Pushbutton 4
C768 ...Repeated for Control Pushbutton 5
C76A ...Repeated for Control Pushbutton 6
C76C ...Repeated for Control Pushbutton 7
Clear Records (Read/Write Setting)
C771 Clear User Fault Reports Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
C772 Clear Event Records Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
C773 Clear Oscillography Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
C774 Clear Data Logger Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
C77D Clear Energy Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
C77F Clear Unauthorized Access Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
C780 Clear Start Data Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
C781 Clear Platform Direct Input/Output Statistics Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
C783 Reserved (13 items) --- --- --- F001 0
Force Contact Inputs/Outputs (Read/Write Settings)
C7A0 Force Contact Input x State (96 items) 0 to 2 --- 1 F144 0 (Disabled)
C800 Force Contact Output x State (64 items) 0 to 3 --- 1 F131 0 (Disabled)
Direct Inputs/Outputs (Read/Write Setting)
C880 Direct Device ID 1 to 16 --- 1 F001 1
C881 Direct I/O Channel 1 Ring Configuration Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
C882 Platform Direct I/O Data Rate 64 to 128 kbps 64 F001 64
C883 Direct I/O Channel 2 Ring Configuration Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
C884 Platform Direct I/O Crossover Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
Direct Input/Output Commands (Read/Write Command)
C888 Direct Input/Output Clear Counters Command 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
Direct Inputs (Read/Write Setting) (32 modules)
C890 Direct Input 1 Device Number 0 to 16 --- 1 F001 0
C891 Direct Input 1 Number 0 to 96 --- 1 F001 0
C892 Direct Input 1 Default State 0 to 3 --- 1 F086 0 (Off)
C893 Direct Input 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
C894 ...Repeated for Direct Input 2
C898 ...Repeated for Direct Input 3
C89C ...Repeated for Direct Input 4
C8A0 ...Repeated for Direct Input 5
C8A4 ...Repeated for Direct Input 6
C8A8 ...Repeated for Direct Input 7
C8AC ...Repeated for Direct Input 8
C8B0 ...Repeated for Direct Input 9
CAD2 Direct Input/Output Channel 1 CRC Alarm Threshold 1 to 1000 --- 1 F001 10
CAD3 Direct Input/Output Channel 1 CRC Alarm Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
CAD4 Reserved (4 items) 1 to 1000 --- 1 F001 10
CAD8 Direct Input/Output Channel 2 CRC Alarm Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
CAD9 Direct Input/Output Channel 2 CRC Alarm Message 100 to 10000 --- 1 F001 600
Count
CADA Direct Input/Output Channel 2 CRC Alarm Threshold 1 to 1000 --- 1 F001 10
CADB Direct Input/Output Channel 2 CRC Alarm Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
CADC Reserved (4 items) 1 to 1000 --- 1 F001 10
CAE0 Direct Input/Output Channel 1 Unreturned Messages 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
Alarm Function
CAE1 Direct Input/Output Channel 1 Unreturned Messages 100 to 10000 --- 1 F001 600
Alarm Msg Count
CAE2 Direct Input/Output Channel 1 Unreturned Messages 1 to 1000 --- 1 F001 10
Alarm Threshold
CAE3 Direct Input/Output Channel 1 Unreturned Messages 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
Alarm Events
CAE4 Reserved (4 items) 1 to 1000 --- 1 F001 10
CAE8 Direct Input/Output Channel 2 Unreturned Messages 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
Alarm Function
CAE9 Direct Input/Output Channel 2 Unreturned Messages 100 to 10000 --- 1 F001 600
Alarm Msg Count
CAEA Direct Input/Output Channel 2 Unreturned Messages 1 to 1000 --- 1 F001 10
Alarm Threshold
CAEB Direct Input/Output Channel 2 Unreturned Messages 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
Alarm Events
CAEC Reserved (4 items) 1 to 1000 --- 1 F001 10
Remote Devices (Read/Write Setting) (16 modules)
CB00 Remote Device 1 GSSE/GOOSE Application ID (GOID) --- --- --- F209 “Remote Device 1“
CB21 Remote Device 1 GOOSE Ethernet APPID 0 to 16383 --- 1 F001 0
CB22 Remote Device 1 GOOSE Dataset 0 to 16 --- 1 F184 0 (Fixed)
CB23 Remote Device 1 in PMU Scheme 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
CB24 ...Repeated for Device 2
CB48 ...Repeated for Device 3
CB6C ...Repeated for Device 4
CB90 ...Repeated for Device 5
CBB4 ...Repeated for Device 6
CBD8 ...Repeated for Device 7
CBFC ...Repeated for Device 8
CC20 ...Repeated for Device 9
CC44 ...Repeated for Device 10
CC68 ...Repeated for Device 11
CC8C ...Repeated for Device 12
CCB0 ...Repeated for Device 13
CCD4 ...Repeated for Device 14
CCF8 ...Repeated for Device 15
CD1C ...Repeated for Device 16
Remote Inputs (Read/Write Setting) (32 modules)
CFA0 Remote Input 1 Device 1 to 32 --- 1 F001 1
CFA1 Remote Input 1 Bit Pair 0 to 96 --- 1 F156 0 (None)
CFA2 Remote Input 1 Default State 0 to 3 --- 1 F086 0 (Off)
B D27C
D280
...Repeated for Remote Output 24
...Repeated for Remote Output 25
D284 ...Repeated for Remote Output 26
D288 ...Repeated for Remote Output 27
D28C ...Repeated for Remote Output 28
D290 ...Repeated for Remote Output 29
D294 ...Repeated for Remote Output 30
D298 ...Repeated for Remote Output 31
D29C ...Repeated for Remote Output 32
Remote Output UserSt Pairs (Read/Write Setting) (32 modules)
D2A0 Remote Output UserSt 1 Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
D2A1 Remote Output UserSt 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
D2A2 Reserved (2 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F001 0
D2A4 ...Repeated for Remote Output 2
D2A8 ...Repeated for Remote Output 3
D2AC ...Repeated for Remote Output 4
D2B0 ...Repeated for Remote Output 5
D2B4 ...Repeated for Remote Output 6
D2B8 ...Repeated for Remote Output 7
D2BC ...Repeated for Remote Output 8
D2C0 ...Repeated for Remote Output 9
D2C4 ...Repeated for Remote Output 10
D2C8 ...Repeated for Remote Output 11
D2CC ...Repeated for Remote Output 12
D2D0 ...Repeated for Remote Output 13
D2D4 ...Repeated for Remote Output 14
D2D8 ...Repeated for Remote Output 15
D2DC ...Repeated for Remote Output 16
D2E0 ...Repeated for Remote Output 17
D2E4 ...Repeated for Remote Output 18
D2E8 ...Repeated for Remote Output 19
D2EC ...Repeated for Remote Output 20
D2F0 ...Repeated for Remote Output 21
D2F4 ...Repeated for Remote Output 22
D2F8 ...Repeated for Remote Output 23
D2FC ...Repeated for Remote Output 24
D300 ...Repeated for Remote Output 25
D304 ...Repeated for Remote Output 26
D308 ...Repeated for Remote Output 27
D30C ...Repeated for Remote Output 28
D310 ...Repeated for Remote Output 29
D314 ...Repeated for Remote Output 30
D318 ...Repeated for Remote Output 31
D31C ...Repeated for Remote Output 32
IEC 61850 GGIO2 Control Configuration (Read/Write Setting) (64 modules)
D320 IEC 61850 GGIO2.CF.SPCSO1.ctlModel Value 0 to 2 --- 1 F001 1
D321 IEC 61850 GGIO2.CF.SPCSO2.ctlModel Value 0 to 2 --- 1 F001 1
D322 IEC 61850 GGIO2.CF.SPCSO3.ctlModel Value 0 to 2 --- 1 F001 1
D323 IEC 61850 GGIO2.CF.SPCSO4.ctlModel Value 0 to 2 --- 1 F001 1
F060
F002
UR_SINT16 SIGNED 16 BIT INTEGER
FLOATING_POINT IEEE FLOATING POINT (32 bits)
B
F072
F003 HEX6 6 BYTES - 12 ASCII DIGITS
UR_UINT32 UNSIGNED 32 BIT INTEGER (2 registers)
High order word is stored in the first register.
F073
Low order word is stored in the second register.
HEX8 8 BYTES - 16 ASCII DIGITS
F004
F074
UR_SINT32 SIGNED 32 BIT INTEGER (2 registers)
HEX20 20 BYTES - 40 ASCII DIGITS
High order word is stored in the first register.
Low order word is stored in the second register.
F083
ENUMERATION: SELECTOR MODES
F011
0 = Time-out, 1 = Acknowledge
UR_UINT16 FLEXCURVE DATA (120 points)
A FlexCurve is an array of 120 consecutive data points (x, y) that
are interpolated to generate a smooth curve. The y-axis is the F084
user-defined trip or operation time setting; the x-axis is the pickup ENUMERATION: SELECTOR POWER UP
ratio and is pre-defined. See format F119 for a listing of the pickup
0 = Restore, 1 = Synchronize, 2 = Sync/Restore
ratios; the enumeration value for the pickup ratio indicates the off-
set into the FlexCurve base address where the corresponding time
value is stored.
F086
ENUMERATION: DIGITAL (CONTACT) INPUT DEFAULT STATE
F013 0 = Off, 1 = On, 2= Latest/Off, 3 = Latest/On
POWER_FACTOR (SIGNED 16 BIT INTEGER)
Positive values indicate lagging power factor; negative values
F090
indicate leading.
ENUMERATION: LATCHING OUTPUT TYPE
0 = Operate-dominant, 1 = Reset-dominant
F050
UR_UINT32 TIME and DATE (UNSIGNED 32 BIT INTEGER)
F095
Gives the current time in seconds elapsed since 00:00:00 January
ENUMERATION: REDUCED VOLTAGE START TRANSITION
1, 1970.
MODE
0 = Current Only, 1 = Current or Timer, 2 = Current and Timer
F051
UR_UINT32 DATE in SR format (alternate format for F050)
F096
First 16 bits are Month/Day (MM/DD/xxxx).
ENUMERATION: THERMAL MODEL CURVE EFFECT
Month: 1=January, 2=February,...,12=December.
Day: 1 to 31 in steps of 1. 0 = Cutoff, 1 = Shift
Last 16 bits are Year (xx/xx/YYYY): 1970 to 2106 in steps of 1.
F097
F052 ENUMERATION: MOTOR ACCELERATION MODE
UR_UINT32 TIME in SR format (alternate format for F050)
0 = Definite Time, 1 = Adaptive
First 16 bits are Hours/Minutes (HH:MM:xx.xxx).
Hours: 0=12am, 1=1am,...,12=12pm,...23=11pm.
Minutes: 0 to 59 in steps of 1.
F098 F106
ENUMERATION: MOTOR STATUS ENUMERATION: PHASE ROTATION
0 = Offline, 1 = Starting, 2 = Running, 3 = Overload 0 = ABC, 1 = ACB
F099 F108
ENUMERATION: MOTOR CURVES ENUMERATION: OFF/ON
B 0 = Motor, 1 = FlexCurve A, 2 = FlexCurve B, 0 = Off, 1 = On
3 = FlexCurve C, 4 = FlexCurve D, 5 = IEC
F109
F100 ENUMERATION: CONTACT OUTPUT OPERATION
ENUMERATION: VT CONNECTION TYPE
0 = Self-reset, 1 = Latched, 2 = Disabled
0 = Wye, 1 = Delta
F111
F101 ENUMERATION: UNDERVOLTAGE CURVE SHAPES
ENUMERATION: MESSAGE DISPLAY INTENSITY
0 = Definite Time, 1 = Inverse Time
0 = 25%, 1 = 50%, 2 = 75%, 3 = 100%
F112
F102 ENUMERATION: RS485 BAUD RATES
ENUMERATION: DISABLED/ENABLED
Bitmask Value Bitmask Value Bitmask Value
0 = Disabled, 1 = Enabled
0 300 4 9600 8 115200
1 1200 5 19200 9 14400
F103 2 2400 6 38400 10 28800
ENUMERATION: CURVE SHAPES 3 4800 7 57600 11 33600
F116
ENUMERATION: NEUTRAL OVERVOLTAGE CURVES
F104
ENUMERATION: RESET TYPE 0 = Definite Time, 1 = FlexCurve A, 2 = FlexCurve B,
3 = FlexCurve C
0 = Instantaneous, 1 = Timed
F118
ENUMERATION: OSCILLOGRAPHY MODE
0 = Automatic Overwrite, 1 = Protected
Bitmask Element
F119
5 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 6
ENUMERATION: FLEXCURVE PICKUP RATIOS
6 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 7
Mask Value Mask Value Mask Value Mask Value 7 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 8
0 0.00 30 0.88 60 2.90 90 5.90 24 Phase Directional Overcurrent 1
1 0.05 31 0.90 61 3.00 91 6.00 25 Phase Directional Overcurrent 2
2 0.10 32 0.91 62 3.10 92 6.50 32 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 1
3 0.15 33 0.92 63 3.20 93 7.00 33 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 2 B
4 0.20 34 0.93 64 3.30 94 7.50 34 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 3
5 0.25 35 0.94 65 3.40 95 8.00 35 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 4
6 0.30 36 0.95 66 3.50 96 8.50 36 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 5
7 0.35 37 0.96 67 3.60 97 9.00 37 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 6
8 0.40 38 0.97 68 3.70 98 9.50 38 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 7
9 0.45 39 0.98 69 3.80 99 10.00 39 Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 8
10 0.48 40 1.03 70 3.90 100 10.50 56 Neutral Directional Overcurrent 1
11 0.50 41 1.05 71 4.00 101 11.00 57 Neutral Directional Overcurrent 2
12 0.52 42 1.10 72 4.10 102 11.50 64 Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 1
13 0.54 43 1.20 73 4.20 103 12.00 65 Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 2
14 0.56 44 1.30 74 4.30 104 12.50 66 Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 3
15 0.58 45 1.40 75 4.40 105 13.00 67 Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 4
16 0.60 46 1.50 76 4.50 106 13.50 68 Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 5
17 0.62 47 1.60 77 4.60 107 14.00 69 Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 6
18 0.64 48 1.70 78 4.70 108 14.50 70 Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 7
19 0.66 49 1.80 79 4.80 109 15.00 71 Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 8
20 0.68 50 1.90 80 4.90 110 15.50 80 Ground Time Overcurrent 1
21 0.70 51 2.00 81 5.00 111 16.00 81 Ground Time Overcurrent 2
22 0.72 52 2.10 82 5.10 112 16.50 82 Ground Time Overcurrent 3
23 0.74 53 2.20 83 5.20 113 17.00 83 Ground Time Overcurrent 4
24 0.76 54 2.30 84 5.30 114 17.50 120 Negative Sequence Overvoltage 1
25 0.78 55 2.40 85 5.40 115 18.00 121 Negative Sequence Overvoltage 2
26 0.80 56 2.50 86 5.50 116 18.50 122 Negative Sequence Overvoltage 3
27 0.82 57 2.60 87 5.60 117 19.00 140 Auxiliary Undervoltage 1
28 0.84 58 2.70 88 5.70 118 19.50 141 Auxiliary Undervoltage 2
29 0.86 59 2.80 89 5.80 119 20.00 144 Phase Undervoltage 1
145 Phase Undervoltage 2
146 Phase Undervoltage 3
F122
148 Auxiliary Overvoltage 1
ENUMERATION: ELEMENT INPUT SIGNAL TYPE
149 Auxiliary Overvoltage 2
0 = Phasor, 1 = RMS 152 Phase Overvoltage 1
156 Neutral Overvoltage 1
Bitmask Element
F141
970 Breaker 3
ENUMERATION: SELF TEST ERRORS
971 Breaker 4
991 Remote RTD Input 1 Bitmask Error
992 Remote RTD Input 2 0 Any Self Tests
993 Remote RTD Input 3 1 IRIG-B Failure
994 Remote RTD Input 4
B
2 Port 1 Offline
995 Remote RTD Input 5 3 Port 2 Offline
996 Remote RTD Input 6 4 Port 3 Offline
997 Remote RTD Input 7 5 Port 4 Offline
998 Remote RTD Input 8 6 Port 5 Offline
999 Remote RTD Input 9 7 Port 6 Offline
1000 Remote RTD Input 10 8 RRTD Communications Failure
1001 Remote RTD Input 11 9 Voltage Monitor
1002 Remote RTD Input 12 10 FlexLogic Error Token
1004 Broken Rotor Bar 11 Equipment Mismatch
12 Process Bus Failure
13 Unit Not Programmed
F126
ENUMERATION: NO/YES CHOICE 14 System Exception
15 Latching Output Discrepancy
0 = No, 1 = Yes
16 Ethernet Switch Fail
17 Maintenance Alert 01
F127 18 SNTP Failure
ENUMERATION: LATCHED OR SELF-RESETTING 19 Maintenance Alert
0 = Latched, 1 = Self-Reset 20 Primary Ethernet Fail
21 Secondary Ethernet Fail
22 Temperature Monitor
F128
23 Process Bus Trouble
ENUMERATION: CONTACT INPUT THRESHOLD
24 Brick Trouble
0 = 17 V DC, 1 = 33 V DC, 2 = 84 V DC, 3 = 166 V DC
25 Field RTD Trouble
26 Field TDR Trouble
F129 27 Remote Device Offline
ENUMERATION: FLEXLOGIC TIMER TYPE 28 Direct Device Offline
F155 F166
ENUMERATION: REMOTE DEVICE STATE ENUMERATION: AUXILIARY VT CONNECTION TYPE
0 = Offline, 1 = Online 0 = Vn, 1 = Vag, 2 = Vbg, 3 = Vcg, 4 = Vab, 5 = Vbc, 6 = Vca
F156 F167
ENUMERATION: REMOTE INPUT BIT PAIRS ENUMERATION: SIGNAL SOURCE
B Bitmask Value Bitmask Value
0 = SRC 1, 1 = SRC 2, 2 = SRC 3, 3 = SRC 4,
4 = SRC 5, 5 = SRC 6
0 None 35 UserSt-3
1 DNA-1 36 UserSt-4
2 DNA-2 37 UserSt-5 F172
3 DNA-3 38 UserSt-6 ENUMERATION: SLOT LETTERS
4 DNA-4 39 UserSt-7
Bitmask Slot Bitmask Slot Bitmask Slot Bitmask Slot
5 DNA-5 40 UserSt-8
0 F 4 K 8 P 12 U
6 DNA-6 41 UserSt-9
1 G 5 L 9 R 13 V
7 DNA-7 42 UserSt-10
2 H 6 M 10 S 14 W
8 DNA-8 43 UserSt-11
3 J 7 N 11 T 15 X
9 DNA-9 44 UserSt-12
10 DNA-10 45 UserSt-13
11 DNA-11 46 UserSt-14 F173
12 DNA-12 47 UserSt-15 ENUMERATION: DCmA INPUT/OUTPUT RANGE
13 DNA-13 48 UserSt-16
Bitmask DCmA input/output range
14 DNA-14 49 UserSt-17
0 0 to –1 mA
15 DNA-15 50 UserSt-18
1 0 to 1 mA
16 DNA-16 51 UserSt-19
2 –1 to 1 mA
17 DNA-17 52 UserSt-20
3 0 to 5 mA
18 DNA-18 53 UserSt-21
4 0 to 10 mA
19 DNA-19 54 UserSt-22
5 0 to 20 mA
20 DNA-20 55 UserSt-23
6 4 to 20 mA
21 DNA-21 56 UserSt-24
22 DNA-22 57 UserSt-25
23 DNA-23 58 UserSt-26 F174
24 DNA-24 59 UserSt-27 ENUMERATION: TRANSDUCER RTD INPUT TYPE
25 DNA-25 60 UserSt-28 0 = 100 Ohm Platinum, 1 = 120 Ohm Nickel,
26 DNA-26 61 UserSt-29 2 = 100 Ohm Nickel, 3 = 10 Ohm Copper
27 DNA-27 62 UserSt-30
28 DNA-28 63 UserSt-31
F177
29 DNA-29 64 UserSt-32 ENUMERATION: COMMUNICATION PORT
30 DNA-30 65 Dataset Item 1
0 = None, 1 = COM1-RS485, 2 = COM2-RS485,
31 DNA-31 66 Dataset Item 2
3 = Front Panel-RS232, 4 = Network - TCP, 5 = Network - UDP
32 DNA-32 67 Dataset Item 3
33 UserSt-1
34 UserSt-2 96 Dataset Item 32 F183
ENUMERATION: AC INPUT WAVEFORMS
Value IEC 61850 Tx dataset item Value IEC 61850 Tx dataset item
330 MMXU2.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f 383 MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
331 MMXU3.MX.TotW.mag.f 384 MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
332 MMXU3.MX.TotVAr.mag.f 385 MMXU4.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
333 MMXU3.MX.TotVA.mag.f 386 MMXU4.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
334 MMXU3.MX.TotPF.mag.f 387 MMXU4.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
335 MMXU3.MX.Hz.mag.f 388 MMXU4.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
336 MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f 389 MMXU4.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f B
337 MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f 390 MMXU4.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
338 MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f 391 MMXU4.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
339 MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f 392 MMXU4.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
340 MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f 393 MMXU4.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
341 MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f 394 MMXU4.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
342 MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f 395 MMXU4.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
343 MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f 396 MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
344 MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f 397 MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
345 MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f 398 MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
346 MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f 399 MMXU4.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
347 MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f 400 MMXU4.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
348 MMXU3.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f 401 MMXU4.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
349 MMXU3.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f 402 MMXU4.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
350 MMXU3.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f 403 MMXU4.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
351 MMXU3.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f 404 MMXU4.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
352 MMXU3.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f 405 MMXU5.MX.TotW.mag.f
353 MMXU3.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f 406 MMXU5.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
354 MMXU3.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f 407 MMXU5.MX.TotVA.mag.f
355 MMXU3.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f 408 MMXU5.MX.TotPF.mag.f
356 MMXU3.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f 409 MMXU5.MX.Hz.mag.f
357 MMXU3.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f 410 MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
358 MMXU3.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f 411 MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
359 MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f 412 MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
360 MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f 413 MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
361 MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f 414 MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
362 MMXU3.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f 415 MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
363 MMXU3.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f 416 MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
364 MMXU3.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f 417 MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
365 MMXU3.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f 418 MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
366 MMXU3.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f 419 MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
367 MMXU3.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f 420 MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
368 MMXU4.MX.TotW.mag.f 421 MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
369 MMXU4.MX.TotVAr.mag.f 422 MMXU5.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
370 MMXU4.MX.TotVA.mag.f 423 MMXU5.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
371 MMXU4.MX.TotPF.mag.f 424 MMXU5.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
372 MMXU4.MX.Hz.mag.f 425 MMXU5.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
373 MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f 426 MMXU5.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
374 MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f 427 MMXU5.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
375 MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f 428 MMXU5.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
376 MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f 429 MMXU5.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
377 MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f 430 MMXU5.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
378 MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f 431 MMXU5.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
379 MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f 432 MMXU5.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
380 MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f 433 MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
381 MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f 434 MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
382 MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f 435 MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
Value IEC 61850 Tx dataset item Value IEC 61850 Tx dataset item
436 MMXU5.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f 489 GGIO4.MX.AnIn11.mag.f
437 MMXU5.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f 490 GGIO4.MX.AnIn12.mag.f
438 MMXU5.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f 491 GGIO4.MX.AnIn13.mag.f
439 MMXU5.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f 492 GGIO4.MX.AnIn14.mag.f
440 MMXU5.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f 493 GGIO4.MX.AnIn15.mag.f
441 MMXU5.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f 494 GGIO4.MX.AnIn16.mag.f
B 442 MMXU6.MX.TotW.mag.f 495 GGIO4.MX.AnIn17.mag.f
443 MMXU6.MX.TotVAr.mag.f 496 GGIO4.MX.AnIn18.mag.f
444 MMXU6.MX.TotVA.mag.f 497 GGIO4.MX.AnIn19.mag.f
445 MMXU6.MX.TotPF.mag.f 498 GGIO4.MX.AnIn20.mag.f
446 MMXU6.MX.Hz.mag.f 499 GGIO4.MX.AnIn21.mag.f
447 MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f 500 GGIO4.MX.AnIn22.mag.f
448 MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f 501 GGIO4.MX.AnIn23.mag.f
449 MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f 502 GGIO4.MX.AnIn24.mag.f
450 MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f 503 GGIO4.MX.AnIn25.mag.f
451 MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f 504 GGIO4.MX.AnIn26.mag.f
452 MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f 505 GGIO4.MX.AnIn27.mag.f
453 MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f 506 GGIO4.MX.AnIn28.mag.f
454 MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f 507 GGIO4.MX.AnIn29.mag.f
455 MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f 508 GGIO4.MX.AnIn30.mag.f
456 MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f 509 GGIO4.MX.AnIn31.mag.f
457 MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f 510 GGIO4.MX.AnIn32.mag.f
458 MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f 511 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn1.q
459 MMXU6.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f 512 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn1.stVal
460 MMXU6.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f 513 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn2.q
461 MMXU6.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f 514 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn2.stVal
462 MMXU6.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f 515 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn3.q
463 MMXU6.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f 516 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn3.stVal
464 MMXU6.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f 517 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn4.q
465 MMXU6.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f 518 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn4.stVal
466 MMXU6.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f 519 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn5.q
467 MMXU6.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f 520 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn5.stVal
468 MMXU6.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f 521 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn6.q
469 MMXU6.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f 522 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn6.stVal
470 MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f 523 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn7.q
471 MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f 524 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn7.stVal
472 MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f 525 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn8.q
473 MMXU6.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f 526 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn8.stVal
474 MMXU6.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f 527 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn9.q
475 MMXU6.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f 528 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn9.stVal
476 MMXU6.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f 529 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn10.q
477 MMXU6.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f 530 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn10.stVal
478 MMXU6.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f 531 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn11.q
479 GGIO4.MX.AnIn1.mag.f 532 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn11.stVal
480 GGIO4.MX.AnIn2.mag.f 533 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn12.q
481 GGIO4.MX.AnIn3.mag.f 534 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn12.stVal
482 GGIO4.MX.AnIn4.mag.f 535 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn13.q
483 GGIO4.MX.AnIn5.mag.f 536 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn13.stVal
484 GGIO4.MX.AnIn6.mag.f 537 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn14.q
485 GGIO4.MX.AnIn7.mag.f 538 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn14.stVal
486 GGIO4.MX.AnIn8.mag.f 539 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn15.q
487 GGIO4.MX.AnIn9.mag.f 540 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn15.stVal
488 GGIO4.MX.AnIn10.mag.f 541 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn16.q
Value IEC 61850 Tx dataset item Value IEC 61850 GOOSE Rx dataset
item
542 GGIO5.ST.UIntIn16.stVal
165 GGIO3.ST.IndPos5.stVal
166 GGIO3.ST.UIntIn1.q
F233 167 GGIO3.ST.UIntIn1.stVal
ENUMERATION: CONFIGURABLE GOOSE Rx 168 GGIO3.ST.UIntIn2.q
DATASET ITEMS
169 GGIO3.ST.UIntIn2.stVal
Value Description
F238
5 0...10mA
ENUMERATION: REAL TIME CLOCK DAY (FOR EXAMPLE,
6 0...20mA
DAYLIGHT SAVINGS TIME)
7 4...20mA
Value Day 8 potentiometer
0 Sunday 9 tap position
1 Monday
B 2 Tuesday
F247
3 Wednesday
ENUMERATION: BRICK AC BANK ORIGIN
4 Thursday
5 Friday Value Description
6 Saturday 0 None
1 U1/AC1..3
2 U1/AC5..7
F239
3 U2/AC1..3
ENUMERATION: REAL TIME CLOCK DAYLIGHT SAVINGS
TIME START DAY INSTANCE 4 U2/AC5..7
5 U3/AC1..3
Value Instance 6 U3/AC5..7
0 First 7 U4/AC1..3
1 Second 8 U4/AC5..7
2 Third 9 U5/AC1..3
3 Fourth 10 U5/AC5..7
4 Last 11 U6/AC1..3
12 U6/AC5..7
13 U7/AC1..3
F243
14 U7/AC5..7
ENUMERATION: FIELD UNIT TYPE
15 U8/AC1..3
0 = CC-05, 1 = CV-05, 2 = CC-01, 3 = CV-01
16 U8/AC5..7
F244
F248
ENUMERATION: FIELD UNIT PROCESS CARD PORT
ENUMERATION: BRICK AUX AC BANK ORIGIN
0 = H4a, 1 = H4b, 2 = H3a, 3 = H3b, 4 = H2a, 5 = H2b, 6 = H1a,
7 =H1b Value Description
0 None
1 U1/AC4
F245
ENUMERATION: TEST MODE FUNCTION 2 U1/AC8
3 U2/AC4
Value Function 4 U2/AC8
0 Disabled 5 U3/AC4
1 Isolated 6 U3/AC8
2 Forcible 7 U4/AC4
8 U4/AC8
9 U5/AC4
F246
10 U5/AC8
ENUMERATION: BRICK TRANSDUCER RANGE
11 U6/AC4
Value Description 12 U6/AC8
0 -5...5V 13 U7/AC5
1 -1...1mA 14 U7/AC8
2 0...1mA 15 U8/AC5
3 0...-1mA 16 U8/AC8
4 0...5mA
F262 F400
ENUMERATION: BRICK STATUS UR_UINT16: CT/VT BANK SELECTION
0 = Disabled, 1 = OK, 2 = Communications Trouble, 3 = Equip-
Bitmask Bank selection
ment Mismatch, 4 = Brick Trouble
0 Card 1 Contact 1 to 4
1 Card 1 Contact 5 to 8
F300 2 Card 2 Contact 1 to 4
UR_UINT16: FLEXLOGIC™ BASE TYPE (7-bit type) 3 Card 2 Contact 5 to 8
The FlexLogic™ BASE type is 7 bits and is combined with an 8-bit 4 Card 3 Contact 1 to 4
descriptor and 1 bit for protection element to form a 16-bit value. 5 Card 3 Contact 5 to 8
The combined bits are of the form: PTTTTTTTDDDDDDDD,
F491 F518
ENUMERATION: ANALOG INPUT MODE ENUMERATION: FLEXELEMENT™ UNITS
0 = Default Value, 1 = Last Known 0 = Milliseconds, 1 = Seconds, 2 = Minutes
F519
F500
ENUMERATION: NON-VOLATILE LATCH
B UR_UINT16: PACKED BITFIELD
First register indicates input/output state with bits 0 (MSB) to 15
0 = Reset Dominant, 1 = Set Dominant
(LSB) corresponding to input/output state 1 to 16. The second reg-
ister indicates input/output state with bits 0 to 15 corresponding to
F522
input/output state 17 to 32 (if required). The third register indicates
ENUMERATION: TRANSDUCER DCmA OUTPUT RANGE
input/output state with bits 0 to 15 corresponding to input/output
state 33 to 48 (if required). The fourth register indicates input/out- 0 = –1 to 1 mA, 1 = 0 to 1 mA, 2 = 4 to 20 mA
put state with bits 0 to 15 corresponding to input/output state 49 to
64 (if required).
F523
The number of registers required is determined by the specific
ENUMERATION: DNP OBJECTS 20, 22, AND 23 DEFAULT
data item. A bit value of 0 = Off and 1 = On.
VARIATION
0 = Off, 1 = On
Bitmask Default variation
0 1
F501
1 2
UR_UINT16: LED STATUS
2 5
Low byte of register indicates LED status with bit 0 representing
3 6
the top LED and bit 7 the bottom LED. A bit value of 1 indicates
the LED is on, 0 indicates the LED is off.
0 = Off, 1 = On F524
ENUMERATION: DNP OBJECT 21 DEFAULT VARIATION
F515 F525
ENUMERATION ELEMENT INPUT MODE ENUMERATION: DNP OBJECT 32 DEFAULT VARIATION
0 = Signed, 1 = Absolute
Bitmask Default variation
0 1
F516 1 2
ENUMERATION ELEMENT COMPARE MODE 2 3
0 = Level, 1 = Delta 3 4
4 5
5 7
F517
ENUMERATION: ELEMENT DIRECTION OPERATION
0 = Over, 1 = Under
F550
F602
ENUMERATION: RTD INPUT APPLICATION
ENUMERATION: RRTD BAUD RATE
Enumeration RTD input application
Enumeration RRTD baud rate
0 None
0 1200 bps
1 Stator
1 2400 bps
2 Bearing
2 4800 bps
3 Ambient
3 9600 bps
4 Group 1
4 19200 bps
5 Group 2
F603
F551
ENUMERATION: RRTD TRIP VOTING
ENUMERATION: RTD TRIP VOTING
Enumeration RRTD trip voting
Enumeration RTD trip voting
0 None
0 None
1 Group
1 Group
2 Remote RTD 1
2 RTD Input 1
3 Remote RTD 2
3 RTD Input 2
4 Remote RTD 3
4 RTD Input 3
5 Remote RTD 4
5 RTD Input 4
6 Remote RTD 5
6 RTD Input 5
7 Remote RTD 6
7 RTD Input 6
8 Remote RTD 7
8 RTD Input 7
9 Remote RTD 8
9 RTD Input 8
10 Remote RTD 9
10 RTD Input 9
11 Remote RTD 10
11 RTD Input 10
12 Remote RTD 11
12 RTD Input 11
13 Remote RTD 12
F612 43 PIOC8.ST.Str.general
UR_UINT16: FLEXINTEGER PARAMETER 44 PIOC8.ST.Op.general
45 PIOC9.ST.Str.general
This 16-bit value corresponds to the Modbus address of the
selected FlexInteger parameter. Only certain values can be used 46 PIOC9.ST.Op.general
as FlexIntegers. 47 PIOC10.ST.Str.general
48 PIOC10.ST.Op.general
49 PIOC11.ST.Str.general
F615
50 PIOC11.ST.Op.general
ENUMERATION: IEC 61850 REPORT DATASET ITEMS
51 PIOC12.ST.Str.general
Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items 52 PIOC12.ST.Op.general
0 None 53 PIOC13.ST.Str.general
1 PDIF1.ST.Str.general 54 PIOC13.ST.Op.general
2 PDIF1.ST.Op.general 55 PIOC14.ST.Str.general
3 PDIF2.ST.Str.general 56 PIOC14.ST.Op.general
4 PDIF2.ST.Op.general 57 PIOC15.ST.Str.general
5 PDIF3.ST.Str.general 58 PIOC15.ST.Op.general
6 PDIF3.ST.Op.general 59 PIOC16.ST.Str.general
7 PDIF4.ST.Str.general 60 PIOC16.ST.Op.general
8 PDIF4.ST.Op.general 61 PIOC17.ST.Str.general
9 PDIS1.ST.Str.general 62 PIOC17.ST.Op.general
10 PDIS1.ST.Op.general 63 PIOC18.ST.Str.general
11 PDIS2.ST.Str.general 64 PIOC18.ST.Op.general
12 PDIS2.ST.Op.general 65 PIOC19.ST.Str.general
13 PDIS3.ST.Str.general 66 PIOC19.ST.Op.general
Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items
67 PIOC20.ST.Str.general 120 PIOC46.ST.Op.general
68 PIOC20.ST.Op.general 121 PIOC47.ST.Str.general
69 PIOC21.ST.Str.general 122 PIOC47.ST.Op.general
70 PIOC21.ST.Op.general 123 PIOC48.ST.Str.general
71 PIOC22.ST.Str.general 124 PIOC48.ST.Op.general
72 PIOC22.ST.Op.general 125 PIOC49.ST.Str.general
73 PIOC23.ST.Str.general 126 PIOC49.ST.Op.general B
74 PIOC23.ST.Op.general 127 PIOC50.ST.Str.general
75 PIOC24.ST.Str.general 128 PIOC50.ST.Op.general
76 PIOC24.ST.Op.general 129 PIOC51.ST.Str.general
77 PIOC25.ST.Str.general 130 PIOC51.ST.Op.general
78 PIOC25.ST.Op.general 131 PIOC52.ST.Str.general
79 PIOC26.ST.Str.general 132 PIOC52.ST.Op.general
80 PIOC26.ST.Op.general 133 PIOC53.ST.Str.general
81 PIOC27.ST.Str.general 134 PIOC53.ST.Op.general
82 PIOC27.ST.Op.general 135 PIOC54.ST.Str.general
83 PIOC28.ST.Str.general 136 PIOC54.ST.Op.general
84 PIOC28.ST.Op.general 137 PIOC55.ST.Str.general
85 PIOC29.ST.Str.general 138 PIOC55.ST.Op.general
86 PIOC29.ST.Op.general 139 PIOC56.ST.Str.general
87 PIOC30.ST.Str.general 140 PIOC56.ST.Op.general
88 PIOC30.ST.Op.general 141 PIOC57.ST.Str.general
89 PIOC31.ST.Str.general 142 PIOC57.ST.Op.general
90 PIOC31.ST.Op.general 143 PIOC58.ST.Str.general
91 PIOC32.ST.Str.general 144 PIOC58.ST.Op.general
92 PIOC32.ST.Op.general 145 PIOC59.ST.Str.general
93 PIOC33.ST.Str.general 146 PIOC59.ST.Op.general
94 PIOC33.ST.Op.general 147 PIOC60.ST.Str.general
95 PIOC34.ST.Str.general 148 PIOC60.ST.Op.general
96 PIOC34.ST.Op.general 149 PIOC61.ST.Str.general
97 PIOC35.ST.Str.general 150 PIOC61.ST.Op.general
98 PIOC35.ST.Op.general 151 PIOC62.ST.Str.general
99 PIOC36.ST.Str.general 152 PIOC62.ST.Op.general
100 PIOC36.ST.Op.general 153 PIOC63.ST.Str.general
101 PIOC37.ST.Str.general 154 PIOC63.ST.Op.general
102 PIOC37.ST.Op.general 155 PIOC64.ST.Str.general
103 PIOC38.ST.Str.general 156 PIOC64.ST.Op.general
104 PIOC38.ST.Op.general 157 PIOC65.ST.Str.general
105 PIOC39.ST.Str.general 158 PIOC65.ST.Op.general
106 PIOC39.ST.Op.general 159 PIOC66.ST.Str.general
107 PIOC40.ST.Str.general 160 PIOC66.ST.Op.general
108 PIOC40.ST.Op.general 161 PIOC67.ST.Str.general
109 PIOC41.ST.Str.general 162 PIOC67.ST.Op.general
110 PIOC41.ST.Op.general 163 PIOC68.ST.Str.general
111 PIOC42.ST.Str.general 164 PIOC68.ST.Op.general
112 PIOC42.ST.Op.general 165 PIOC69.ST.Str.general
113 PIOC43.ST.Str.general 166 PIOC69.ST.Op.general
114 PIOC43.ST.Op.general 167 PIOC70.ST.Str.general
115 PIOC44.ST.Str.general 168 PIOC70.ST.Op.general
116 PIOC44.ST.Op.general 169 PIOC71.ST.Str.general
117 PIOC45.ST.Str.general 170 PIOC71.ST.Op.general
118 PIOC45.ST.Op.general 171 PIOC72.ST.Str.general
119 PIOC46.ST.Str.general 172 PIOC72.ST.Op.general
Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items
173 PTOC1.ST.Str.general 226 PTOV3.ST.Op.general
174 PTOC1.ST.Op.general 227 PTOV4.ST.Str.general
175 PTOC2.ST.Str.general 228 PTOV4.ST.Op.general
176 PTOC2.ST.Op.general 229 PTOV5.ST.Str.general
177 PTOC3.ST.Str.general 230 PTOV5.ST.Op.general
178 PTOC3.ST.Op.general 231 PTOV6.ST.Str.general
B 179 PTOC4.ST.Str.general 232 PTOV6.ST.Op.general
180 PTOC4.ST.Op.general 233 PTOV7.ST.Str.general
181 PTOC5.ST.Str.general 234 PTOV7.ST.Op.general
182 PTOC5.ST.Op.general 235 PTOV8.ST.Str.general
183 PTOC6.ST.Str.general 236 PTOV8.ST.Op.general
184 PTOC6.ST.Op.general 237 PTOV9.ST.Str.general
185 PTOC7.ST.Str.general 238 PTOV9.ST.Op.general
186 PTOC7.ST.Op.general 239 PTOV10.ST.Str.general
187 PTOC8.ST.Str.general 240 PTOV10.ST.Op.general
188 PTOC8.ST.Op.general 241 PTRC1.ST.Tr.general
189 PTOC9.ST.Str.general 242 PTRC1.ST.Op.general
190 PTOC9.ST.Op.general 243 PTRC2.ST.Tr.general
191 PTOC10.ST.Str.general 244 PTRC2.ST.Op.general
192 PTOC10.ST.Op.general 245 PTRC3.ST.Tr.general
193 PTOC11.ST.Str.general 246 PTRC3.ST.Op.general
194 PTOC11.ST.Op.general 247 PTRC4.ST.Tr.general
195 PTOC12.ST.Str.general 248 PTRC4.ST.Op.general
196 PTOC12.ST.Op.general 249 PTRC5.ST.Tr.general
197 PTOC13.ST.Str.general 250 PTRC5.ST.Op.general
198 PTOC13.ST.Op.general 251 PTRC6.ST.Tr.general
199 PTOC14.ST.Str.general 252 PTRC6.ST.Op.general
200 PTOC14.ST.Op.general 253 PTUV1.ST.Str.general
201 PTOC15.ST.Str.general 254 PTUV1.ST.Op.general
202 PTOC15.ST.Op.general 255 PTUV2.ST.Str.general
203 PTOC16.ST.Str.general 256 PTUV2.ST.Op.general
204 PTOC16.ST.Op.general 257 PTUV3.ST.Str.general
205 PTOC17.ST.Str.general 258 PTUV3.ST.Op.general
206 PTOC17.ST.Op.general 259 PTUV4.ST.Str.general
207 PTOC18.ST.Str.general 260 PTUV4.ST.Op.general
208 PTOC18.ST.Op.general 261 PTUV5.ST.Str.general
209 PTOC19.ST.Str.general 262 PTUV5.ST.Op.general
210 PTOC19.ST.Op.general 263 PTUV6.ST.Str.general
211 PTOC20.ST.Str.general 264 PTUV6.ST.Op.general
212 PTOC20.ST.Op.general 265 PTUV7.ST.Str.general
213 PTOC21.ST.Str.general 266 PTUV7.ST.Op.general
214 PTOC21.ST.Op.general 267 PTUV8.ST.Str.general
215 PTOC22.ST.Str.general 268 PTUV8.ST.Op.general
216 PTOC22.ST.Op.general 269 PTUV9.ST.Str.general
217 PTOC23.ST.Str.general 270 PTUV9.ST.Op.general
218 PTOC23.ST.Op.general 271 PTUV10.ST.Str.general
219 PTOC24.ST.Str.general 272 PTUV10.ST.Op.general
220 PTOC24.ST.Op.general 273 PTUV11.ST.Str.general
221 PTOV1.ST.Str.general 274 PTUV11.ST.Op.general
222 PTOV1.ST.Op.general 275 PTUV12.ST.Str.general
223 PTOV2.ST.Str.general 276 PTUV12.ST.Op.general
224 PTOV2.ST.Op.general 277 PTUV13.ST.Str.general
225 PTOV3.ST.Str.general 278 PTUV13.ST.Op.general
Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items
279 RBRF1.ST.OpEx.general 332 RPSB1.ST.Str.general
280 RBRF1.ST.OpIn.general 333 RPSB1.ST.Op.general
281 RBRF2.ST.OpEx.general 334 RPSB1.ST.BlkZn.stVal
282 RBRF2.ST.OpIn.general 335 RREC1.ST.Op.general
283 RBRF3.ST.OpEx.general 336 RREC1.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
284 RBRF3.ST.OpIn.general 337 RREC2.ST.Op.general
285 RBRF4.ST.OpEx.general 338 RREC2.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal B
286 RBRF4.ST.OpIn.general 339 RREC3.ST.Op.general
287 RBRF5.ST.OpEx.general 340 RREC3.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
288 RBRF5.ST.OpIn.general 341 RREC4.ST.Op.general
289 RBRF6.ST.OpEx.general 342 RREC4.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
290 RBRF6.ST.OpIn.general 343 RREC5.ST.Op.general
291 RBRF7.ST.OpEx.general 344 RREC5.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
292 RBRF7.ST.OpIn.general 345 RREC6.ST.Op.general
293 RBRF8.ST.OpEx.general 346 RREC6.ST.AutoRecSt.stVal
294 RBRF8.ST.OpIn.general 347 CSWI1.ST.Loc.stVal
295 RBRF9.ST.OpEx.general 348 CSWI1.ST.Pos.stVal
296 RBRF9.ST.OpIn.general 349 CSWI2.ST.Loc.stVal
297 RBRF10.ST.OpEx.general 350 CSWI2.ST.Pos.stVal
298 RBRF10.ST.OpIn.general 351 CSWI3.ST.Loc.stVal
299 RBRF11.ST.OpEx.general 352 CSWI3.ST.Pos.stVal
300 RBRF11.ST.OpIn.general 353 CSWI4.ST.Loc.stVal
301 RBRF12.ST.OpEx.general 354 CSWI4.ST.Pos.stVal
302 RBRF12.ST.OpIn.general 355 CSWI5.ST.Loc.stVal
303 RBRF13.ST.OpEx.general 356 CSWI5.ST.Pos.stVal
304 RBRF13.ST.OpIn.general 357 CSWI6.ST.Loc.stVal
305 RBRF14.ST.OpEx.general 358 CSWI6.ST.Pos.stVal
306 RBRF14.ST.OpIn.general 359 CSWI7.ST.Loc.stVal
307 RBRF15.ST.OpEx.general 360 CSWI7.ST.Pos.stVal
308 RBRF15.ST.OpIn.general 361 CSWI8.ST.Loc.stVal
309 RBRF16.ST.OpEx.general 362 CSWI8.ST.Pos.stVal
310 RBRF16.ST.OpIn.general 363 CSWI9.ST.Loc.stVal
311 RBRF17.ST.OpEx.general 364 CSWI9.ST.Pos.stVal
312 RBRF17.ST.OpIn.general 365 CSWI10.ST.Loc.stVal
313 RBRF18.ST.OpEx.general 366 CSWI10.ST.Pos.stVal
314 RBRF18.ST.OpIn.general 367 CSWI11.ST.Loc.stVal
315 RBRF19.ST.OpEx.general 368 CSWI11.ST.Pos.stVal
316 RBRF19.ST.OpIn.general 369 CSWI12.ST.Loc.stVal
317 RBRF20.ST.OpEx.general 370 CSWI12.ST.Pos.stVal
318 RBRF20.ST.OpIn.general 371 CSWI13.ST.Loc.stVal
319 RBRF21.ST.OpEx.general 372 CSWI13.ST.Pos.stVal
320 RBRF21.ST.OpIn.general 373 CSWI14.ST.Loc.stVal
321 RBRF22.ST.OpEx.general 374 CSWI14.ST.Pos.stVal
322 RBRF22.ST.OpIn.general 375 CSWI15.ST.Loc.stVal
323 RBRF23.ST.OpEx.general 376 CSWI15.ST.Pos.stVal
324 RBRF23.ST.OpIn.general 377 CSWI16.ST.Loc.stVal
325 RBRF24.ST.OpEx.general 378 CSWI16.ST.Pos.stVal
326 RBRF24.ST.OpIn.general 379 CSWI17.ST.Loc.stVal
327 RFLO1.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f 380 CSWI17.ST.Pos.stVal
328 RFLO2.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f 381 CSWI18.ST.Loc.stVal
329 RFLO3.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f 382 CSWI18.ST.Pos.stVal
330 RFLO4.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f 383 CSWI19.ST.Loc.stVal
331 RFLO5.MX.FltDiskm.mag.f 384 CSWI19.ST.Pos.stVal
Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items
385 CSWI20.ST.Loc.stVal 438 GGIO1.ST.Ind32.stVal
386 CSWI20.ST.Pos.stVal 439 GGIO1.ST.Ind33.stVal
387 CSWI21.ST.Loc.stVal 440 GGIO1.ST.Ind34.stVal
388 CSWI21.ST.Pos.stVal 441 GGIO1.ST.Ind35.stVal
389 CSWI22.ST.Loc.stVal 442 GGIO1.ST.Ind36.stVal
390 CSWI22.ST.Pos.stVal 443 GGIO1.ST.Ind37.stVal
B 391 CSWI23.ST.Loc.stVal 444 GGIO1.ST.Ind38.stVal
392 CSWI23.ST.Pos.stVal 445 GGIO1.ST.Ind39.stVal
393 CSWI24.ST.Loc.stVal 446 GGIO1.ST.Ind40.stVal
394 CSWI24.ST.Pos.stVal 447 GGIO1.ST.Ind41.stVal
395 CSWI25.ST.Loc.stVal 448 GGIO1.ST.Ind42.stVal
396 CSWI25.ST.Pos.stVal 449 GGIO1.ST.Ind43.stVal
397 CSWI26.ST.Loc.stVal 450 GGIO1.ST.Ind44.stVal
398 CSWI26.ST.Pos.stVal 451 GGIO1.ST.Ind45.stVal
399 CSWI27.ST.Loc.stVal 452 GGIO1.ST.Ind46.stVal
400 CSWI27.ST.Pos.stVal 453 GGIO1.ST.Ind47.stVal
401 CSWI28.ST.Loc.stVal 454 GGIO1.ST.Ind48.stVal
402 CSWI28.ST.Pos.stVal 455 GGIO1.ST.Ind49.stVal
403 CSWI29.ST.Loc.stVal 456 GGIO1.ST.Ind50.stVal
404 CSWI29.ST.Pos.stVal 457 GGIO1.ST.Ind51.stVal
405 CSWI30.ST.Loc.stVal 458 GGIO1.ST.Ind52.stVal
406 CSWI30.ST.Pos.stVal 459 GGIO1.ST.Ind53.stVal
407 GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal 460 GGIO1.ST.Ind54.stVal
408 GGIO1.ST.Ind2.stVal 461 GGIO1.ST.Ind55.stVal
409 GGIO1.ST.Ind3.stVal 462 GGIO1.ST.Ind56.stVal
410 GGIO1.ST.Ind4.stVal 463 GGIO1.ST.Ind57.stVal
411 GGIO1.ST.Ind5.stVal 464 GGIO1.ST.Ind58.stVal
412 GGIO1.ST.Ind6.stVal 465 GGIO1.ST.Ind59.stVal
413 GGIO1.ST.Ind7.stVal 466 GGIO1.ST.Ind60.stVal
414 GGIO1.ST.Ind8.stVal 467 GGIO1.ST.Ind61.stVal
415 GGIO1.ST.Ind9.stVal 468 GGIO1.ST.Ind62.stVal
416 GGIO1.ST.Ind10.stVal 469 GGIO1.ST.Ind63.stVal
417 GGIO1.ST.Ind11.stVal 470 GGIO1.ST.Ind64.stVal
418 GGIO1.ST.Ind12.stVal 471 GGIO1.ST.Ind65.stVal
419 GGIO1.ST.Ind13.stVal 472 GGIO1.ST.Ind66.stVal
420 GGIO1.ST.Ind14.stVal 473 GGIO1.ST.Ind67.stVal
421 GGIO1.ST.Ind15.stVal 474 GGIO1.ST.Ind68.stVal
422 GGIO1.ST.Ind16.stVal 475 GGIO1.ST.Ind69.stVal
423 GGIO1.ST.Ind17.stVal 476 GGIO1.ST.Ind70.stVal
424 GGIO1.ST.Ind18.stVal 477 GGIO1.ST.Ind71.stVal
425 GGIO1.ST.Ind19.stVal 478 GGIO1.ST.Ind72.stVal
426 GGIO1.ST.Ind20.stVal 479 GGIO1.ST.Ind73.stVal
427 GGIO1.ST.Ind21.stVal 480 GGIO1.ST.Ind74.stVal
428 GGIO1.ST.Ind22.stVal 481 GGIO1.ST.Ind75.stVal
429 GGIO1.ST.Ind23.stVal 482 GGIO1.ST.Ind76.stVal
430 GGIO1.ST.Ind24.stVal 483 GGIO1.ST.Ind77.stVal
431 GGIO1.ST.Ind25.stVal 484 GGIO1.ST.Ind78.stVal
432 GGIO1.ST.Ind26.stVal 485 GGIO1.ST.Ind79.stVal
433 GGIO1.ST.Ind27.stVal 486 GGIO1.ST.Ind80.stVal
434 GGIO1.ST.Ind28.stVal 487 GGIO1.ST.Ind81.stVal
435 GGIO1.ST.Ind29.stVal 488 GGIO1.ST.Ind82.stVal
436 GGIO1.ST.Ind30.stVal 489 GGIO1.ST.Ind83.stVal
437 GGIO1.ST.Ind31.stVal 490 GGIO1.ST.Ind84.stVal
Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items
491 GGIO1.ST.Ind85.stVal 544 MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
492 GGIO1.ST.Ind86.stVal 545 MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
493 GGIO1.ST.Ind87.stVal 546 MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
494 GGIO1.ST.Ind88.stVal 547 MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
495 GGIO1.ST.Ind89.stVal 548 MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
496 GGIO1.ST.Ind90.stVal 549 MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
497 GGIO1.ST.Ind91.stVal 550 MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f B
498 GGIO1.ST.Ind92.stVal 551 MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
499 GGIO1.ST.Ind93.stVal 552 MMXU1.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
500 GGIO1.ST.Ind94.stVal 553 MMXU1.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
501 GGIO1.ST.Ind95.stVal 554 MMXU1.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
502 GGIO1.ST.Ind96.stVal 555 MMXU1.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
503 GGIO1.ST.Ind97.stVal 556 MMXU1.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
504 GGIO1.ST.Ind98.stVal 557 MMXU1.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
505 GGIO1.ST.Ind99.stVal 558 MMXU1.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
506 GGIO1.ST.Ind100.stVal 559 MMXU1.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
507 GGIO1.ST.Ind101.stVal 560 MMXU1.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
508 GGIO1.ST.Ind102.stVal 561 MMXU1.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
509 GGIO1.ST.Ind103.stVal 562 MMXU1.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
510 GGIO1.ST.Ind104.stVal 563 MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
511 GGIO1.ST.Ind105.stVal 564 MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
512 GGIO1.ST.Ind106.stVal 565 MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
513 GGIO1.ST.Ind107.stVal 566 MMXU1.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
514 GGIO1.ST.Ind108.stVal 567 MMXU1.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
515 GGIO1.ST.Ind109.stVal 568 MMXU1.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
516 GGIO1.ST.Ind110.stVal 569 MMXU1.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
517 GGIO1.ST.Ind111.stVal 570 MMXU1.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
518 GGIO1.ST.Ind112.stVal 571 MMXU1.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
519 GGIO1.ST.Ind113.stVal 572 MMXU2.MX.TotW.mag.f
520 GGIO1.ST.Ind114.stVal 573 MMXU2.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
521 GGIO1.ST.Ind115.stVal 574 MMXU2.MX.TotVA.mag.f
522 GGIO1.ST.Ind116.stVal 575 MMXU2.MX.TotPF.mag.f
523 GGIO1.ST.Ind117.stVal 576 MMXU2.MX.Hz.mag.f
524 GGIO1.ST.Ind118.stVal 577 MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
525 GGIO1.ST.Ind119.stVal 578 MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
526 GGIO1.ST.Ind120.stVal 579 MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
527 GGIO1.ST.Ind121.stVal 580 MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
528 GGIO1.ST.Ind122.stVal 581 MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
529 GGIO1.ST.Ind123.stVal 582 MMXU2.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
530 GGIO1.ST.Ind124.stVal 583 MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
531 GGIO1.ST.Ind125.stVal 584 MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
532 GGIO1.ST.Ind126.stVal 585 MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
533 GGIO1.ST.Ind127.stVal 586 MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
534 GGIO1.ST.Ind128.stVal 587 MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
535 MMXU1.MX.TotW.mag.f 588 MMXU2.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
536 MMXU1.MX.TotVAr.mag.f 589 MMXU2.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
537 MMXU1.MX.TotVA.mag.f 590 MMXU2.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
538 MMXU1.MX.TotPF.mag.f 591 MMXU2.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
539 MMXU1.MX.Hz.mag.f 592 MMXU2.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
540 MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f 593 MMXU2.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
541 MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f 594 MMXU2.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
542 MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f 595 MMXU2.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
543 MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f 596 MMXU2.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items
597 MMXU2.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f 650 MMXU4.MX.Hz.mag.f
598 MMXU2.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f 651 MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
599 MMXU2.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f 652 MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
600 MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f 653 MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
601 MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f 654 MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
602 MMXU2.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f 655 MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
B 603 MMXU2.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f 656 MMXU4.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
604 MMXU2.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f 657 MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
605 MMXU2.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f 658 MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
606 MMXU2.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f 659 MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
607 MMXU2.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f 660 MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
608 MMXU2.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f 661 MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
609 MMXU3.MX.TotW.mag.f 662 MMXU4.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
610 MMXU3.MX.TotVAr.mag.f 663 MMXU4.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
611 MMXU3.MX.TotVA.mag.f 664 MMXU4.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
612 MMXU3.MX.TotPF.mag.f 665 MMXU4.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
613 MMXU3.MX.Hz.mag.f 666 MMXU4.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f
614 MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f 667 MMXU4.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f
615 MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f 668 MMXU4.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f
616 MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f 669 MMXU4.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f
617 MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f 670 MMXU4.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f
618 MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f 671 MMXU4.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f
619 MMXU3.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f 672 MMXU4.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f
620 MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f 673 MMXU4.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f
621 MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f 674 MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f
622 MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f 675 MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f
623 MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f 676 MMXU4.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f
624 MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f 677 MMXU4.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f
625 MMXU3.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f 678 MMXU4.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f
626 MMXU3.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f 679 MMXU4.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f
627 MMXU3.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f 680 MMXU4.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f
628 MMXU3.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f 681 MMXU4.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f
629 MMXU3.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f 682 MMXU4.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
630 MMXU3.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f 683 MMXU5.MX.TotW.mag.f
631 MMXU3.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f 684 MMXU5.MX.TotVAr.mag.f
632 MMXU3.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f 685 MMXU5.MX.TotVA.mag.f
633 MMXU3.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f 686 MMXU5.MX.TotPF.mag.f
634 MMXU3.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f 687 MMXU5.MX.Hz.mag.f
635 MMXU3.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f 688 MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f
636 MMXU3.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f 689 MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f
637 MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f 690 MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f
638 MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f 691 MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f
639 MMXU3.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f 692 MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f
640 MMXU3.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f 693 MMXU5.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f
641 MMXU3.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f 694 MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f
642 MMXU3.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f 695 MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f
643 MMXU3.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f 696 MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f
644 MMXU3.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f 697 MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f
645 MMXU3.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f 698 MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f
646 MMXU4.MX.TotW.mag.f 699 MMXU5.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f
647 MMXU4.MX.TotVAr.mag.f 700 MMXU5.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f
648 MMXU4.MX.TotVA.mag.f 701 MMXU5.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f
649 MMXU4.MX.TotPF.mag.f 702 MMXU5.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f
Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items
703 MMXU5.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f 756 MMXU6.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f
704 MMXU5.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f 757 GGIO4.MX.AnIn1.mag.f
705 MMXU5.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f 758 GGIO4.MX.AnIn2.mag.f
706 MMXU5.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f 759 GGIO4.MX.AnIn3.mag.f
707 MMXU5.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f 760 GGIO4.MX.AnIn4.mag.f
708 MMXU5.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f 761 GGIO4.MX.AnIn5.mag.f
709 MMXU5.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f 762 GGIO4.MX.AnIn6.mag.f B
710 MMXU5.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f 763 GGIO4.MX.AnIn7.mag.f
711 MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f 764 GGIO4.MX.AnIn8.mag.f
712 MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f 765 GGIO4.MX.AnIn9.mag.f
713 MMXU5.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f 766 GGIO4.MX.AnIn10.mag.f
714 MMXU5.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f 767 GGIO4.MX.AnIn11.mag.f
715 MMXU5.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f 768 GGIO4.MX.AnIn12.mag.f
716 MMXU5.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f 769 GGIO4.MX.AnIn13.mag.f
717 MMXU5.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f 770 GGIO4.MX.AnIn14.mag.f
718 MMXU5.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f 771 GGIO4.MX.AnIn15.mag.f
719 MMXU5.MX.PF.phsC.cVal.mag.f 772 GGIO4.MX.AnIn16.mag.f
720 MMXU6.MX.TotW.mag.f 773 GGIO4.MX.AnIn17.mag.f
721 MMXU6.MX.TotVAr.mag.f 774 GGIO4.MX.AnIn18.mag.f
722 MMXU6.MX.TotVA.mag.f 775 GGIO4.MX.AnIn19.mag.f
723 MMXU6.MX.TotPF.mag.f 776 GGIO4.MX.AnIn20.mag.f
724 MMXU6.MX.Hz.mag.f 777 GGIO4.MX.AnIn21.mag.f
725 MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.mag.f 778 GGIO4.MX.AnIn22.mag.f
726 MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsAB.cVal.ang.f 779 GGIO4.MX.AnIn23.mag.f
727 MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.mag.f 780 GGIO4.MX.AnIn24.mag.f
728 MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsBC.cVal.ang.f 781 GGIO4.MX.AnIn25.mag.f
729 MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.mag.f 782 GGIO4.MX.AnIn26.mag.f
730 MMXU6.MX.PPV.phsCA.cVal.ang.f 783 GGIO4.MX.AnIn27.mag.f
731 MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.mag.f 784 GGIO4.MX.AnIn28.mag.f
732 MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsA.cVal.ang.f 785 GGIO4.MX.AnIn29.mag.f
733 MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.mag.f 786 GGIO4.MX.AnIn30.mag.f
734 MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsB.cVal.ang.f 787 GGIO4.MX.AnIn31.mag.f
735 MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.mag.f 788 GGIO4.MX.AnIn32.mag.f
736 MMXU6.MX.PhV.phsC.cVal.ang.f 789 XSWI1.ST.Loc.stVal
737 MMXU6.MX.A.phsA.cVal.mag.f 790 XSWI1.ST.Pos.stVal
738 MMXU6.MX.A.phsA.cVal.ang.f 791 XSWI2.ST.Loc.stVal
739 MMXU6.MX.A.phsB.cVal.mag.f 792 XSWI2.ST.Pos.stVal
740 MMXU6.MX.A.phsB.cVal.ang.f 793 XSWI3.ST.Loc.stVal
741 MMXU6.MX.A.phsC.cVal.mag.f 794 XSWI3.ST.Pos.stVal
742 MMXU6.MX.A.phsC.cVal.ang.f 795 XSWI4.ST.Loc.stVal
743 MMXU6.MX.A.neut.cVal.mag.f 796 XSWI4.ST.Pos.stVal
744 MMXU6.MX.A.neut.cVal.ang.f 797 XSWI5.ST.Loc.stVal
745 MMXU6.MX.W.phsA.cVal.mag.f 798 XSWI5.ST.Pos.stVal
746 MMXU6.MX.W.phsB.cVal.mag.f 799 XSWI6.ST.Loc.stVal
747 MMXU6.MX.W.phsC.cVal.mag.f 800 XSWI6.ST.Pos.stVal
748 MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsA.cVal.mag.f 801 XSWI7.ST.Loc.stVal
749 MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsB.cVal.mag.f 802 XSWI7.ST.Pos.stVal
750 MMXU6.MX.VAr.phsC.cVal.mag.f 803 XSWI8.ST.Loc.stVal
751 MMXU6.MX.VA.phsA.cVal.mag.f 804 XSWI8.ST.Pos.stVal
752 MMXU6.MX.VA.phsB.cVal.mag.f 805 XSWI9.ST.Loc.stVal
753 MMXU6.MX.VA.phsC.cVal.mag.f 806 XSWI9.ST.Pos.stVal
754 MMXU6.MX.PF.phsA.cVal.mag.f 807 XSWI10.ST.Loc.stVal
755 MMXU6.MX.PF.phsB.cVal.mag.f 808 XSWI10.ST.Pos.stVal
Enumeration IEC 61850 report dataset items Enumeration GOOSE dataset items
809 XSWI11.ST.Loc.stVal 8 GGIO1.ST.Ind4.stVal
810 XSWI11.ST.Pos.stVal 9 GGIO1.ST.Ind5.q
811 XSWI12.ST.Loc.stVal 10 GGIO1.ST.Ind5.stVal
812 XSWI12.ST.Pos.stVal 11 GGIO1.ST.Ind6.q
813 XSWI13.ST.Loc.stVal 12 GGIO1.ST.Ind6.stVal
814 XSWI13.ST.Pos.stVal 13 GGIO1.ST.Ind7.q
B 815 XSWI14.ST.Loc.stVal 14 GGIO1.ST.Ind7.stVal
816 XSWI14.ST.Pos.stVal 15 GGIO1.ST.Ind8.q
817 XSWI15.ST.Loc.stVal 16 GGIO1.ST.Ind8.stVal
818 XSWI15.ST.Pos.stVal 17 GGIO1.ST.Ind9.q
819 XSWI16.ST.Loc.stVal 18 GGIO1.ST.Ind9.stVal
820 XSWI16.ST.Pos.stVal 19 GGIO1.ST.Ind10.q
821 XSWI17.ST.Loc.stVal 20 GGIO1.ST.Ind10.stVal
822 XSWI17.ST.Pos.stVal 21 GGIO1.ST.Ind11.q
823 XSWI18.ST.Loc.stVal 22 GGIO1.ST.Ind11.stVal
824 XSWI18.ST.Pos.stVal 23 GGIO1.ST.Ind12.q
825 XSWI19.ST.Loc.stVal 24 GGIO1.ST.Ind12.stVal
826 XSWI19.ST.Pos.stVal 25 GGIO1.ST.Ind13.q
827 XSWI20.ST.Loc.stVal 26 GGIO1.ST.Ind13.stVal
828 XSWI20.ST.Pos.stVal 27 GGIO1.ST.Ind14.q
829 XSWI21.ST.Loc.stVal 28 GGIO1.ST.Ind14.stVal
830 XSWI21.ST.Pos.stVal 29 GGIO1.ST.Ind15.q
831 XSWI22.ST.Loc.stVal 30 GGIO1.ST.Ind15.stVal
832 XSWI22.ST.Pos.stVal 31 GGIO1.ST.Ind16.q
833 XSWI23.ST.Loc.stVal 32 GGIO1.ST.Ind16.stVal
834 XSWI23.ST.Pos.stVal 33 GGIO1.ST.Ind17.q
835 XSWI24.ST.Loc.stVal 34 GGIO1.ST.Ind17.stVal
836 XSWI24.ST.Pos.stVal 35 GGIO1.ST.Ind18.q
837 XCBR1.ST.Loc.stVal 36 GGIO1.ST.Ind18.stVal
838 XCBR1.ST.Pos.stVal 37 GGIO1.ST.Ind19.q
839 XCBR2.ST.Loc.stVal 38 GGIO1.ST.Ind19.stVal
840 XCBR2.ST.Pos.stVal 39 GGIO1.ST.Ind20.q
841 XCBR3.ST.Loc.stVal 40 GGIO1.ST.Ind20.stVal
842 XCBR3.ST.Pos.stVal 41 GGIO1.ST.Ind21.q
843 XCBR4.ST.Loc.stVal 42 GGIO1.ST.Ind21.stVal
844 XCBR4.ST.Pos.stVal 43 GGIO1.ST.Ind22.q
845 XCBR5.ST.Loc.stVal 44 GGIO1.ST.Ind22.stVal
846 XCBR5.ST.Pos.stVal 45 GGIO1.ST.Ind23.q
847 XCBR6.ST.Loc.stVal 46 GGIO1.ST.Ind23.stVal
848 XCBR6.ST.Pos.stVal 47 GGIO1.ST.Ind24.q
48 GGIO1.ST.Ind24.stVal
49 GGIO1.ST.Ind25.q
F616
50 GGIO1.ST.Ind25.stVal
ENUMERATION: IEC 61850 GOOSE DATASET ITEMS
51 GGIO1.ST.Ind26.q
Enumeration GOOSE dataset items 52 GGIO1.ST.Ind26.stVal
0 None 53 GGIO1.ST.Ind27.q
1 GGIO1.ST.Ind1.q 54 GGIO1.ST.Ind27.stVal
2 GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal 55 GGIO1.ST.Ind28.q
3 GGIO1.ST.Ind2.q 56 GGIO1.ST.Ind28.stVal
4 GGIO1.ST.Ind2.stVal 57 GGIO1.ST.Ind29.q
5 GGIO1.ST.Ind3.q 58 GGIO1.ST.Ind29.stVal
6 GGIO1.ST.Ind3.stVal 59 GGIO1.ST.Ind30.q
7 GGIO1.ST.Ind4.q 60 GGIO1.ST.Ind30.stVal
The IEC 61850 standard is the result of electric utilities and vendors of electronic equipment to produce standardized com-
munications systems. IEC 61850 is a series of standards describing client/server and peer-to-peer communications, sub-
station design and configuration, testing, environmental and project standards. The complete set includes:
• IEC 61850-1: Introduction and overview
• IEC 61850-2: Glossary
• IEC 61850-3: General requirements
• IEC 61850-4: System and project management
• IEC 61850-5: Communications and requirements for functions and device models
•
•
IEC 61850-6: Configuration description language for communication in electrical substations related to IEDs
IEC 61850-7-1: Basic communication structure for substation and feeder equipment - Principles and models
C
• IEC 61850-7-2: Basic communication structure for substation and feeder equipment - Abstract communication service
interface (ACSI)
• IEC 61850-7-3: Basic communication structure for substation and feeder equipment – Common data classes
• IEC 61850-7-4: Basic communication structure for substation and feeder equipment – Compatible logical node classes
and data classes
• IEC 61850-8-1: Specific Communication Service Mapping (SCSM) – Mappings to MMS (ISO 9506-1 and ISO 9506-2)
and to ISO/IEC 8802-3
• IEC 61850-9-1: Specific Communication Service Mapping (SCSM) – Sampled values over serial unidirectional multi-
drop point to point link
• IEC 61850-9-2: Specific Communication Service Mapping (SCSM) – Sampled values over ISO/IEC 8802-3
• IEC 61850-10: Conformance testing
These documents can be obtained from the IEC (http://www.iec.ch). It is strongly recommended that all those involved with
any IEC 61850 implementation obtain this document set.
IEC 61850 specifies the use of the Manufacturing Message Specification (MMS) at the upper (application) layer for transfer
of real-time data. This protocol has been in existence for several of years and provides a set of services suitable for the
transfer of data within a substation LAN environment. Actual MMS protocol services are mapped to IEC 61850 abstract ser-
vices in IEC 61850-8-1.
The M60 relay supports IEC 61850 server services over both TCP/IP and TP4/CLNP (OSI) communication protocol stacks.
The TP4/CLNP profile requires the M60 to have a network address or Network Service Access Point (NSAP) to establish a
communication link. The TCP/IP profile requires the M60 to have an IP address to establish communications. These
addresses are located in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK menu. Note that the M60
supports IEC 61850 over the TP4/CLNP or TCP/IP stacks, and also operation over both stacks simultaneously. It is possi-
ble to have up to five simultaneous connections (in addition to DNP and Modbus/TCP (non-IEC 61850) connections).
• Client/server: This is a connection-oriented type of communication. The connection is initiated by the client, and com-
munication activity is controlled by the client. IEC 61850 clients are often substation computers running HMI programs
or SOE logging software. Servers are usually substation equipment such as protection relays, meters, RTUs, trans-
former tap changers, or bay controllers.
• Peer-to-peer: This is a non-connection-oriented, high speed type of communication usually between substation equip-
ment such as protection relays. GSSE and GOOSE are methods of peer-to-peer communication.
• Substation configuration language (SCL): A substation configuration language is a number of files used to describe
the configuration of substation equipment. Each configured device has an IEC Capability Description (ICD) file. The
substation single line information is stored in a System Specification Description (SSD) file. The entire substation con-
figuration is stored in a Substation Configuration Description (SCD) file. The SCD file is the combination of the individ-
ual ICD files and the SSD file.
The M60 supports file transfer by IEC 61850. The approach is as follows, using the SISCO AX-S4 61850 client software as
an example.
1. In the AX-S4 61850 Explorer window, click the Tools menu and access the SISCO File Transfer Utility.
2. Select the Remote AR Name from the drop-down list. Available files appear in the File Specification area on the right
side of the window.
3. With the Copy option active, select a file to transfer and click the Go button. The file is copied and displays in the
Local list on the left side of the window.
4. Repeat the process to transfer any other files.
Figure 0–1: FILE TRANSFER BY IEC 61850
C
IEC 61850 defines an object-oriented approach to data and services. An IEC 61850 physical device can contain one or
more logical device(s). Each logical device can contain many logical nodes. Each logical node can contain many data
objects. Each data object is composed of data attributes and data attribute components. Services are available at each
level for performing various functions, such as reading, writing, control commands, and reporting.
Each M60 IED represents one IEC 61850 physical device. The physical device contains one logical device, and the logical
device contains many logical nodes. The logical node LPHD1 contains information about the M60 IED physical device. The
logical node LLN0 contains information about the M60 IED logical device.
The GGIO1 logical node is available in the M60 to provide access to as many 128 digital status points and associated time-
stamps and quality flags. The data content must be configured before the data can be used. GGIO1 provides digital status C
points for access by clients.
It is intended that clients use GGIO1 in order to access digital status values from the M60. Configuration settings are pro-
vided to allow the selection of the number of digital status indications available in GGIO1 (8 to 128), and to allow the choice
of the M60 FlexLogic™ operands that drive the status of the GGIO1 status indications. Clients can utilize the IEC 61850
buffered and unbuffered reporting features available from GGIO1 in order to build sequence of events (SOE) logs and HMI
display screens. Buffered reporting should generally be used for SOE logs since the buffering capability reduces the
chances of missing data state changes. Unbuffered reporting should generally be used for local status display.
The GGIO2 logical node is available to provide access to the M60 virtual inputs. Virtual inputs are single-point control
(binary) values that can be written by clients. They are generally used as control inputs. GGIO2 provides access to the vir-
tual inputs through the IEC 61850 standard control model (ctlModel) services:
• Status only.
• Direct control with normal security.
• SBO control with normal security.
Configuration settings are available to select the control model for each point. Each virtual input used through GGIO2
should have its VIRTUAL INPUT 1(64) FUNCTION setting programmed as “Enabled” and its corresponding GGIO2 CF SPSCO1(64)
CTLMODEL setting programmed to the appropriate control configuration.
C.2.4 GGIO3: DIGITAL STATUS AND ANALOG VALUES FROM RECEIVED GOOSE DATA
The GGIO3 logical node is available to provide access for clients to values received via configurable GOOSE messages.
The values of the digital status indications and analog values in GGIO3 originate in GOOSE messages sent from other
devices.
The GGIO4 logical node provides access to as many as 32 analog value points, as well as associated timestamps and
quality flags. The data content must be configured before the data can be used. GGIO4 provides analog values for access
by clients.
It is intended that clients use GGIO4 to access generic analog values from the M60. Configuration settings allow the selec-
tion of the number of analog values available in GGIO4 (4 to 32) and the choice of the FlexAnalog™ values that determine
the value of the GGIO4 analog inputs. Clients can utilize polling or the IEC 61850 unbuffered reporting feature available
from GGIO4 in order to obtain the analog values provided by GGIO4.
A limited number of measured analog values are available through the MMXU logical nodes.
Each MMXU logical node provides data from a M60 current and voltage source. There is one MMXU available for each
configurable source (programmed in the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES menu). MMXU1 provides data
from M60 source 1, and MMXU2 provides data from M60 source 2.
MMXU data is provided in two forms: instantaneous and deadband. The instantaneous values are updated every time a
read operation is performed by a client. The deadband values are calculated as described in IEC 61850 parts 7-1 and 7-3.
The selection of appropriate deadband settings for the M60 is described in chapter 5 of this manual.
IEC 61850 buffered and unbuffered reporting capability is available in all MMXU logical nodes. MMXUx logical nodes pro-
vide the following data for each source:
C •
•
MMXU1.MX.TotW: three-phase real power
MMXU1.MX.TotVAr: three-phase reactive power
• MMXU1.MX.TotVA: three-phase apparent power
• MMXU1.MX.TotPF: three-phase power factor
• MMXU1.MX.Hz: frequency
• MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsAB: phase AB voltage magnitude and angle
• MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsBC: phase BC voltage magnitude and angle
• MMXU1.MX.PPV.phsCA: Phase CA voltage magnitude and angle
• MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsA: phase AG voltage magnitude and angle
• MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsB: phase BG voltage magnitude and angle
• MMXU1.MX.PhV.phsC: phase CG voltage magnitude and angle
• MMXU1.MX.A.phsA: phase A current magnitude and angle
• MMXU1.MX.A.phsB: phase B current magnitude and angle
• MMXU1.MX.A.phsC: phase C current magnitude and angle
• MMXU1.MX.A.neut: ground current magnitude and angle
• MMXU1.MX.W.phsA: phase A real power
• MMXU1.MX.W.phsB: phase B real power
• MMXU1.MX.W.phsC: phase C real power
• MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsA: phase A reactive power
• MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsB: phase B reactive power
• MMXU1.MX.VAr.phsC: phase C reactive power
• MMXU1.MX.VA.phsA: phase A apparent power
• MMXU1.MX.VA.phsB: phase B apparent power
• MMXU1.MX.VA.phsC: phase C apparent power
• MMXU1.MX.PF.phsA: phase A power factor
• MMXU1.MX.PF.phsB: phase B power factor
• MMXU1.MX.PF.phsC: phase C power factor
The following list describes the protection elements for all UR-series relays. The M60 relay will contain a subset of protec-
tion elements from this list.
• PDIF: bus differential, transformer instantaneous differential, transformer percent differential, current differential
IEC 61850 buffered and unbuffered reporting is provided in the GGIO1 logical nodes (for binary status values) and MMXU1
to MMXU6 (for analog measured values). Report settings can be configured using an IEC 61850 client, substation configu-
rator software, or via an IEC 61850 client. The following items can be configured:
• TrgOps: Trigger options. The following bits are supported by the M60:
– Bit 1: data-change
– Bit 4: integrity
– Bit 5: general interrogation
• OptFlds: Option Fields. The following bits are supported by the M60:
C –
–
Bit 1: sequence-number
Bit 2: report-time-stamp
– Bit 3: reason-for-inclusion
– Bit 4: data-set-name
– Bit 5: data-reference
– Bit 6: buffer-overflow (for buffered reports only)
– Bit 7: entryID (for buffered reports only)
– Bit 8: conf-revision
– Bit 9: segmentation
• IntgPd: Integrity period.
• BufTm: Buffer time.
MMS file services are supported to allow transfer of oscillography, event record, or other files from a M60 relay.
The timestamp values associated with all IEC 61850 data items represent the time of the last change of either the value or
quality flags of the data item. To accomplish this functionality, all IEC 61850 data items must be regularly scanned for data
changes, and the timestamp updated when a change is detected, regardless of the connection status of any IEC 61850 cli-
ents. For applications where there is no IEC 61850 client in use, the IEC 61850 SERVER SCANNING setting can be pro-
grammed as “Disabled”. If a client is in use, this setting should be programmed as “Enabled” to ensure the proper
generation of IEC 61850 timestamps.
The logical device name is used to identify the IEC 61850 logical device that exists within the M60. This name is composed
of two parts: the IED name setting and the logical device instance. The complete logical device name is the combination of
the two character strings programmed in the IEDNAME and LD INST settings. The default values for these strings are “IED-
Name” and “LDInst”. These values should be changed to reflect a logical naming convention for all IEC 61850 logical
devices in the system.
C.3.5 LOCATION
The LPHD1 logical node contains a data attribute called location (LPHD1.DC.PhyNam.location). This is a character string
meant to describe the physical location of the M60. This attribute is programmed through the LOCATION setting and its
default value is “Location”. This value should be changed to describe the actual physical location of the M60.
IEC 61850 specifies that each logical node can have a name with a total length of 11 characters. The name is composed of:
• A five or six-character name prefix.
• A four-character standard name (for example, MMXU, GGIO, PIOC, etc.).
• A one or two-character instantiation index.
Complete names are of the form xxxxxxPIOC1, where the xxxxxx character string is configurable. Details regarding the
logical node naming rules are given in IEC 61850 parts 6 and 7-2. It is recommended that a consistent naming convention
be used for an entire substation project.
A built-in TCP/IP connection timeout of two minutes is employed by the M60 to detect ‘dead’ connections. If there is no data
C
traffic on a TCP connection for greater than two minutes, the connection will be aborted by the M60. This frees up the con-
nection to be used by other clients. Therefore, when using IEC 61850 reporting, clients should configure report control
block items such that an integrity report will be issued at least every two minutes (120000 ms). This ensures that the M60
will not abort the connection. If other MMS data is being polled on the same connection at least once every two minutes,
this timeout will not apply.
The M60 relay makes available a number of non-IEC 61850 data items. These data items can be accessed through the
“UR” MMS domain. IEC 61850 data can be accessed through the standard IEC 61850 logical device. To access the non-
IEC data items, the INCLUDE NON-IEC DATA setting must be “Enabled”.
The exact structure and values of the supported IEC 61850 logical nodes can be seen by connecting to a M60 relay with an
MMS browser, such as the “MMS Object Explorer and AXS4-MMS” DDE/OPC server from Sisco Inc.
IEC 61850 specifies two types of peer-to-peer data transfer services: Generic Substation State Events (GSSE) and Generic
Object Oriented Substation Events (GOOSE). GSSE services are compatible with UCA 2.0 GOOSE. IEC 61850 GOOSE
services provide virtual LAN (VLAN) support, Ethernet priority tagging, and Ethertype Application ID configuration. The sup-
port for VLANs and priority tagging allows for the optimization of Ethernet network traffic. GOOSE messages can be given
a higher priority than standard Ethernet traffic, and they can be separated onto specific VLANs. Because of the additional
features of GOOSE services versus GSSE services, it is recommended that GOOSE be used wherever backwards com-
patibility with GSSE (or UCA 2.0 GOOSE) is not required.
Devices that transmit GSSE and/or GOOSE messages also function as servers. Each GSSE publisher contains a “GSSE
control block” to configure and control the transmission. Each GOOSE publisher contains a “GOOSE control block” to con-
figure and control the transmission. The transmission is also controlled via device settings. These settings can be seen in
the ICD and/or SCD files, or in the device configuration software or files.
C IEC 61850 recommends a default priority value of 4 for GOOSE. Ethernet traffic that does not contain a priority tag has a
default priority of 1. More details are specified in IEC 61850 part 8-1.
IEC 61850 recommends that the Ethertype Application ID number be configured according to the GOOSE source. In the
M60, the transmitted GOOSE Application ID number must match the configured receive Application ID number in the
receiver. A common number may be used for all GOOSE transmitters in a system. More details are specified in IEC 61850
part 8-1.
IEC 61850 Generic Substation Status Event (GSSE) communication is compatible with UCA GOOSE communication.
GSSE messages contain a number of double point status data items. These items are transmitted in two pre-defined data
structures named DNA and UserSt. Each DNA and UserSt item is referred to as a ‘bit pair’. GSSE messages are transmit-
ted in response to state changes in any of the data points contained in the message. GSSE messages always contain the
same number of DNA and UserSt bit pairs. Depending the on the configuration, only some of these bit pairs may have val-
ues that are of interest to receiving devices.
The GSSE FUNCTION, GSSE ID, and GSSE DESTINATION MAC ADDRESS settings are used to configure GSSE transmission.
GSSE FUNCTION is set to “Enabled” to enable the transmission. If a valid multicast Ethernet MAC address is entered for the
GSSE DESTINATION MAC ADDRESS setting, this address will be used as the destination MAC address for GSSE messages. If
a valid multicast Ethernet MAC address is not entered (for example, 00 00 00 00 00 00), the M60 will use the source Ether-
net MAC address as the destination, with the multicast bit set.
The M60 supports two types of IEC 61850 Generic Object Oriented Substation Event (GOOSE) communication: fixed
GOOSE and configurable GOOSE. All GOOSE messages contain IEC 61850 data collected into a dataset. It is this dataset
that is transferred using GOOSE message services. The dataset transferred using the M60 fixed GOOSE is the same data
that is transferred using the GSSE feature; that is, the DNA and UserSt bit pairs. The FlexLogic™ operands that determine
the state of the DNA and UserSt bit pairs are configurable via settings, but the fixed GOOSE dataset always contains the
same DNA/UserSt data structure. Upgrading from GSSE to GOOSE services is simply a matter of enabling fixed GOOSE
and disabling GSSE. The remote inputs and outputs are configured in the same manner for both GSSE and fixed GOOSE.
It is recommended that the fixed GOOSE be used for implementations that require GOOSE data transfer between UR-
series IEDs. Configurable GOOSE may be used for implementations that require GOOSE data transfer between UR-series
IEDs and devices from other manufacturers.
The configurable GOOSE feature allows for the configuration of the datasets to be transmitted or received from the M60.
The M60 supports the configuration of eight transmission and reception datasets, allowing for the optimization of data
transfer between devices.
Items programmed for dataset 1 and 2 will have changes in their status transmitted as soon as the change is detected.
Dataset 1 should be used for high-speed transmission of data that is required for applications such as transfer tripping,
blocking, and breaker fail initiate. At least one digital status value needs to be configured in dataset 1 to enable transmis-
sion of all data configured for dataset 1. Configuring analog data only to dataset 1 will not activate transmission.
Items programmed for datasets 3 through 8 will have changes in their status transmitted at a maximum rate of every
100 ms. Datasets 3 through 8 will regularly analyze each data item configured within them every 100 ms to identify if any
changes have been made. If any changes in the data items are detected, these changes will be transmitted through a
GOOSE message. If there are no changes detected during this 100 ms period, no GOOSE message will be sent.
For all datasets 1 through 8, the integrity GOOSE message will still continue to be sent at the pre-configured rate even if no
changes in the data items are detected.
The GOOSE functionality was enhanced to prevent the relay from flooding a communications network with GOOSE mes-
sages due to an oscillation being created that is triggering a message.
The M60 has the ability of detecting if a data item in one of the GOOSE datasets is erroneously oscillating. This can be C
caused by events such as errors in logic programming, inputs improperly being asserted and de-asserted, or failed station
components. If erroneously oscillation is detected, the M60 will stop sending GOOSE messages from the dataset for a min-
imum period of one second. Should the oscillation persist after the one second time-out period, the M60 will continue to
block transmission of the dataset. The M60 will assert the MAINTENANCE ALERT: GGIO Ind XXX oscill self-test error mes-
sage on the front panel display, where XXX denotes the data item detected as oscillating.
The configurable GOOSE feature is recommended for applications that require GOOSE data transfer between UR-series
IEDs and devices from other manufacturers. Fixed GOOSE is recommended for applications that require GOOSE data
transfer between UR-series IEDs.
IEC 61850 GOOSE messaging contains a number of configurable parameters, all of which must be correct to achieve the
successful transfer of data. It is critical that the configured datasets at the transmission and reception devices are an exact
match in terms of data structure, and that the GOOSE addresses and name strings match exactly. Manual configuration is
possible, but third-party substation configuration software may be used to automate the process. The EnerVista UR Setup-
software can produce IEC 61850 ICD files and import IEC 61850 SCD files produced by a substation configurator (refer to
the IEC 61850 IED Configuration section later in this appendix).
The following example illustrates the configuration required to transfer IEC 61850 data items between two devices. The
general steps required for transmission configuration are:
1. Configure the transmission dataset.
2. Configure the GOOSE service settings.
3. Configure the data.
The general steps required for reception configuration are:
1. Configure the reception dataset.
2. Configure the GOOSE service settings.
3. Configure the data.
This example shows how to configure the transmission and reception of three IEC 61850 data items: a single point status
value, its associated quality flags, and a floating point analog value.
The following procedure illustrates the transmission configuration.
1. Configure the transmission dataset by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION
IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION TRANSMISSION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE
GOOSE 1 CONFIG GSE 1 DATASET ITEMS settings menu:
– Set ITEM 1 to “GGIO1.ST.Ind1.q” to indicate quality flags for GGIO1 status indication 1.
– Set ITEM 2 to “GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal” to indicate the status value for GGIO1 status indication 1.
The transmission dataset now contains a set of quality flags and a single point status Boolean value. The reception
dataset on the receiving device must exactly match this structure.
2. Configure the GOOSE service settings by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION
IEC 61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION TRANSMISSION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGU-
RABLE GOOSE 1 settings menu:
–
settings menu:
Set GGIO1 INDICATION 1 to a FlexLogic™ operand used to provide the status of GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal (for example,
a contact input, virtual input, a protection element status, etc.).
The M60 must be rebooted (control power removed and re-applied) before these settings take effect.
The following procedure illustrates the reception configuration.
1. Configure the reception dataset by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATION IEC
61850 PROTOCOL GSSE/GOOSE CONFIGURATION RECEPTION CONFIGURABLE GOOSE CONFIGURABLE GOOSE
1 CONFIG GSE 1 DATASET ITEMS settings menu:
– Set ITEM 1 to “GGIO3.ST.Ind1.q” to indicate quality flags for GGIO3 status indication 1.
– Set ITEM 2 to “GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal” to indicate the status value for GGIO3 status indication 1.
The reception dataset now contains a set of quality flags, a single point status Boolean value, and a floating point ana-
log value. This matches the transmission dataset configuration above.
2. Configure the GOOSE service settings by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE DEVICES
REMOTE DEVICE 1 settings menu:
– Set REMOTE DEVICE 1 ID to match the GOOSE ID string for the transmitting device. Enter “GOOSEOut_1”.
– Set REMOTE DEVICE 1 ETYPE APPID to match the Ethertype application ID from the transmitting device. This is “0” in
the example above.
– Set the REMOTE DEVICE 1 DATASET value. This value represents the dataset number in use. Since we are using
configurable GOOSE 1 in this example, program this value as “GOOSEIn 1”.
3. Configure the data by making the following changes in the INPUTS/OUTPUTS REMOTE INPUTS REMOTE INPUT 1
settings menu:
– Set REMOTE IN 1 DEVICE to “GOOSEOut_1”.
– Set REMOTE IN 1 ITEM to “Dataset Item 2”. This assigns the value of the GGIO3.ST.Ind1.stVal single point status
item to remote input 1.
Remote input 1 can now be used in FlexLogic™ equations or other settings. The M60 must be rebooted (control power
removed and re-applied) before these settings take effect.
The value of remote input 1 (Boolean on or off) in the receiving device will be determined by the GGIO1.ST.Ind1.stVal value
in the sending device. The above settings will be automatically populated by the EnerVista UR Setup software when a com-
plete SCD file is created by third party substation configurator software.
Ethernet capable devices each contain a unique identifying address called a Media Access Control (MAC) address. This
address cannot be changed and is unique for each Ethernet device produced worldwide. The address is six bytes in length
and is usually represented as six hexadecimal values (for example, 00 A0 F4 01 02 03). It is used in all Ethernet frames as
the ‘source’ address of the frame. Each Ethernet frame also contains a destination address. The destination address can
be different for each Ethernet frame depending on the intended destination of the frame.
A special type of destination address called a multicast address is used when the Ethernet frame can be received by more
than one device. An Ethernet MAC address is multicast when the least significant bit of the first byte is set (for example, 01
00 00 00 00 00 is a multicast address).
GSSE and GOOSE messages must have multicast destination MAC addresses.
By default, the M60 is configured to use an automated multicast MAC scheme. If the M60 destination MAC address setting
is not a valid multicast address (that is, the least significant bit of the first byte is not set), the address used as the destina-
tion MAC will be the same as the local MAC address, but with the multicast bit set. Thus, if the local MAC address is 00 A0
F4 01 02 03, then the destination MAC address will be 01 A0 F4 01 02 03.
GSSE messages contain an identifier string used by receiving devices to identify the sender of the message, defined in IEC
61850 part 8-1 as GsID. This is a programmable 65-character string. This string should be chosen to provide a descriptive
name of the originator of the GSSE message.
C
GOOSE messages contain an identifier string used by receiving devices to identify the sender of the message, defined in
IEC 61850 part 8-1 as GoID. This programmable 65-character string should be a descriptive name of the originator of the
GOOSE message. GOOSE messages also contain two additional character strings used for identification of the message:
DatSet - the name of the associated dataset, and GoCBRef - the reference (name) of the associated GOOSE control block.
These strings are automatically populated and interpreted by the M60; no settings are required.
The M60 can be configured for IEC 61850 via the EnerVista UR Setup software as follows.
1. An ICD file is generated for the M60 by the EnerVista UR Setup software that describe the capabilities of the IED.
2. The ICD file is then imported into a system configurator along with other ICD files for other IEDs (from GE or other ven-
dors) for system configuration.
3. The result is saved to a SCD file, which is then imported back to EnerVista UR Setup to create one or more settings
file(s). The settings file(s) can then be used to update the relay(s) with the new configuration information.
The configuration process is illustrated below.
C
Creating ICD (GE Multilin)
Import
System
specification data SSD file
System specification tool
System configurator
System Configuration
(network, cross-
communications, IED setting
modification, etc.)
SCD file
EnerVista UR Setup
Ethernet
842790A1.CDR
Before creating an ICD file, the user can customize the IEC 61850 related settings for the IED. For example, the IED name
and logical device instance can be specified to uniquely identify the IED within the substation, or transmission GOOSE
datasets created so that the system configurator can configure the cross-communication links to send GOOSE messages
from the IED. Once the IEC 61850 settings are configured, the ICD creation process will recognize the changes and gener-
ate an ICD file that contains the updated settings.
Some of the IED settings will be modified during they system configuration process. For example, a new IP address may be
assigned, line items in a Transmission GOOSE dataset may be added or deleted, or prefixes of some logical nodes may be
changed. While all new configurations will be mapped to the M60 settings file when importing an SCD file, all unchanged
settings will preserve the same values in the new settings file.
These settings can be configured either directly through the relay panel or through the EnerVista UR Setup software (pre-
ferred method). The full list of IEC 61850 related settings for are as follows:
• Network configuration: IP address, IP subnet mask, and default gateway IP address (access through the Settings >
Product Setup > Communications > Network menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
• Server configuration: IED name and logical device instance (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Com-
munications > IEC 61850 > Server Configuration menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
• Logical node prefixes, which includes prefixes for all logical nodes except LLN0 (access through the Settings > Prod-
uct Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > Logical Node Prefixes menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
• MMXU deadbands, which includes deadbands for all available MMXUs. The number of MMXUs is related to the num-
ber of CT/VT modules in the relay. There are two MMXUs for each CT/VT module. For example, if a relay contains two
CT/VT modules, there will be four MMXUs available (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communica-
tions > IEC 61850 > MMXU Deadbands menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
• GGIO1 status configuration, which includes the number of status points in GGIO1 as well as the potential internal map-
pings for each GGIO1 indication. However only the number of status points will be used in the ICD creation process
(access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GGIO1 Status Configuration
menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
• GGIO2 control configuration, which includes ctlModels for all SPCSOs within GGIO2 (access through the Settings >
Product Setup > Communications > IEC 61850 > GGIO2 Control Configuration menu tree in EnerVista UR
Setup).
• Configurable transmission GOOSE, which includes eight configurable datasets that can be used for GOOSE transmis-
C sion. The GOOSE ID can be specified for each dataset (it must be unique within the IED as well as across the whole
substation), as well as the destination MAC address, VLAN priority, VLAN ID, ETYPE APPID, and the dataset items.
The selection of the dataset item is restricted by firmware version; for version 5.9x, only GGIO1.ST.Indx.stVal and
GGIO1.ST.Indx.q are valid selection (where x is between 1 to N, and N is determined by number of GGIO1 status
points). Although configurable transmission GOOSE can also be created and altered by some third-party system con-
figurators, we recommend configuring transmission GOOSE for GE Multilin IEDs before creating the ICD, and strictly
within EnerVista UR Setup software or the front panel display (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Com-
munications > IEC 61850 > GSSE/GOOSE Configuration > Transmission > Tx Configurable GOOSE menu tree
in EnerVista UR Setup).
• Configurable reception GOOSE, which includes eight configurable datasets that can be used for GOOSE reception.
However, unlike datasets for transmission, datasets for reception only contains dataset items, and they are usually cre-
ated automatically by process of importing the SCD file (access through the Settings > Product Setup > Communi-
cations > IEC 61850 > GSSE/GOOSE Configuration > Reception > Rx Configurable GOOSE menu tree in
EnerVista UR Setup).
• Remote devices configuration, which includes remote device ID (GOOSE ID or GoID of the incoming transmission
GOOSE dataset), ETYPE APPID (of the GSE communication block for the incoming transmission GOOSE), and
DATASET (which is the name of the associated reception GOOSE dataset). These settings are usually done automat-
ically by process of importing SCD file (access through the Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Remote Devices menu tree
in EnerVista UR Setup).
• Remote inputs configuration, which includes device (remote device ID) and item (which dataset item in the associated
reception GOOSE dataset to map) values. Only the items with cross-communication link created in SCD file should be
mapped. These configurations are usually done automatically by process of importing SCD file (access through the
Settings > Inputs/Outputs > Remote Inputs menu tree in EnerVista UR Setup).
The SCL language is based on XML, and its syntax definition is described as a W3C XML Schema. ICD is one type of SCL
file (which also includes SSD, CID and SCD files). The ICD file describes the capabilities of an IED and consists of four
major sections:
• Header
• Communication
• IEDs
• DataTypeTemplates
The root file structure of an ICD file is illustrated below.
SCL
Communication
DataTypeTemplates
Communication
SubNetwork (name)
Address
P (type)
Text
Other P elements
Address
P (type)
Text
Services
AccessPoint (name)
Server
C Authentication (none)
LDevice (inst)
DataSet (name)
DOI (name)
DataSet (name)
DOI (name)
The DataTypeTemplates node defines instantiable logical node types. A logical node type is an instantiable template of the
data of a logical node. A LnodeType is referenced each time that this instantiable type is needed with an IED. A logical
node type template is built from DATA (DO) elements, which again have a DO type, which is derived from the DATA classes
(CDC). DOs consist of attributes (DA) or of elements of already defined DO types (SDO). The attribute (DA) has a func-
tional constraint, and can either have a basic type, be an enumeration, or a structure of a DAType. The DAType is built from
BDA elements, defining the structure elements, which again can be BDA elements of have a base type such as DA.
DataTypeTemplates
C
DO (name, type)
Other DO elements
DAType (id)
EnumType (id)
An ICD file can be created directly from a connected M60 IED or from an offline M60 settings file with the EnerVista UR
Setup software using the following procedure:
1. Right-click the connected UR-series relay or settings file and select Create ICD File.
2. The EnerVista UR Setup will prompt to save the file. Select the file path and enter the name for the ICD file, then click
OK to generate the file.
The time to create an ICD file from the offline M60 settings file is typically much quicker than create an ICD file directly from
the relay.
System configuration is performed in the system configurator. While many vendors (including GE Multilin) are working their
own system configuration tools, there are some system configurators available in the market (for example, Siemens DIGSI
version 4.6 or above and ASE Visual SCL Beta 0.12).
Although the configuration tools vary from one vendor to another, the procedure is pretty much the same. First, a substation
project must be created, either as an empty template or with some system information by importing a system specification
file (SSD). Then, IEDs are added to the substation. Since each IED is represented by its associated ICD, the ICD files are
imported into the substation project, and the system configurator validates the ICD files during the importing process. If the
ICD files are successfully imported into the substation project, it may be necessary to perform some additional minor steps
to attach the IEDs to the substation (see the system configurator manual for details).
Once all IEDs are inserted into the substation, further configuration is possible, such as:
• Assigning network addresses to individual IEDs.
• Customizing the prefixes of logical nodes.
• Creating cross-communication links (configuring GOOSE messages to send from one IED to others).
When system configurations are complete, the results are saved to an SCD file, which contains not only the configuration
for each IED in the substation, but also the system configuration for the entire substation. Finally, the SCD file is passed
back to the IED configurator (vendor specific tool) to update the new configuration into the IED.
The SCD file consists of at least five major sections:
• Header.
• Substation.
• Communication.
• IED section (one or more).
• DataTypeTemplates.
The root file structure of an SCD file is illustrated below.
SCL
C
Header (id, version, revision, toolID, nameStructure)
Substation
Communication
DataTypeTemplates
842791A1.CDR
Substation
PowerSystemResource
GeneralEquipment
EquipmentContainer
C
VoltageLevel Bay
Voltage
PowerSystemResource
Function SubFunction
GeneralEquipment
842792A1.CDR
Communication
SubNetwork (name)
ConnectedAP (IED 1)
Address
P (type)
Text
C
Other P elements
Address
P (type)
Other P elements
ConnectedAP (IED 2)
Address
P (type)
Text
Other P elements
Address
P (type)
Text
Other P elements
Other GSE elements
AccessPoint (name)
Server
Authentication (none)
LDevice (inst)
C DataSet elements
ReportControl elements
DOI elements
Inputs
GSEControl elements
842794A1.CDR
The following procedure describes how to update the M60 with the new configuration from an SCD file with the EnerVista
UR Setup software.
1. Right-click anywhere in the files panel and select the Import Contents From SCD File item.
c1: shall be "M" if support for LOGICAL-DEVICE model has been declared
O: Optional
127( M: Mandatory
c2: shall be "M" if support for LOGICAL-NODE model has been declared
c3: shall be "M" if support for DATA model has been declared
127( c4: shall be "M" if support for DATA-SET, Substitution, Report, Log Control, or Time models has been declared
c5: shall be "M" if support for Report, GSE, or SMV models has been declared
M: Mandatory
In the table below, the acronym AA refers to Application Associations (TP: Two Party / MC: Multicast). The c6 to c10 entries
are defined in the notes following the table.
The UR-series of relays supports IEC 61850 logical nodes as indicated in the following table. Note that the actual instantia-
tion of each logical node is determined by the product order code. For example. the logical node “PDIS” (distance protec-
tion) is available only in the D60 Line Distance Relay.
This document is adapted from the IEC 60870-5-104 standard. For this section the boxes indicate the following: – used
in standard direction; – not used; – cannot be selected in IEC 60870-5-104 standard.
1. SYSTEM OR DEVICE:
System Definition
Controlling Station Definition (Master)
Controlled Station Definition (Slave)
2. NETWORK CONFIGURATION:
Point-to-Point Multipoint
Multiple Point-to-Point Multipoint Star
3. PHYSICAL LAYER
Transmission Speed (control direction):
Unbalanced Interchange Unbalanced Interchange Balanced Interchange Circuit
Circuit V.24/V.28 Standard: Circuit V.24/V.28 Recommended X.24/X.27:
if >1200 bits/s: D
100 bits/sec. 2400 bits/sec. 2400 bits/sec.
200 bits/sec. 4800 bits/sec. 4800 bits/sec.
300 bits/sec. 9600 bits/sec. 9600 bits/sec.
600 bits/sec. 19200 bits/sec.
1200 bits/sec. 38400 bits/sec.
56000 bits/sec.
64000 bits/sec.
Transmission Speed (monitor direction):
Unbalanced Interchange Unbalanced Interchange Balanced Interchange Circuit
Circuit V.24/V.28 Standard: Circuit V.24/V.28 Recommended X.24/X.27:
if >1200 bits/s:
100 bits/sec. 2400 bits/sec. 2400 bits/sec.
200 bits/sec. 4800 bits/sec. 4800 bits/sec.
300 bits/sec. 9600 bits/sec. 9600 bits/sec.
600 bits/sec. 19200 bits/sec.
1200 bits/sec. 38400 bits/sec.
56000 bits/sec.
64000 bits/sec.
4. LINK LAYER
Link Transmission Procedure: Address Field of the Link:
Balanced Transmission Not Present (Balanced Transmission Only)
Unbalanced Transmission One Octet
Two Octets
Structured
Unstructured
Frame Length (maximum length, number of octets): Not selectable in companion IEC 60870-5-104 standard
When using an unbalanced link layer, the following Application Service Data Unit (ASDU) types are returned in class 2
messages (low priority) with the indicated causes of transmission:
The standard assignment of ASDUs to class 2 messages is used as follows:
5. APPLICATION LAYER
Transmission Mode for Application Data:
Mode 1 (least significant octet first), as defined in Clause 4.10 of IEC 60870-5-4, is used exclusively in this companion
stanadard.
Common Address of ASDU:
One Octet
Two Octets
Information Object Address:
One Octet Structured
Either the ASDUs of the set <2>, <4>, <6>, <8>, <10>, <12>, <14>, <16>, <17>, <18>, and <19> or of the set
<30> to <40> are used.
Process information in control direction
<45> := Single command C_SC_NA_1
D
<46> := Double command C_DC_NA_1
<47> := Regulating step command C_RC_NA_1
<48> := Set point command, normalized value C_SE_NA_1
<49> := Set point command, scaled value C_SE_NB_1
<50> := Set point command, short floating point value C_SE_NC_1
<51> := Bitstring of 32 bits C_BO_NA_1
Either the ASDUs of the set <45> to <51> or of the set <58> to <64> are used.
System information in monitor direction
<70> := End of initialization M_EI_NA_1
File transfer
<120> := File Ready F_FR_NA_1
<121> := Section Ready F_SR_NA_1
<122> := Call directory, select file, call file, call section F_SC_NA_1
<123> := Last section, last segment F_LS_NA_1
<124> := Ack file, ack section F_AF_NA_1
<125> := Segment F_SG_NA_1
<126> := Directory (blank or X, available only in monitor [standard] direction) C_CD_NA_1
ACTIVATION TERMINATION
REQUEST OR REQUESTED
BACKGROUND SCAN
PERIODIC, CYCLIC
FILE TRANSFER
SPONTANEOUS
DEACTIVATION
ACTIVATION
INITIALIZED
20 37
NO. MNEMONIC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 to to 44 45 46 47
36 41
<1> M_SP_NA_1 X X X X X
<2> M_SP_TA_1
<3> M_DP_NA_1
<4> M_DP_TA_1
<5> M_ST_NA_1
<6> M_ST_TA_1
<7> M_BO_NA_1
<8> M_BO_TA_1
<9> M_ME_NA_1
ACTIVATION TERMINATION
BACKGROUND SCAN
PERIODIC, CYCLIC
FILE TRANSFER
SPONTANEOUS
DEACTIVATION
ACTIVATION
INITIALIZED
20 37
NO. MNEMONIC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 to to 44 45 46 47
36 41
<10> M_ME_TA_1 D
<11> M_ME_NB_1
<12> M_ME_TB_1
<13> M_ME_NC_1 X X X X
<14> M_ME_TC_1
<15> M_IT_NA_1 X X
<16> M_IT_TA_1
<17> M_EP_TA_1
<18> M_EP_TB_1
<19> M_EP_TC_1
<20> M_PS_NA_1
<21> M_ME_ND_1
<30> M_SP_TB_1 X X X
<31> M_DP_TB_1
<32> M_ST_TB_1
<33> M_BO_TB_1
<34> M_ME_TD_1
<35> M_ME_TE_1
<36> M_ME_TF_1
<37> M_IT_TB_1 X X
<38> M_EP_TD_1
<39> M_EP_TE_1
<40> M_EP_TF_1
<45> C_SC_NA_1 X X X X X
<46> C_DC_NA_1
<47> C_RC_NA_1
<48> C_SE_NA_1
<49> C_SE_NB_1
<50> C_SE_NC_1
<51> C_BO_NA_1
<58> C_SC_TA_1 X X X X X
<59> C_DC_TA_1
<60> C_RC_TA_1
ACTIVATION TERMINATION
BACKGROUND SCAN
PERIODIC, CYCLIC
FILE TRANSFER
SPONTANEOUS
DEACTIVATION
ACTIVATION
INITIALIZED
20 37
NO. MNEMONIC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 to to 44 45 46 47
36 41
D <61>
<62>
C_SE_TA_1
C_SE_TB_1
<63> C_SE_TC_1
<64> C_BO_TA_1
<70> M_EI_NA_1*) X
<100> C_IC_NA_1 X X X X X
<101> C_CI_NA_1 X X X
<102> C_RD_NA_1 X
<103> C_CS_NA_1 X X X
<104> C_TS_NA_1
<105> C_RP_NA_1 X X
<106> C_CD_NA_1
<107> C_TS_TA_1
<110> P_ME_NA_1
<111> P_ME_NB_1
<112> P_ME_NC_1 X X X
<113> P_AC_NA_1
<120> F_FR_NA_1
<121> F_SR_NA_1
<122> F_SC_NA_1
<123> F_LS_NA_1
<124> F_AF_NA_1
<125> F_SG_NA_1
<126> F_DR_TA_1*)
Spontaneous Transmission:
Spontaneous transmission
Double transmission of information objects with cause of transmission spontaneous:
The following type identifications may be transmitted in succession caused by a single status change of an information
object. The particular information object addresses for which double transmission is enabled are defined in a project-
specific list.
Single point information: M_SP_NA_1, M_SP_TA_1, M_SP_TB_1, and M_PS_NA_1
Double point information: M_DP_NA_1, M_DP_TA_1, and M_DP_TB_1
Step position information: M_ST_NA_1, M_ST_TA_1, and M_ST_TB_1
Bitstring of 32 bits: M_BO_NA_1, M_BO_TA_1, and M_BO_TB_1 (if defined for a specific project)
Measured value, normalized value: M_ME_NA_1, M_ME_TA_1, M_ME_ND_1, and M_ME_TD_1
Measured value, scaled value: M_ME_NB_1, M_ME_TB_1, and M_ME_TE_1
Measured value, short floating point number: M_ME_NC_1, M_ME_TC_1, and M_ME_TF_1
Station interrogation:
Global D
Group 1 Group 5 Group 9 Group 13
Group 2 Group 6 Group 10 Group 14
Group 3 Group 7 Group 11 Group 15
Group 4 Group 8 Group 12 Group 16
Clock synchronization:
Clock synchronization (optional, see Clause 7.6)
Command transmission:
Direct command transmission
Direct setpoint command transmission
Select and execute command
Select and execute setpoint command
C_SE ACTTERM used
No additional definition
Short pulse duration (duration determined by a system parameter in the outstation)
Long pulse duration (duration determined by a system parameter in the outstation)
Persistent output
Counter read
Counter freeze without reset
APPENDIX E DNP COMMUNICATIONSE.1DEVICE PROFILE DOCUMENT E.1.1 DNP V3.00 DEVICE PROFILE
The following table provides a ‘Device Profile Document’ in the standard format defined in the DNP 3.0 Subset Definitions
Document.
Notable objects, functions, and/or qualifiers supported in addition to the Highest DNP Levels Supported (the complete
list is described in the attached table):
Binary Inputs (Object 1)
Binary Input Changes (Object 2)
Binary Outputs (Object 10)
Control Relay Output Block (Object 12)
Binary Counters (Object 20)
E
Frozen Counters (Object 21)
Counter Change Event (Object 22)
Frozen Counter Event (Object 23)
Analog Inputs (Object 30)
Analog Input Changes (Object 32)
Analog Deadbands (Object 34)
Time and Date (Object 50)
File Transfer (Object 70)
Internal Indications (Object 80)
Maximum Data Link Frame Size (octets): Maximum Application Fragment Size (octets):
Transmitted: 292 Transmitted: configurable up to 2048
Received: 292 Received: 2048
Others:
Transmission Delay: No intentional delay
Need Time Interval: Configurable (default = 24 hrs.)
Select/Operate Arm Timeout: 10 s
Binary input change scanning period: 8 times per power system cycle
Analog input change scanning period: 500 ms
Explanation of ‘Sometimes’: Object 12 points are mapped to UR Virtual Inputs. The persistence of Virtual Inputs is
determined by the VIRTUAL INPUT X TYPE settings. Both “Pulse On” and “Latch On” operations perform the same func-
tion in the UR; that is, the appropriate Virtual Input is put into the “On” state. If the Virtual Input is set to “Self-Reset”,
it will reset after one pass of FlexLogic™. The On/Off times and Count value are ignored. “Pulse Off” and “Latch Off”
operations put the appropriate Virtual Input into the “Off” state. “Trip” and “Close” operations both put the appropriate
Virtual Input into the “On” state.
Reports Binary Input Change Events when no Reports time-tagged Binary Input Change Events when no
specific variation requested: specific variation requested:
Never Never
Only time-tagged Binary Input Change With Time
Only non-time-tagged Binary Input Change With Relative Time
Configurable Configurable (attach explanation)
The following table identifies the variations, function codes, and qualifiers supported by the M60 in both request messages
and in response messages. For static (non-change-event) objects, requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be
responded with qualifiers 00 or 01. Static object requests sent with qualifiers 17 or 28 will be responded with qualifiers 17 or
28. For change-event objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.
3 Binary Input Change with Relative Time 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
10 0 Binary Output Status (Variation 0 is used to 1 (read) 00, 01(start-stop)
request default variation) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
2 Binary Output Status 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) (see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
12 1 Control Relay Output Block 3 (select) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) echo of request
4 (operate) 07, 08 (limited quantity)
5 (direct op) 17, 28 (index)
6 (dir. op, noack)
20 0 Binary Counter 1 (read) 00, 01(start-stop)
(Variation 0 is used to request default 7 (freeze) 06(no range, or all)
variation) 8 (freeze noack) 07, 08(limited quantity)
9 (freeze clear) 17, 28(index)
10 (frz. cl. noack)
22 (assign class)
1 32-Bit Binary Counter 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
7 (freeze) 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index)
8 (freeze noack) 07, 08 (limited quantity) (see Note 2)
9 (freeze clear) 17, 28 (index)
10 (frz. cl. noack)
22 (assign class)
Note 1: A default variation refers to the variation responded when variation 0 is requested and/or in class 0, 1, 2, or 3 scans. The default varia-
tions for object types 1, 2, 20, 21, 22, 23, 30, and 32 are selected via relay settings. Refer to the Communications section in Chapter 5
for details. This optimizes the class 0 poll data size.
Note 2: For static (non-change-event) objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are only responded when a request is sent with qualifiers 17 or 28, respec-
tively. Otherwise, static object requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be responded with qualifiers 00 or 01 (for change-
event objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.)
Note 3: Cold restarts are implemented the same as warm restarts – the M60 is not restarted, but the DNP process is restarted.
The DNP binary input data points are configured through the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT
LISTS BINARY INPUT / MSP POINTS menu. Refer to the Communications section of Chapter 5 for additional details. When a
freeze function is performed on a binary counter point, the frozen value is available in the corresponding frozen counter
point.
Supported Control Relay Output Block fields: Pulse On, Pulse Off, Latch On, Latch Off, Paired Trip, Paired Close.
E.2.3 COUNTERS
The following table lists both Binary Counters (Object 20) and Frozen Counters (Object 21). When a freeze function is per-
formed on a Binary Counter point, the frozen value is available in the corresponding Frozen Counter point.
BINARY COUNTERS
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 20
Change Event Object Number: 22
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read), 7 (freeze), 8 (freeze noack), 9 (freeze and clear),
10 (freeze and clear, noack), 22 (assign class)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Binary Counter with Flag)
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Counter Change Event without time)
Change Event Buffer Size: 10
Default Class for all points: 3
FROZEN COUNTERS
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 21
Change Event Object Number: 23
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Frozen Counter with Flag)
E Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Frozen Counter Event without time)
Change Event Buffer Size: 10
Default Class for all points: 3
A counter freeze command has no meaning for counters 8 and 9. M60 Digital Counter values are represented as 32-bit
integers. The DNP 3.0 protocol defines counters to be unsigned integers. Care should be taken when interpreting negative
counter values.
The DNP analog input data points are configured through the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP / IEC104 POINT
LISTS ANALOG INPUT / MME POINTS menu. Refer to the Communications section of Chapter 5 for additional details.
It is important to note that 16-bit and 32-bit variations of analog inputs are transmitted through DNP as signed numbers.
Even for analog input points that are not valid as negative values, the maximum positive representation is 32767 for 16-bit
values and 2147483647 for 32-bit values. This is a DNP requirement.
The deadbands for all Analog Input points are in the same units as the Analog Input quantity. For example, an Analog Input
quantity measured in volts has a corresponding deadband in units of volts. This is in conformance with DNP Technical Bul-
letin 9809-001: Analog Input Reporting Deadband. Relay settings are available to set default deadband values according to
data type. Deadbands for individual Analog Input Points can be set using DNP Object 34.
3- 3- Update Updated Typical Wiring Diagram at CPU module, CPU Module Communications Wiring figure,
and Options for IRIG-B Connection figure
3-13 3-13 Add Added Figure 3-15 Typical Wiring with Remote RTD Unit
5-136 5-136 Update Updated Figure 5-64 Thermal Model Logic diagram as per specification
--- 9- Add Added Theory of Operation chapter in order to add Saturation Detector section
B-9 B-9 Update Updated MODBUS MEMORY MAP section and data format codes
F ---
---
xiii
---
Add
Add
Added battery disposal information as chapter 0
Added EAC compliance information throughout, including logo on title page, rear panel, added
specifications, added life expectancy and decommissioning, added sections on Uninstall and
Clear Files and Data, Repairs, Storage, and Disposal
--- --- Add Added the 10/100Base-T connection to CPU modules 9J and 9K as of November 2014 (product
change)
3-18 3-18 Update Updated Figure 3-17 Contact Input and Output Module Wiring to include surge on module 67
3-24 3-24 Update Updated section 3.2.9 CPU Communication Ports section
3-24 3-24 Update Updated RS485 PORTS section
3-27 3-27 Update Updated Figure 3-26 Options for IRIG-B Connection
4-23 4-23 Delete Deleted Standard Faceplate section on how to customize LED and blank panels. Clear Lexan
front cover (part number 1501-0014) no longer being sold. Units with blank LED panels no longer
being sold.
--- 3-42 Update Added INITIAL SETUP OF THE ETHERNET SWITCH MODULE section
C-3 C-3 Update Updated PROTECTION AND OTHER LOGICAL NODES section
For products shipped as of 1 October 2013, GE Grid Solutions warrants most of its GE manufactured products for 10 years.
For warranty details including any limitations and disclaimers, see the GE Grid Solutions Terms and Conditions at
https://www.gegridsolutions.com/multilin/warranty.htm
For products shipped before 1 October 2013, the standard 24-month warranty applies.
Index
F
E F485 ................................................................................ 1-18
FACEPLATE ............................................................... 3-1, 3-4
EGD PROTOCOL FACEPLATE PANELS ...................................................... 4-15
actual values .......................................................... 6-9, 6-10 FAST FORM-C RELAY ..................................................... 2-19
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-40 FAST TRANSIENT TESTING ............................................ 2-23
settings ......................................................................... 5-38 FAX NUMBERS .................................................................. 1-2
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE ....................................... 2-23 FEATURES ........................................................................ 2-1
ELEMENTS ....................................................................... 5-4 FILE TRANSFER BY IEC 61850 ......................................... C-2
END OF LIFE ................................................................... 11-4 FILES
ENERGY METERING delete ............................................................................ 11-1
actual values ................................................................. 6-19 FIRMWARE REVISION ..................................................... 6-28
Modbus registers ........................................................... B-14 FIRMWARE UPGRADES .................................................... 4-2
specifications ................................................................ 2-17 FLA ................................................................................. 5-75
ENERGY METERING, CLEARING ............................. 5-14, 7-2 FLASH MEMORY ............................................................. 11-1
FLASH MEMORY DATA STORAGE ................................... 3-15
FLASH MESSAGES .......................................................... 5-13
W
Z
WARNINGS ....................................................................... 1-1
WARRANTY .......................................................................F-6 ZERO SEQUENCE CORE BALANCE .................................3-16